xref: /freebsd/contrib/llvm-project/clang/lib/Sema/SemaExpr.cpp (revision 3fd796204fe6aa2e8a2b70bb9ea95f7497247fa3)
1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 //  This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "CheckExprLifetime.h"
14 #include "TreeTransform.h"
15 #include "UsedDeclVisitor.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTDiagnostic.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/OperationKinds.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/Type.h"
33 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
34 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
35 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticSema.h"
36 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
37 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
38 #include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
39 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
40 #include "clang/Basic/TypeTraits.h"
41 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
42 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
45 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
46 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
47 #include "clang/Sema/EnterExpressionEvaluationContext.h"
48 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
49 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
50 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
51 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
52 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
53 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
54 #include "clang/Sema/SemaARM.h"
55 #include "clang/Sema/SemaCUDA.h"
56 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
57 #include "clang/Sema/SemaHLSL.h"
58 #include "clang/Sema/SemaObjC.h"
59 #include "clang/Sema/SemaOpenMP.h"
60 #include "clang/Sema/SemaPseudoObject.h"
61 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
62 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
63 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
64 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h"
65 #include "llvm/Support/SaveAndRestore.h"
66 #include "llvm/Support/TimeProfiler.h"
67 #include "llvm/Support/TypeSize.h"
68 #include <limits>
69 #include <optional>
70 
71 using namespace clang;
72 using namespace sema;
73 
CanUseDecl(NamedDecl * D,bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid)74 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid) {
75   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
76   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
77     return false;
78 
79   // See if this is a deleted function.
80   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
81     if (FD->isDeleted())
82       return false;
83 
84     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
85     // then we can't use it either.
86     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
87         DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false))
88       return false;
89 
90     // See if this is an aligned allocation/deallocation function that is
91     // unavailable.
92     if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid &&
93         isUnavailableAlignedAllocationFunction(*FD))
94       return false;
95   }
96 
97   // See if this function is unavailable.
98   if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable &&
99       cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
100     return false;
101 
102   if (isa<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(D))
103     return false;
104 
105   return true;
106 }
107 
DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema & S,NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc)108 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
109   // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
110   if (const auto *A = D->getAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
111     // [[maybe_unused]] should not diagnose uses, but __attribute__((unused))
112     // should diagnose them.
113     if (A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::CXX11_maybe_unused &&
114         A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::C23_maybe_unused) {
115       const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.ObjC().getCurObjCLexicalContext());
116       if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
117         S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D;
118     }
119   }
120 }
121 
NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl * Decl)122 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) {
123   assert(Decl && Decl->isDeleted());
124 
125   if (Decl->isDefaulted()) {
126     // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration.
127     if (!Decl->isImplicit())
128       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted);
129 
130     // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly
131     // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies.
132     DiagnoseDeletedDefaultedFunction(Decl);
133     return;
134   }
135 
136   auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl);
137   if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor())
138     return NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(Ctor);
139 
140   Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here)
141     << Decl << 1;
142 }
143 
144 /// Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an
145 /// explicit storage class.
hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl * D)146 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) {
147   for (auto *I : D->redecls()) {
148     if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None)
149       return true;
150   }
151   return false;
152 }
153 
154 /// Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a
155 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3).
156 ///
157 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but
158 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode
159 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6)
160 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't
161 /// prove that there are errors.
diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema & S,const NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc)162 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S,
163                                                       const NamedDecl *D,
164                                                       SourceLocation Loc) {
165   // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in
166   // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically
167   // correct but benign.
168   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
169     return;
170 
171   // Check if this is an inlined function or method.
172   FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl();
173   if (!Current)
174     return;
175   if (!Current->isInlined())
176     return;
177   if (!Current->isExternallyVisible())
178     return;
179 
180   // Check if the decl has internal linkage.
181   if (D->getFormalLinkage() != Linkage::Internal)
182     return;
183 
184   // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if
185   //  (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file,
186   //      and probably won't be included anywhere else.
187   //  (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function.
188   //  (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function.
189   // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on
190   // wrappers for simple C library functions.
191   const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
192   bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc);
193   if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn)
194     DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>();
195 
196   S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet
197                                : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline)
198     << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D;
199 
200   S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current);
201 
202   S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
203       << D;
204 }
205 
MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl * Cur)206 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) {
207   const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl();
208 
209   // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible.
210   if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) {
211     SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin();
212     Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static)
213       << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static ");
214   }
215 }
216 
DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl * D,ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * UnknownObjCClass,bool ObjCPropertyAccess,bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks,ObjCInterfaceDecl * ClassReceiver,bool SkipTrailingRequiresClause)217 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs,
218                              const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
219                              bool ObjCPropertyAccess,
220                              bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks,
221                              ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver,
222                              bool SkipTrailingRequiresClause) {
223   SourceLocation Loc = Locs.front();
224   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
225     // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
226     // emit them now.
227     auto Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
228     if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
229       for (const auto &[DiagLoc, PD] : Pos->second) {
230         DiagnosticBuilder Builder(Diags.Report(DiagLoc, PD.getDiagID()));
231         PD.Emit(Builder);
232       }
233       // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
234       // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
235       // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
236       // diagnostics again.
237       Pos->second.clear();
238     }
239 
240     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3:
241     //   The function 'main' shall not be used within a program.
242     if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain())
243       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used);
244 
245     diagnoseUnavailableAlignedAllocation(*cast<FunctionDecl>(D), Loc);
246   }
247 
248   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
249   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
250     if (isa<BindingDecl>(D)) {
251       Diag(Loc, diag::err_binding_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
252         << D->getDeclName();
253     } else {
254       Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
255           << diag::ParsingInitFor::Var << D->getDeclName()
256           << cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType();
257     }
258     return true;
259   }
260 
261   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
262     // See if this is a deleted function.
263     if (FD->isDeleted()) {
264       auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD);
265       if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor())
266         Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_inherited_ctor_use)
267             << Ctor->getParent()
268             << Ctor->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()->getParent();
269       else {
270         StringLiteral *Msg = FD->getDeletedMessage();
271         Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use)
272             << (Msg != nullptr) << (Msg ? Msg->getString() : StringRef());
273       }
274       NoteDeletedFunction(FD);
275       return true;
276     }
277 
278     // [expr.prim.id]p4
279     //   A program that refers explicitly or implicitly to a function with a
280     //   trailing requires-clause whose constraint-expression is not satisfied,
281     //   other than to declare it, is ill-formed. [...]
282     //
283     // See if this is a function with constraints that need to be satisfied.
284     // Check this before deducing the return type, as it might instantiate the
285     // definition.
286     if (!SkipTrailingRequiresClause && FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
287       ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
288       if (CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc,
289                                    /*ForOverloadResolution*/ true))
290         // A diagnostic will have already been generated (non-constant
291         // constraint expression, for example)
292         return true;
293       if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
294         Diag(Loc,
295              diag::err_reference_to_function_with_unsatisfied_constraints)
296             << D;
297         DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
298         return true;
299       }
300     }
301 
302     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
303     // then we can't use it either.
304     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
305         DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc))
306       return true;
307 
308     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !CUDA().CheckCall(Loc, FD))
309       return true;
310 
311   }
312 
313   if (auto *Concept = dyn_cast<ConceptDecl>(D);
314       Concept && CheckConceptUseInDefinition(Concept, Loc))
315     return true;
316 
317   if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
318     // Lambdas are only default-constructible or assignable in C++2a onwards.
319     if (MD->getParent()->isLambda() &&
320         ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) &&
321           cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)->isDefaultConstructor()) ||
322          MD->isCopyAssignmentOperator() || MD->isMoveAssignmentOperator())) {
323       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_cxx17_compat_lambda_def_ctor_assign)
324         << !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD);
325     }
326   }
327 
328   auto getReferencedObjCProp = [](const NamedDecl *D) ->
329                                       const ObjCPropertyDecl * {
330     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
331       return MD->findPropertyDecl();
332     return nullptr;
333   };
334   if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = getReferencedObjCProp(D)) {
335     if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(ObjCPDecl, Loc))
336       return true;
337   } else if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(D, Loc)) {
338       return true;
339   }
340 
341   // [OpenMP 4.0], 2.15 declare reduction Directive, Restrictions
342   // Only the variables omp_in and omp_out are allowed in the combiner.
343   // Only the variables omp_priv and omp_orig are allowed in the
344   // initializer-clause.
345   auto *DRD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(CurContext);
346   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DRD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) &&
347       isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
348     Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_wrong_var_in_declare_reduction)
349         << getCurFunction()->HasOMPDeclareReductionCombiner;
350     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D;
351     return true;
352   }
353 
354   // [OpenMP 5.0], 2.19.7.3. declare mapper Directive, Restrictions
355   //  List-items in map clauses on this construct may only refer to the declared
356   //  variable var and entities that could be referenced by a procedure defined
357   //  at the same location.
358   // [OpenMP 5.2] Also allow iterator declared variables.
359   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
360       !OpenMP().isOpenMPDeclareMapperVarDeclAllowed(cast<VarDecl>(D))) {
361     Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_declare_mapper_wrong_var)
362         << OpenMP().getOpenMPDeclareMapperVarName();
363     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D;
364     return true;
365   }
366 
367   if (const auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(D)) {
368     Diag(Loc, diag::err_use_of_empty_using_if_exists);
369     Diag(EmptyD->getLocation(), diag::note_empty_using_if_exists_here);
370     return true;
371   }
372 
373   DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(D, Locs, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess,
374                              AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, ClassReceiver);
375 
376   DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc);
377 
378   diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc);
379 
380   if (D->hasAttr<AvailableOnlyInDefaultEvalMethodAttr>()) {
381     if (getLangOpts().getFPEvalMethod() !=
382             LangOptions::FPEvalMethodKind::FEM_UnsetOnCommandLine &&
383         PP.getLastFPEvalPragmaLocation().isValid() &&
384         PP.getCurrentFPEvalMethod() != getLangOpts().getFPEvalMethod())
385       Diag(D->getLocation(),
386            diag::err_type_available_only_in_default_eval_method)
387           << D->getName();
388   }
389 
390   if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D))
391     checkTypeSupport(VD->getType(), Loc, VD);
392 
393   if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice ||
394       (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsTargetDevice)) {
395     if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported())
396       if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
397         if (VD->getTLSKind() != VarDecl::TLS_None)
398           targetDiag(*Locs.begin(), diag::err_thread_unsupported);
399   }
400 
401   return false;
402 }
403 
DiagnoseSentinelCalls(const NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args)404 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(const NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
405                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
406   const SentinelAttr *Attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
407   if (!Attr)
408     return;
409 
410   // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
411   unsigned NumFormalParams;
412 
413   // The kind of declaration.  This is also an index into a %select in
414   // the diagnostic.
415   enum { CK_Function, CK_Method, CK_Block } CalleeKind;
416 
417   if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
418     NumFormalParams = MD->param_size();
419     CalleeKind = CK_Method;
420   } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
421     NumFormalParams = FD->param_size();
422     CalleeKind = CK_Function;
423   } else if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
424     QualType Ty = VD->getType();
425     const FunctionType *Fn = nullptr;
426     if (const auto *PtrTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>()) {
427       Fn = PtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
428       if (!Fn)
429         return;
430       CalleeKind = CK_Function;
431     } else if (const auto *PtrTy = Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
432       Fn = PtrTy->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
433       CalleeKind = CK_Block;
434     } else {
435       return;
436     }
437 
438     if (const auto *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn))
439       NumFormalParams = proto->getNumParams();
440     else
441       NumFormalParams = 0;
442   } else {
443     return;
444   }
445 
446   // "NullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
447   // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments.  This is
448   // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
449   // but the language forces you to have at least one.
450   unsigned NullPos = Attr->getNullPos();
451   assert((NullPos == 0 || NullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
452   NumFormalParams = (NullPos > NumFormalParams ? 0 : NumFormalParams - NullPos);
453 
454   // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
455   unsigned NumArgsAfterSentinel = Attr->getSentinel();
456 
457   // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
458   // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
459   if (Args.size() < NumFormalParams + NumArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
460     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
461     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(CalleeKind);
462     return;
463   }
464 
465   // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
466   const Expr *SentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - NumArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
467   if (!SentinelExpr)
468     return;
469   if (SentinelExpr->isValueDependent())
470     return;
471   if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(SentinelExpr))
472     return;
473 
474   // Pick a reasonable string to insert.  Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr',
475   // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context.  Only use
476   // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
477   // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
478   SourceLocation MissingNilLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(SentinelExpr->getEndLoc());
479   std::string NullValue;
480   if (CalleeKind == CK_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil"))
481     NullValue = "nil";
482   else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
483     NullValue = "nullptr";
484   else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL"))
485     NullValue = "NULL";
486   else
487     NullValue = "(void*) 0";
488 
489   if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
490     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(CalleeKind);
491   else
492     Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
493         << int(CalleeKind)
494         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
495   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here)
496       << int(CalleeKind) << Attr->getRange();
497 }
498 
getExprRange(Expr * E) const499 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
500   return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
501 }
502 
503 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
504 //  Standard Promotions and Conversions
505 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
506 
507 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr * E,bool Diagnose)508 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) {
509   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
510   if (E->hasPlaceholderType()) {
511     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
512     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
513     E = result.get();
514   }
515 
516   QualType Ty = E->getType();
517   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
518 
519   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
520     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
521       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
522         if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, Diagnose, E->getExprLoc()))
523           return ExprError();
524 
525     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
526                           CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
527   } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
528     // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
529     // an lvalue.  The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
530     // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
531     // to type'...".  In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
532     // that has type 'array of type' ...".  The relevant change is "an lvalue"
533     // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
534     //
535     // C++ 4.2p1:
536     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
537     // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
538     //
539     if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) {
540       ExprResult Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
541                                          CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
542       if (Res.isInvalid())
543         return ExprError();
544       E = Res.get();
545     }
546   }
547   return E;
548 }
549 
CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema & S,Expr * E)550 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
551   // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer.  If so,
552   // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
553   // optimizer will delete, so warn about it.  People sometimes try to use this
554   // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior.  This
555   // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
556   const auto *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
557   if (UO && UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
558       UO->getSubExpr()->getType()->isPointerType()) {
559     const LangAS AS =
560         UO->getSubExpr()->getType()->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
561     if ((!isTargetAddressSpace(AS) ||
562          (isTargetAddressSpace(AS) && toTargetAddressSpace(AS) == 0)) &&
563         UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
564             S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
565         !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
566       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
567                             S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
568                                 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
569       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
570                             S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
571     }
572   }
573 }
574 
DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema & S,const ObjCIvarRefExpr * OIRE,SourceLocation AssignLoc,const Expr * RHS)575 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE,
576                                     SourceLocation AssignLoc,
577                                     const Expr* RHS) {
578   const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl();
579   if (!IV)
580     return;
581 
582   DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName();
583   IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
584   if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa"))
585     return;
586 
587   const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase();
588   QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
589   if (OIRE->isArrow())
590     BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType();
591   if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
592     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) {
593       ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr;
594       ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
595       if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass()
596           && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) {
597         if (RHS) {
598           NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass =
599             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
600                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
601                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
602           if (ObjectSetClass) {
603             SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getEndLoc());
604             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign)
605                 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(),
606                                               "object_setClass(")
607                 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
608                        SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), AssignLoc), ",")
609                 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
610           }
611           else
612             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
613         } else {
614           NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass =
615             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
616                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
617                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
618           if (ObjectGetClass)
619             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use)
620                 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(),
621                                               "object_getClass(")
622                 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
623                        SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), OIRE->getEndLoc()), ")");
624           else
625             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
626         }
627         S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl);
628       }
629     }
630 }
631 
DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr * E)632 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
633   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
634   if (E->hasPlaceholderType()) {
635     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
636     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
637     E = result.get();
638   }
639 
640   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
641   //   A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
642   //   converted to a prvalue.
643   if (!E->isGLValue()) return E;
644 
645   QualType T = E->getType();
646   assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
647 
648   // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion cannot be applied to types that decay to
649   // pointers (i.e. function or array types).
650   if (T->canDecayToPointerType())
651     return E;
652 
653   // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
654   // expressions of certain types in C++.
655   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
656     if (T == Context.OverloadTy || T->isRecordType() ||
657         (T->isDependentType() && !T->isAnyPointerType() &&
658          !T->isMemberPointerType()))
659       return E;
660   }
661 
662   // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
663   // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why.  It's
664   // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
665   // lvalue-to-rvalue at all.  Note that expressions of unqualified
666   // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
667   if (T->isVoidType())
668     return E;
669 
670   // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type.
671   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
672       !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", getLangOpts()) &&
673       T->isHalfType()) {
674     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store)
675       << 0 << T;
676     return ExprError();
677   }
678 
679   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
680   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
681     NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
682                                      &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
683                                      SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
684     if (ObjectGetClass)
685       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use)
686           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getBeginLoc(), "object_getClass(")
687           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
688                  SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")");
689     else
690       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
691   }
692   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
693             dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
694     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr);
695 
696   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
697   //   [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
698   //   cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
699   //   rvalue is T.
700   //
701   // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
702   //   If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
703   //   version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
704   //   type of the lvalue.
705   if (T.hasQualifiers())
706     T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
707 
708   // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
709   if (T->isMemberPointerType() &&
710       Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
711     (void)isCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), T);
712 
713   ExprResult Res = CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(E);
714   if (Res.isInvalid())
715     return Res;
716   E = Res.get();
717 
718   // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to
719   // balance that.
720   if (E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
721     Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
722 
723   if (E->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
724     Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
725 
726   if (!BoundsSafetyCheckUseOfCountAttrPtr(Res.get()))
727     return ExprError();
728 
729   // C++ [conv.lval]p3:
730   //   If T is cv std::nullptr_t, the result is a null pointer constant.
731   CastKind CK = T->isNullPtrType() ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_LValueToRValue;
732   Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK, E, nullptr, VK_PRValue,
733                                  CurFPFeatureOverrides());
734 
735   // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
736   //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
737   //   of the type of the lvalue ...
738   if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) {
739     T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType();
740     Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(),
741                                    nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride());
742   }
743 
744   return Res;
745 }
746 
DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr * E,bool Diagnose)747 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) {
748   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E, Diagnose);
749   if (Res.isInvalid())
750     return ExprError();
751   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
752   if (Res.isInvalid())
753     return ExprError();
754   return Res;
755 }
756 
CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr * E)757 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
758   QualType Ty = E->getType();
759   ExprResult Res = E;
760   // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer
761   // to function type.
762   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
763     Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
764                             CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
765     if (Res.isInvalid())
766       return ExprError();
767   }
768   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
769   if (Res.isInvalid())
770     return ExprError();
771   return Res.get();
772 }
773 
774 /// UsualUnaryFPConversions - Promotes floating-point types according to the
775 /// current language semantics.
UsualUnaryFPConversions(Expr * E)776 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryFPConversions(Expr *E) {
777   QualType Ty = E->getType();
778   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryFPConversions - missing type");
779 
780   LangOptions::FPEvalMethodKind EvalMethod = CurFPFeatures.getFPEvalMethod();
781   if (EvalMethod != LangOptions::FEM_Source && Ty->isFloatingType() &&
782       (getLangOpts().getFPEvalMethod() !=
783            LangOptions::FPEvalMethodKind::FEM_UnsetOnCommandLine ||
784        PP.getLastFPEvalPragmaLocation().isValid())) {
785     switch (EvalMethod) {
786     default:
787       llvm_unreachable("Unrecognized float evaluation method");
788       break;
789     case LangOptions::FEM_UnsetOnCommandLine:
790       llvm_unreachable("Float evaluation method should be set by now");
791       break;
792     case LangOptions::FEM_Double:
793       if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(Context.DoubleTy, Ty) > 0)
794         // Widen the expression to double.
795         return Ty->isComplexType()
796                    ? ImpCastExprToType(E,
797                                        Context.getComplexType(Context.DoubleTy),
798                                        CK_FloatingComplexCast)
799                    : ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast);
800       break;
801     case LangOptions::FEM_Extended:
802       if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(Context.LongDoubleTy, Ty) > 0)
803         // Widen the expression to long double.
804         return Ty->isComplexType()
805                    ? ImpCastExprToType(
806                          E, Context.getComplexType(Context.LongDoubleTy),
807                          CK_FloatingComplexCast)
808                    : ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.LongDoubleTy,
809                                        CK_FloatingCast);
810       break;
811     }
812   }
813 
814   // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
815   if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
816     return ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
817 
818   return E;
819 }
820 
821 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
822 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
823 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
824 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
825 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
UsualUnaryConversions(Expr * E)826 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
827   // First, convert to an r-value.
828   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
829   if (Res.isInvalid())
830     return ExprError();
831 
832   // Promote floating-point types.
833   Res = UsualUnaryFPConversions(Res.get());
834   if (Res.isInvalid())
835     return ExprError();
836   E = Res.get();
837 
838   QualType Ty = E->getType();
839   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
840 
841   // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
842   // promotable type.
843   if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
844     // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
845     //
846     //   The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
847     //   unsigned int may be used:
848     //     - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
849     //       conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
850     //       and unsigned int.
851     //     - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
852     //
853     //   If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
854     //   value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
855     //   unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
856     //   other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
857 
858     QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
859     if (!PTy.isNull()) {
860       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
861       return E;
862     }
863     if (Context.isPromotableIntegerType(Ty)) {
864       QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
865       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get();
866       return E;
867     }
868   }
869   return E;
870 }
871 
872 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
873 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16
874 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by
875 /// UsualUnaryConversions().
DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr * E)876 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
877   QualType Ty = E->getType();
878   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
879 
880   ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
881   if (Res.isInvalid())
882     return ExprError();
883   E = Res.get();
884 
885   // If this is a 'float'  or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef)
886   // promote to double.
887   // Note that default argument promotion applies only to float (and
888   // half/fp16); it does not apply to _Float16.
889   const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
890   if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half ||
891               BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) {
892     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
893         !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp64", getLangOpts())) {
894       if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half) {
895         E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
896       }
897     } else {
898       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
899     }
900   }
901   if (BTy &&
902       getLangOpts().getExtendIntArgs() ==
903           LangOptions::ExtendArgsKind::ExtendTo64 &&
904       Context.getTargetInfo().supportsExtendIntArgs() && Ty->isIntegerType() &&
905       Context.getTypeSizeInChars(BTy) <
906           Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Context.LongLongTy)) {
907     E = (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerType())
908             ? ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy, CK_IntegralCast)
909                   .get()
910             : ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.LongLongTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
911     assert(8 == Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Context.LongLongTy).getQuantity() &&
912            "Unexpected typesize for LongLongTy");
913   }
914 
915   // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
916   // promotion, even on class types, but note:
917   //   C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
918   //     When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
919   //     operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
920   //     referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
921   //     has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
922   //     of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
923   //     is a prvalue for the temporary.
924   // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
925   // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
926   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
927     ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
928                        InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
929                                                 E->getExprLoc(), E);
930     if (Temp.isInvalid())
931       return ExprError();
932     E = Temp.get();
933   }
934 
935   // C++ [expr.call]p7, per CWG722:
936   //   An argument that has (possibly cv-qualified) type std::nullptr_t is
937   //   converted to void* ([conv.ptr]).
938   // (This does not apply to C23 nullptr)
939   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->getType()->isNullPtrType())
940     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.VoidPtrTy, CK_NullToPointer).get();
941 
942   return E;
943 }
944 
isValidVarArgType(const QualType & Ty)945 VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) {
946   if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) {
947     // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
948     //   After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic,
949     //   enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program
950     //   is ill-formed.
951     //
952     // Since we've already performed null pointer conversion, array-to-pointer
953     // decay and function-to-pointer decay, the only such type in C++ is cv
954     // void. This also handles initializer lists as variadic arguments.
955     if (Ty->isVoidType())
956       return VarArgKind::Invalid;
957 
958     if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
959       return VarArgKind::Invalid;
960     return VarArgKind::Valid;
961   }
962 
963   if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
964     return VarArgKind::Invalid;
965 
966   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm() &&
967       Ty.isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) {
968     return VarArgKind::Invalid;
969   }
970 
971   if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context))
972     return VarArgKind::Valid;
973 
974   // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
975   //   Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
976   //   having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
977   //   or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
978   //   is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
979   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType())
980     if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
981       if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
982           !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
983           !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
984         return VarArgKind::ValidInCXX11;
985 
986   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType())
987     return VarArgKind::Valid;
988 
989   if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
990     return VarArgKind::Invalid;
991 
992   if (getLangOpts().HLSL && Ty->getAs<HLSLAttributedResourceType>())
993     return VarArgKind::Valid;
994 
995   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
996     return VarArgKind::MSVCUndefined;
997 
998   if (getLangOpts().HLSL && Ty->getAs<HLSLAttributedResourceType>())
999     return VarArgKind::Valid;
1000 
1001   // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're
1002   // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so.
1003   return VarArgKind::Undefined;
1004 }
1005 
checkVariadicArgument(const Expr * E,VariadicCallType CT)1006 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) {
1007   // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
1008   const QualType &Ty = E->getType();
1009   VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty);
1010 
1011   // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs.
1012   switch (VAK) {
1013   case VarArgKind::ValidInCXX11:
1014     DiagRuntimeBehavior(
1015         E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
1016         PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) << Ty << CT);
1017     [[fallthrough]];
1018   case VarArgKind::Valid:
1019     if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
1020       // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a
1021       // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that.
1022       DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
1023                           PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg)
1024                               << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()");
1025     }
1026     break;
1027 
1028   case VarArgKind::Undefined:
1029   case VarArgKind::MSVCUndefined:
1030     DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
1031                         PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
1032                             << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT);
1033     break;
1034 
1035   case VarArgKind::Invalid:
1036     if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
1037       Diag(E->getBeginLoc(),
1038            diag::err_cannot_pass_non_trivial_c_struct_to_vararg)
1039           << Ty << CT;
1040     else if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
1041       DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr,
1042                           PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
1043                               << Ty << CT);
1044     else
1045       Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg)
1046           << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT;
1047     break;
1048   }
1049 }
1050 
DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr * E,VariadicCallType CT,FunctionDecl * FDecl)1051 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
1052                                                   FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
1053   if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
1054     // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
1055     if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
1056         (CT == VariadicCallType::Method ||
1057          (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) {
1058       E = ObjC().stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
1059 
1060       // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking.
1061     } else {
1062       ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
1063       if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
1064         return ExprError();
1065       E = ExprRes.get();
1066     }
1067   }
1068 
1069   ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
1070   if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
1071     return ExprError();
1072 
1073   // Copy blocks to the heap.
1074   if (ExprRes.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
1075     maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprRes);
1076 
1077   E = ExprRes.get();
1078 
1079   // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are
1080   // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall().
1081   if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VarArgKind::Undefined) {
1082     // Turn this into a trap.
1083     CXXScopeSpec SS;
1084     SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
1085     UnqualifiedId Name;
1086     Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
1087                        E->getBeginLoc());
1088     ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, Name,
1089                                           /*HasTrailingLParen=*/true,
1090                                           /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false);
1091     if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
1092       return ExprError();
1093 
1094     ExprResult Call = BuildCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), E->getBeginLoc(), {},
1095                                     E->getEndLoc());
1096     if (Call.isInvalid())
1097       return ExprError();
1098 
1099     ExprResult Comma =
1100         ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getBeginLoc(), tok::comma, Call.get(), E);
1101     if (Comma.isInvalid())
1102       return ExprError();
1103     return Comma.get();
1104   }
1105 
1106   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1107       RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(),
1108                           diag::err_call_incomplete_argument))
1109     return ExprError();
1110 
1111   return E;
1112 }
1113 
1114 /// Convert complex integers to complex floats and real integers to
1115 /// real floats as required for complex arithmetic. Helper function of
1116 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
1117 ///
1118 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
1119 /// successfully converted to the (complex) float type.
handleComplexIntegerToFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & IntExpr,ExprResult & ComplexExpr,QualType IntTy,QualType ComplexTy,bool SkipCast)1120 static bool handleComplexIntegerToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
1121                                                   ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
1122                                                   QualType IntTy,
1123                                                   QualType ComplexTy,
1124                                                   bool SkipCast) {
1125   if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
1126   if (SkipCast) return false;
1127   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
1128     QualType fpTy = ComplexTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
1129     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
1130   } else {
1131     assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
1132     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
1133                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
1134   }
1135   return false;
1136 }
1137 
1138 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
1139 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
1140 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
1141 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
1142 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
1143 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
1144 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
1145 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
1146 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
1147 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & Shorter,QualType ShorterType,QualType LongerType,bool PromotePrecision)1148 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &Shorter,
1149                                              QualType ShorterType,
1150                                              QualType LongerType,
1151                                              bool PromotePrecision) {
1152   bool LongerIsComplex = isa<ComplexType>(LongerType.getCanonicalType());
1153   QualType Result =
1154       LongerIsComplex ? LongerType : S.Context.getComplexType(LongerType);
1155 
1156   if (PromotePrecision) {
1157     if (isa<ComplexType>(ShorterType.getCanonicalType())) {
1158       Shorter =
1159           S.ImpCastExprToType(Shorter.get(), Result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
1160     } else {
1161       if (LongerIsComplex)
1162         LongerType = LongerType->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
1163       Shorter = S.ImpCastExprToType(Shorter.get(), LongerType, CK_FloatingCast);
1164     }
1165   }
1166   return Result;
1167 }
1168 
1169 /// Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types.  Helper function of
1170 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleComplexConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1171 static QualType handleComplexConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1172                                         ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1173                                         QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1174   // Handle (complex) integer types.
1175   if (!handleComplexIntegerToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1176                                              /*SkipCast=*/false))
1177     return LHSType;
1178   if (!handleComplexIntegerToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1179                                              /*SkipCast=*/IsCompAssign))
1180     return RHSType;
1181 
1182   // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex.
1183   int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1184   if (Order < 0)
1185     // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment.
1186     return handleComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1187                                         /*PromotePrecision=*/!IsCompAssign);
1188   // Promote the precision of the RHS unless it is already the same as the LHS.
1189   return handleComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1190                                       /*PromotePrecision=*/Order > 0);
1191 }
1192 
1193 /// Handle arithmetic conversion from integer to float.  Helper function
1194 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & FloatExpr,ExprResult & IntExpr,QualType FloatTy,QualType IntTy,bool ConvertFloat,bool ConvertInt)1195 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
1196                                            ExprResult &IntExpr,
1197                                            QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
1198                                            bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
1199   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
1200     if (ConvertInt)
1201       // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
1202       IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy,
1203                                     CK_IntegralToFloating);
1204     return FloatTy;
1205   }
1206 
1207   // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
1208   assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
1209   QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
1210 
1211   // _Complex int -> _Complex float
1212   if (ConvertInt)
1213     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result,
1214                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
1215 
1216   // float -> _Complex float
1217   if (ConvertFloat)
1218     FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result,
1219                                     CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
1220 
1221   return result;
1222 }
1223 
1224 /// Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types.  Helper
1225 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1226 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1227                                       ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1228                                       QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1229   bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1230   bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1231 
1232   // N1169 4.1.4: If one of the operands has a floating type and the other
1233   //              operand has a fixed-point type, the fixed-point operand
1234   //              is converted to the floating type [...]
1235   if (LHSType->isFixedPointType() || RHSType->isFixedPointType()) {
1236     if (LHSFloat)
1237       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FixedPointToFloating);
1238     else if (!IsCompAssign)
1239       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FixedPointToFloating);
1240     return LHSFloat ? LHSType : RHSType;
1241   }
1242 
1243   // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
1244   // to the bigger result.
1245   if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
1246     int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1247     if (order > 0) {
1248       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1249       return LHSType;
1250     }
1251 
1252     assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
1253     if (!IsCompAssign)
1254       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1255     return RHSType;
1256   }
1257 
1258   if (LHSFloat) {
1259     // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
1260     if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
1261       LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy;
1262 
1263     return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1264                                       /*ConvertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
1265                                       /*ConvertInt=*/ true);
1266   }
1267   assert(RHSFloat);
1268   return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1269                                     /*ConvertFloat=*/ true,
1270                                     /*ConvertInt=*/!IsCompAssign);
1271 }
1272 
1273 /// Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128, __ibm128 and
1274 /// long double if there is no support for such conversion.
1275 /// Helper function of UsualArithmeticConversions().
unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)1276 static bool unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
1277                                       QualType RHSType) {
1278   // No issue if either is not a floating point type.
1279   if (!LHSType->isFloatingType() || !RHSType->isFloatingType())
1280     return false;
1281 
1282   // No issue if both have the same 128-bit float semantics.
1283   auto *LHSComplex = LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1284   auto *RHSComplex = RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1285 
1286   QualType LHSElem = LHSComplex ? LHSComplex->getElementType() : LHSType;
1287   QualType RHSElem = RHSComplex ? RHSComplex->getElementType() : RHSType;
1288 
1289   const llvm::fltSemantics &LHSSem = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(LHSElem);
1290   const llvm::fltSemantics &RHSSem = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(RHSElem);
1291 
1292   if ((&LHSSem != &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble() ||
1293        &RHSSem != &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) &&
1294       (&LHSSem != &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad() ||
1295        &RHSSem != &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1296     return false;
1297 
1298   return true;
1299 }
1300 
1301 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType);
1302 
1303 namespace {
1304 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to
1305 /// permit their use as function template parameters.
doIntegralCast(Sema & S,Expr * op,QualType toType)1306 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1307   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast);
1308 }
1309 
doComplexIntegralCast(Sema & S,Expr * op,QualType toType)1310 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1311   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType),
1312                              CK_IntegralComplexCast);
1313 }
1314 }
1315 
1316 /// Handle integer arithmetic conversions.  Helper function of
1317 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
1318 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast>
handleIntegerConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1319 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1320                                         ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1321                                         QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1322   // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
1323   int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1324   bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1325   bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1326   if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
1327     // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
1328     if (order >= 0) {
1329       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1330       return LHSType;
1331     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1332       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1333     return RHSType;
1334   } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
1335     // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
1336     // signed type, so use the unsigned type
1337     if (RHSSigned) {
1338       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1339       return LHSType;
1340     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1341       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1342     return RHSType;
1343   } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
1344     // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
1345     // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
1346     // use the signed type.
1347     if (LHSSigned) {
1348       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1349       return LHSType;
1350     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1351       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1352     return RHSType;
1353   } else {
1354     // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
1355     // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
1356     // on most 32-bit systems).  Use the unsigned type corresponding
1357     // to the signed type.
1358     QualType result =
1359       S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
1360     RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result);
1361     if (!IsCompAssign)
1362       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result);
1363     return result;
1364   }
1365 }
1366 
1367 /// Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension.  Helper function
1368 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleComplexIntConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1369 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1370                                            ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1371                                            QualType RHSType,
1372                                            bool IsCompAssign) {
1373   const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1374   const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1375 
1376   if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
1377     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1378     QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1379     QualType ScalarType =
1380       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1381         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1382 
1383     return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1384   }
1385 
1386   if (LHSComplexInt) {
1387     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1388     QualType ScalarType =
1389       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1390         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1391     QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1392     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType,
1393                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1394 
1395     return ComplexType;
1396   }
1397 
1398   assert(RHSComplexInt);
1399 
1400   QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1401   QualType ScalarType =
1402     handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1403       (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1404   QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1405 
1406   if (!IsCompAssign)
1407     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType,
1408                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1409   return ComplexType;
1410 }
1411 
1412 /// Return the rank of a given fixed point or integer type. The value itself
1413 /// doesn't matter, but the values must be increasing with proper increasing
1414 /// rank as described in N1169 4.1.1.
GetFixedPointRank(QualType Ty)1415 static unsigned GetFixedPointRank(QualType Ty) {
1416   const auto *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1417   assert(BTy && "Expected a builtin type.");
1418 
1419   switch (BTy->getKind()) {
1420   case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
1421   case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
1422   case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
1423   case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
1424     return 1;
1425   case BuiltinType::Fract:
1426   case BuiltinType::UFract:
1427   case BuiltinType::SatFract:
1428   case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
1429     return 2;
1430   case BuiltinType::LongFract:
1431   case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
1432   case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
1433   case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
1434     return 3;
1435   case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
1436   case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
1437   case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
1438   case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
1439     return 4;
1440   case BuiltinType::Accum:
1441   case BuiltinType::UAccum:
1442   case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
1443   case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
1444     return 5;
1445   case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
1446   case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
1447   case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
1448   case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
1449     return 6;
1450   default:
1451     if (BTy->isInteger())
1452       return 0;
1453     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected fixed point or integer type");
1454   }
1455 }
1456 
1457 /// handleFixedPointConversion - Fixed point operations between fixed
1458 /// point types and integers or other fixed point types do not fall under
1459 /// usual arithmetic conversion since these conversions could result in loss
1460 /// of precsision (N1169 4.1.4). These operations should be calculated with
1461 /// the full precision of their result type (N1169 4.1.6.2.1).
handleFixedPointConversion(Sema & S,QualType LHSTy,QualType RHSTy)1462 static QualType handleFixedPointConversion(Sema &S, QualType LHSTy,
1463                                            QualType RHSTy) {
1464   assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isFixedPointType()) &&
1465          "Expected at least one of the operands to be a fixed point type");
1466   assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType() ||
1467           RHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType()) &&
1468          "Special fixed point arithmetic operation conversions are only "
1469          "applied to ints or other fixed point types");
1470 
1471   // If one operand has signed fixed-point type and the other operand has
1472   // unsigned fixed-point type, then the unsigned fixed-point operand is
1473   // converted to its corresponding signed fixed-point type and the resulting
1474   // type is the type of the converted operand.
1475   if (RHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType())
1476     LHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(LHSTy);
1477   else if (RHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType())
1478     RHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(RHSTy);
1479 
1480   // The result type is the type with the highest rank, whereby a fixed-point
1481   // conversion rank is always greater than an integer conversion rank; if the
1482   // type of either of the operands is a saturating fixedpoint type, the result
1483   // type shall be the saturating fixed-point type corresponding to the type
1484   // with the highest rank; the resulting value is converted (taking into
1485   // account rounding and overflow) to the precision of the resulting type.
1486   // Same ranks between signed and unsigned types are resolved earlier, so both
1487   // types are either signed or both unsigned at this point.
1488   unsigned LHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(LHSTy);
1489   unsigned RHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(RHSTy);
1490 
1491   QualType ResultTy = LHSTyRank > RHSTyRank ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
1492 
1493   if (LHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType())
1494     ResultTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(ResultTy);
1495 
1496   return ResultTy;
1497 }
1498 
1499 /// Check that the usual arithmetic conversions can be performed on this pair of
1500 /// expressions that might be of enumeration type.
checkEnumArithmeticConversions(Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS,SourceLocation Loc,ArithConvKind ACK)1501 void Sema::checkEnumArithmeticConversions(Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
1502                                           SourceLocation Loc,
1503                                           ArithConvKind ACK) {
1504   // C++2a [expr.arith.conv]p1:
1505   //   If one operand is of enumeration type and the other operand is of a
1506   //   different enumeration type or a floating-point type, this behavior is
1507   //   deprecated ([depr.arith.conv.enum]).
1508   //
1509   // Warn on this in all language modes. Produce a deprecation warning in C++20.
1510   // Eventually we will presumably reject these cases (in C++23 onwards?).
1511   QualType L = LHS->getEnumCoercedType(Context),
1512            R = RHS->getEnumCoercedType(Context);
1513   bool LEnum = L->isUnscopedEnumerationType(),
1514        REnum = R->isUnscopedEnumerationType();
1515   bool IsCompAssign = ACK == ArithConvKind::CompAssign;
1516   if ((!IsCompAssign && LEnum && R->isFloatingType()) ||
1517       (REnum && L->isFloatingType())) {
1518     Diag(Loc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus26 ? diag::err_arith_conv_enum_float_cxx26
1519               : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
1520                   ? diag::warn_arith_conv_enum_float_cxx20
1521                   : diag::warn_arith_conv_enum_float)
1522         << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange() << (int)ACK << LEnum
1523         << L << R;
1524   } else if (!IsCompAssign && LEnum && REnum &&
1525              !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(L, R)) {
1526     unsigned DiagID;
1527     // In C++ 26, usual arithmetic conversions between 2 different enum types
1528     // are ill-formed.
1529     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus26)
1530       DiagID = diag::warn_conv_mixed_enum_types_cxx26;
1531     else if (!L->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->hasNameForLinkage() ||
1532              !R->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->hasNameForLinkage()) {
1533       // If either enumeration type is unnamed, it's less likely that the
1534       // user cares about this, but this situation is still deprecated in
1535       // C++2a. Use a different warning group.
1536       DiagID = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
1537                    ? diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_anon_enum_types_cxx20
1538                    : diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_anon_enum_types;
1539     } else if (ACK == ArithConvKind::Conditional) {
1540       // Conditional expressions are separated out because they have
1541       // historically had a different warning flag.
1542       DiagID = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
1543                    ? diag::warn_conditional_mixed_enum_types_cxx20
1544                    : diag::warn_conditional_mixed_enum_types;
1545     } else if (ACK == ArithConvKind::Comparison) {
1546       // Comparison expressions are separated out because they have
1547       // historically had a different warning flag.
1548       DiagID = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
1549                    ? diag::warn_comparison_mixed_enum_types_cxx20
1550                    : diag::warn_comparison_mixed_enum_types;
1551     } else {
1552       DiagID = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
1553                    ? diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_enum_types_cxx20
1554                    : diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_enum_types;
1555     }
1556     Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange()
1557                       << (int)ACK << L << R;
1558   }
1559 }
1560 
CheckUnicodeArithmeticConversions(Sema & SemaRef,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS,SourceLocation Loc,ArithConvKind ACK)1561 static void CheckUnicodeArithmeticConversions(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *LHS,
1562                                               Expr *RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
1563                                               ArithConvKind ACK) {
1564   QualType LHSType = LHS->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
1565   QualType RHSType = RHS->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
1566 
1567   if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !LHSType->isUnicodeCharacterType() ||
1568       !RHSType->isUnicodeCharacterType())
1569     return;
1570 
1571   if (ACK == ArithConvKind::Comparison) {
1572     if (SemaRef.getASTContext().hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
1573       return;
1574 
1575     auto IsSingleCodeUnitCP = [](const QualType &T, const llvm::APSInt &Value) {
1576       if (T->isChar8Type())
1577         return llvm::IsSingleCodeUnitUTF8Codepoint(Value.getExtValue());
1578       if (T->isChar16Type())
1579         return llvm::IsSingleCodeUnitUTF16Codepoint(Value.getExtValue());
1580       assert(T->isChar32Type());
1581       return llvm::IsSingleCodeUnitUTF32Codepoint(Value.getExtValue());
1582     };
1583 
1584     Expr::EvalResult LHSRes, RHSRes;
1585     bool LHSSuccess = LHS->EvaluateAsInt(LHSRes, SemaRef.getASTContext(),
1586                                          Expr::SE_AllowSideEffects,
1587                                          SemaRef.isConstantEvaluatedContext());
1588     bool RHSuccess = RHS->EvaluateAsInt(RHSRes, SemaRef.getASTContext(),
1589                                         Expr::SE_AllowSideEffects,
1590                                         SemaRef.isConstantEvaluatedContext());
1591 
1592     // Don't warn if the one known value is a representable
1593     // in the type of both expressions.
1594     if (LHSSuccess != RHSuccess) {
1595       Expr::EvalResult &Res = LHSSuccess ? LHSRes : RHSRes;
1596       if (IsSingleCodeUnitCP(LHSType, Res.Val.getInt()) &&
1597           IsSingleCodeUnitCP(RHSType, Res.Val.getInt()))
1598         return;
1599     }
1600 
1601     if (!LHSSuccess || !RHSuccess) {
1602       SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_unicode_mixed_types)
1603           << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange() << LHSType
1604           << RHSType;
1605       return;
1606     }
1607 
1608     llvm::APSInt LHSValue(32);
1609     LHSValue = LHSRes.Val.getInt();
1610     llvm::APSInt RHSValue(32);
1611     RHSValue = RHSRes.Val.getInt();
1612 
1613     bool LHSSafe = IsSingleCodeUnitCP(LHSType, LHSValue);
1614     bool RHSSafe = IsSingleCodeUnitCP(RHSType, RHSValue);
1615     if (LHSSafe && RHSSafe)
1616       return;
1617 
1618     SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_unicode_mixed_types_constant)
1619         << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange() << LHSType << RHSType
1620         << FormatUTFCodeUnitAsCodepoint(LHSValue.getExtValue(), LHSType)
1621         << FormatUTFCodeUnitAsCodepoint(RHSValue.getExtValue(), RHSType);
1622     return;
1623   }
1624 
1625   if (SemaRef.getASTContext().hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
1626     return;
1627 
1628   SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_arith_conv_mixed_unicode_types)
1629       << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange() << ACK << LHSType
1630       << RHSType;
1631 }
1632 
1633 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
1634 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
1635 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
1636 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,ArithConvKind ACK)1637 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
1638                                           SourceLocation Loc,
1639                                           ArithConvKind ACK) {
1640 
1641   checkEnumArithmeticConversions(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc, ACK);
1642 
1643   CheckUnicodeArithmeticConversions(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc, ACK);
1644 
1645   if (ACK != ArithConvKind::CompAssign) {
1646     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
1647     if (LHS.isInvalid())
1648       return QualType();
1649   }
1650 
1651   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
1652   if (RHS.isInvalid())
1653     return QualType();
1654 
1655   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
1656   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
1657   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
1658   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
1659 
1660   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS.
1661   if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1662     LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType();
1663 
1664   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1665   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
1666     return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSType, RHSType);
1667 
1668   // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
1669   // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
1670   if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
1671     return QualType();
1672 
1673   // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
1674   QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
1675   if (Context.isPromotableIntegerType(LHSType))
1676     LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
1677   QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
1678   if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
1679     LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
1680   if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && ACK != ArithConvKind::CompAssign)
1681     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
1682 
1683   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1684   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
1685     return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSType, RHSType);
1686 
1687   // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
1688 
1689   // Diagnose attempts to convert between __ibm128, __float128 and long double
1690   // where such conversions currently can't be handled.
1691   if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType))
1692     return QualType();
1693 
1694   // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
1695   if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
1696     return handleComplexConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1697                                    ACK == ArithConvKind::CompAssign);
1698 
1699   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
1700   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
1701     return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1702                                  ACK == ArithConvKind::CompAssign);
1703 
1704   // Handle GCC complex int extension.
1705   if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
1706     return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1707                                       ACK == ArithConvKind::CompAssign);
1708 
1709   if (LHSType->isFixedPointType() || RHSType->isFixedPointType())
1710     return handleFixedPointConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
1711 
1712   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
1713   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>(
1714       *this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, ACK == ArithConvKind::CompAssign);
1715 }
1716 
1717 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1718 //  Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
1719 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1720 
1721 
ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,SourceLocation DefaultLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,bool PredicateIsExpr,void * ControllingExprOrType,ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,ArrayRef<Expr * > ArgExprs)1722 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(
1723     SourceLocation KeyLoc, SourceLocation DefaultLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1724     bool PredicateIsExpr, void *ControllingExprOrType,
1725     ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) {
1726   unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
1727   assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
1728 
1729   TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
1730   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1731     if (ArgTypes[i])
1732       (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]);
1733     else
1734       Types[i] = nullptr;
1735   }
1736 
1737   // If we have a controlling type, we need to convert it from a parsed type
1738   // into a semantic type and then pass that along.
1739   if (!PredicateIsExpr) {
1740     TypeSourceInfo *ControllingType;
1741     (void)GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(ControllingExprOrType),
1742                             &ControllingType);
1743     assert(ControllingType && "couldn't get the type out of the parser");
1744     ControllingExprOrType = ControllingType;
1745   }
1746 
1747   ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(
1748       KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, PredicateIsExpr, ControllingExprOrType,
1749       llvm::ArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), ArgExprs);
1750   delete [] Types;
1751   return ER;
1752 }
1753 
CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,SourceLocation DefaultLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,bool PredicateIsExpr,void * ControllingExprOrType,ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo * > Types,ArrayRef<Expr * > Exprs)1754 ExprResult Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(
1755     SourceLocation KeyLoc, SourceLocation DefaultLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1756     bool PredicateIsExpr, void *ControllingExprOrType,
1757     ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) {
1758   unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size();
1759   assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size());
1760   assert(ControllingExprOrType &&
1761          "Must have either a controlling expression or a controlling type");
1762 
1763   Expr *ControllingExpr = nullptr;
1764   TypeSourceInfo *ControllingType = nullptr;
1765   if (PredicateIsExpr) {
1766     // Decay and strip qualifiers for the controlling expression type, and
1767     // handle placeholder type replacement. See committee discussion from WG14
1768     // DR423.
1769     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
1770         *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
1771     ExprResult R = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(
1772         reinterpret_cast<Expr *>(ControllingExprOrType));
1773     if (R.isInvalid())
1774       return ExprError();
1775     ControllingExpr = R.get();
1776   } else {
1777     // The extension form uses the type directly rather than converting it.
1778     ControllingType = reinterpret_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>(ControllingExprOrType);
1779     if (!ControllingType)
1780       return ExprError();
1781   }
1782 
1783   bool TypeErrorFound = false,
1784        IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr
1785                                ? ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent()
1786                                : ControllingType->getType()->isDependentType(),
1787        ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack =
1788            ControllingExpr
1789                ? ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()
1790                : ControllingType->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
1791 
1792   // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are
1793   // likely unintended.
1794   if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !IsResultDependent && ControllingExpr &&
1795       ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
1796     Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(),
1797          diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
1798 
1799   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1800     if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1801       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1802 
1803     if (Types[i]) {
1804       if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1805         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1806 
1807       if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1808         IsResultDependent = true;
1809       } else {
1810         // We relax the restriction on use of incomplete types and non-object
1811         // types with the type-based extension of _Generic. Allowing incomplete
1812         // objects means those can be used as "tags" for a type-safe way to map
1813         // to a value. Similarly, matching on function types rather than
1814         // function pointer types can be useful. However, the restriction on VM
1815         // types makes sense to retain as there are open questions about how
1816         // the selection can be made at compile time.
1817         //
1818         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
1819         // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
1820         // C2y removed the requirement that an expression form must
1821         // use a complete type, though it's still as-if the type has undergone
1822         // lvalue conversion. We support this as an extension in C23 and
1823         // earlier because GCC does so.
1824         unsigned D = 0;
1825         if (ControllingExpr && Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
1826           D = LangOpts.C2y ? diag::warn_c2y_compat_assoc_type_incomplete
1827                            : diag::ext_assoc_type_incomplete;
1828         else if (ControllingExpr && !Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
1829           D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
1830         else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
1831           D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
1832         else if (ControllingExpr) {
1833           // Because the controlling expression undergoes lvalue conversion,
1834           // array conversion, and function conversion, an association which is
1835           // of array type, function type, or is qualified can never be
1836           // reached. We will warn about this so users are less surprised by
1837           // the unreachable association. However, we don't have to handle
1838           // function types; that's not an object type, so it's handled above.
1839           //
1840           // The logic is somewhat different for C++ because C++ has different
1841           // lvalue to rvalue conversion rules than C. [conv.lvalue]p1 says,
1842           // If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the cv-
1843           // unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the prvalue is T.
1844           // The result of these rules is that all qualified types in an
1845           // association in C are unreachable, and in C++, only qualified non-
1846           // class types are unreachable.
1847           //
1848           // NB: this does not apply when the first operand is a type rather
1849           // than an expression, because the type form does not undergo
1850           // conversion.
1851           unsigned Reason = 0;
1852           QualType QT = Types[i]->getType();
1853           if (QT->isArrayType())
1854             Reason = 1;
1855           else if (QT.hasQualifiers() &&
1856                    (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !QT->isRecordType()))
1857             Reason = 2;
1858 
1859           if (Reason)
1860             Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1861                  diag::warn_unreachable_association)
1862                 << QT << (Reason - 1);
1863         }
1864 
1865         if (D != 0) {
1866           Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
1867               << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() << Types[i]->getType();
1868           if (getDiagnostics().getDiagnosticLevel(
1869                   D, Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc()) >=
1870               DiagnosticsEngine::Error)
1871             TypeErrorFound = true;
1872         }
1873 
1874         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
1875         // selection shall specify compatible types."
1876         for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
1877           if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
1878               Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
1879                                          Types[j]->getType())) {
1880             Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1881                  diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
1882               << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1883               << Types[j]->getType()
1884               << Types[i]->getType();
1885             Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1886                  diag::note_compat_assoc)
1887               << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1888               << Types[i]->getType();
1889             TypeErrorFound = true;
1890           }
1891       }
1892     }
1893   }
1894   if (TypeErrorFound)
1895     return ExprError();
1896 
1897   // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
1898   // try to compute the result expression.
1899   if (IsResultDependent) {
1900     if (ControllingExpr)
1901       return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr,
1902                                           Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1903                                           ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
1904     return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(Context, KeyLoc, ControllingType, Types,
1905                                         Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1906                                         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
1907   }
1908 
1909   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
1910   unsigned DefaultIndex = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
1911   // Look at the canonical type of the controlling expression in case it was a
1912   // deduced type like __auto_type. However, when issuing diagnostics, use the
1913   // type the user wrote in source rather than the canonical one.
1914   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1915     if (!Types[i])
1916       DefaultIndex = i;
1917     else if (ControllingExpr &&
1918              Context.typesAreCompatible(
1919                  ControllingExpr->getType().getCanonicalType(),
1920                  Types[i]->getType()))
1921       CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1922     else if (ControllingType &&
1923              Context.typesAreCompatible(
1924                  ControllingType->getType().getCanonicalType(),
1925                  Types[i]->getType()))
1926       CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1927   }
1928 
1929   auto GetControllingRangeAndType = [](Expr *ControllingExpr,
1930                                        TypeSourceInfo *ControllingType) {
1931     // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1932     // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1933     if (ControllingExpr)
1934       ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1935 
1936     SourceRange SR = ControllingExpr
1937                          ? ControllingExpr->getSourceRange()
1938                          : ControllingType->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
1939     QualType QT = ControllingExpr ? ControllingExpr->getType()
1940                                   : ControllingType->getType();
1941 
1942     return std::make_pair(SR, QT);
1943   };
1944 
1945   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
1946   // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
1947   // association list."
1948   if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
1949     auto P = GetControllingRangeAndType(ControllingExpr, ControllingType);
1950     SourceRange SR = P.first;
1951     Diag(SR.getBegin(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
1952         << SR << P.second << (unsigned)CompatIndices.size();
1953     for (unsigned I : CompatIndices) {
1954       Diag(Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1955            diag::note_compat_assoc)
1956         << Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1957         << Types[I]->getType();
1958     }
1959     return ExprError();
1960   }
1961 
1962   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
1963   // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
1964   // the types named in its generic association list."
1965   if (DefaultIndex == std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max() &&
1966       CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
1967     auto P = GetControllingRangeAndType(ControllingExpr, ControllingType);
1968     SourceRange SR = P.first;
1969     Diag(SR.getBegin(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) << SR << P.second;
1970     return ExprError();
1971   }
1972 
1973   // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
1974   // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
1975   // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
1976   // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
1977   // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
1978   unsigned ResultIndex =
1979     CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
1980 
1981   if (ControllingExpr) {
1982     return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
1983         Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1984         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
1985   }
1986   return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
1987       Context, KeyLoc, ControllingType, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1988       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
1989 }
1990 
getPredefinedExprKind(tok::TokenKind Kind)1991 static PredefinedIdentKind getPredefinedExprKind(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
1992   switch (Kind) {
1993   default:
1994     llvm_unreachable("unexpected TokenKind");
1995   case tok::kw___func__:
1996     return PredefinedIdentKind::Func; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1997   case tok::kw___FUNCTION__:
1998     return PredefinedIdentKind::Function;
1999   case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__:
2000     return PredefinedIdentKind::FuncDName; // [MS]
2001   case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__:
2002     return PredefinedIdentKind::FuncSig; // [MS]
2003   case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__:
2004     return PredefinedIdentKind::LFunction; // [MS]
2005   case tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__:
2006     return PredefinedIdentKind::LFuncSig; // [MS]
2007   case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__:
2008     return PredefinedIdentKind::PrettyFunction; // [GNU]
2009   }
2010 }
2011 
2012 /// getPredefinedExprDecl - Returns Decl of a given DeclContext that can be used
2013 /// to determine the value of a PredefinedExpr. This can be either a
2014 /// block, lambda, captured statement, function, otherwise a nullptr.
getPredefinedExprDecl(DeclContext * DC)2015 static Decl *getPredefinedExprDecl(DeclContext *DC) {
2016   while (DC && !isa<BlockDecl, CapturedDecl, FunctionDecl, ObjCMethodDecl>(DC))
2017     DC = DC->getParent();
2018   return cast_or_null<Decl>(DC);
2019 }
2020 
2021 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the
2022 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it.
getUDSuffixLoc(Sema & S,SourceLocation TokLoc,unsigned Offset)2023 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
2024                                      unsigned Offset) {
2025   return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(),
2026                                         S.getLangOpts());
2027 }
2028 
2029 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up
2030 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it.
BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema & S,Scope * Scope,IdentifierInfo * UDSuffix,SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation LitEndLoc)2031 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope,
2032                                                  IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix,
2033                                                  SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,
2034                                                  ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
2035                                                  SourceLocation LitEndLoc) {
2036   assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator");
2037 
2038   QualType ArgTy[2];
2039   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
2040     ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType();
2041     if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType())
2042       ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]);
2043   }
2044 
2045   DeclarationName OpName =
2046     S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
2047   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
2048   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
2049 
2050   LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
2051   if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::ArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()),
2052                               /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false,
2053                               /*AllowStringTemplatePack*/ false,
2054                               /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true) == Sema::LOLR_Error)
2055     return ExprError();
2056 
2057   return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc);
2058 }
2059 
ActOnUnevaluatedStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks)2060 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnevaluatedStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks) {
2061   // StringToks needs backing storage as it doesn't hold array elements itself
2062   std::vector<Token> ExpandedToks;
2063   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
2064     StringToks = ExpandedToks = ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(StringToks);
2065 
2066   StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP,
2067                               StringLiteralEvalMethod::Unevaluated);
2068   if (Literal.hadError)
2069     return ExprError();
2070 
2071   SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
2072   for (const Token &Tok : StringToks)
2073     StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation());
2074 
2075   StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
2076                                              StringLiteralKind::Unevaluated,
2077                                              false, {}, StringTokLocs);
2078 
2079   if (!Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) {
2080     SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
2081         getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
2082                        Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
2083     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
2084   }
2085 
2086   return Lit;
2087 }
2088 
2089 std::vector<Token>
ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(ArrayRef<Token> Toks)2090 Sema::ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(ArrayRef<Token> Toks) {
2091   // MSVC treats some predefined identifiers (e.g. __FUNCTION__) as function
2092   // local macros that expand to string literals that may be concatenated.
2093   // These macros are expanded here (in Sema), because StringLiteralParser
2094   // (in Lex) doesn't know the enclosing function (because it hasn't been
2095   // parsed yet).
2096   assert(getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt);
2097 
2098   // Note: Although function local macros are defined only inside functions,
2099   // we ensure a valid `CurrentDecl` even outside of a function. This allows
2100   // expansion of macros into empty string literals without additional checks.
2101   Decl *CurrentDecl = getPredefinedExprDecl(CurContext);
2102   if (!CurrentDecl)
2103     CurrentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
2104 
2105   std::vector<Token> ExpandedToks;
2106   ExpandedToks.reserve(Toks.size());
2107   for (const Token &Tok : Toks) {
2108     if (!isFunctionLocalStringLiteralMacro(Tok.getKind(), getLangOpts())) {
2109       assert(tok::isStringLiteral(Tok.getKind()));
2110       ExpandedToks.emplace_back(Tok);
2111       continue;
2112     }
2113     if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(CurrentDecl))
2114       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
2115     // Stringify predefined expression
2116     Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_string_literal_from_predefined)
2117         << Tok.getKind();
2118     SmallString<64> Str;
2119     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
2120     Token &Exp = ExpandedToks.emplace_back();
2121     Exp.startToken();
2122     if (Tok.getKind() == tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__ ||
2123         Tok.getKind() == tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__) {
2124       OS << 'L';
2125       Exp.setKind(tok::wide_string_literal);
2126     } else {
2127       Exp.setKind(tok::string_literal);
2128     }
2129     OS << '"'
2130        << Lexer::Stringify(PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(
2131               getPredefinedExprKind(Tok.getKind()), CurrentDecl))
2132        << '"';
2133     PP.CreateString(OS.str(), Exp, Tok.getLocation(), Tok.getEndLoc());
2134   }
2135   return ExpandedToks;
2136 }
2137 
2138 ExprResult
ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks,Scope * UDLScope)2139 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) {
2140   assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!");
2141 
2142   // StringToks needs backing storage as it doesn't hold array elements itself
2143   std::vector<Token> ExpandedToks;
2144   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
2145     StringToks = ExpandedToks = ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(StringToks);
2146 
2147   StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP);
2148   if (Literal.hadError)
2149     return ExprError();
2150 
2151   SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
2152   for (const Token &Tok : StringToks)
2153     StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation());
2154 
2155   QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy;
2156   StringLiteralKind Kind = StringLiteralKind::Ordinary;
2157   if (Literal.isWide()) {
2158     CharTy = Context.getWideCharType();
2159     Kind = StringLiteralKind::Wide;
2160   } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) {
2161     if (getLangOpts().Char8)
2162       CharTy = Context.Char8Ty;
2163     else if (getLangOpts().C23)
2164       CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
2165     Kind = StringLiteralKind::UTF8;
2166   } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) {
2167     CharTy = Context.Char16Ty;
2168     Kind = StringLiteralKind::UTF16;
2169   } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) {
2170     CharTy = Context.Char32Ty;
2171     Kind = StringLiteralKind::UTF32;
2172   } else if (Literal.isPascal()) {
2173     CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
2174   }
2175 
2176   // Warn on u8 string literals before C++20 and C23, whose type
2177   // was an array of char before but becomes an array of char8_t.
2178   // In C++20, it cannot be used where a pointer to char is expected.
2179   // In C23, it might have an unexpected value if char was signed.
2180   if (Kind == StringLiteralKind::UTF8 &&
2181       (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
2182            ? !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && !getLangOpts().Char8
2183            : !getLangOpts().C23)) {
2184     Diag(StringTokLocs.front(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
2185                                     ? diag::warn_cxx20_compat_utf8_string
2186                                     : diag::warn_c23_compat_utf8_string);
2187 
2188     // Create removals for all 'u8' prefixes in the string literal(s). This
2189     // ensures C++20/C23 compatibility (but may change the program behavior when
2190     // built by non-Clang compilers for which the execution character set is
2191     // not always UTF-8).
2192     auto RemovalDiag = PDiag(diag::note_cxx20_c23_compat_utf8_string_remove_u8);
2193     SourceLocation RemovalDiagLoc;
2194     for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) {
2195       if (Tok.getKind() == tok::utf8_string_literal) {
2196         if (RemovalDiagLoc.isInvalid())
2197           RemovalDiagLoc = Tok.getLocation();
2198         RemovalDiag << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(CharSourceRange::getCharRange(
2199             Tok.getLocation(),
2200             Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(Tok.getLocation(), 2,
2201                                            getSourceManager(), getLangOpts())));
2202       }
2203     }
2204     Diag(RemovalDiagLoc, RemovalDiag);
2205   }
2206 
2207   QualType StrTy =
2208       Context.getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Literal.GetNumStringChars());
2209 
2210   // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
2211   StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(
2212       Context, Literal.GetString(), Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, StringTokLocs);
2213   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
2214     return Lit;
2215 
2216   // We're building a user-defined literal.
2217   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
2218   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
2219     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
2220                    Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
2221 
2222   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
2223   if (!UDLScope)
2224     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
2225 
2226   // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
2227   //   operator "" X (str, len)
2228   QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
2229 
2230   DeclarationName OpName =
2231     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
2232   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
2233   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
2234 
2235   QualType ArgTy[] = {
2236     Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType
2237   };
2238 
2239   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
2240   switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy,
2241                                 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ true,
2242                                 /*AllowStringTemplatePack*/ true,
2243                                 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true, Lit)) {
2244 
2245   case LOLR_Cooked: {
2246     llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars());
2247     IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType,
2248                                                     StringTokLocs[0]);
2249     Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg };
2250 
2251     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back());
2252   }
2253 
2254   case LOLR_Template: {
2255     TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
2256     TemplateArgument Arg(Lit, /*IsCanonical=*/false);
2257     TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo(Lit);
2258     ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
2259     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, {}, StringTokLocs.back(),
2260                                     &ExplicitArgs);
2261   }
2262 
2263   case LOLR_StringTemplatePack: {
2264     TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
2265 
2266     unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy);
2267     bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
2268     llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
2269 
2270     TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy);
2271     TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy));
2272     ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo));
2273 
2274     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) {
2275       Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I);
2276       TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy);
2277       TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
2278       ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
2279     }
2280     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, {}, StringTokLocs.back(),
2281                                     &ExplicitArgs);
2282   }
2283   case LOLR_Raw:
2284   case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic:
2285     llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
2286   case LOLR_Error:
2287     return ExprError();
2288   }
2289   llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
2290 }
2291 
2292 DeclRefExpr *
BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl * D,QualType Ty,ExprValueKind VK,SourceLocation Loc,const CXXScopeSpec * SS)2293 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
2294                        SourceLocation Loc,
2295                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
2296   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
2297   return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
2298 }
2299 
2300 DeclRefExpr *
BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl * D,QualType Ty,ExprValueKind VK,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,const CXXScopeSpec * SS,NamedDecl * FoundD,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs)2301 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
2302                        const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2303                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
2304                        SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
2305                        const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2306   NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS =
2307       SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
2308   return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, NNS, FoundD, TemplateKWLoc,
2309                           TemplateArgs);
2310 }
2311 
2312 // CUDA/HIP: Check whether a captured reference variable is referencing a
2313 // host variable in a device or host device lambda.
isCapturingReferenceToHostVarInCUDADeviceLambda(const Sema & S,VarDecl * VD)2314 static bool isCapturingReferenceToHostVarInCUDADeviceLambda(const Sema &S,
2315                                                             VarDecl *VD) {
2316   if (!S.getLangOpts().CUDA || !VD->hasInit())
2317     return false;
2318   assert(VD->getType()->isReferenceType());
2319 
2320   // Check whether the reference variable is referencing a host variable.
2321   auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(VD->getInit());
2322   if (!DRE)
2323     return false;
2324   auto *Referee = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
2325   if (!Referee || !Referee->hasGlobalStorage() ||
2326       Referee->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>())
2327     return false;
2328 
2329   // Check whether the current function is a device or host device lambda.
2330   // Check whether the reference variable is a capture by getDeclContext()
2331   // since refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture() is not ready at this point.
2332   auto *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext);
2333   if (MD && MD->getParent()->isLambda() &&
2334       MD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Call && MD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() &&
2335       VD->getDeclContext() != MD)
2336     return true;
2337 
2338   return false;
2339 }
2340 
getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl * D)2341 NonOdrUseReason Sema::getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl *D) {
2342   // A declaration named in an unevaluated operand never constitutes an odr-use.
2343   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
2344     return NOUR_Unevaluated;
2345 
2346   // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
2347   //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e
2348   //   is odr-used by e unless [...] x is a reference that is usable in
2349   //   constant expressions.
2350   // CUDA/HIP:
2351   //   If a reference variable referencing a host variable is captured in a
2352   //   device or host device lambda, the value of the referee must be copied
2353   //   to the capture and the reference variable must be treated as odr-use
2354   //   since the value of the referee is not known at compile time and must
2355   //   be loaded from the captured.
2356   if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2357     if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
2358         !(getLangOpts().OpenMP && OpenMP().isOpenMPCapturedDecl(D)) &&
2359         !isCapturingReferenceToHostVarInCUDADeviceLambda(*this, VD) &&
2360         VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))
2361       return NOUR_Constant;
2362   }
2363 
2364   // All remaining non-variable cases constitute an odr-use. For variables, we
2365   // need to wait and see how the expression is used.
2366   return NOUR_None;
2367 }
2368 
2369 DeclRefExpr *
BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl * D,QualType Ty,ExprValueKind VK,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS,NamedDecl * FoundD,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs)2370 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
2371                        const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2372                        NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
2373                        SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
2374                        const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2375   bool RefersToCapturedVariable = isa<VarDecl, BindingDecl>(D) &&
2376                                   NeedToCaptureVariable(D, NameInfo.getLoc());
2377 
2378   DeclRefExpr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create(
2379       Context, NNS, TemplateKWLoc, D, RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo, Ty,
2380       VK, FoundD, TemplateArgs, getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(D));
2381   MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
2382 
2383   // C++ [except.spec]p17:
2384   //   An exception-specification is considered to be needed when:
2385   //   - in an expression, the function is the unique lookup result or
2386   //     the selected member of a set of overloaded functions.
2387   //
2388   // We delay doing this until after we've built the function reference and
2389   // marked it as used so that:
2390   //  a) if the function is defaulted, we get errors from defining it before /
2391   //     instead of errors from computing its exception specification, and
2392   //  b) if the function is a defaulted comparison, we can use the body we
2393   //     build when defining it as input to the exception specification
2394   //     computation rather than computing a new body.
2395   if (const auto *FPT = Ty->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2396     if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
2397       if (const auto *NewFPT = ResolveExceptionSpec(NameInfo.getLoc(), FPT))
2398         E->setType(Context.getQualifiedType(NewFPT, Ty.getQualifiers()));
2399     }
2400   }
2401 
2402   if (getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
2403       Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && !isUnevaluatedContext() &&
2404       !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getBeginLoc()))
2405     getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(E);
2406 
2407   const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
2408   if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(D))
2409     FD = IFD->getAnonField();
2410   if (FD) {
2411     UnusedPrivateFields.remove(FD);
2412     // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
2413     if (FD->isBitField())
2414       E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
2415   }
2416 
2417   // C++ [expr.prim]/8: The expression [...] is a bit-field if the identifier
2418   // designates a bit-field.
2419   if (const auto *BD = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D))
2420     if (const auto *BE = BD->getBinding())
2421       E->setObjectKind(BE->getObjectKind());
2422 
2423   return E;
2424 }
2425 
2426 void
DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId & Id,TemplateArgumentListInfo & Buffer,DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * & TemplateArgs)2427 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
2428                              TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
2429                              DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2430                              const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
2431   if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
2432     Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
2433     Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
2434 
2435     ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
2436                                        Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
2437     translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
2438 
2439     TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
2440     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
2441     NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
2442     TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
2443   } else {
2444     NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
2445     TemplateArgs = nullptr;
2446   }
2447 }
2448 
DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(const LookupResult & R)2449 bool Sema::DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(const LookupResult &R) {
2450   // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points
2451   // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a
2452   // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check.
2453   bool isDefaultArgument =
2454       !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() &&
2455       CodeSynthesisContexts.back().Kind ==
2456           CodeSynthesisContext::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation;
2457   const auto *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
2458   bool isInstance = CurMethod && CurMethod->isInstance() &&
2459                     R.getNamingClass() == CurMethod->getParent() &&
2460                     !isDefaultArgument;
2461 
2462   // There are two ways we can find a class-scope declaration during template
2463   // instantiation that we did not find in the template definition: if it is a
2464   // member of a dependent base class, or if it is declared after the point of
2465   // use in the same class. Distinguish these by comparing the class in which
2466   // the member was found to the naming class of the lookup.
2467   unsigned DiagID = diag::err_found_in_dependent_base;
2468   unsigned NoteID = diag::note_member_declared_at;
2469   if (R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getDeclContext()->Equals(R.getNamingClass())) {
2470     DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_found_later_in_class
2471                                       : diag::err_found_later_in_class;
2472   } else if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
2473     DiagID = diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base;
2474     NoteID = diag::note_dependent_member_use;
2475   }
2476 
2477   if (isInstance) {
2478     // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
2479     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), DiagID)
2480         << R.getLookupName()
2481         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
2482     CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc());
2483   } else {
2484     // FIXME: Add a FixItHint to insert 'Base::' or 'Derived::' (assuming
2485     // they're not shadowed).
2486     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), DiagID) << R.getLookupName();
2487   }
2488 
2489   for (const NamedDecl *D : R)
2490     Diag(D->getLocation(), NoteID);
2491 
2492   // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation
2493   // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise
2494   // the caller will try to create an implicit member call and this is wrong
2495   // for default arguments.
2496   //
2497   // FIXME: Is this special case necessary? We could allow the caller to
2498   // diagnose this.
2499   if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) {
2500     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object) << 0;
2501     return true;
2502   }
2503 
2504   // Tell the callee to try to recover.
2505   return false;
2506 }
2507 
DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope * S,CXXScopeSpec & SS,LookupResult & R,CorrectionCandidateCallback & CCC,TemplateArgumentListInfo * ExplicitTemplateArgs,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,DeclContext * LookupCtx)2508 bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
2509                                CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC,
2510                                TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
2511                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, DeclContext *LookupCtx) {
2512   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
2513   SourceRange NameRange = R.getLookupNameInfo().getSourceRange();
2514 
2515   unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
2516   unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
2517   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
2518       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
2519       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
2520     diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
2521     diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
2522   }
2523 
2524   // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
2525   // unqualified lookup.  This is useful when (for example) the
2526   // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
2527   // dependent name.
2528   DeclContext *DC =
2529       LookupCtx ? LookupCtx : (SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : nullptr);
2530   while (DC) {
2531     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
2532       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
2533         if (LookupTemplateName(
2534                 R, S, SS, Context.getRecordType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)),
2535                 /*EnteringContext*/ false, TemplateNameIsRequired,
2536                 /*RequiredTemplateKind*/ nullptr, /*AllowTypoCorrection*/ true))
2537           return true;
2538       } else {
2539         LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
2540       }
2541 
2542       if (!R.empty()) {
2543         // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
2544         R.suppressDiagnostics();
2545 
2546         // If there's a best viable function among the results, only mention
2547         // that one in the notes.
2548         OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(R.getNameLoc(),
2549                                         OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
2550         AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Candidates);
2551         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2552         if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best) ==
2553             OR_Success) {
2554           R.clear();
2555           R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
2556           R.resolveKind();
2557         }
2558 
2559         return DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R);
2560       }
2561 
2562       R.clear();
2563     }
2564 
2565     DC = DC->getLookupParent();
2566   }
2567 
2568   // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
2569   TypoCorrection Corrected;
2570   if (S && (Corrected =
2571                 CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS,
2572                             CCC, CorrectTypoKind::ErrorRecovery, LookupCtx))) {
2573     std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
2574     bool DroppedSpecifier =
2575         Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
2576     R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
2577 
2578     bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false;
2579     bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false;
2580     NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl();
2581     if (ND) {
2582       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
2583         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(),
2584                                  OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
2585         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2586         for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) {
2587           if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
2588                    dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(CD))
2589             AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
2590                 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
2591                 Args, OCS);
2592           else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD))
2593             if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
2594               AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
2595                                    Args, OCS);
2596         }
2597         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
2598         case OR_Success:
2599           ND = Best->FoundDecl;
2600           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
2601           break;
2602         default:
2603           // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note.
2604           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
2605           break;
2606         }
2607       }
2608       R.addDecl(ND);
2609       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) {
2610         CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
2611         if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) {
2612           const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType();
2613           Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
2614         }
2615         if (!Record)
2616           Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(
2617               ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext());
2618         R.setNamingClass(Record);
2619       }
2620 
2621       auto *UnderlyingND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl();
2622       AcceptableWithRecovery = isa<ValueDecl>(UnderlyingND) ||
2623                                isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(UnderlyingND);
2624       // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
2625       // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
2626       // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
2627       // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
2628       // to recover well anyway.
2629       AcceptableWithoutRecovery = isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingND) ||
2630                                   getAsTypeTemplateDecl(UnderlyingND) ||
2631                                   isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingND);
2632     } else {
2633       // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
2634       // because we aren't able to recover.
2635       AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true;
2636     }
2637 
2638     if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) {
2639       unsigned NoteID = Corrected.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>()
2640                             ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
2641                             : diag::note_previous_decl;
2642       if (SS.isEmpty())
2643         diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name << NameRange,
2644                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
2645       else
2646         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
2647                      PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2648                          << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2649                          << DroppedSpecifier << NameRange,
2650                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
2651 
2652       // Tell the callee whether to try to recover.
2653       return !AcceptableWithRecovery;
2654     }
2655   }
2656   R.clear();
2657 
2658   // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
2659   // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
2660   if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
2661     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2662         << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << NameRange;
2663     return true;
2664   }
2665 
2666   // Give up, we can't recover.
2667   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name << NameRange;
2668   return true;
2669 }
2670 
2671 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has
2672 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then
2673 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class.  We can only
2674 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts
2675 /// where 'this' is available.  This doesn't precisely match MSVC's
2676 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough.
2677 static Expr *
recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema & S,ASTContext & Context,DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs)2678 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context,
2679                                DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2680                                SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
2681                                const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2682   // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or
2683   // contexts where 'this' is available.
2684   QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType();
2685   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
2686   if (!ThisType.isNull())
2687     RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
2688   else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext))
2689     RD = MD->getParent();
2690   if (!RD || !RD->hasDefinition() || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases())
2691     return nullptr;
2692 
2693   // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class.  If 'this'
2694   // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit.
2695   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2696   auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base);
2697   DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD;
2698 
2699   if (!ThisType.isNull()) {
2700     DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->");
2701     return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
2702         Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true,
2703         /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc,
2704         /*FirstQualifierFoundInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2705   }
2706 
2707   // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class.  This will
2708   // perform name lookup during template instantiation.
2709   CXXScopeSpec SS;
2710   auto *NNS =
2711       NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->getTypeForDecl());
2712   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc));
2713   return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create(
2714       Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2715       TemplateArgs);
2716 }
2717 
2718 ExprResult
ActOnIdExpression(Scope * S,CXXScopeSpec & SS,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,UnqualifiedId & Id,bool HasTrailingLParen,bool IsAddressOfOperand,CorrectionCandidateCallback * CCC,bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier,Token * KeywordReplacement)2719 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2720                         SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
2721                         bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2722                         CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC,
2723                         bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) {
2724   assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
2725          "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
2726   if (SS.isInvalid())
2727     return ExprError();
2728 
2729   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
2730 
2731   // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
2732   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
2733   const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
2734   DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2735 
2736   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
2737   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2738   SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2739 
2740   if (II && II->isEditorPlaceholder()) {
2741     // FIXME: When typed placeholders are supported we can create a typed
2742     // placeholder expression node.
2743     return ExprError();
2744   }
2745 
2746   // This specially handles arguments of attributes appertains to a type of C
2747   // struct field such that the name lookup within a struct finds the member
2748   // name, which is not the case for other contexts in C.
2749   if (isAttrContext() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->isClassScope()) {
2750     // See if this is reference to a field of struct.
2751     LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
2752     // LookupName handles a name lookup from within anonymous struct.
2753     if (LookupName(R, S)) {
2754       if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(R.getFoundDecl())) {
2755         QualType type = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
2756         // This will eventually be translated into MemberExpr upon
2757         // the use of instantiated struct fields.
2758         return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, VK_LValue, NameLoc);
2759       }
2760     }
2761   }
2762 
2763   // Perform the required lookup.
2764   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
2765                  (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
2766                      ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam
2767                      : LookupOrdinaryName);
2768   if (TemplateKWLoc.isValid() || TemplateArgs) {
2769     // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
2770     // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
2771     // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
2772     // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
2773     // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
2774     AssumedTemplateKind AssumedTemplate;
2775     if (LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, /*ObjectType=*/QualType(),
2776                            /*EnteringContext=*/false, TemplateKWLoc,
2777                            &AssumedTemplate))
2778       return ExprError();
2779 
2780     if (R.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() || SS.isInvalid())
2781       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2782                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2783   } else {
2784     bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl();
2785     LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, /*ObjectType=*/QualType(),
2786                      /*AllowBuiltinCreation=*/!IvarLookupFollowUp);
2787 
2788     // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
2789     // id-expression.
2790     if (R.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() || SS.isInvalid())
2791       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2792                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2793 
2794     // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
2795     // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
2796     if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
2797       ExprResult E(ObjC().LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
2798       if (E.isInvalid())
2799         return ExprError();
2800 
2801       if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>())
2802         return Ex;
2803     }
2804   }
2805 
2806   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2807     return ExprError();
2808 
2809   // This could be an implicitly declared function reference if the language
2810   // mode allows it as a feature.
2811   if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II &&
2812       getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) {
2813     NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
2814     if (D) R.addDecl(D);
2815   }
2816 
2817   // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
2818   // argument-dependent lookup.
2819   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
2820 
2821   if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
2822     if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
2823       if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo,
2824                                                    TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs))
2825         return E;
2826     }
2827 
2828     // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly.
2829     if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier)
2830       return ExprError();
2831 
2832     // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
2833     // call, diagnose the problem.
2834     DefaultFilterCCC DefaultValidator(II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep()
2835                                                        : nullptr);
2836     DefaultValidator.IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand;
2837     assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) &&
2838            "Typo correction callback misconfigured");
2839     if (CCC) {
2840       // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is.
2841       CCC->setTypoName(II);
2842       if (SS.isValid())
2843         CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep());
2844     }
2845     // FIXME: DiagnoseEmptyLookup produces bad diagnostics if we're looking for
2846     // a template name, but we happen to have always already looked up the name
2847     // before we get here if it must be a template name.
2848     if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CCC ? *CCC : DefaultValidator, nullptr,
2849                             {}, nullptr))
2850       return ExprError();
2851 
2852     assert(!R.empty() &&
2853            "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
2854 
2855     // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
2856     // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
2857     // reference the ivar.
2858     if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
2859       R.clear();
2860       ExprResult E(ObjC().LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
2861       // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
2862       // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
2863       if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
2864         return ExprError();
2865       return E;
2866     }
2867   }
2868 
2869   // This is guaranteed from this point on.
2870   assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
2871 
2872   // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
2873   // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
2874   //   When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
2875   //   syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
2876   //   body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
2877   //   resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
2878   //   member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
2879   //   class member access expression using (*this) as the
2880   //   postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
2881   //
2882   // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
2883   // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
2884   // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
2885   // non-static member function:
2886   //
2887   // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
2888   //   Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
2889   //   [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
2890   //   member function call.
2891   //
2892   // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
2893   // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
2894   // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
2895   // instance method.
2896   if (isPotentialImplicitMemberAccess(SS, R, IsAddressOfOperand))
2897     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, TemplateArgs,
2898                                            S);
2899 
2900   if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) {
2901 
2902     // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it
2903     // in BuildTemplateIdExpr().
2904     // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration.
2905     if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId &&
2906         Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) {
2907       assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() &&
2908              "There should only be one declaration found.");
2909     }
2910 
2911     return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs);
2912   }
2913 
2914   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
2915 }
2916 
BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec & SS,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,bool IsAddressOfOperand,TypeSourceInfo ** RecoveryTSI)2917 ExprResult Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(
2918     CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2919     bool IsAddressOfOperand, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) {
2920   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
2921   LookupParsedName(R, /*S=*/nullptr, &SS, /*ObjectType=*/QualType());
2922 
2923   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2924     return ExprError();
2925 
2926   if (R.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() || SS.isInvalid())
2927     return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2928                                      NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2929 
2930   if (R.empty()) {
2931     // Don't diagnose problems with invalid record decl, the secondary no_member
2932     // diagnostic during template instantiation is likely bogus, e.g. if a class
2933     // is invalid because it's derived from an invalid base class, then missing
2934     // members were likely supposed to be inherited.
2935     DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS);
2936     if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
2937       if (CD->isInvalidDecl() || CD->isBeingDefined())
2938         return ExprError();
2939     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2940       << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
2941     return ExprError();
2942   }
2943 
2944   if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) {
2945     QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
2946     QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None, SS, Ty);
2947 
2948     // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in
2949     // a dependent context.  If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to
2950     // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode.
2951     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
2952     if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
2953       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
2954     SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc();
2955     auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID);
2956     D << ET << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc());
2957 
2958     // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE
2959     // context.
2960     if (!RecoveryTSI)
2961       return ExprError();
2962 
2963     // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover.
2964     D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename ");
2965 
2966     // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type.
2967     TypeLocBuilder TLB;
2968     TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc());
2969 
2970     ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET);
2971     QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
2972     QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
2973 
2974     *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET);
2975 
2976     return ExprEmpty();
2977   }
2978 
2979   // If necessary, build an implicit class member access.
2980   if (isPotentialImplicitMemberAccess(SS, R, IsAddressOfOperand))
2981     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS,
2982                                            /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2983                                            R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr,
2984                                            /*S=*/nullptr);
2985 
2986   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL=*/false);
2987 }
2988 
2989 ExprResult
PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr * From,NestedNameSpecifier * Qualifier,NamedDecl * FoundDecl,NamedDecl * Member)2990 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
2991                                     NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
2992                                     NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
2993                                     NamedDecl *Member) {
2994   const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
2995   if (!RD)
2996     return From;
2997 
2998   QualType DestRecordType;
2999   QualType DestType;
3000   QualType FromRecordType;
3001   QualType FromType = From->getType();
3002   bool PointerConversions = false;
3003   if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
3004     DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
3005     auto FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
3006     DestRecordType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(
3007         DestRecordType, FromPtrType
3008                             ? FromType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace()
3009                             : FromType.getAddressSpace());
3010 
3011     if (FromPtrType) {
3012       DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
3013       FromRecordType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
3014       PointerConversions = true;
3015     } else {
3016       DestType = DestRecordType;
3017       FromRecordType = FromType;
3018     }
3019   } else if (const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
3020     if (!Method->isImplicitObjectMemberFunction())
3021       return From;
3022 
3023     DestType = Method->getThisType().getNonReferenceType();
3024     DestRecordType = Method->getFunctionObjectParameterType();
3025 
3026     if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3027       FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
3028       PointerConversions = true;
3029     } else {
3030       FromRecordType = FromType;
3031       DestType = DestRecordType;
3032     }
3033 
3034     LangAS FromAS = FromRecordType.getAddressSpace();
3035     LangAS DestAS = DestRecordType.getAddressSpace();
3036     if (FromAS != DestAS) {
3037       QualType FromRecordTypeWithoutAS =
3038           Context.removeAddrSpaceQualType(FromRecordType);
3039       QualType FromTypeWithDestAS =
3040           Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(FromRecordTypeWithoutAS, DestAS);
3041       if (PointerConversions)
3042         FromTypeWithDestAS = Context.getPointerType(FromTypeWithDestAS);
3043       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, FromTypeWithDestAS,
3044                                CK_AddressSpaceConversion, From->getValueKind())
3045                  .get();
3046     }
3047   } else {
3048     // No conversion necessary.
3049     return From;
3050   }
3051 
3052   if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
3053     return From;
3054 
3055   // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
3056   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
3057     return From;
3058 
3059   SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
3060   SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
3061 
3062   ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
3063 
3064   // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
3065   //   [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
3066   //   class name.
3067   //
3068   // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
3069   // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
3070   // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
3071   // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
3072   //
3073   //   class Base { public: int x; };
3074   //   class Derived1 : public Base { };
3075   //   class Derived2 : public Base { };
3076   //   class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
3077   //
3078   //   void VeryDerived::f() {
3079   //     x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
3080   //     Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
3081   //   }
3082   if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) {
3083     QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
3084     assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
3085 
3086     QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->castAs<RecordType>(), 0);
3087 
3088     // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
3089     // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
3090     // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
3091     if (IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
3092       CXXCastPath BasePath;
3093       if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
3094                                        FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
3095         return ExprError();
3096 
3097       if (PointerConversions)
3098         QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
3099       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
3100                                VK, &BasePath).get();
3101 
3102       FromType = QType;
3103       FromRecordType = QRecordType;
3104 
3105       // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
3106       // we're done.
3107       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
3108         return From;
3109     }
3110   }
3111 
3112   CXXCastPath BasePath;
3113   if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
3114                                    FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
3115                                    /*IgnoreAccess=*/true))
3116     return ExprError();
3117 
3118   // Propagate qualifiers to base subobjects as per:
3119   // C++ [basic.type.qualifier]p1.2:
3120   //   A volatile object is [...] a subobject of a volatile object.
3121   Qualifiers FromTypeQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3122   FromTypeQuals.setAddressSpace(DestType.getAddressSpace());
3123   DestType = Context.getQualifiedType(DestType, FromTypeQuals);
3124 
3125   return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, VK,
3126                            &BasePath);
3127 }
3128 
UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,const LookupResult & R,bool HasTrailingLParen)3129 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3130                                       const LookupResult &R,
3131                                       bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3132   // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
3133   if (!HasTrailingLParen)
3134     return false;
3135 
3136   // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
3137   if (SS.isNotEmpty())
3138     return false;
3139 
3140   // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
3141   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
3142     return false;
3143 
3144   // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
3145   // normal lookup:
3146   for (const NamedDecl *D : R) {
3147     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
3148     //     -- a declaration of a class member
3149     // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
3150     // original decl.
3151     if (D->isCXXClassMember())
3152       return false;
3153 
3154     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
3155     //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
3156     //        using-declaration
3157     // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
3158     // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
3159     // turn off ADL anyway).
3160     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3161       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3162     else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
3163       return false;
3164 
3165     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
3166     //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
3167     //        template
3168     // And also for builtin functions.
3169     if (const auto *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
3170       // But also builtin functions.
3171       if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
3172         return false;
3173     } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
3174       return false;
3175   }
3176 
3177   return true;
3178 }
3179 
3180 
3181 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
3182 /// as an expression.  This is only actually called for lookups that
3183 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
3184 /// will in fact be used.
CheckDeclInExpr(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,NamedDecl * D,bool AcceptInvalid)3185 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D,
3186                             bool AcceptInvalid) {
3187   if (D->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalid)
3188     return true;
3189 
3190   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
3191     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
3192     return true;
3193   }
3194 
3195   if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
3196     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
3197     return true;
3198   }
3199 
3200   if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
3201     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
3202     return true;
3203   }
3204 
3205   return false;
3206 }
3207 
3208 // Certain multiversion types should be treated as overloaded even when there is
3209 // only one result.
ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult & R)3210 static bool ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult &R) {
3211   assert(R.isSingleResult() && "Expected only a single result");
3212   const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
3213   return FD &&
3214          (FD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || FD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion());
3215 }
3216 
BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,LookupResult & R,bool NeedsADL,bool AcceptInvalidDecl)3217 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3218                                           LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL,
3219                                           bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
3220   // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
3221   // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
3222   if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() &&
3223       !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>() &&
3224       !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R))
3225     return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(),
3226                                     R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr,
3227                                     AcceptInvalidDecl);
3228 
3229   // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
3230   // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
3231   // functions and function templates.
3232   if (R.isSingleResult() && !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R) &&
3233       CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl(),
3234                       AcceptInvalidDecl))
3235     return ExprError();
3236 
3237   // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression.  Suppress
3238   // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
3239   // we've picked a target.
3240   R.suppressDiagnostics();
3241 
3242   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(
3243       Context, R.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
3244       R.getLookupNameInfo(), NeedsADL, R.begin(), R.end(),
3245       /*KnownDependent=*/false, /*KnownInstantiationDependent=*/false);
3246 
3247   return ULE;
3248 }
3249 
3250 static void diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(Sema &S,
3251                                                         SourceLocation loc,
3252                                                         ValueDecl *var);
3253 
BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,NamedDecl * D,NamedDecl * FoundD,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs,bool AcceptInvalidDecl)3254 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
3255     const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
3256     NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
3257     bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
3258   assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
3259   assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
3260          "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
3261 
3262   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
3263   if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D, AcceptInvalidDecl)) {
3264     // Recovery from invalid cases (e.g. D is an invalid Decl).
3265     // We use the dependent type for the RecoveryExpr to prevent bogus follow-up
3266     // diagnostics, as invalid decls use int as a fallback type.
3267     return CreateRecoveryExpr(NameInfo.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo.getEndLoc(), {});
3268   }
3269 
3270   if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
3271     // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
3272     // a template argument list.
3273     diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(SS, /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, TD, Loc);
3274     return ExprError();
3275   }
3276 
3277   // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
3278   if (!isa<ValueDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(D)) {
3279     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) << D << SS.getRange();
3280     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
3281     return ExprError();
3282   }
3283 
3284   // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
3285   // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
3286   // on this function name, because this might not be the function
3287   // that overload resolution actually selects.
3288   if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(D, Loc))
3289     return ExprError();
3290 
3291   auto *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D);
3292 
3293   // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
3294   if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl)
3295     return ExprError();
3296 
3297   // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions.  If we got here,
3298   // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
3299   // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
3300   if (auto *IndirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD);
3301       IndirectField && !IndirectField->isCXXClassMember())
3302     return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
3303                                                     IndirectField);
3304 
3305   QualType type = VD->getType();
3306   if (type.isNull())
3307     return ExprError();
3308   ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3309 
3310   // In 'T ...V;', the type of the declaration 'V' is 'T...', but the type of
3311   // a reference to 'V' is simply (unexpanded) 'T'. The type, like the value,
3312   // is expanded by some outer '...' in the context of the use.
3313   type = type.getNonPackExpansionType();
3314 
3315   switch (D->getKind()) {
3316     // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
3317 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
3318 #define VALUE(type, base)
3319 #define DECL(type, base) case Decl::type:
3320 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
3321     llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
3322 
3323   // These shouldn't make it here.
3324   case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
3325     llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
3326 
3327   // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
3328   // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
3329   case Decl::EnumConstant:
3330   case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
3331   case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction:
3332   case Decl::OMPDeclareMapper:
3333     valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3334     break;
3335 
3336   // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
3337   // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
3338   // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
3339   // exist in the high-level semantics.
3340   case Decl::Field:
3341   case Decl::IndirectField:
3342   case Decl::ObjCIvar:
3343     assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isAttrContext()) &&
3344            "building reference to field in C?");
3345 
3346     // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
3347     // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
3348     type = type.getNonReferenceType();
3349     valueKind = VK_LValue;
3350     break;
3351 
3352   // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
3353   // depending on the type.
3354   case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
3355     if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
3356       type = reftype->getPointeeType();
3357       valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
3358       break;
3359     }
3360 
3361     // [expr.prim.id.unqual]p2:
3362     //   If the entity is a template parameter object for a template
3363     //   parameter of type T, the type of the expression is const T.
3364     //   [...] The expression is an lvalue if the entity is a [...] template
3365     //   parameter object.
3366     if (type->isRecordType()) {
3367       type = type.getUnqualifiedType().withConst();
3368       valueKind = VK_LValue;
3369       break;
3370     }
3371 
3372     // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
3373     // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
3374     valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3375     type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
3376     break;
3377   }
3378 
3379   case Decl::Var:
3380   case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
3381   case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
3382   case Decl::Decomposition:
3383   case Decl::Binding:
3384   case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr:
3385     // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
3386     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type.hasQualifiers() &&
3387         type->isVoidType()) {
3388       valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3389       break;
3390     }
3391     [[fallthrough]];
3392 
3393   case Decl::ImplicitParam:
3394   case Decl::ParmVar: {
3395     // These are always l-values.
3396     valueKind = VK_LValue;
3397     type = type.getNonReferenceType();
3398 
3399     // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in
3400     // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually
3401     // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no.
3402     if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) {
3403       QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<ValueDecl>(VD), Loc);
3404       if (!CapturedType.isNull())
3405         type = CapturedType;
3406     }
3407     break;
3408   }
3409 
3410   case Decl::Function: {
3411     if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) {
3412       if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isDirectlyAddressable(BID)) {
3413         type = Context.BuiltinFnTy;
3414         valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3415         break;
3416       }
3417     }
3418 
3419     const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
3420 
3421     // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
3422     // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
3423     if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
3424       type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
3425       valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3426       break;
3427     }
3428 
3429     // Functions are l-values in C++.
3430     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3431       valueKind = VK_LValue;
3432       break;
3433     }
3434 
3435     // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
3436     // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
3437     // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
3438     // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
3439     // type.
3440     if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
3441       type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(),
3442                                             fty->getExtInfo());
3443 
3444     // Functions are r-values in C.
3445     valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3446     break;
3447   }
3448 
3449   case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide:
3450     llvm_unreachable("building reference to deduction guide");
3451 
3452   case Decl::MSProperty:
3453   case Decl::MSGuid:
3454   case Decl::TemplateParamObject:
3455     // FIXME: Should MSGuidDecl and template parameter objects be subject to
3456     // capture in OpenMP, or duplicated between host and device?
3457     valueKind = VK_LValue;
3458     break;
3459 
3460   case Decl::UnnamedGlobalConstant:
3461     valueKind = VK_LValue;
3462     break;
3463 
3464   case Decl::CXXMethod:
3465     // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
3466     // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
3467     // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
3468     if (const FunctionProtoType *proto =
3469             dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
3470       if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
3471         type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
3472         valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3473         break;
3474       }
3475 
3476     // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
3477     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
3478       valueKind = VK_LValue;
3479       break;
3480     }
3481     [[fallthrough]];
3482 
3483   case Decl::CXXConversion:
3484   case Decl::CXXDestructor:
3485   case Decl::CXXConstructor:
3486     valueKind = VK_PRValue;
3487     break;
3488   }
3489 
3490   auto *E =
3491       BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD,
3492                        /*FIXME: TemplateKWLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateArgs);
3493   // Clang AST consumers assume a DeclRefExpr refers to a valid decl. We
3494   // wrap a DeclRefExpr referring to an invalid decl with a dependent-type
3495   // RecoveryExpr to avoid follow-up semantic analysis (thus prevent bogus
3496   // diagnostics).
3497   if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && E)
3498     return CreateRecoveryExpr(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getEndLoc(), {E});
3499   return E;
3500 }
3501 
ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth,StringRef Source,SmallString<32> & Target)3502 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source,
3503                                     SmallString<32> &Target) {
3504   Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1));
3505   char *ResultPtr = &Target[0];
3506   const llvm::UTF8 *ErrorPtr;
3507   bool success =
3508       llvm::ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr);
3509   (void)success;
3510   assert(success);
3511   Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]);
3512 }
3513 
BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,PredefinedIdentKind IK)3514 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
3515                                      PredefinedIdentKind IK) {
3516   Decl *currentDecl = getPredefinedExprDecl(CurContext);
3517   if (!currentDecl) {
3518     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
3519     currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
3520   }
3521 
3522   QualType ResTy;
3523   StringLiteral *SL = nullptr;
3524   if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext())
3525     ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
3526   else {
3527     // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of
3528     // the string.
3529     bool ForceElaboratedPrinting =
3530         IK == PredefinedIdentKind::Function && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat;
3531     auto Str =
3532         PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IK, currentDecl, ForceElaboratedPrinting);
3533     unsigned Length = Str.length();
3534 
3535     llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
3536     if (IK == PredefinedIdentKind::LFunction ||
3537         IK == PredefinedIdentKind::LFuncSig) {
3538       ResTy =
3539           Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.WideCharTy.withConst());
3540       SmallString<32> RawChars;
3541       ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(),
3542                               Str, RawChars);
3543       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, nullptr,
3544                                            ArraySizeModifier::Normal,
3545                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3546       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteralKind::Wide,
3547                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3548     } else {
3549       ResTy = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst());
3550       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, nullptr,
3551                                            ArraySizeModifier::Normal,
3552                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3553       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteralKind::Ordinary,
3554                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3555     }
3556   }
3557 
3558   return PredefinedExpr::Create(Context, Loc, ResTy, IK, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt,
3559                                 SL);
3560 }
3561 
ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,tok::TokenKind Kind)3562 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
3563   return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, getPredefinedExprKind(Kind));
3564 }
3565 
ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token & Tok,Scope * UDLScope)3566 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3567   SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
3568   bool Invalid = false;
3569   StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
3570   if (Invalid)
3571     return ExprError();
3572 
3573   CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
3574                             PP, Tok.getKind());
3575   if (Literal.hadError())
3576     return ExprError();
3577 
3578   QualType Ty;
3579   if (Literal.isWide())
3580     Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++.
3581   else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().C23)
3582     Ty = Context.UnsignedCharTy; // u8'x' -> unsigned char in C23
3583   else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().Char8)
3584     Ty = Context.Char8Ty; // u8'x' -> char8_t when it exists.
3585   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3586     Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11.
3587   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3588     Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11.
3589   else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar())
3590     Ty = Context.IntTy;   // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
3591   else
3592     Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++;
3593                          // u8'x' -> char in C11-C17 and in C++ without char8_t.
3594 
3595   CharacterLiteralKind Kind = CharacterLiteralKind::Ascii;
3596   if (Literal.isWide())
3597     Kind = CharacterLiteralKind::Wide;
3598   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3599     Kind = CharacterLiteralKind::UTF16;
3600   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3601     Kind = CharacterLiteralKind::UTF32;
3602   else if (Literal.isUTF8())
3603     Kind = CharacterLiteralKind::UTF8;
3604 
3605   Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
3606                                              Tok.getLocation());
3607 
3608   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
3609     return Lit;
3610 
3611   // We're building a user-defined literal.
3612   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3613   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3614     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3615 
3616   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3617   if (!UDLScope)
3618     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl));
3619 
3620   // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
3621   //   operator "" X (ch)
3622   return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc,
3623                                         Lit, Tok.getLocation());
3624 }
3625 
ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc,int64_t Val)3626 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, int64_t Val) {
3627   unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3628   return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context,
3629                                 llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val, /*isSigned=*/true),
3630                                 Context.IntTy, Loc);
3631 }
3632 
BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema & S,NumericLiteralParser & Literal,QualType Ty,SourceLocation Loc)3633 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal,
3634                                   QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) {
3635   const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
3636 
3637   using llvm::APFloat;
3638   APFloat Val(Format);
3639 
3640   llvm::RoundingMode RM = S.CurFPFeatures.getRoundingMode();
3641   if (RM == llvm::RoundingMode::Dynamic)
3642     RM = llvm::RoundingMode::NearestTiesToEven;
3643   APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val, RM);
3644 
3645   // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
3646   // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
3647   if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
3648       ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
3649     unsigned diagnostic;
3650     SmallString<20> buffer;
3651     if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
3652       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
3653       APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
3654     } else {
3655       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
3656       APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
3657     }
3658 
3659     S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << Ty << buffer.str();
3660   }
3661 
3662   bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
3663   return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc);
3664 }
3665 
CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc,bool AllowZero)3666 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, bool AllowZero) {
3667   assert(E && "Invalid expression");
3668 
3669   if (E->isValueDependent())
3670     return false;
3671 
3672   QualType QT = E->getType();
3673   if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) {
3674     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT;
3675     return true;
3676   }
3677 
3678   llvm::APSInt ValueAPS;
3679   ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS);
3680 
3681   if (R.isInvalid())
3682     return true;
3683 
3684   // GCC allows the value of unroll count to be 0.
3685   // https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Loop-Specific-Pragmas.html says
3686   // "The values of 0 and 1 block any unrolling of the loop."
3687   // The values doesn't have to be strictly positive in '#pragma GCC unroll' and
3688   // '#pragma unroll' cases.
3689   bool ValueIsPositive =
3690       AllowZero ? ValueAPS.isNonNegative() : ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive();
3691   if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) {
3692     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_requires_positive_value)
3693         << toString(ValueAPS, 10) << ValueIsPositive;
3694     return true;
3695   }
3696 
3697   return false;
3698 }
3699 
ActOnNumericConstant(const Token & Tok,Scope * UDLScope)3700 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3701   // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common).  A single digit
3702   // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix.
3703   if (Tok.getLength() == 1 || Tok.getKind() == tok::binary_data) {
3704     const uint8_t Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
3705     return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val);
3706   }
3707 
3708   SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer;
3709   // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character.  Add padding to
3710   // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer.  If getSpelling()
3711   // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at
3712   // the EOF, so it is also safe.
3713   SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1);
3714 
3715   // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
3716   bool Invalid = false;
3717   StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid);
3718   if (Invalid)
3719     return ExprError();
3720 
3721   NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(),
3722                                PP.getSourceManager(), PP.getLangOpts(),
3723                                PP.getTargetInfo(), PP.getDiagnostics());
3724   if (Literal.hadError)
3725     return ExprError();
3726 
3727   if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) {
3728     // We're building a user-defined literal.
3729     const IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3730     SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3731       getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3732 
3733     // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3734     if (!UDLScope)
3735       return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl));
3736 
3737     QualType CookedTy;
3738     if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3739       // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3740       // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3741       //   operator "" X (f L)
3742       CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3743     } else {
3744       // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3745       // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3746       //   operator "" X (n ULL)
3747       CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3748     }
3749 
3750     DeclarationName OpName =
3751       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
3752     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
3753     OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
3754 
3755     SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation();
3756 
3757     // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw
3758     // literal or a cooked one.
3759     LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
3760     switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy,
3761                                   /*AllowRaw*/ true, /*AllowTemplate*/ true,
3762                                   /*AllowStringTemplatePack*/ false,
3763                                   /*DiagnoseMissing*/ !Literal.isImaginary)) {
3764     case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic:
3765       // Lookup failure for imaginary constants isn't fatal, there's still the
3766       // GNU extension producing _Complex types.
3767       break;
3768     case LOLR_Error:
3769       return ExprError();
3770     case LOLR_Cooked: {
3771       Expr *Lit;
3772       if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3773         Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation());
3774       } else {
3775         llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0);
3776         if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal))
3777           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3778               << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3779         Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy,
3780                                      Tok.getLocation());
3781       }
3782       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3783     }
3784 
3785     case LOLR_Raw: {
3786       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the
3787       // literal is treated as a call of the form
3788       //   operator "" X ("n")
3789       unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset();
3790       QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(
3791           Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()),
3792           llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), nullptr, ArraySizeModifier::Normal, 0);
3793       Expr *Lit =
3794           StringLiteral::Create(Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length),
3795                                 StringLiteralKind::Ordinary,
3796                                 /*Pascal*/ false, StrTy, TokLoc);
3797       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3798     }
3799 
3800     case LOLR_Template: {
3801       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator
3802       // template), L is treated as a call fo the form
3803       //   operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>()
3804       // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck.
3805       TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
3806       unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy);
3807       bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
3808       llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
3809       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) {
3810         Value = TokSpelling[I];
3811         TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy);
3812         TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
3813         ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
3814       }
3815       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, {}, TokLoc, &ExplicitArgs);
3816     }
3817     case LOLR_StringTemplatePack:
3818       llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
3819     }
3820   }
3821 
3822   Expr *Res;
3823 
3824   if (Literal.isFixedPointLiteral()) {
3825     QualType Ty;
3826 
3827     if (Literal.isAccum) {
3828       if (Literal.isHalf) {
3829         Ty = Context.ShortAccumTy;
3830       } else if (Literal.isLong) {
3831         Ty = Context.LongAccumTy;
3832       } else {
3833         Ty = Context.AccumTy;
3834       }
3835     } else if (Literal.isFract) {
3836       if (Literal.isHalf) {
3837         Ty = Context.ShortFractTy;
3838       } else if (Literal.isLong) {
3839         Ty = Context.LongFractTy;
3840       } else {
3841         Ty = Context.FractTy;
3842       }
3843     }
3844 
3845     if (Literal.isUnsigned) Ty = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Ty);
3846 
3847     bool isSigned = !Literal.isUnsigned;
3848     unsigned scale = Context.getFixedPointScale(Ty);
3849     unsigned bit_width = Context.getTypeInfo(Ty).Width;
3850 
3851     llvm::APInt Val(bit_width, 0, isSigned);
3852     bool Overflowed = Literal.GetFixedPointValue(Val, scale);
3853     bool ValIsZero = Val.isZero() && !Overflowed;
3854 
3855     auto MaxVal = Context.getFixedPointMax(Ty).getValue();
3856     if (Literal.isFract && Val == MaxVal + 1 && !ValIsZero)
3857       // Clause 6.4.4 - The value of a constant shall be in the range of
3858       // representable values for its type, with exception for constants of a
3859       // fract type with a value of exactly 1; such a constant shall denote
3860       // the maximal value for the type.
3861       --Val;
3862     else if (Val.ugt(MaxVal) || Overflowed)
3863       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_too_large_for_fixed_point);
3864 
3865     Res = FixedPointLiteral::CreateFromRawInt(Context, Val, Ty,
3866                                               Tok.getLocation(), scale);
3867   } else if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3868     QualType Ty;
3869     if (Literal.isHalf){
3870       if (getLangOpts().HLSL ||
3871           getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", getLangOpts()))
3872         Ty = Context.HalfTy;
3873       else {
3874         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_half_const_requires_fp16);
3875         return ExprError();
3876       }
3877     } else if (Literal.isFloat)
3878       Ty = Context.FloatTy;
3879     else if (Literal.isLong)
3880       Ty = !getLangOpts().HLSL ? Context.LongDoubleTy : Context.DoubleTy;
3881     else if (Literal.isFloat16)
3882       Ty = Context.Float16Ty;
3883     else if (Literal.isFloat128)
3884       Ty = Context.Float128Ty;
3885     else if (getLangOpts().HLSL)
3886       Ty = Context.FloatTy;
3887     else
3888       Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
3889 
3890     Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3891 
3892     if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
3893       if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
3894         if (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind() != BuiltinType::Float) {
3895           Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3896         }
3897       } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
3898                                              "cl_khr_fp64", getLangOpts())) {
3899         // Impose single-precision float type when cl_khr_fp64 is not enabled.
3900         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64)
3901             << (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 300);
3902         Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3903       }
3904     }
3905   } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
3906     return ExprError();
3907   } else {
3908     QualType Ty;
3909 
3910     // 'z/uz' literals are a C++23 feature.
3911     if (Literal.isSizeT)
3912       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
3913                                   ? getLangOpts().CPlusPlus23
3914                                         ? diag::warn_cxx20_compat_size_t_suffix
3915                                         : diag::ext_cxx23_size_t_suffix
3916                                   : diag::err_cxx23_size_t_suffix);
3917 
3918     // 'wb/uwb' literals are a C23 feature. We support _BitInt as a type in C++,
3919     // but we do not currently support the suffix in C++ mode because it's not
3920     // entirely clear whether WG21 will prefer this suffix to return a library
3921     // type such as std::bit_int instead of returning a _BitInt. '__wb/__uwb'
3922     // literals are a C++ extension.
3923     if (Literal.isBitInt)
3924       PP.Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
3925               getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? diag::ext_cxx_bitint_suffix
3926               : getLangOpts().C23     ? diag::warn_c23_compat_bitint_suffix
3927                                       : diag::ext_c23_bitint_suffix);
3928 
3929     // Get the value in the widest-possible width. What is "widest" depends on
3930     // whether the literal is a bit-precise integer or not. For a bit-precise
3931     // integer type, try to scan the source to determine how many bits are
3932     // needed to represent the value. This may seem a bit expensive, but trying
3933     // to get the integer value from an overly-wide APInt is *extremely*
3934     // expensive, so the naive approach of assuming
3935     // llvm::IntegerType::MAX_INT_BITS is a big performance hit.
3936     unsigned BitsNeeded = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth();
3937     if (Literal.isBitInt)
3938       BitsNeeded = llvm::APInt::getSufficientBitsNeeded(
3939           Literal.getLiteralDigits(), Literal.getRadix());
3940     if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
3941       if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 &&
3942           !Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
3943         PP.Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3944             << Literal.isUnsigned;
3945       BitsNeeded = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
3946     }
3947 
3948     llvm::APInt ResultVal(BitsNeeded, 0);
3949 
3950     if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
3951       // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull.
3952       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3953           << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3954       Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3955       assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
3956              "long long is not intmax_t?");
3957     } else {
3958       // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
3959       // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
3960 
3961       // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
3962       // be an unsigned int.
3963       bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
3964 
3965       // HLSL doesn't really have `long` or `long long`. We support the `ll`
3966       // suffix for portability of code with C++, but both `l` and `ll` are
3967       // 64-bit integer types, and we want the type of `1l` and `1ll` to be the
3968       // same.
3969       if (getLangOpts().HLSL && !Literal.isLong && Literal.isLongLong) {
3970         Literal.isLong = true;
3971         Literal.isLongLong = false;
3972       }
3973 
3974       // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
3975       unsigned Width = 0;
3976 
3977       // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized.
3978       if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
3979         if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) {
3980           Width = 8;
3981           Ty = Context.CharTy;
3982         } else {
3983           Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
3984           Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width,
3985                                              /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned);
3986         }
3987       }
3988 
3989       // Bit-precise integer literals are automagically-sized based on the
3990       // width required by the literal.
3991       if (Literal.isBitInt) {
3992         // The signed version has one more bit for the sign value. There are no
3993         // zero-width bit-precise integers, even if the literal value is 0.
3994         Width = std::max(ResultVal.getActiveBits(), 1u) +
3995                 (Literal.isUnsigned ? 0u : 1u);
3996 
3997         // Diagnose if the width of the constant is larger than BITINT_MAXWIDTH,
3998         // and reset the type to the largest supported width.
3999         unsigned int MaxBitIntWidth =
4000             Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxBitIntWidth();
4001         if (Width > MaxBitIntWidth) {
4002           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
4003               << Literal.isUnsigned;
4004           Width = MaxBitIntWidth;
4005         }
4006 
4007         // Reset the result value to the smaller APInt and select the correct
4008         // type to be used. Note, we zext even for signed values because the
4009         // literal itself is always an unsigned value (a preceeding - is a
4010         // unary operator, not part of the literal).
4011         ResultVal = ResultVal.zextOrTrunc(Width);
4012         Ty = Context.getBitIntType(Literal.isUnsigned, Width);
4013       }
4014 
4015       // Check C++23 size_t literals.
4016       if (Literal.isSizeT) {
4017         assert(!Literal.MicrosoftInteger &&
4018                "size_t literals can't be Microsoft literals");
4019         unsigned SizeTSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getTypeWidth(
4020             Context.getTargetInfo().getSizeType());
4021 
4022         // Does it fit in size_t?
4023         if (ResultVal.isIntN(SizeTSize)) {
4024           // Does it fit in ssize_t?
4025           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[SizeTSize - 1] == 0)
4026             Ty = Context.getSignedSizeType();
4027           else if (AllowUnsigned)
4028             Ty = Context.getSizeType();
4029           Width = SizeTSize;
4030         }
4031       }
4032 
4033       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong &&
4034           !Literal.isSizeT) {
4035         // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
4036         unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
4037 
4038         // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
4039         if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
4040           // Does it fit in a signed int?
4041           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
4042             Ty = Context.IntTy;
4043           else if (AllowUnsigned)
4044             Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
4045           Width = IntSize;
4046         }
4047       }
4048 
4049       // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
4050       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong && !Literal.isSizeT) {
4051         unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
4052 
4053         // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
4054         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
4055           // Does it fit in a signed long?
4056           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
4057             Ty = Context.LongTy;
4058           else if (AllowUnsigned)
4059             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
4060           // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2
4061           // is compatible.
4062           else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
4063             const unsigned LongLongSize =
4064                 Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
4065             Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
4066                  getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
4067                      ? Literal.isLong
4068                            ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
4069                            : /*C++98 UB*/ diag::
4070                                  ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
4071                      : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long)
4072                 << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0
4073                                             : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1);
4074             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
4075           }
4076           Width = LongSize;
4077         }
4078       }
4079 
4080       // Check long long if needed.
4081       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isSizeT) {
4082         unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
4083 
4084         // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
4085         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
4086           // Does it fit in a signed long long?
4087           // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
4088           // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
4089           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
4090               (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && Literal.isLongLong)))
4091             Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
4092           else if (AllowUnsigned)
4093             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
4094           Width = LongLongSize;
4095 
4096           // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature, whether the literal
4097           // explicitly specified 'long long' or we needed the extra width.
4098           if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4099             Diag(Tok.getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11
4100                                         ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong
4101                                         : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong);
4102           else if (!getLangOpts().C99)
4103             Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong);
4104         }
4105       }
4106 
4107       // If we still couldn't decide a type, we either have 'size_t' literal
4108       // that is out of range, or a decimal literal that does not fit in a
4109       // signed long long and has no U suffix.
4110       if (Ty.isNull()) {
4111         if (Literal.isSizeT)
4112           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_size_t_literal_too_large)
4113               << Literal.isUnsigned;
4114         else
4115           Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
4116                diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed);
4117         Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
4118         Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
4119       }
4120 
4121       if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
4122         ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
4123     }
4124     Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
4125   }
4126 
4127   // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
4128   if (Literal.isImaginary) {
4129     Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
4130                                         Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
4131 
4132     // In C++, this is a GNU extension. In C, it's a C2y extension.
4133     unsigned DiagId;
4134     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4135       DiagId = diag::ext_gnu_imaginary_constant;
4136     else if (getLangOpts().C2y)
4137       DiagId = diag::warn_c23_compat_imaginary_constant;
4138     else
4139       DiagId = diag::ext_c2y_imaginary_constant;
4140     Diag(Tok.getLocation(), DiagId);
4141   }
4142   return Res;
4143 }
4144 
ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,SourceLocation R,Expr * E)4145 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
4146   assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
4147   QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
4148   if (getLangOpts().ProtectParens && CurFPFeatures.getAllowFPReassociate() &&
4149       !E->isLValue() && ExprTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())
4150     return BuildBuiltinCallExpr(R, Builtin::BI__arithmetic_fence, E);
4151   return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E);
4152 }
4153 
CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange)4154 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
4155                                          SourceLocation Loc,
4156                                          SourceRange ArgRange) {
4157   // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
4158   // scalar or vector data type argument..."
4159   // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
4160   // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
4161   if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
4162     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
4163       << T << ArgRange;
4164     return true;
4165   }
4166 
4167   assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
4168          "Scalar types should always be complete");
4169   return false;
4170 }
4171 
CheckVectorElementsTraitOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange)4172 static bool CheckVectorElementsTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
4173                                                 SourceLocation Loc,
4174                                                 SourceRange ArgRange) {
4175   // builtin_vectorelements supports both fixed-sized and scalable vectors.
4176   if (!T->isVectorType() && !T->isSizelessVectorType())
4177     return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_builtin_non_vector_type)
4178            << ""
4179            << "__builtin_vectorelements" << T << ArgRange;
4180 
4181   return false;
4182 }
4183 
checkPtrAuthTypeDiscriminatorOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange)4184 static bool checkPtrAuthTypeDiscriminatorOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
4185                                                      SourceLocation Loc,
4186                                                      SourceRange ArgRange) {
4187   if (S.checkPointerAuthEnabled(Loc, ArgRange))
4188     return true;
4189 
4190   if (!T->isFunctionType() && !T->isFunctionPointerType() &&
4191       !T->isFunctionReferenceType() && !T->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) {
4192     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ptrauth_type_disc_undiscriminated) << T << ArgRange;
4193     return true;
4194   }
4195 
4196   return false;
4197 }
4198 
CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind)4199 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
4200                                            SourceLocation Loc,
4201                                            SourceRange ArgRange,
4202                                            UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
4203   // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++.
4204   if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus)
4205     return true;
4206 
4207   // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
4208   if (T->isFunctionType() &&
4209       (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf ||
4210        TraitKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf)) {
4211     // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
4212     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
4213         << getTraitSpelling(TraitKind) << ArgRange;
4214     return false;
4215   }
4216 
4217   // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where
4218   // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k)
4219   if (T->isVoidType()) {
4220     unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type
4221                                         : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type;
4222     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << getTraitSpelling(TraitKind) << ArgRange;
4223     return false;
4224   }
4225 
4226   return true;
4227 }
4228 
CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind)4229 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
4230                                              SourceLocation Loc,
4231                                              SourceRange ArgRange,
4232                                              UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
4233   // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the
4234   // runtime doesn't allow it.
4235   if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
4236     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
4237       << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
4238       << ArgRange;
4239     return true;
4240   }
4241 
4242   return false;
4243 }
4244 
4245 /// Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed
4246 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is.
warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,QualType T,const Expr * E)4247 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
4248                                      const Expr *E) {
4249   // Don't warn if the operation changed the type.
4250   if (T != E->getType())
4251     return;
4252 
4253   // Now look for array decays.
4254   const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
4255   if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay)
4256     return;
4257 
4258   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange()
4259                                              << ICE->getType()
4260                                              << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType();
4261 }
4262 
CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr * E,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)4263 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
4264                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
4265   QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
4266   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
4267 
4268   bool IsUnevaluatedOperand =
4269       (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_DataSizeOf ||
4270        ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf ||
4271        ExprKind == UETT_VecStep || ExprKind == UETT_CountOf);
4272   if (IsUnevaluatedOperand) {
4273     ExprResult Result = CheckUnevaluatedOperand(E);
4274     if (Result.isInvalid())
4275       return true;
4276     E = Result.get();
4277   }
4278 
4279   // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context,
4280   // so side effects could result in unintended consequences.
4281   // Exclude instantiation-dependent expressions, because 'sizeof' is sometimes
4282   // used to build SFINAE gadgets.
4283   // FIXME: Should we consider instantiation-dependent operands to 'alignof'?
4284   if (IsUnevaluatedOperand && !inTemplateInstantiation() &&
4285       !E->isInstantiationDependent() &&
4286       !E->getType()->isVariableArrayType() &&
4287       E->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
4288     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
4289 
4290   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
4291     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
4292                                         E->getSourceRange());
4293 
4294   if (ExprKind == UETT_VectorElements)
4295     return CheckVectorElementsTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
4296                                                E->getSourceRange());
4297 
4298   // Explicitly list some types as extensions.
4299   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
4300                                       E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
4301     return false;
4302 
4303   // WebAssembly tables are always illegal operands to unary expressions and
4304   // type traits.
4305   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm() &&
4306       E->getType()->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
4307     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_wasm_table_invalid_uett_operand)
4308         << getTraitSpelling(ExprKind);
4309     return true;
4310   }
4311 
4312   // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of
4313   // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to
4314   // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown
4315   // bound).
4316   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) {
4317     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
4318             E->getExprLoc(), Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()),
4319             diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
4320             getTraitSpelling(ExprKind), E->getSourceRange()))
4321       return true;
4322   } else {
4323     if (RequireCompleteSizedExprType(
4324             E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
4325             getTraitSpelling(ExprKind), E->getSourceRange()))
4326       return true;
4327   }
4328 
4329   // Completing the expression's type may have changed it.
4330   ExprTy = E->getType();
4331   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
4332 
4333   if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) {
4334     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
4335         << getTraitSpelling(ExprKind) << E->getSourceRange();
4336     return true;
4337   }
4338 
4339   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
4340                                        E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
4341     return true;
4342 
4343   if (ExprKind == UETT_CountOf) {
4344     // The type has to be an array type. We already checked for incomplete
4345     // types above.
4346     QualType ExprType = E->IgnoreParens()->getType();
4347     if (!ExprType->isArrayType()) {
4348       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_countof_arg_not_array_type) << ExprType;
4349       return true;
4350     }
4351     // FIXME: warn on _Countof on an array parameter. Not warning on it
4352     // currently because there are papers in WG14 about array types which do
4353     // not decay that could impact this behavior, so we want to see if anything
4354     // changes here before coming up with a warning group for _Countof-related
4355     // diagnostics.
4356   }
4357 
4358   if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
4359     if (const auto *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
4360       if (const auto *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
4361         QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
4362         QualType Type = PVD->getType();
4363         if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
4364           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
4365             << Type << OType;
4366           Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
4367         }
4368       }
4369     }
4370 
4371     // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array
4372     // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most
4373     // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x".
4374     if (const auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
4375       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
4376                                BO->getLHS());
4377       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
4378                                BO->getRHS());
4379     }
4380   }
4381 
4382   return false;
4383 }
4384 
CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema & S,Expr * E,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)4385 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
4386   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
4387   if (E->isTypeDependent())
4388     return false;
4389 
4390   if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) {
4391     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield)
4392        << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
4393     return true;
4394   }
4395 
4396   ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
4397   Expr *Inner = E->IgnoreParens();
4398   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Inner)) {
4399     D = DRE->getDecl();
4400   } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Inner)) {
4401     D = ME->getMemberDecl();
4402   }
4403 
4404   // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a
4405   // complete definition so that we can compute the layout.
4406   //
4407   // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member
4408   // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression
4409   // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member
4410   // in a trailing-return-type.
4411   //
4412   // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC
4413   // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the
4414   // nonsensical answer 0.
4415   //
4416   // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just
4417   // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing
4418   // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of
4419   // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal
4420   // use-case.
4421   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) {
4422     // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a
4423     // definition if we can find a member of it.
4424     if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) {
4425       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type)
4426         << E->getSourceRange();
4427       return true;
4428     }
4429 
4430     // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have
4431     // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a
4432     // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to
4433     // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial.
4434     if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
4435       return false;
4436   }
4437 
4438   return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, ExprKind);
4439 }
4440 
CheckVecStepExpr(Expr * E)4441 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
4442   E = E->IgnoreParens();
4443 
4444   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
4445   if (E->isTypeDependent())
4446     return false;
4447 
4448   return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
4449 }
4450 
captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext & Context,QualType T,CapturingScopeInfo * CSI)4451 static void captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
4452                                         CapturingScopeInfo *CSI) {
4453   assert(T->isVariablyModifiedType());
4454   assert(CSI != nullptr);
4455 
4456   // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA expressions.
4457   do {
4458     const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
4459     switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) {
4460 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
4461 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
4462 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
4463 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
4464 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)
4465 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
4466       T = QualType();
4467       break;
4468     // These types are never variably-modified.
4469     case Type::Builtin:
4470     case Type::Complex:
4471     case Type::Vector:
4472     case Type::ExtVector:
4473     case Type::ConstantMatrix:
4474     case Type::Record:
4475     case Type::Enum:
4476     case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
4477     case Type::ObjCObject:
4478     case Type::ObjCInterface:
4479     case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
4480     case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
4481     case Type::Pipe:
4482     case Type::BitInt:
4483     case Type::HLSLInlineSpirv:
4484       llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!");
4485     case Type::Elaborated:
4486       T = cast<ElaboratedType>(Ty)->getNamedType();
4487       break;
4488     case Type::Adjusted:
4489       T = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType();
4490       break;
4491     case Type::Decayed:
4492       T = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
4493       break;
4494     case Type::ArrayParameter:
4495       T = cast<ArrayParameterType>(Ty)->getElementType();
4496       break;
4497     case Type::Pointer:
4498       T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
4499       break;
4500     case Type::BlockPointer:
4501       T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
4502       break;
4503     case Type::LValueReference:
4504     case Type::RValueReference:
4505       T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
4506       break;
4507     case Type::MemberPointer:
4508       T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
4509       break;
4510     case Type::ConstantArray:
4511     case Type::IncompleteArray:
4512       // Losing element qualification here is fine.
4513       T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType();
4514       break;
4515     case Type::VariableArray: {
4516       // Losing element qualification here is fine.
4517       const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty);
4518 
4519       // Unknown size indication requires no size computation.
4520       // Otherwise, evaluate and record it.
4521       auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr();
4522       if (Size && !CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT) &&
4523           (isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) || isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)))
4524         CSI->addVLATypeCapture(Size->getExprLoc(), VAT, Context.getSizeType());
4525 
4526       T = VAT->getElementType();
4527       break;
4528     }
4529     case Type::FunctionProto:
4530     case Type::FunctionNoProto:
4531       T = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType();
4532       break;
4533     case Type::Paren:
4534     case Type::TypeOf:
4535     case Type::UnaryTransform:
4536     case Type::Attributed:
4537     case Type::BTFTagAttributed:
4538     case Type::HLSLAttributedResource:
4539     case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
4540     case Type::MacroQualified:
4541     case Type::CountAttributed:
4542       // Keep walking after single level desugaring.
4543       T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Context);
4544       break;
4545     case Type::Typedef:
4546       T = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar();
4547       break;
4548     case Type::Decltype:
4549       T = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar();
4550       break;
4551     case Type::PackIndexing:
4552       T = cast<PackIndexingType>(Ty)->desugar();
4553       break;
4554     case Type::Using:
4555       T = cast<UsingType>(Ty)->desugar();
4556       break;
4557     case Type::Auto:
4558     case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
4559       T = cast<DeducedType>(Ty)->getDeducedType();
4560       break;
4561     case Type::TypeOfExpr:
4562       T = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType();
4563       break;
4564     case Type::Atomic:
4565       T = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType();
4566       break;
4567     }
4568   } while (!T.isNull() && T->isVariablyModifiedType());
4569 }
4570 
CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceRange ExprRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,StringRef KWName)4571 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
4572                                             SourceLocation OpLoc,
4573                                             SourceRange ExprRange,
4574                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
4575                                             StringRef KWName) {
4576   if (ExprType->isDependentType())
4577     return false;
4578 
4579   // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2:
4580   //     When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result
4581   //     is the size of the referenced type.
4582   // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
4583   //     When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result
4584   //     shall be the alignment of the referenced type.
4585   if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4586     ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
4587 
4588   // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
4589   //   When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result
4590   //   is the alignment of the element type.
4591   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf ||
4592       ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) {
4593     // If the trait is 'alignof' in C before C2y, the ability to apply the
4594     // trait to an incomplete array is an extension.
4595     if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4596         ExprType->isIncompleteArrayType())
4597       Diag(OpLoc, getLangOpts().C2y
4598                       ? diag::warn_c2y_compat_alignof_incomplete_array
4599                       : diag::ext_c2y_alignof_incomplete_array);
4600     ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType);
4601   }
4602 
4603   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
4604     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
4605 
4606   if (ExprKind == UETT_VectorElements)
4607     return CheckVectorElementsTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc,
4608                                                ExprRange);
4609 
4610   if (ExprKind == UETT_PtrAuthTypeDiscriminator)
4611     return checkPtrAuthTypeDiscriminatorOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc,
4612                                                     ExprRange);
4613 
4614   // Explicitly list some types as extensions.
4615   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
4616                                       ExprKind))
4617     return false;
4618 
4619   if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
4620           OpLoc, ExprType, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
4621           KWName, ExprRange))
4622     return true;
4623 
4624   if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) {
4625     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) << KWName << ExprRange;
4626     return true;
4627   }
4628 
4629   if (ExprKind == UETT_CountOf) {
4630     // The type has to be an array type. We already checked for incomplete
4631     // types above.
4632     if (!ExprType->isArrayType()) {
4633       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_countof_arg_not_array_type) << ExprType;
4634       return true;
4635     }
4636   }
4637 
4638   // WebAssembly tables are always illegal operands to unary expressions and
4639   // type traits.
4640   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm() &&
4641       ExprType->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
4642     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_wasm_table_invalid_uett_operand)
4643         << getTraitSpelling(ExprKind);
4644     return true;
4645   }
4646 
4647   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
4648                                        ExprKind))
4649     return true;
4650 
4651   if (ExprType->isVariablyModifiedType() && FunctionScopes.size() > 1) {
4652     if (auto *TT = ExprType->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
4653       for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(),
4654                 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend());
4655            I != E; ++I) {
4656         auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I);
4657         if (CSI == nullptr)
4658           break;
4659         DeclContext *DC = nullptr;
4660         if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))
4661           DC = LSI->CallOperator;
4662         else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))
4663           DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl;
4664         else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI))
4665           DC = BSI->TheDecl;
4666         if (DC) {
4667           if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl()))
4668             break;
4669           captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, ExprType, CSI);
4670         }
4671       }
4672     }
4673   }
4674 
4675   return false;
4676 }
4677 
CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,SourceRange R)4678 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
4679                                                 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4680                                                 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
4681                                                 SourceRange R) {
4682   if (!TInfo)
4683     return ExprError();
4684 
4685   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
4686 
4687   if (!T->isDependentType() &&
4688       CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind,
4689                                        getTraitSpelling(ExprKind)))
4690     return ExprError();
4691 
4692   // Adds overload of TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated for TypeSourceInfo to
4693   // properly deal with VLAs in nested calls of sizeof and typeof.
4694   if (currentEvaluationContext().isUnevaluated() &&
4695       currentEvaluationContext().InConditionallyConstantEvaluateContext &&
4696       (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_CountOf) &&
4697       TInfo->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
4698     TInfo = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(TInfo);
4699 
4700   // It's possible that the transformation above failed.
4701   if (!TInfo)
4702     return ExprError();
4703 
4704   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
4705   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
4706       ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd());
4707 }
4708 
4709 ExprResult
CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr * E,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)4710 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
4711                                      UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
4712   ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
4713   if (PE.isInvalid())
4714     return ExprError();
4715 
4716   E = PE.get();
4717 
4718   // Verify that the operand is valid.
4719   bool isInvalid = false;
4720   if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
4721     // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
4722   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) {
4723     isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, ExprKind);
4724   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
4725     isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
4726   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) {
4727       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr);
4728       isInvalid = true;
4729   } else if (E->refersToBitField()) {  // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
4730     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 0;
4731     isInvalid = true;
4732   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VectorElements || ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf ||
4733              ExprKind == UETT_CountOf) { // FIXME: __datasizeof?
4734     isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, ExprKind);
4735   }
4736 
4737   if (isInvalid)
4738     return ExprError();
4739 
4740   if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_CountOf) &&
4741       E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) {
4742     PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
4743     if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4744     E = PE.get();
4745   }
4746 
4747   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
4748   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
4749       ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
4750 }
4751 
4752 ExprResult
ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,bool IsType,void * TyOrEx,SourceRange ArgRange)4753 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
4754                                     UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
4755                                     void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange) {
4756   // If error parsing type, ignore.
4757   if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError();
4758 
4759   if (IsType) {
4760     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4761     (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
4762     return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
4763   }
4764 
4765   Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
4766   ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
4767   return Result;
4768 }
4769 
CheckAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceRange R)4770 bool Sema::CheckAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
4771                                     SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R) {
4772   if (!TInfo)
4773     return true;
4774   return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(TInfo->getType(), OpLoc, R,
4775                                           UETT_AlignOf, KWName);
4776 }
4777 
ActOnAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName,ParsedType Ty,SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceRange R)4778 bool Sema::ActOnAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, ParsedType Ty,
4779                                     SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R) {
4780   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4781   (void)GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(Ty.getAsOpaquePtr()),
4782                           &TInfo);
4783   return CheckAlignasTypeArgument(KWName, TInfo, OpLoc, R);
4784 }
4785 
CheckRealImagOperand(Sema & S,ExprResult & V,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsReal)4786 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
4787                                      bool IsReal) {
4788   if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
4789     return S.Context.DependentTy;
4790 
4791   // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
4792   if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
4793     V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get());
4794     if (V.isInvalid())
4795       return QualType();
4796   }
4797 
4798   // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
4799   if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
4800     return CT->getElementType();
4801 
4802   // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
4803   if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4804     return V.get()->getType();
4805 
4806   // Test for placeholders.
4807   ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
4808   if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
4809   if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
4810     V = PR;
4811     return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
4812   }
4813 
4814   // Reject anything else.
4815   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
4816     << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
4817   return QualType();
4818 }
4819 
4820 
4821 
4822 ExprResult
ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,tok::TokenKind Kind,Expr * Input)4823 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
4824                           tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
4825   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
4826   switch (Kind) {
4827   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
4828   case tok::plusplus:   Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
4829   case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
4830   }
4831 
4832   // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
4833   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input);
4834   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4835   Input = Result.get();
4836 
4837   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
4838 }
4839 
4840 /// Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal.
4841 ///
4842 /// \return true on error
checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation opLoc,Expr * op)4843 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S,
4844                                          SourceLocation opLoc,
4845                                          Expr *op) {
4846   assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType());
4847   if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() &&
4848       !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime)
4849     return false;
4850 
4851   S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
4852     << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType()
4853     << op->getSourceRange();
4854   return true;
4855 }
4856 
isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema & S,Expr * Base)4857 static bool isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema &S, Expr *Base) {
4858   auto *BaseNoParens = Base->IgnoreParens();
4859   if (auto *MSProp = dyn_cast<MSPropertyRefExpr>(BaseNoParens))
4860     return MSProp->getPropertyDecl()->getType()->isArrayType();
4861   return isa<MSPropertySubscriptExpr>(BaseNoParens);
4862 }
4863 
4864 // Returns the type used for LHS[RHS], given one of LHS, RHS is type-dependent.
4865 // Typically this is DependentTy, but can sometimes be more precise.
4866 //
4867 // There are cases when we could determine a non-dependent type:
4868 //  - LHS and RHS may have non-dependent types despite being type-dependent
4869 //    (e.g. unbounded array static members of the current instantiation)
4870 //  - one may be a dependent-sized array with known element type
4871 //  - one may be a dependent-typed valid index (enum in current instantiation)
4872 //
4873 // We *always* return a dependent type, in such cases it is DependentTy.
4874 // This avoids creating type-dependent expressions with non-dependent types.
4875 // FIXME: is this important to avoid? See https://reviews.llvm.org/D107275
getDependentArraySubscriptType(Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS,const ASTContext & Ctx)4876 static QualType getDependentArraySubscriptType(Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
4877                                                const ASTContext &Ctx) {
4878   assert(LHS->isTypeDependent() || RHS->isTypeDependent());
4879   QualType LTy = LHS->getType(), RTy = RHS->getType();
4880   QualType Result = Ctx.DependentTy;
4881   if (RTy->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
4882     if (const PointerType *PT = LTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4883       Result = PT->getPointeeType();
4884     else if (const ArrayType *AT = LTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
4885       Result = AT->getElementType();
4886   } else if (LTy->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
4887     if (const PointerType *PT = RTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4888       Result = PT->getPointeeType();
4889     else if (const ArrayType *AT = RTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
4890       Result = AT->getElementType();
4891   }
4892   // Ensure we return a dependent type.
4893   return Result->isDependentType() ? Result : Ctx.DependentTy;
4894 }
4895 
ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope * S,Expr * base,SourceLocation lbLoc,MultiExprArg ArgExprs,SourceLocation rbLoc)4896 ExprResult Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base,
4897                                          SourceLocation lbLoc,
4898                                          MultiExprArg ArgExprs,
4899                                          SourceLocation rbLoc) {
4900 
4901   if (base && !base->getType().isNull() &&
4902       base->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ArraySection)) {
4903     auto *AS = cast<ArraySectionExpr>(base);
4904     if (AS->isOMPArraySection())
4905       return OpenMP().ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(
4906           base, lbLoc, ArgExprs.front(), SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4907           /*Length*/ nullptr,
4908           /*Stride=*/nullptr, rbLoc);
4909 
4910     return OpenACC().ActOnArraySectionExpr(base, lbLoc, ArgExprs.front(),
4911                                            SourceLocation(), /*Length*/ nullptr,
4912                                            rbLoc);
4913   }
4914 
4915   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
4916   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) {
4917     ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base);
4918     if (result.isInvalid())
4919       return ExprError();
4920     base = result.get();
4921   }
4922 
4923   // Check if base and idx form a MatrixSubscriptExpr.
4924   //
4925   // Helper to check for comma expressions, which are not allowed as indices for
4926   // matrix subscript expressions.
4927   auto CheckAndReportCommaError = [this, base, rbLoc](Expr *E) {
4928     if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E) && cast<BinaryOperator>(E)->isCommaOp()) {
4929       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_matrix_subscript_comma)
4930           << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc);
4931       return true;
4932     }
4933     return false;
4934   };
4935   // The matrix subscript operator ([][])is considered a single operator.
4936   // Separating the index expressions by parenthesis is not allowed.
4937   if (base && !base->getType().isNull() &&
4938       base->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::IncompleteMatrixIdx) &&
4939       !isa<MatrixSubscriptExpr>(base)) {
4940     Diag(base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_matrix_separate_incomplete_index)
4941         << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc);
4942     return ExprError();
4943   }
4944   // If the base is a MatrixSubscriptExpr, try to create a new
4945   // MatrixSubscriptExpr.
4946   auto *matSubscriptE = dyn_cast<MatrixSubscriptExpr>(base);
4947   if (matSubscriptE) {
4948     assert(ArgExprs.size() == 1);
4949     if (CheckAndReportCommaError(ArgExprs.front()))
4950       return ExprError();
4951 
4952     assert(matSubscriptE->isIncomplete() &&
4953            "base has to be an incomplete matrix subscript");
4954     return CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(matSubscriptE->getBase(),
4955                                             matSubscriptE->getRowIdx(),
4956                                             ArgExprs.front(), rbLoc);
4957   }
4958   if (base->getType()->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
4959     Diag(base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_wasm_table_art)
4960         << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc) << 3;
4961     return ExprError();
4962   }
4963 
4964   CheckInvalidBuiltinCountedByRef(base,
4965                                   BuiltinCountedByRefKind::ArraySubscript);
4966 
4967   // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index
4968   // expressions.  We can't handle overloads here because the other
4969   // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload
4970   // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack
4971   // at the overload.
4972   bool IsMSPropertySubscript = false;
4973   if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
4974     IsMSPropertySubscript = isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(*this, base);
4975     if (!IsMSPropertySubscript) {
4976       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base);
4977       if (result.isInvalid())
4978         return ExprError();
4979       base = result.get();
4980     }
4981   }
4982 
4983   // If the base is a matrix type, try to create a new MatrixSubscriptExpr.
4984   if (base->getType()->isMatrixType()) {
4985     assert(ArgExprs.size() == 1);
4986     if (CheckAndReportCommaError(ArgExprs.front()))
4987       return ExprError();
4988 
4989     return CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(base, ArgExprs.front(), nullptr,
4990                                             rbLoc);
4991   }
4992 
4993   if (ArgExprs.size() == 1 && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) {
4994     Expr *idx = ArgExprs[0];
4995     if ((isa<BinaryOperator>(idx) && cast<BinaryOperator>(idx)->isCommaOp()) ||
4996         (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx) &&
4997          cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx)->getOperator() == OO_Comma)) {
4998       Diag(idx->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_comma_subscript)
4999           << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc);
5000     }
5001   }
5002 
5003   if (ArgExprs.size() == 1 &&
5004       ArgExprs[0]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
5005     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ArgExprs[0]);
5006     if (result.isInvalid())
5007       return ExprError();
5008     ArgExprs[0] = result.get();
5009   } else {
5010     if (CheckArgsForPlaceholders(ArgExprs))
5011       return ExprError();
5012   }
5013 
5014   // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
5015   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ArgExprs.size() == 1 &&
5016       (base->isTypeDependent() ||
5017        Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) &&
5018       !isa<PackExpansionExpr>(ArgExprs[0])) {
5019     return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(
5020         base, ArgExprs.front(),
5021         getDependentArraySubscriptType(base, ArgExprs.front(), getASTContext()),
5022         VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
5023   }
5024 
5025   // MSDN, property (C++)
5026   // https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/yhfk0thd(v=vs.120).aspx
5027   // This attribute can also be used in the declaration of an empty array in a
5028   // class or structure definition. For example:
5029   // __declspec(property(get=GetX, put=PutX)) int x[];
5030   // The above statement indicates that x[] can be used with one or more array
5031   // indices. In this case, i=p->x[a][b] will be turned into i=p->GetX(a, b),
5032   // and p->x[a][b] = i will be turned into p->PutX(a, b, i);
5033   if (IsMSPropertySubscript) {
5034     assert(ArgExprs.size() == 1);
5035     // Build MS property subscript expression if base is MS property reference
5036     // or MS property subscript.
5037     return new (Context)
5038         MSPropertySubscriptExpr(base, ArgExprs.front(), Context.PseudoObjectTy,
5039                                 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
5040   }
5041 
5042   // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record
5043   // type.  The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*,
5044   // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion
5045   // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution
5046   // to do if there aren't any record types involved.
5047   //
5048   // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied
5049   // to overload resolution and so should not take this path.
5050   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
5051       ((base->getType()->isRecordType() ||
5052         (ArgExprs.size() != 1 || isa<PackExpansionExpr>(ArgExprs[0]) ||
5053          ArgExprs[0]->getType()->isRecordType())))) {
5054     return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, ArgExprs);
5055   }
5056 
5057   ExprResult Res =
5058       CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, ArgExprs.front(), rbLoc);
5059 
5060   if (!Res.isInvalid() && isa<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get()))
5061     CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get()));
5062 
5063   return Res;
5064 }
5065 
tryConvertExprToType(Expr * E,QualType Ty)5066 ExprResult Sema::tryConvertExprToType(Expr *E, QualType Ty) {
5067   InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(Ty);
5068   InitializationKind Kind =
5069       InitializationKind::CreateCopy(E->getBeginLoc(), SourceLocation());
5070   InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, E);
5071   return InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, E);
5072 }
5073 
CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(Expr * Base,Expr * RowIdx,Expr * ColumnIdx,SourceLocation RBLoc)5074 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, Expr *RowIdx,
5075                                                   Expr *ColumnIdx,
5076                                                   SourceLocation RBLoc) {
5077   ExprResult BaseR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Base);
5078   if (BaseR.isInvalid())
5079     return BaseR;
5080   Base = BaseR.get();
5081 
5082   ExprResult RowR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RowIdx);
5083   if (RowR.isInvalid())
5084     return RowR;
5085   RowIdx = RowR.get();
5086 
5087   if (!ColumnIdx)
5088     return new (Context) MatrixSubscriptExpr(
5089         Base, RowIdx, ColumnIdx, Context.IncompleteMatrixIdxTy, RBLoc);
5090 
5091   // Build an unanalyzed expression if any of the operands is type-dependent.
5092   if (Base->isTypeDependent() || RowIdx->isTypeDependent() ||
5093       ColumnIdx->isTypeDependent())
5094     return new (Context) MatrixSubscriptExpr(Base, RowIdx, ColumnIdx,
5095                                              Context.DependentTy, RBLoc);
5096 
5097   ExprResult ColumnR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ColumnIdx);
5098   if (ColumnR.isInvalid())
5099     return ColumnR;
5100   ColumnIdx = ColumnR.get();
5101 
5102   // Check that IndexExpr is an integer expression. If it is a constant
5103   // expression, check that it is less than Dim (= the number of elements in the
5104   // corresponding dimension).
5105   auto IsIndexValid = [&](Expr *IndexExpr, unsigned Dim,
5106                           bool IsColumnIdx) -> Expr * {
5107     if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
5108         !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
5109       Diag(IndexExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_matrix_index_not_integer)
5110           << IsColumnIdx;
5111       return nullptr;
5112     }
5113 
5114     if (std::optional<llvm::APSInt> Idx =
5115             IndexExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
5116       if ((*Idx < 0 || *Idx >= Dim)) {
5117         Diag(IndexExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_matrix_index_outside_range)
5118             << IsColumnIdx << Dim;
5119         return nullptr;
5120       }
5121     }
5122 
5123     ExprResult ConvExpr = IndexExpr;
5124     assert(!ConvExpr.isInvalid() &&
5125            "should be able to convert any integer type to size type");
5126     return ConvExpr.get();
5127   };
5128 
5129   auto *MTy = Base->getType()->getAs<ConstantMatrixType>();
5130   RowIdx = IsIndexValid(RowIdx, MTy->getNumRows(), false);
5131   ColumnIdx = IsIndexValid(ColumnIdx, MTy->getNumColumns(), true);
5132   if (!RowIdx || !ColumnIdx)
5133     return ExprError();
5134 
5135   return new (Context) MatrixSubscriptExpr(Base, RowIdx, ColumnIdx,
5136                                            MTy->getElementType(), RBLoc);
5137 }
5138 
CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr * E)5139 void Sema::CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr *E) {
5140   ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back();
5141   const Expr *StrippedExpr = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
5142 
5143   // For expressions like `&(*s).b`, the base is recorded and what should be
5144   // checked.
5145   const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr;
5146   while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(StrippedExpr)) && !Member->isArrow())
5147     StrippedExpr = Member->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
5148 
5149   LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.erase(StrippedExpr);
5150 }
5151 
CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr * E)5152 void Sema::CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr *E) {
5153   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
5154     return;
5155 
5156   QualType ResultTy = E->getType();
5157   ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back();
5158 
5159   // Bail if the element is an array since it is not memory access.
5160   if (isa<ArrayType>(ResultTy))
5161     return;
5162 
5163   if (ResultTy->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) {
5164     LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E);
5165     return;
5166   }
5167 
5168   // Check if the base type is a pointer to a member access of a struct
5169   // marked with noderef.
5170   const Expr *Base = E->getBase();
5171   QualType BaseTy = Base->getType();
5172   if (!(isa<ArrayType>(BaseTy) || isa<PointerType>(BaseTy)))
5173     // Not a pointer access
5174     return;
5175 
5176   const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr;
5177   while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base->IgnoreParenCasts())) &&
5178          Member->isArrow())
5179     Base = Member->getBase();
5180 
5181   if (const auto *Ptr = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Base->getType())) {
5182     if (Ptr->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref))
5183       LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E);
5184   }
5185 }
5186 
5187 ExprResult
CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr * Base,SourceLocation LLoc,Expr * Idx,SourceLocation RLoc)5188 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
5189                                       Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
5190   Expr *LHSExp = Base;
5191   Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
5192 
5193   ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
5194   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
5195 
5196   // Per C++ core issue 1213, the result is an xvalue if either operand is
5197   // a non-lvalue array, and an lvalue otherwise.
5198   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
5199     for (auto *Op : {LHSExp, RHSExp}) {
5200       Op = Op->IgnoreImplicit();
5201       if (Op->getType()->isArrayType() && !Op->isLValue())
5202         VK = VK_XValue;
5203     }
5204   }
5205 
5206   // Perform default conversions.
5207   if (!LHSExp->getType()->isSubscriptableVectorType()) {
5208     ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
5209     if (Result.isInvalid())
5210       return ExprError();
5211     LHSExp = Result.get();
5212   }
5213   ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
5214   if (Result.isInvalid())
5215     return ExprError();
5216   RHSExp = Result.get();
5217 
5218   QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
5219 
5220   // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
5221   // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
5222   // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
5223   // and index from the expression types.
5224   Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
5225   QualType ResultType;
5226   if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
5227     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
5228     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
5229     ResultType =
5230         getDependentArraySubscriptType(LHSExp, RHSExp, getASTContext());
5231   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5232     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
5233     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
5234     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
5235   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
5236                LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5237     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
5238     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
5239 
5240     // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript
5241     // expression.
5242     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic())
5243       return ObjC().BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr,
5244                                                  nullptr, nullptr);
5245 
5246     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
5247   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5248      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
5249     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
5250     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
5251     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
5252   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
5253                RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5254      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
5255     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
5256     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
5257     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
5258     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) {
5259       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
5260         << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
5261       return ExprError();
5262     }
5263   } else if (LHSTy->isSubscriptableVectorType()) {
5264     if (LHSTy->isBuiltinType() &&
5265         LHSTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
5266       const BuiltinType *BTy = LHSTy->getAs<BuiltinType>();
5267       if (BTy->isSVEBool())
5268         return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_svbool_t)
5269                          << LHSExp->getSourceRange()
5270                          << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
5271       ResultType = BTy->getSveEltType(Context);
5272     } else {
5273       const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5274       ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
5275     }
5276     BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
5277     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
5278     // We apply C++ DR1213 to vector subscripting too.
5279     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && LHSExp->isPRValue()) {
5280       ExprResult Materialized = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(LHSExp);
5281       if (Materialized.isInvalid())
5282         return ExprError();
5283       LHSExp = Materialized.get();
5284     }
5285     VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
5286     if (VK != VK_PRValue)
5287       OK = OK_VectorComponent;
5288 
5289     QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
5290     Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
5291     Qualifiers MemberQuals = ResultType.getQualifiers();
5292     Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
5293     if (Combined != MemberQuals)
5294       ResultType = Context.getQualifiedType(ResultType, Combined);
5295   } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
5296     // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
5297     // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
5298     // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
5299     // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays.  Warn, then
5300     // force the promotion here.
5301     Diag(LHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue)
5302         << LHSExp->getSourceRange();
5303     LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
5304                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
5305     LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
5306 
5307     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
5308     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
5309     ResultType = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5310   } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
5311     // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
5312     Diag(RHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue)
5313         << RHSExp->getSourceRange();
5314     RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
5315                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
5316     RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
5317 
5318     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
5319     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
5320     ResultType = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5321   } else {
5322     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
5323        << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
5324   }
5325   // C99 6.5.2.1p1
5326   if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
5327     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
5328                      << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
5329 
5330   if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
5331        IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) &&
5332       !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
5333     std::optional<llvm::APSInt> IntegerContantExpr =
5334         IndexExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(getASTContext());
5335     if (!IntegerContantExpr.has_value() ||
5336         IntegerContantExpr.value().isNegative())
5337       Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
5338   }
5339 
5340   // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
5341   // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
5342   // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
5343   // incomplete types are not object types.
5344   if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
5345     Diag(BaseExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
5346         << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
5347     return ExprError();
5348   }
5349 
5350   if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5351     // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
5352     Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
5353       << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
5354 
5355     // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
5356     // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
5357     if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers())
5358       VK = VK_PRValue;
5359   } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
5360              !ResultType.isWebAssemblyReferenceType() &&
5361              RequireCompleteSizedType(
5362                  LLoc, ResultType,
5363                  diag::err_subscript_incomplete_or_sizeless_type, BaseExpr))
5364     return ExprError();
5365 
5366   assert(VK == VK_PRValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
5367          !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
5368 
5369   if (LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
5370       FunctionScopes.size() > 1) {
5371     if (auto *TT =
5372             LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
5373       for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(),
5374                 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend());
5375            I != E; ++I) {
5376         auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I);
5377         if (CSI == nullptr)
5378           break;
5379         DeclContext *DC = nullptr;
5380         if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))
5381           DC = LSI->CallOperator;
5382         else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))
5383           DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl;
5384         else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI))
5385           DC = BSI->TheDecl;
5386         if (DC) {
5387           if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl()))
5388             break;
5389           captureVariablyModifiedType(
5390               Context, LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(), CSI);
5391         }
5392       }
5393     }
5394   }
5395 
5396   return new (Context)
5397       ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc);
5398 }
5399 
CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,FunctionDecl * FD,ParmVarDecl * Param,Expr * RewrittenInit,bool SkipImmediateInvocations)5400 bool Sema::CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD,
5401                                   ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *RewrittenInit,
5402                                   bool SkipImmediateInvocations) {
5403   if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
5404     assert(!RewrittenInit && "Should not have a rewritten init expression yet");
5405     // If we've already cleared out the location for the default argument,
5406     // that means we're parsing it right now.
5407     if (!UnparsedDefaultArgLocs.count(Param)) {
5408       Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD;
5409       Diag(CallLoc, diag::note_recursive_default_argument_used_here);
5410       Param->setInvalidDecl();
5411       return true;
5412     }
5413 
5414     Diag(CallLoc, diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later)
5415         << FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext());
5416     Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
5417          diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
5418     return true;
5419   }
5420 
5421   if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
5422     assert(!RewrittenInit && "Should not have a rewitten init expression yet");
5423     if (InstantiateDefaultArgument(CallLoc, FD, Param))
5424       return true;
5425   }
5426 
5427   Expr *Init = RewrittenInit ? RewrittenInit : Param->getInit();
5428   assert(Init && "default argument but no initializer?");
5429 
5430   // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
5431   // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
5432   // be properly destroyed.
5433   // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
5434   // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
5435   // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because
5436   // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything.
5437   if (auto *InitWithCleanup = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) {
5438     // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are
5439     // any explicit objects.
5440     Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(InitWithCleanup->cleanupsHaveSideEffects());
5441     // Append all the objects to the cleanup list.  Right now, this
5442     // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument
5443     // expressions should never be able to capture anything.
5444     assert(!InitWithCleanup->getNumObjects() &&
5445            "default argument expression has capturing blocks?");
5446   }
5447   // C++ [expr.const]p15.1:
5448   //   An expression or conversion is in an immediate function context if it is
5449   //   potentially evaluated and [...] its innermost enclosing non-block scope
5450   //   is a function parameter scope of an immediate function.
5451   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
5452       *this,
5453       FD->isImmediateFunction()
5454           ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext
5455           : ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated,
5456       Param);
5457   ExprEvalContexts.back().IsCurrentlyCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer =
5458       SkipImmediateInvocations;
5459   runWithSufficientStackSpace(CallLoc, [&] {
5460     MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Init, /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true);
5461   });
5462   return false;
5463 }
5464 
5465 struct ImmediateCallVisitor : DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor {
5466   const ASTContext &Context;
ImmediateCallVisitorImmediateCallVisitor5467   ImmediateCallVisitor(const ASTContext &Ctx) : Context(Ctx) {
5468     ShouldVisitImplicitCode = true;
5469   }
5470 
5471   bool HasImmediateCalls = false;
5472 
VisitCallExprImmediateCallVisitor5473   bool VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) override {
5474     if (const FunctionDecl *FD = E->getDirectCallee())
5475       HasImmediateCalls |= FD->isImmediateFunction();
5476     return DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor::VisitStmt(E);
5477   }
5478 
VisitCXXConstructExprImmediateCallVisitor5479   bool VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) override {
5480     if (const FunctionDecl *FD = E->getConstructor())
5481       HasImmediateCalls |= FD->isImmediateFunction();
5482     return DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor::VisitStmt(E);
5483   }
5484 
5485   // SourceLocExpr are not immediate invocations
5486   // but CXXDefaultInitExpr/CXXDefaultArgExpr containing a SourceLocExpr
5487   // need to be rebuilt so that they refer to the correct SourceLocation and
5488   // DeclContext.
VisitSourceLocExprImmediateCallVisitor5489   bool VisitSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr *E) override {
5490     HasImmediateCalls = true;
5491     return DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor::VisitStmt(E);
5492   }
5493 
5494   // A nested lambda might have parameters with immediate invocations
5495   // in their default arguments.
5496   // The compound statement is not visited (as it does not constitute a
5497   // subexpression).
5498   // FIXME: We should consider visiting and transforming captures
5499   // with init expressions.
VisitLambdaExprImmediateCallVisitor5500   bool VisitLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) override {
5501     return VisitCXXMethodDecl(E->getCallOperator());
5502   }
5503 
VisitCXXDefaultArgExprImmediateCallVisitor5504   bool VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) override {
5505     return TraverseStmt(E->getExpr());
5506   }
5507 
VisitCXXDefaultInitExprImmediateCallVisitor5508   bool VisitCXXDefaultInitExpr(CXXDefaultInitExpr *E) override {
5509     return TraverseStmt(E->getExpr());
5510   }
5511 };
5512 
5513 struct EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs
5514     : TreeTransform<EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs> {
EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgsEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5515   EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs(Sema &SemaRef)
5516       : TreeTransform(SemaRef) {}
5517 
AlwaysRebuildEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5518   bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
5519 
5520   // Lambda can only have immediate invocations in the default
5521   // args of their parameters, which is transformed upon calling the closure.
5522   // The body is not a subexpression, so we have nothing to do.
5523   // FIXME: Immediate calls in capture initializers should be transformed.
TransformLambdaExprEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5524   ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) { return E; }
TransformBlockExprEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5525   ExprResult TransformBlockExpr(BlockExpr *E) { return E; }
5526 
5527   // Make sure we don't rebuild the this pointer as it would
5528   // cause it to incorrectly point it to the outermost class
5529   // in the case of nested struct initialization.
TransformCXXThisExprEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5530   ExprResult TransformCXXThisExpr(CXXThisExpr *E) { return E; }
5531 
5532   // Rewrite to source location to refer to the context in which they are used.
TransformSourceLocExprEnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs5533   ExprResult TransformSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr *E) {
5534     DeclContext *DC = E->getParentContext();
5535     if (DC == SemaRef.CurContext)
5536       return E;
5537 
5538     // FIXME: During instantiation, because the rebuild of defaults arguments
5539     // is not always done in the context of the template instantiator,
5540     // we run the risk of producing a dependent source location
5541     // that would never be rebuilt.
5542     // This usually happens during overload resolution, or in contexts
5543     // where the value of the source location does not matter.
5544     // However, we should find a better way to deal with source location
5545     // of function templates.
5546     if (!SemaRef.CurrentInstantiationScope ||
5547         !SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext() || DC->isDependentContext())
5548       DC = SemaRef.CurContext;
5549 
5550     return getDerived().RebuildSourceLocExpr(
5551         E->getIdentKind(), E->getType(), E->getBeginLoc(), E->getEndLoc(), DC);
5552   }
5553 };
5554 
BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,FunctionDecl * FD,ParmVarDecl * Param,Expr * Init)5555 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
5556                                         FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param,
5557                                         Expr *Init) {
5558   assert(Param->hasDefaultArg() && "can't build nonexistent default arg");
5559 
5560   bool NestedDefaultChecking = isCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer();
5561   bool NeedRebuild = needsRebuildOfDefaultArgOrInit();
5562   std::optional<ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext>
5563       InitializationContext =
5564           OutermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations();
5565   if (!InitializationContext.has_value())
5566     InitializationContext.emplace(CallLoc, Param, CurContext);
5567 
5568   if (!Init && !Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
5569     // Mark that we are replacing a default argument first.
5570     // If we are instantiating a template we won't have to
5571     // retransform immediate calls.
5572     // C++ [expr.const]p15.1:
5573     //   An expression or conversion is in an immediate function context if it
5574     //   is potentially evaluated and [...] its innermost enclosing non-block
5575     //   scope is a function parameter scope of an immediate function.
5576     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
5577         *this,
5578         FD->isImmediateFunction()
5579             ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext
5580             : ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated,
5581         Param);
5582 
5583     if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
5584       if (InstantiateDefaultArgument(CallLoc, FD, Param))
5585         return ExprError();
5586     }
5587     // CWG2631
5588     // An immediate invocation that is not evaluated where it appears is
5589     // evaluated and checked for whether it is a constant expression at the
5590     // point where the enclosing initializer is used in a function call.
5591     ImmediateCallVisitor V(getASTContext());
5592     if (!NestedDefaultChecking)
5593       V.TraverseDecl(Param);
5594 
5595     // Rewrite the call argument that was created from the corresponding
5596     // parameter's default argument.
5597     if (V.HasImmediateCalls ||
5598         (NeedRebuild && isa_and_present<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit()))) {
5599       if (V.HasImmediateCalls)
5600         ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDefaultInitializationContext = {
5601             CallLoc, Param, CurContext};
5602       // Pass down lifetime extending flag, and collect temporaries in
5603       // CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr when we rewrite the call argument.
5604       currentEvaluationContext().InLifetimeExtendingContext =
5605           parentEvaluationContext().InLifetimeExtendingContext;
5606       EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs Immediate(*this);
5607       ExprResult Res;
5608       runWithSufficientStackSpace(CallLoc, [&] {
5609         Res = Immediate.TransformInitializer(Param->getInit(),
5610                                              /*NotCopy=*/false);
5611       });
5612       if (Res.isInvalid())
5613         return ExprError();
5614       Res = ConvertParamDefaultArgument(Param, Res.get(),
5615                                         Res.get()->getBeginLoc());
5616       if (Res.isInvalid())
5617         return ExprError();
5618       Init = Res.get();
5619     }
5620   }
5621 
5622   if (CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(
5623           CallLoc, FD, Param, Init,
5624           /*SkipImmediateInvocations=*/NestedDefaultChecking))
5625     return ExprError();
5626 
5627   return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, InitializationContext->Loc, Param,
5628                                    Init, InitializationContext->Context);
5629 }
5630 
FindFieldDeclInstantiationPattern(const ASTContext & Ctx,FieldDecl * Field)5631 static FieldDecl *FindFieldDeclInstantiationPattern(const ASTContext &Ctx,
5632                                                     FieldDecl *Field) {
5633   if (FieldDecl *Pattern = Ctx.getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(Field))
5634     return Pattern;
5635   auto *ParentRD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Field->getParent());
5636   CXXRecordDecl *ClassPattern = ParentRD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern();
5637   DeclContext::lookup_result Lookup =
5638       ClassPattern->lookup(Field->getDeclName());
5639   auto Rng = llvm::make_filter_range(
5640       Lookup, [](auto &&L) { return isa<FieldDecl>(*L); });
5641   if (Rng.empty())
5642     return nullptr;
5643   // FIXME: this breaks clang/test/Modules/pr28812.cpp
5644   // assert(std::distance(Rng.begin(), Rng.end()) <= 1
5645   //       && "Duplicated instantiation pattern for field decl");
5646   return cast<FieldDecl>(*Rng.begin());
5647 }
5648 
BuildCXXDefaultInitExpr(SourceLocation Loc,FieldDecl * Field)5649 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultInitExpr(SourceLocation Loc, FieldDecl *Field) {
5650   assert(Field->hasInClassInitializer());
5651 
5652   CXXThisScopeRAII This(*this, Field->getParent(), Qualifiers());
5653 
5654   auto *ParentRD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Field->getParent());
5655 
5656   std::optional<ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext>
5657       InitializationContext =
5658           OutermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations();
5659   if (!InitializationContext.has_value())
5660     InitializationContext.emplace(Loc, Field, CurContext);
5661 
5662   Expr *Init = nullptr;
5663 
5664   bool NestedDefaultChecking = isCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer();
5665   bool NeedRebuild = needsRebuildOfDefaultArgOrInit();
5666   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
5667       *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Field);
5668 
5669   if (!Field->getInClassInitializer()) {
5670     // Maybe we haven't instantiated the in-class initializer. Go check the
5671     // pattern FieldDecl to see if it has one.
5672     if (isTemplateInstantiation(ParentRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) {
5673       FieldDecl *Pattern =
5674           FindFieldDeclInstantiationPattern(getASTContext(), Field);
5675       assert(Pattern && "We must have set the Pattern!");
5676       if (!Pattern->hasInClassInitializer() ||
5677           InstantiateInClassInitializer(Loc, Field, Pattern,
5678                                         getTemplateInstantiationArgs(Field))) {
5679         Field->setInvalidDecl();
5680         return ExprError();
5681       }
5682     }
5683   }
5684 
5685   // CWG2631
5686   // An immediate invocation that is not evaluated where it appears is
5687   // evaluated and checked for whether it is a constant expression at the
5688   // point where the enclosing initializer is used in a [...] a constructor
5689   // definition, or an aggregate initialization.
5690   ImmediateCallVisitor V(getASTContext());
5691   if (!NestedDefaultChecking)
5692     V.TraverseDecl(Field);
5693 
5694   // CWG1815
5695   // Support lifetime extension of temporary created by aggregate
5696   // initialization using a default member initializer. We should rebuild
5697   // the initializer in a lifetime extension context if the initializer
5698   // expression is an ExprWithCleanups. Then make sure the normal lifetime
5699   // extension code recurses into the default initializer and does lifetime
5700   // extension when warranted.
5701   bool ContainsAnyTemporaries =
5702       isa_and_present<ExprWithCleanups>(Field->getInClassInitializer());
5703   if (Field->getInClassInitializer() &&
5704       !Field->getInClassInitializer()->containsErrors() &&
5705       (V.HasImmediateCalls || (NeedRebuild && ContainsAnyTemporaries))) {
5706     ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDefaultInitializationContext = {Loc, Field,
5707                                                                    CurContext};
5708     ExprEvalContexts.back().IsCurrentlyCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer =
5709         NestedDefaultChecking;
5710     // Pass down lifetime extending flag, and collect temporaries in
5711     // CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr when we rewrite the call argument.
5712     currentEvaluationContext().InLifetimeExtendingContext =
5713         parentEvaluationContext().InLifetimeExtendingContext;
5714     EnsureImmediateInvocationInDefaultArgs Immediate(*this);
5715     ExprResult Res;
5716     runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] {
5717       Res = Immediate.TransformInitializer(Field->getInClassInitializer(),
5718                                            /*CXXDirectInit=*/false);
5719     });
5720     if (!Res.isInvalid())
5721       Res = ConvertMemberDefaultInitExpression(Field, Res.get(), Loc);
5722     if (Res.isInvalid()) {
5723       Field->setInvalidDecl();
5724       return ExprError();
5725     }
5726     Init = Res.get();
5727   }
5728 
5729   if (Field->getInClassInitializer()) {
5730     Expr *E = Init ? Init : Field->getInClassInitializer();
5731     if (!NestedDefaultChecking)
5732       runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] {
5733         MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(E, /*SkipLocalVariables=*/false);
5734       });
5735     if (isInLifetimeExtendingContext())
5736       DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
5737     // C++11 [class.base.init]p7:
5738     //   The initialization of each base and member constitutes a
5739     //   full-expression.
5740     ExprResult Res = ActOnFinishFullExpr(E, /*DiscardedValue=*/false);
5741     if (Res.isInvalid()) {
5742       Field->setInvalidDecl();
5743       return ExprError();
5744     }
5745     Init = Res.get();
5746 
5747     return CXXDefaultInitExpr::Create(Context, InitializationContext->Loc,
5748                                       Field, InitializationContext->Context,
5749                                       Init);
5750   }
5751 
5752   // DR1351:
5753   //   If the brace-or-equal-initializer of a non-static data member
5754   //   invokes a defaulted default constructor of its class or of an
5755   //   enclosing class in a potentially evaluated subexpression, the
5756   //   program is ill-formed.
5757   //
5758   // This resolution is unworkable: the exception specification of the
5759   // default constructor can be needed in an unevaluated context, in
5760   // particular, in the operand of a noexcept-expression, and we can be
5761   // unable to compute an exception specification for an enclosed class.
5762   //
5763   // Any attempt to resolve the exception specification of a defaulted default
5764   // constructor before the initializer is lexically complete will ultimately
5765   // come here at which point we can diagnose it.
5766   RecordDecl *OutermostClass = ParentRD->getOuterLexicalRecordContext();
5767   Diag(Loc, diag::err_default_member_initializer_not_yet_parsed)
5768       << OutermostClass << Field;
5769   Diag(Field->getEndLoc(),
5770        diag::note_default_member_initializer_not_yet_parsed);
5771   // Recover by marking the field invalid, unless we're in a SFINAE context.
5772   if (!isSFINAEContext())
5773     Field->setInvalidDecl();
5774   return ExprError();
5775 }
5776 
getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,Expr * Fn)5777 VariadicCallType Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl,
5778                                            const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
5779                                            Expr *Fn) {
5780   if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) {
5781     if (isa_and_nonnull<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl))
5782       return VariadicCallType::Constructor;
5783     else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
5784       return VariadicCallType::Block;
5785     else if (FDecl) {
5786       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
5787         if (Method->isInstance())
5788           return VariadicCallType::Method;
5789     } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy)
5790       return VariadicCallType::Method;
5791     return VariadicCallType::Function;
5792   }
5793   return VariadicCallType::DoesNotApply;
5794 }
5795 
5796 namespace {
5797 class FunctionCallCCC final : public FunctionCallFilterCCC {
5798 public:
FunctionCallCCC(Sema & SemaRef,const IdentifierInfo * FuncName,unsigned NumArgs,MemberExpr * ME)5799   FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName,
5800                   unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME)
5801       : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME),
5802         FunctionName(FuncName) {}
5803 
ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection & candidate)5804   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
5805     if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() ||
5806         candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) {
5807       return false;
5808     }
5809 
5810     return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate);
5811   }
5812 
clone()5813   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
5814     return std::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(*this);
5815   }
5816 
5817 private:
5818   const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName;
5819 };
5820 }
5821 
TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema & S,Expr * Fn,FunctionDecl * FDecl,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args)5822 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn,
5823                                                FunctionDecl *FDecl,
5824                                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5825   MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn);
5826   DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName();
5827   SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getBeginLoc();
5828 
5829   FunctionCallCCC CCC(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), Args.size(), ME);
5830   if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo(
5831           DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
5832           S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, CCC,
5833           CorrectTypoKind::ErrorRecovery)) {
5834     if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl()) {
5835       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
5836         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
5837         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5838         for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) {
5839           if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD))
5840             S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args,
5841                                    OCS);
5842         }
5843         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) {
5844         case OR_Success:
5845           ND = Best->FoundDecl;
5846           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
5847           break;
5848         default:
5849           break;
5850         }
5851       }
5852       ND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl();
5853       if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
5854         return Corrected;
5855     }
5856   }
5857   return TypoCorrection();
5858 }
5859 
5860 // [C++26][[expr.unary.op]/p4
5861 // A pointer to member is only formed when an explicit &
5862 // is used and its operand is a qualified-id not enclosed in parentheses.
isParenthetizedAndQualifiedAddressOfExpr(Expr * Fn)5863 static bool isParenthetizedAndQualifiedAddressOfExpr(Expr *Fn) {
5864   if (!isa<ParenExpr>(Fn))
5865     return false;
5866 
5867   Fn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
5868 
5869   auto *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(Fn);
5870   if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != clang::UO_AddrOf)
5871     return false;
5872   if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) {
5873     return DRE->hasQualifier();
5874   }
5875   if (auto *OVL = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens()))
5876     return OVL->getQualifier();
5877   return false;
5878 }
5879 
5880 bool
ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr * Call,Expr * Fn,FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation RParenLoc,bool IsExecConfig)5881 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
5882                               FunctionDecl *FDecl,
5883                               const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
5884                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5885                               SourceLocation RParenLoc,
5886                               bool IsExecConfig) {
5887   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
5888   if (FDecl)
5889     if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
5890       if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
5891         return false;
5892 
5893   // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
5894   // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
5895 
5896   bool AddressOf = isParenthetizedAndQualifiedAddressOfExpr(Fn);
5897   bool HasExplicitObjectParameter =
5898       !AddressOf && FDecl && FDecl->hasCXXExplicitFunctionObjectParameter();
5899   unsigned ExplicitObjectParameterOffset = HasExplicitObjectParameter ? 1 : 0;
5900   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
5901   bool Invalid = false;
5902   unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams;
5903   unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
5904                        ? 1 /* block */
5905                        : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
5906                                        : 0 /* function */);
5907 
5908   // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
5909   // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
5910   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
5911     if (Args.size() < MinArgs) {
5912       TypoCorrection TC;
5913       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
5914         unsigned diag_id =
5915             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
5916                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest
5917                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest;
5918         diagnoseTypo(
5919             TC, PDiag(diag_id)
5920                     << FnKind << MinArgs - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5921                     << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) -
5922                            ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5923                     << HasExplicitObjectParameter << TC.getCorrectionRange());
5924       } else if (MinArgs - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset == 1 && FDecl &&
5925                  FDecl->getParamDecl(ExplicitObjectParameterOffset)
5926                      ->getDeclName())
5927         Diag(RParenLoc,
5928              MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
5929                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one
5930                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one)
5931             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(ExplicitObjectParameterOffset)
5932             << HasExplicitObjectParameter << Fn->getSourceRange();
5933       else
5934         Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
5935                             ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
5936                             : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
5937             << FnKind << MinArgs - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5938             << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) -
5939                    ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5940             << HasExplicitObjectParameter << Fn->getSourceRange();
5941 
5942       // Emit the location of the prototype.
5943       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
5944         Diag(FDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_decl)
5945             << FDecl << FDecl->getParametersSourceRange();
5946 
5947       return true;
5948     }
5949     // We reserve space for the default arguments when we create
5950     // the call expression, before calling ConvertArgumentsForCall.
5951     assert((Call->getNumArgs() == NumParams) &&
5952            "We should have reserved space for the default arguments before!");
5953   }
5954 
5955   // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
5956   // them.
5957   if (Args.size() > NumParams) {
5958     if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
5959       TypoCorrection TC;
5960       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
5961         unsigned diag_id =
5962             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
5963                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest
5964                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest;
5965         diagnoseTypo(
5966             TC, PDiag(diag_id)
5967                     << FnKind << NumParams - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5968                     << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) -
5969                            ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5970                     << HasExplicitObjectParameter << TC.getCorrectionRange());
5971       } else if (NumParams - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset == 1 && FDecl &&
5972                  FDecl->getParamDecl(ExplicitObjectParameterOffset)
5973                      ->getDeclName())
5974         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
5975              MinArgs == NumParams
5976                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one
5977                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one)
5978             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(ExplicitObjectParameterOffset)
5979             << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) -
5980                    ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5981             << HasExplicitObjectParameter << Fn->getSourceRange()
5982             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
5983                            Args.back()->getEndLoc());
5984       else
5985         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
5986              MinArgs == NumParams
5987                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
5988                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
5989             << FnKind << NumParams - ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5990             << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) -
5991                    ExplicitObjectParameterOffset
5992             << HasExplicitObjectParameter << Fn->getSourceRange()
5993             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(),
5994                            Args.back()->getEndLoc());
5995 
5996       // Emit the location of the prototype.
5997       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
5998         Diag(FDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_decl)
5999             << FDecl << FDecl->getParametersSourceRange();
6000 
6001       // This deletes the extra arguments.
6002       Call->shrinkNumArgs(NumParams);
6003       return true;
6004     }
6005   }
6006   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
6007   VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn);
6008 
6009   Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getExprLoc(), FDecl, Proto, 0, Args,
6010                                    AllArgs, CallType);
6011   if (Invalid)
6012     return true;
6013   unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
6014   for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
6015     Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
6016 
6017   Call->computeDependence();
6018   return false;
6019 }
6020 
GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,unsigned FirstParam,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SmallVectorImpl<Expr * > & AllArgs,VariadicCallType CallType,bool AllowExplicit,bool IsListInitialization)6021 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
6022                                   const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
6023                                   unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6024                                   SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs,
6025                                   VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit,
6026                                   bool IsListInitialization) {
6027   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6028   bool Invalid = false;
6029   size_t ArgIx = 0;
6030   // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
6031   for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) {
6032     QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i);
6033 
6034     Expr *Arg;
6035     ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr;
6036     if (ArgIx < Args.size()) {
6037       Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
6038 
6039       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), ProtoArgType,
6040                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
6041         return true;
6042 
6043       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
6044       bool CFAudited = false;
6045       if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy &&
6046           FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
6047           (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
6048         Arg = ObjC().stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg);
6049       else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6050                FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
6051                (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
6052         CFAudited = true;
6053 
6054       if (Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).isNoEscape() &&
6055           ProtoArgType->isBlockPointerType())
6056         if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenNoopCasts(Context)))
6057           BE->getBlockDecl()->setDoesNotEscape();
6058       if ((Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).getABI() == ParameterABI::HLSLOut ||
6059            Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).getABI() == ParameterABI::HLSLInOut)) {
6060         ExprResult ArgExpr = HLSL().ActOnOutParamExpr(Param, Arg);
6061         if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
6062           return true;
6063         Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
6064       }
6065 
6066       InitializedEntity Entity =
6067           Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param,
6068                                                          ProtoArgType)
6069                 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6070                       Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
6071 
6072       // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API.
6073       if (CFAudited)
6074         Entity.setParameterCFAudited();
6075 
6076       ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(
6077           Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit);
6078       if (ArgE.isInvalid())
6079         return true;
6080 
6081       Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
6082     } else {
6083       assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee");
6084 
6085       ExprResult ArgExpr = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
6086       if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
6087         return true;
6088 
6089       Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
6090     }
6091 
6092     // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
6093     // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
6094     // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
6095     CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
6096 
6097     // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7).
6098     CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg);
6099 
6100     AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
6101   }
6102 
6103   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
6104   if (CallType != VariadicCallType::DoesNotApply) {
6105     // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
6106     // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
6107     if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl &&
6108         FDecl->isExternC()) {
6109       for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) {
6110         QualType paramType; // ignored
6111         ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, A, paramType);
6112         Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
6113         AllArgs.push_back(arg.get());
6114       }
6115 
6116     // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
6117     } else {
6118       for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) {
6119         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(A, CallType, FDecl);
6120         Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
6121         AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get());
6122       }
6123     }
6124 
6125     // Check for array bounds violations.
6126     for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx))
6127       CheckArrayAccess(A);
6128   }
6129   return Invalid;
6130 }
6131 
DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema & S,ParmVarDecl * PVD)6132 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) {
6133   TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
6134   if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>())
6135     TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc();
6136   if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>())
6137     S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array)
6138       << ATL.getLocalSourceRange();
6139 }
6140 
6141 void
CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,ParmVarDecl * Param,const Expr * ArgExpr)6142 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,
6143                                ParmVarDecl *Param,
6144                                const Expr *ArgExpr) {
6145   // Static array parameters are not supported in C++.
6146   if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6147     return;
6148 
6149   QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType();
6150 
6151   const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy);
6152   if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArraySizeModifier::Static)
6153     return;
6154 
6155   if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
6156                                      Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) {
6157     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange();
6158     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
6159     return;
6160   }
6161 
6162   const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT);
6163   if (!CAT)
6164     return;
6165 
6166   const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT =
6167     Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType());
6168   if (!ArgCAT)
6169     return;
6170 
6171   if (getASTContext().hasSameUnqualifiedType(CAT->getElementType(),
6172                                              ArgCAT->getElementType())) {
6173     if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) {
6174       Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
6175           << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() << (unsigned)ArgCAT->getZExtSize()
6176           << (unsigned)CAT->getZExtSize() << 0;
6177       DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
6178     }
6179     return;
6180   }
6181 
6182   std::optional<CharUnits> ArgSize =
6183       getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(ArgCAT);
6184   std::optional<CharUnits> ParmSize =
6185       getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(CAT);
6186   if (ArgSize && ParmSize && *ArgSize < *ParmSize) {
6187     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
6188         << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() << (unsigned)ArgSize->getQuantity()
6189         << (unsigned)ParmSize->getQuantity() << 1;
6190     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
6191   }
6192 }
6193 
6194 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
6195 /// to have a function type.
6196 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
6197 
6198 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out
6199 /// immediately during argument processing?
isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type)6200 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) {
6201   // Placeholders are never sugared.
6202   const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type);
6203   if (!placeholder) return false;
6204 
6205   switch (placeholder->getKind()) {
6206   // Ignore all the non-placeholder types.
6207 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
6208   case BuiltinType::Id:
6209 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
6210 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
6211   case BuiltinType::Id:
6212 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
6213   // In practice we'll never use this, since all SVE types are sugared
6214   // via TypedefTypes rather than exposed directly as BuiltinTypes.
6215 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
6216   case BuiltinType::Id:
6217 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64ACLETypes.def"
6218 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
6219   case BuiltinType::Id:
6220 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
6221 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
6222 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
6223 #define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
6224 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
6225 #define AMDGPU_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, Width, Align) case BuiltinType::Id:
6226 #include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
6227 #define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
6228 #include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
6229 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID)
6230 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID:
6231 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
6232     return false;
6233 
6234   case BuiltinType::UnresolvedTemplate:
6235   // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved
6236   // by the call machinery.
6237   case BuiltinType::Overload:
6238     return false;
6239 
6240   // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and
6241   // should be left in place.
6242   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast:
6243     return false;
6244 
6245   // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible.
6246   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
6247     return true;
6248 
6249   // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try
6250   // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types.
6251   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
6252     return true;
6253 
6254   // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported.
6255   case BuiltinType::BoundMember:
6256   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn:
6257   case BuiltinType::IncompleteMatrixIdx:
6258   case BuiltinType::ArraySection:
6259   case BuiltinType::OMPArrayShaping:
6260   case BuiltinType::OMPIterator:
6261     return true;
6262 
6263   }
6264   llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind");
6265 }
6266 
CheckArgsForPlaceholders(MultiExprArg args)6267 bool Sema::CheckArgsForPlaceholders(MultiExprArg args) {
6268   // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of
6269   // dying at the first failure.
6270   bool hasInvalid = false;
6271   for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) {
6272     if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) {
6273       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]);
6274       if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true;
6275       else args[i] = result.get();
6276     }
6277   }
6278   return hasInvalid;
6279 }
6280 
6281 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address
6282 /// space, then it should be able to accept a pointer to any address
6283 /// space as input.  In order to do this, we need to replace the
6284 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space
6285 /// as the call.
6286 ///
6287 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e.
6288 ///                  it does not contain any pointer arguments without
6289 ///                  an address space qualifer.  Otherwise the rewritten
6290 ///                  FunctionDecl is returned.
6291 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types.
rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema * Sema,ASTContext & Context,FunctionDecl * FDecl,MultiExprArg ArgExprs)6292 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context,
6293                                                 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
6294                                                 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
6295 
6296   QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType();
6297   const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType);
6298 
6299   if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || !FT ||
6300       ArgExprs.size() < FT->getNumParams())
6301     return nullptr;
6302 
6303   bool NeedsNewDecl = false;
6304   unsigned i = 0;
6305   SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams;
6306 
6307   for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) {
6308 
6309     // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup.
6310     ExprResult ArgRes =
6311         Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]);
6312     if (ArgRes.isInvalid())
6313       return nullptr;
6314     Expr *Arg = ArgRes.get();
6315     QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
6316     if (!ParamType->isPointerType() ||
6317         ParamType->getPointeeType().hasAddressSpace() ||
6318         !ArgType->isPointerType() ||
6319         !ArgType->getPointeeType().hasAddressSpace() ||
6320         isPtrSizeAddressSpace(ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace())) {
6321       OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType);
6322       continue;
6323     }
6324 
6325     QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType();
6326     NeedsNewDecl = true;
6327     LangAS AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6328 
6329     PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS);
6330     OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType));
6331   }
6332 
6333   if (!NeedsNewDecl)
6334     return nullptr;
6335 
6336   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
6337   EPI.Variadic = FT->isVariadic();
6338   QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(),
6339                                                 OverloadParams, EPI);
6340   DeclContext *Parent = FDecl->getParent();
6341   FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(
6342       Context, Parent, FDecl->getLocation(), FDecl->getLocation(),
6343       FDecl->getIdentifier(), OverloadTy,
6344       /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, Sema->getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
6345       false,
6346       /*hasPrototype=*/true);
6347   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
6348   FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy);
6349   for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6350     QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i);
6351     ParmVarDecl *Parm =
6352         ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(),
6353                                 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType,
6354                                 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
6355     Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
6356     Params.push_back(Parm);
6357   }
6358   OverloadDecl->setParams(Params);
6359   // We cannot merge host/device attributes of redeclarations. They have to
6360   // be consistent when created.
6361   if (Sema->LangOpts.CUDA) {
6362     if (FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())
6363       OverloadDecl->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
6364     if (FDecl->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>())
6365       OverloadDecl->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
6366   }
6367   Sema->mergeDeclAttributes(OverloadDecl, FDecl);
6368   return OverloadDecl;
6369 }
6370 
checkDirectCallValidity(Sema & S,const Expr * Fn,FunctionDecl * Callee,MultiExprArg ArgExprs)6371 static void checkDirectCallValidity(Sema &S, const Expr *Fn,
6372                                     FunctionDecl *Callee,
6373                                     MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
6374   // `Callee` (when called with ArgExprs) may be ill-formed. enable_if (and
6375   // similar attributes) really don't like it when functions are called with an
6376   // invalid number of args.
6377   if (S.TooManyArguments(Callee->getNumParams(), ArgExprs.size(),
6378                          /*PartialOverloading=*/false) &&
6379       !Callee->isVariadic())
6380     return;
6381   if (Callee->getMinRequiredArguments() > ArgExprs.size())
6382     return;
6383 
6384   if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr =
6385           S.CheckEnableIf(Callee, Fn->getBeginLoc(), ArgExprs, true)) {
6386     S.Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
6387            isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee)
6388                ? diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call
6389                : diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
6390         << Callee << Callee->getSourceRange();
6391     S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
6392            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
6393         << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
6394     return;
6395   }
6396 }
6397 
enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(const UnresolvedMemberExpr * const UME,Sema & S)6398 static bool enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(
6399     const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, Sema &S) {
6400 
6401   const auto GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass =
6402       [](Sema &S) -> const CXXRecordDecl * {
6403     const DeclContext *const DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
6404     if (!DC || !DC->getParent())
6405       return nullptr;
6406 
6407     // If the call to some member function was made from within a member
6408     // function body 'M' return return 'M's parent.
6409     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC))
6410       return MD->getParent()->getCanonicalDecl();
6411     // else the call was made from within a default member initializer of a
6412     // class, so return the class.
6413     if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
6414       return RD->getCanonicalDecl();
6415     return nullptr;
6416   };
6417   // If our DeclContext is neither a member function nor a class (in the
6418   // case of a lambda in a default member initializer), we can't have an
6419   // enclosing 'this'.
6420 
6421   const CXXRecordDecl *const CurParentClass = GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass(S);
6422   if (!CurParentClass)
6423     return false;
6424 
6425   // The naming class for implicit member functions call is the class in which
6426   // name lookup starts.
6427   const CXXRecordDecl *const NamingClass =
6428       UME->getNamingClass()->getCanonicalDecl();
6429   assert(NamingClass && "Must have naming class even for implicit access");
6430 
6431   // If the unresolved member functions were found in a 'naming class' that is
6432   // related (either the same or derived from) to the class that contains the
6433   // member function that itself contained the implicit member access.
6434 
6435   return CurParentClass == NamingClass ||
6436          CurParentClass->isDerivedFrom(NamingClass);
6437 }
6438 
6439 static void
tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs(Sema & S,const UnresolvedMemberExpr * const UME,SourceLocation CallLoc)6440 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs(
6441     Sema &S, const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, SourceLocation CallLoc) {
6442 
6443   if (!UME)
6444     return;
6445 
6446   LambdaScopeInfo *const CurLSI = S.getCurLambda();
6447   // Only try and implicitly capture 'this' within a C++ Lambda if it hasn't
6448   // already been captured, or if this is an implicit member function call (if
6449   // it isn't, an attempt to capture 'this' should already have been made).
6450   if (!CurLSI || CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CurLSI->ImpCap_None ||
6451       !UME->isImplicitAccess() || CurLSI->isCXXThisCaptured())
6452     return;
6453 
6454   // Check if the naming class in which the unresolved members were found is
6455   // related (same as or is a base of) to the enclosing class.
6456 
6457   if (!enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(UME, S))
6458     return;
6459 
6460 
6461   DeclContext *EnclosingFunctionCtx = S.CurContext->getParent()->getParent();
6462   // If the enclosing function is not dependent, then this lambda is
6463   // capture ready, so if we can capture this, do so.
6464   if (!EnclosingFunctionCtx->isDependentContext()) {
6465     // If the current lambda and all enclosing lambdas can capture 'this' -
6466     // then go ahead and capture 'this' (since our unresolved overload set
6467     // contains at least one non-static member function).
6468     if (!S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc, /*Explcit*/ false, /*Diagnose*/ false))
6469       S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc);
6470   } else if (S.CurContext->isDependentContext()) {
6471     // ... since this is an implicit member reference, that might potentially
6472     // involve a 'this' capture, mark 'this' for potential capture in
6473     // enclosing lambdas.
6474     if (CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle != CurLSI->ImpCap_None)
6475       CurLSI->addPotentialThisCapture(CallLoc);
6476   }
6477 }
6478 
6479 // Once a call is fully resolved, warn for unqualified calls to specific
6480 // C++ standard functions, like move and forward.
DiagnosedUnqualifiedCallsToStdFunctions(Sema & S,const CallExpr * Call)6481 static void DiagnosedUnqualifiedCallsToStdFunctions(Sema &S,
6482                                                     const CallExpr *Call) {
6483   // We are only checking unary move and forward so exit early here.
6484   if (Call->getNumArgs() != 1)
6485     return;
6486 
6487   const Expr *E = Call->getCallee()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6488   if (!E || isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E))
6489     return;
6490   const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast_if_present<DeclRefExpr>(E);
6491   if (!DRE || !DRE->getLocation().isValid())
6492     return;
6493 
6494   if (DRE->getQualifier())
6495     return;
6496 
6497   const FunctionDecl *FD = Call->getDirectCallee();
6498   if (!FD)
6499     return;
6500 
6501   // Only warn for some functions deemed more frequent or problematic.
6502   unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID();
6503   if (BuiltinID != Builtin::BImove && BuiltinID != Builtin::BIforward)
6504     return;
6505 
6506   S.Diag(DRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_unqualified_call_to_std_cast_function)
6507       << FD->getQualifiedNameAsString()
6508       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DRE->getLocation(), "std::");
6509 }
6510 
ActOnCallExpr(Scope * Scope,Expr * Fn,SourceLocation LParenLoc,MultiExprArg ArgExprs,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * ExecConfig)6511 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
6512                                MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
6513                                Expr *ExecConfig) {
6514   ExprResult Call =
6515       BuildCallExpr(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig,
6516                     /*IsExecConfig=*/false, /*AllowRecovery=*/true);
6517   if (Call.isInvalid())
6518     return Call;
6519 
6520   // Diagnose uses of the C++20 "ADL-only template-id call" feature in earlier
6521   // language modes.
6522   if (const auto *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Fn);
6523       ULE && ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
6524       ULE->decls_begin() == ULE->decls_end()) {
6525     DiagCompat(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag_compat::adl_only_template_id)
6526         << ULE->getName();
6527   }
6528 
6529   if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
6530     Call = OpenMP().ActOnOpenMPCall(Call, Scope, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
6531                                     ExecConfig);
6532   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
6533     if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Call.get()))
6534       DiagnosedUnqualifiedCallsToStdFunctions(*this, CE);
6535 
6536     // If we previously found that the id-expression of this call refers to a
6537     // consteval function but the call is dependent, we should not treat is an
6538     // an invalid immediate call.
6539     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens());
6540         DRE && Call.get()->isValueDependent()) {
6541       currentEvaluationContext().ReferenceToConsteval.erase(DRE);
6542     }
6543   }
6544   return Call;
6545 }
6546 
6547 // Any type that could be used to form a callable expression
MayBeFunctionType(const ASTContext & Context,const Expr * E)6548 static bool MayBeFunctionType(const ASTContext &Context, const Expr *E) {
6549   QualType T = E->getType();
6550   if (T->isDependentType())
6551     return true;
6552 
6553   if (T == Context.BoundMemberTy || T == Context.UnknownAnyTy ||
6554       T == Context.BuiltinFnTy || T == Context.OverloadTy ||
6555       T->isFunctionType() || T->isFunctionReferenceType() ||
6556       T->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || T->isFunctionPointerType() ||
6557       T->isBlockPointerType() || T->isRecordType())
6558     return true;
6559 
6560   return isa<CallExpr, DeclRefExpr, MemberExpr, CXXPseudoDestructorExpr,
6561              OverloadExpr, UnresolvedMemberExpr, UnaryOperator>(E);
6562 }
6563 
BuildCallExpr(Scope * Scope,Expr * Fn,SourceLocation LParenLoc,MultiExprArg ArgExprs,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * ExecConfig,bool IsExecConfig,bool AllowRecovery)6564 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
6565                                MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
6566                                Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig,
6567                                bool AllowRecovery) {
6568   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
6569   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope, Fn);
6570   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6571   Fn = Result.get();
6572 
6573   if (CheckArgsForPlaceholders(ArgExprs))
6574     return ExprError();
6575 
6576   // The result of __builtin_counted_by_ref cannot be used as a function
6577   // argument. It allows leaking and modification of bounds safety information.
6578   for (const Expr *Arg : ArgExprs)
6579     if (CheckInvalidBuiltinCountedByRef(Arg,
6580                                         BuiltinCountedByRefKind::FunctionArg))
6581       return ExprError();
6582 
6583   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6584     // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
6585     if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
6586       if (!ArgExprs.empty()) {
6587         // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
6588         Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
6589             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
6590                    SourceRange(ArgExprs.front()->getBeginLoc(),
6591                                ArgExprs.back()->getEndLoc()));
6592       }
6593 
6594       return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, /*Args=*/{}, Context.VoidTy,
6595                               VK_PRValue, RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
6596     }
6597     if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) {
6598       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn);
6599       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6600       Fn = result.get();
6601     }
6602 
6603     // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
6604     // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
6605     if (Fn->isTypeDependent() || Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) {
6606       if (ExecConfig) {
6607         return CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(Context, Fn,
6608                                           cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs,
6609                                           Context.DependentTy, VK_PRValue,
6610                                           RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
6611       } else {
6612 
6613         tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs(
6614             *this, dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens()),
6615             Fn->getBeginLoc());
6616 
6617         // If the type of the function itself is not dependent
6618         // check that it is a reasonable as a function, as type deduction
6619         // later assume the CallExpr has a sensible TYPE.
6620         if (!MayBeFunctionType(Context, Fn))
6621           return ExprError(
6622               Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
6623               << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
6624 
6625         return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy,
6626                                 VK_PRValue, RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
6627       }
6628     }
6629 
6630     // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
6631     if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
6632       return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
6633                                           RParenLoc);
6634 
6635     if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6636       ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
6637       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6638       Fn = result.get();
6639     }
6640 
6641     if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
6642       return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
6643                                        RParenLoc, ExecConfig, IsExecConfig,
6644                                        AllowRecovery);
6645     }
6646   }
6647 
6648   // Check for overloaded calls.  This can happen even in C due to extensions.
6649   if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
6650     OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
6651 
6652     // We aren't supposed to apply this logic if there's an '&' involved.
6653     if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer || find.IsAddressOfOperandWithParen) {
6654       if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))
6655         return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy,
6656                                 VK_PRValue, RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
6657       OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
6658       if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl))
6659         return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(
6660             Scope, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig,
6661             /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/true, find.IsAddressOfOperand);
6662       return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
6663                                        RParenLoc, ExecConfig, IsExecConfig,
6664                                        AllowRecovery);
6665     }
6666   }
6667 
6668   // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
6669   if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6670     ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
6671     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6672     Fn = result.get();
6673   }
6674 
6675   Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
6676 
6677   bool CallingNDeclIndirectly = false;
6678   NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr;
6679   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
6680     if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) {
6681       CallingNDeclIndirectly = true;
6682       NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
6683     }
6684   }
6685 
6686   if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) {
6687     NDecl = DRE->getDecl();
6688 
6689     FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
6690     if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) {
6691       // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing parameters
6692       // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments
6693       // in ArgExprs.
6694       if ((FDecl =
6695                rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) {
6696         NDecl = FDecl;
6697         Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create(
6698             Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), SourceLocation(), FDecl, false,
6699             SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl,
6700             nullptr, DRE->isNonOdrUse());
6701       }
6702     }
6703   } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
6704     NDecl = ME->getMemberDecl();
6705 
6706   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) {
6707     if (CallingNDeclIndirectly && !checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(
6708                                       FD, /*Complain=*/true, Fn->getBeginLoc()))
6709       return ExprError();
6710 
6711     checkDirectCallValidity(*this, Fn, FD, ArgExprs);
6712 
6713     // If this expression is a call to a builtin function in HIP device
6714     // compilation, allow a pointer-type argument to default address space to be
6715     // passed as a pointer-type parameter to a non-default address space.
6716     // If Arg is declared in the default address space and Param is declared
6717     // in a non-default address space, perform an implicit address space cast to
6718     // the parameter type.
6719     if (getLangOpts().HIP && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && FD &&
6720         FD->getBuiltinID()) {
6721       for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < ArgExprs.size() && Idx < FD->param_size();
6722           ++Idx) {
6723         ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(Idx);
6724         if (!ArgExprs[Idx] || !Param || !Param->getType()->isPointerType() ||
6725             !ArgExprs[Idx]->getType()->isPointerType())
6726           continue;
6727 
6728         auto ParamAS = Param->getType()->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6729         auto ArgTy = ArgExprs[Idx]->getType();
6730         auto ArgPtTy = ArgTy->getPointeeType();
6731         auto ArgAS = ArgPtTy.getAddressSpace();
6732 
6733         // Add address space cast if target address spaces are different
6734         bool NeedImplicitASC =
6735           ParamAS != LangAS::Default &&       // Pointer params in generic AS don't need special handling.
6736           ( ArgAS == LangAS::Default  ||      // We do allow implicit conversion from generic AS
6737                                               // or from specific AS which has target AS matching that of Param.
6738           getASTContext().getTargetAddressSpace(ArgAS) == getASTContext().getTargetAddressSpace(ParamAS));
6739         if (!NeedImplicitASC)
6740           continue;
6741 
6742         // First, ensure that the Arg is an RValue.
6743         if (ArgExprs[Idx]->isGLValue()) {
6744           ArgExprs[Idx] = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
6745               Context, ArgExprs[Idx]->getType(), CK_NoOp, ArgExprs[Idx],
6746               nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride());
6747         }
6748 
6749         // Construct a new arg type with address space of Param
6750         Qualifiers ArgPtQuals = ArgPtTy.getQualifiers();
6751         ArgPtQuals.setAddressSpace(ParamAS);
6752         auto NewArgPtTy =
6753             Context.getQualifiedType(ArgPtTy.getUnqualifiedType(), ArgPtQuals);
6754         auto NewArgTy =
6755             Context.getQualifiedType(Context.getPointerType(NewArgPtTy),
6756                                      ArgTy.getQualifiers());
6757 
6758         // Finally perform an implicit address space cast
6759         ArgExprs[Idx] = ImpCastExprToType(ArgExprs[Idx], NewArgTy,
6760                                           CK_AddressSpaceConversion)
6761                             .get();
6762       }
6763     }
6764   }
6765 
6766   if (Context.isDependenceAllowed() &&
6767       (Fn->isTypeDependent() || Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))) {
6768     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus);
6769     assert((Fn->containsErrors() ||
6770             llvm::any_of(ArgExprs,
6771                          [](clang::Expr *E) { return E->containsErrors(); })) &&
6772            "should only occur in error-recovery path.");
6773     return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy,
6774                             VK_PRValue, RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
6775   }
6776   return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
6777                                ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
6778 }
6779 
BuildBuiltinCallExpr(SourceLocation Loc,Builtin::ID Id,MultiExprArg CallArgs)6780 Expr *Sema::BuildBuiltinCallExpr(SourceLocation Loc, Builtin::ID Id,
6781                                  MultiExprArg CallArgs) {
6782   std::string Name = Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(Id);
6783   LookupResult R(*this, &Context.Idents.get(Name), Loc,
6784                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
6785   LookupName(R, TUScope, /*AllowBuiltinCreation=*/true);
6786 
6787   auto *BuiltInDecl = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>();
6788   assert(BuiltInDecl && "failed to find builtin declaration");
6789 
6790   ExprResult DeclRef =
6791       BuildDeclRefExpr(BuiltInDecl, BuiltInDecl->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc);
6792   assert(DeclRef.isUsable() && "Builtin reference cannot fail");
6793 
6794   ExprResult Call =
6795       BuildCallExpr(/*Scope=*/nullptr, DeclRef.get(), Loc, CallArgs, Loc);
6796 
6797   assert(!Call.isInvalid() && "Call to builtin cannot fail!");
6798   return Call.get();
6799 }
6800 
ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr * E,ParsedType ParsedDestTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)6801 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
6802                                  SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6803                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6804   QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
6805   return BuildAsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6806 }
6807 
BuildAsTypeExpr(Expr * E,QualType DestTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)6808 ExprResult Sema::BuildAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, QualType DestTy,
6809                                  SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6810                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6811   ExprValueKind VK = VK_PRValue;
6812   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
6813   QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
6814   if (!SrcTy->isDependentType() &&
6815       Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
6816     return ExprError(
6817         Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
6818         << DestTy << SrcTy << E->getSourceRange());
6819   return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DestTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6820 }
6821 
ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr * E,ParsedType ParsedDestTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)6822 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
6823                                         SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6824                                         SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6825   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
6826   GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo);
6827   return ConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6828 }
6829 
BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr * Fn,NamedDecl * NDecl,SourceLocation LParenLoc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * Config,bool IsExecConfig,ADLCallKind UsesADL)6830 ExprResult Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
6831                                        SourceLocation LParenLoc,
6832                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6833                                        SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Config,
6834                                        bool IsExecConfig, ADLCallKind UsesADL) {
6835   FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
6836   unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
6837 
6838   // Functions with 'interrupt' attribute cannot be called directly.
6839   if (FDecl) {
6840     if (FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
6841       Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_anyx86_interrupt_called);
6842       return ExprError();
6843     }
6844     if (FDecl->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()) {
6845       Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_arm_interrupt_called);
6846       return ExprError();
6847     }
6848   }
6849 
6850   // X86 interrupt handlers may only call routines with attribute
6851   // no_caller_saved_registers since there is no efficient way to
6852   // save and restore the non-GPR state.
6853   if (auto *Caller = getCurFunctionDecl()) {
6854     if (Caller->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>() ||
6855         Caller->hasAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>()) {
6856       const TargetInfo &TI = Context.getTargetInfo();
6857       bool HasNonGPRRegisters =
6858           TI.hasFeature("sse") || TI.hasFeature("x87") || TI.hasFeature("mmx");
6859       if (HasNonGPRRegisters &&
6860           (!FDecl || !FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>())) {
6861         Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_anyx86_excessive_regsave)
6862             << (Caller->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>() ? 0 : 1);
6863         if (FDecl)
6864           Diag(FDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl;
6865       }
6866     }
6867   }
6868 
6869   // Promote the function operand.
6870   // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting
6871   // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call.
6872   ExprResult Result;
6873   QualType ResultTy;
6874   if (BuiltinID &&
6875       Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) {
6876     // Extract the return type from the (builtin) function pointer type.
6877     // FIXME Several builtins still have setType in
6878     // Sema::CheckBuiltinFunctionCall. One should review their definitions in
6879     // Builtins.td to ensure they are correct before removing setType calls.
6880     QualType FnPtrTy = Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType());
6881     Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, FnPtrTy, CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
6882     ResultTy = FDecl->getCallResultType();
6883   } else {
6884     Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn);
6885     ResultTy = Context.BoolTy;
6886   }
6887   if (Result.isInvalid())
6888     return ExprError();
6889   Fn = Result.get();
6890 
6891   // Check for a valid function type, but only if it is not a builtin which
6892   // requires custom type checking. These will be handled by
6893   // CheckBuiltinFunctionCall below just after creation of the call expression.
6894   const FunctionType *FuncT = nullptr;
6895   if (!BuiltinID || !Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) {
6896   retry:
6897     if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6898       // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
6899       // have type pointer to function".
6900       FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
6901       if (!FuncT)
6902         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
6903                          << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
6904     } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
6905                    Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
6906       FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
6907     } else {
6908       // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
6909       if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6910         ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
6911         if (rewrite.isInvalid())
6912           return ExprError();
6913         Fn = rewrite.get();
6914         goto retry;
6915       }
6916 
6917       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
6918                        << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
6919     }
6920   }
6921 
6922   // Get the number of parameters in the function prototype, if any.
6923   // We will allocate space for max(Args.size(), NumParams) arguments
6924   // in the call expression.
6925   const auto *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT);
6926   unsigned NumParams = Proto ? Proto->getNumParams() : 0;
6927 
6928   CallExpr *TheCall;
6929   if (Config) {
6930     assert(UsesADL == ADLCallKind::NotADL &&
6931            "CUDAKernelCallExpr should not use ADL");
6932     TheCall = CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config),
6933                                          Args, ResultTy, VK_PRValue, RParenLoc,
6934                                          CurFPFeatureOverrides(), NumParams);
6935   } else {
6936     TheCall =
6937         CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_PRValue, RParenLoc,
6938                          CurFPFeatureOverrides(), NumParams, UsesADL);
6939   }
6940 
6941   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom type checking.
6942   if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) {
6943     ExprResult E = CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
6944     if (!E.isInvalid() && Context.BuiltinInfo.isImmediate(BuiltinID))
6945       E = CheckForImmediateInvocation(E, FDecl);
6946     return E;
6947   }
6948 
6949   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
6950     if (Config) {
6951       // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
6952       if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
6953         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
6954             << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange());
6955 
6956       // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
6957       if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType() &&
6958           !FuncT->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>() &&
6959           !FuncT->getReturnType()->isInstantiationDependentType())
6960         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
6961             << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
6962     } else {
6963       // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
6964       if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
6965         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
6966             << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange());
6967     }
6968   }
6969 
6970   // Check for a valid return type
6971   if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getBeginLoc(), TheCall,
6972                           FDecl))
6973     return ExprError();
6974 
6975   // We know the result type of the call, set it.
6976   TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
6977   TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType()));
6978 
6979   // WebAssembly tables can't be used as arguments.
6980   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm()) {
6981     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
6982       if (Arg && Arg->getType()->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
6983         return ExprError(Diag(Arg->getExprLoc(),
6984                               diag::err_wasm_table_as_function_parameter));
6985       }
6986     }
6987   }
6988 
6989   if (Proto) {
6990     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc,
6991                                 IsExecConfig))
6992       return ExprError();
6993   } else {
6994     assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
6995 
6996     if (FDecl) {
6997       // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
6998       // on our knowledge of the function definition.
6999       const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
7000       if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) {
7001         Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7002        if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size()))
7003           Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
7004           << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
7005       }
7006 
7007       // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
7008       // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
7009       if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
7010         Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7011     }
7012 
7013     // If we still haven't found a prototype to use but there are arguments to
7014     // the call, diagnose this as calling a function without a prototype.
7015     // However, if we found a function declaration, check to see if
7016     // -Wdeprecated-non-prototype was disabled where the function was declared.
7017     // If so, we will silence the diagnostic here on the assumption that this
7018     // interface is intentional and the user knows what they're doing. We will
7019     // also silence the diagnostic if there is a function declaration but it
7020     // was implicitly defined (the user already gets diagnostics about the
7021     // creation of the implicit function declaration, so the additional warning
7022     // is not helpful).
7023     if (!Proto && !Args.empty() &&
7024         (!FDecl || (!FDecl->isImplicit() &&
7025                     !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_strict_uses_without_prototype,
7026                                      FDecl->getLocation()))))
7027       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_strict_uses_without_prototype)
7028           << (FDecl != nullptr) << FDecl;
7029 
7030     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
7031     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
7032       Expr *Arg = Args[i];
7033 
7034       if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) {
7035         InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
7036             Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
7037         ExprResult ArgE =
7038             PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg);
7039         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
7040           return true;
7041 
7042         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
7043 
7044       } else {
7045         ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
7046 
7047         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
7048           return true;
7049 
7050         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
7051       }
7052 
7053       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), Arg->getType(),
7054                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
7055         return ExprError();
7056 
7057       TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
7058     }
7059     TheCall->computeDependence();
7060   }
7061 
7062   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
7063     if (Method->isImplicitObjectMemberFunction())
7064       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
7065                        << Fn->getSourceRange() << 0);
7066 
7067   // Check for sentinels
7068   if (NDecl)
7069     DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args);
7070 
7071   // Warn for unions passing across security boundary (CMSE).
7072   if (FuncT != nullptr && FuncT->getCmseNSCallAttr()) {
7073     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
7074       if (const auto *RT =
7075               dyn_cast<RecordType>(Args[i]->getType().getCanonicalType())) {
7076         if (RT->getDecl()->isOrContainsUnion())
7077           Diag(Args[i]->getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_cmse_nonsecure_union)
7078               << 0 << i;
7079       }
7080     }
7081   }
7082 
7083   // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
7084   if (FDecl) {
7085     if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto))
7086       return ExprError();
7087 
7088     checkFortifiedBuiltinMemoryFunction(FDecl, TheCall);
7089 
7090     if (BuiltinID)
7091       return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
7092   } else if (NDecl) {
7093     if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto))
7094       return ExprError();
7095   } else {
7096     if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto))
7097       return ExprError();
7098   }
7099 
7100   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FDecl);
7101 }
7102 
7103 ExprResult
ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,ParsedType Ty,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * InitExpr)7104 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
7105                            SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
7106   assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
7107   assert(InitExpr && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
7108 
7109   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7110   QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
7111   if (!TInfo)
7112     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
7113 
7114   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
7115 }
7116 
7117 ExprResult
BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * LiteralExpr)7118 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7119                                SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
7120   QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
7121 
7122   if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
7123     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
7124             LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
7125             diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
7126             SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
7127       return ExprError();
7128     if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) {
7129       // C23 6.7.10p4: An entity of variable length array type shall not be
7130       // initialized except by an empty initializer.
7131       //
7132       // The C extension warnings are issued from ParseBraceInitializer() and
7133       // do not need to be issued here. However, we continue to issue an error
7134       // in the case there are initializers or we are compiling C++. We allow
7135       // use of VLAs in C++, but it's not clear we want to allow {} to zero
7136       // init a VLA in C++ in all cases (such as with non-trivial constructors).
7137       // FIXME: should we allow this construct in C++ when it makes sense to do
7138       // so?
7139       //
7140       // But: C99-C23 6.5.2.5 Compound literals constraint 1: The type name
7141       // shall specify an object type or an array of unknown size, but not a
7142       // variable length array type. This seems odd, as it allows 'int a[size] =
7143       // {}', but forbids 'int *a = (int[size]){}'. As this is what the standard
7144       // says, this is what's implemented here for C (except for the extension
7145       // that permits constant foldable size arrays)
7146 
7147       auto diagID = LangOpts.CPlusPlus
7148                         ? diag::err_variable_object_no_init
7149                         : diag::err_compound_literal_with_vla_type;
7150       if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, literalType, LParenLoc,
7151                                            diagID))
7152         return ExprError();
7153     }
7154   } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
7155              RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
7156                diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type,
7157                SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
7158     return ExprError();
7159 
7160   InitializedEntity Entity
7161     = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo);
7162   InitializationKind Kind
7163     = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
7164                                            SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
7165                                            /*InitList=*/true);
7166   InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr);
7167   ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr,
7168                                       &literalType);
7169   if (Result.isInvalid())
7170     return ExprError();
7171   LiteralExpr = Result.get();
7172 
7173   // We treat the compound literal as being at file scope if it's not in a
7174   // function or method body, or within the function's prototype scope. This
7175   // means the following compound literal is not at file scope:
7176   //   void func(char *para[(int [1]){ 0 }[0]);
7177   const Scope *S = getCurScope();
7178   bool IsFileScope = !CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
7179                      !S->isInCFunctionScope() &&
7180                      (!S || !S->isFunctionPrototypeScope());
7181 
7182   // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
7183   // For GCC compatibility, in C++, file-scope array compound literals with
7184   // constant initializers are also l-values, and compound literals are
7185   // otherwise prvalues.
7186   //
7187   // (GCC also treats C++ list-initialized file-scope array prvalues with
7188   // constant initializers as l-values, but that's non-conforming, so we don't
7189   // follow it there.)
7190   //
7191   // FIXME: It would be better to handle the lvalue cases as materializing and
7192   // lifetime-extending a temporary object, but our materialized temporaries
7193   // representation only supports lifetime extension from a variable, not "out
7194   // of thin air".
7195   // FIXME: For C++, we might want to instead lifetime-extend only if a pointer
7196   // is bound to the result of applying array-to-pointer decay to the compound
7197   // literal.
7198   // FIXME: GCC supports compound literals of reference type, which should
7199   // obviously have a value kind derived from the kind of reference involved.
7200   ExprValueKind VK =
7201       (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !(IsFileScope && literalType->isArrayType()))
7202           ? VK_PRValue
7203           : VK_LValue;
7204 
7205   // C99 6.5.2.5
7206   //  "If the compound literal occurs outside the body of a function, the
7207   //  initializer list shall consist of constant expressions."
7208   if (IsFileScope)
7209     if (auto ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(LiteralExpr))
7210       for (unsigned i = 0, j = ILE->getNumInits(); i != j; i++) {
7211         Expr *Init = ILE->getInit(i);
7212         if (!Init->isTypeDependent() && !Init->isValueDependent() &&
7213             !Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, /*IsForRef=*/false)) {
7214           Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant)
7215               << Init->getSourceBitField();
7216           return ExprError();
7217         }
7218 
7219         ILE->setInit(i, ConstantExpr::Create(Context, Init));
7220       }
7221 
7222   auto *E = new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, VK,
7223                                               LiteralExpr, IsFileScope);
7224   if (IsFileScope) {
7225     if (!LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
7226         !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() &&
7227         !literalType->isDependentType()) // C99 6.5.2.5p3
7228       if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr))
7229         return ExprError();
7230   } else if (literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private &&
7231              literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
7232     // Embedded-C extensions to C99 6.5.2.5:
7233     //   "If the compound literal occurs inside the body of a function, the
7234     //   type name shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier."
7235     Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_compound_literal_with_address_space)
7236       << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd());
7237     return ExprError();
7238   }
7239 
7240   if (!IsFileScope && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7241     // Compound literals that have automatic storage duration are destroyed at
7242     // the end of the scope in C; in C++, they're just temporaries.
7243 
7244     // Emit diagnostics if it is or contains a C union type that is non-trivial
7245     // to destruct.
7246     if (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion())
7247       checkNonTrivialCUnion(E->getType(), E->getExprLoc(),
7248                             NonTrivialCUnionContext::CompoundLiteral,
7249                             NTCUK_Destruct);
7250 
7251     // Diagnose jumps that enter or exit the lifetime of the compound literal.
7252     if (literalType.isDestructedType()) {
7253       Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
7254       ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(E);
7255       getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope();
7256     }
7257   }
7258 
7259   if (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
7260       E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
7261     checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(E->getInitializer(),
7262                                        E->getInitializer()->getExprLoc());
7263 
7264   return MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
7265 }
7266 
7267 ExprResult
ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc,MultiExprArg InitArgList,SourceLocation RBraceLoc)7268 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
7269                     SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
7270   // Only produce each kind of designated initialization diagnostic once.
7271   SourceLocation FirstDesignator;
7272   bool DiagnosedArrayDesignator = false;
7273   bool DiagnosedNestedDesignator = false;
7274   bool DiagnosedMixedDesignator = false;
7275 
7276   // Check that any designated initializers are syntactically valid in the
7277   // current language mode.
7278   for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
7279     if (auto *DIE = dyn_cast<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[I])) {
7280       if (FirstDesignator.isInvalid())
7281         FirstDesignator = DIE->getBeginLoc();
7282 
7283       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7284         break;
7285 
7286       if (!DiagnosedNestedDesignator && DIE->size() > 1) {
7287         DiagnosedNestedDesignator = true;
7288         Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_nested)
7289           << DIE->getDesignatorsSourceRange();
7290       }
7291 
7292       for (auto &Desig : DIE->designators()) {
7293         if (!Desig.isFieldDesignator() && !DiagnosedArrayDesignator) {
7294           DiagnosedArrayDesignator = true;
7295           Diag(Desig.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_array)
7296             << Desig.getSourceRange();
7297         }
7298       }
7299 
7300       if (!DiagnosedMixedDesignator &&
7301           !isa<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0])) {
7302         DiagnosedMixedDesignator = true;
7303         Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_mixed)
7304           << DIE->getSourceRange();
7305         Diag(InitArgList[0]->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_designated_init_mixed)
7306           << InitArgList[0]->getSourceRange();
7307       }
7308     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !DiagnosedMixedDesignator &&
7309                isa<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0])) {
7310       DiagnosedMixedDesignator = true;
7311       auto *DIE = cast<DesignatedInitExpr>(InitArgList[0]);
7312       Diag(DIE->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_designated_init_mixed)
7313         << DIE->getSourceRange();
7314       Diag(InitArgList[I]->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_designated_init_mixed)
7315         << InitArgList[I]->getSourceRange();
7316     }
7317   }
7318 
7319   if (FirstDesignator.isValid()) {
7320     // Only diagnose designated initiaization as a C++20 extension if we didn't
7321     // already diagnose use of (non-C++20) C99 designator syntax.
7322     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !DiagnosedArrayDesignator &&
7323         !DiagnosedNestedDesignator && !DiagnosedMixedDesignator) {
7324       Diag(FirstDesignator, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
7325                                 ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_designated_init
7326                                 : diag::ext_cxx_designated_init);
7327     } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C99) {
7328       Diag(FirstDesignator, diag::ext_designated_init);
7329     }
7330   }
7331 
7332   return BuildInitList(LBraceLoc, InitArgList, RBraceLoc);
7333 }
7334 
7335 ExprResult
BuildInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc,MultiExprArg InitArgList,SourceLocation RBraceLoc)7336 Sema::BuildInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
7337                     SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
7338   // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
7339   // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being initialized.
7340 
7341   // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders.  Overloads can be
7342   // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't.
7343   for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
7344     if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
7345       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]);
7346 
7347       // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because
7348       // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc.
7349       if (result.isInvalid()) continue;
7350 
7351       InitArgList[I] = result.get();
7352     }
7353   }
7354 
7355   InitListExpr *E =
7356       new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, RBraceLoc);
7357   E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
7358   return E;
7359 }
7360 
maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult & E)7361 void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) {
7362   assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
7363   assert(E.get()->isPRValue());
7364 
7365   // Only do this in an r-value context.
7366   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
7367 
7368   E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
7369       Context, E.get()->getType(), CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
7370       /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride());
7371   Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
7372 }
7373 
PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult & Src,QualType DestTy)7374 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
7375   // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
7376   // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
7377   // pointers.  Everything else should be possible.
7378 
7379   QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
7380   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
7381     return CK_NoOp;
7382 
7383   switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7384   case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7385     llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
7386 
7387   case Type::STK_CPointer:
7388   case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7389   case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7390     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7391     case Type::STK_CPointer: {
7392       LangAS SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
7393       LangAS DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
7394       if (SrcAS != DestAS)
7395         return CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
7396       if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(SrcTy, DestTy))
7397         return CK_NoOp;
7398       return CK_BitCast;
7399     }
7400     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7401       return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
7402                 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
7403     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7404       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
7405         return CK_BitCast;
7406       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
7407         return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
7408       maybeExtendBlockObject(Src);
7409       return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
7410     case Type::STK_Bool:
7411       return CK_PointerToBoolean;
7412     case Type::STK_Integral:
7413       return CK_PointerToIntegral;
7414     case Type::STK_Floating:
7415     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7416     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7417     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7418     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7419       llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
7420     }
7421     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7422 
7423   case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7424     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7425     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7426       return CK_FixedPointCast;
7427     case Type::STK_Bool:
7428       return CK_FixedPointToBoolean;
7429     case Type::STK_Integral:
7430       return CK_FixedPointToIntegral;
7431     case Type::STK_Floating:
7432       return CK_FixedPointToFloating;
7433     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7434     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7435       Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
7436            diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
7437           << DestTy;
7438       return CK_IntegralCast;
7439     case Type::STK_CPointer:
7440     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7441     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7442     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7443       llvm_unreachable("illegal cast to pointer type");
7444     }
7445     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7446 
7447   case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
7448   case Type::STK_Integral:
7449     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7450     case Type::STK_CPointer:
7451     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7452     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7453       if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
7454                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
7455         return CK_NullToPointer;
7456       return CK_IntegralToPointer;
7457     case Type::STK_Bool:
7458       return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
7459     case Type::STK_Integral:
7460       return CK_IntegralCast;
7461     case Type::STK_Floating:
7462       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
7463     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7464       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7465                       DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7466                       CK_IntegralCast);
7467       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
7468     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7469       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7470                       DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7471                       CK_IntegralToFloating);
7472       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
7473     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7474       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
7475     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7476       return CK_IntegralToFixedPoint;
7477     }
7478     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7479 
7480   case Type::STK_Floating:
7481     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7482     case Type::STK_Floating:
7483       return CK_FloatingCast;
7484     case Type::STK_Bool:
7485       return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
7486     case Type::STK_Integral:
7487       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
7488     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7489       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7490                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7491                               CK_FloatingCast);
7492       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
7493     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7494       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7495                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7496                               CK_FloatingToIntegral);
7497       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
7498     case Type::STK_CPointer:
7499     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7500     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7501       llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
7502     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7503       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
7504     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7505       return CK_FloatingToFixedPoint;
7506     }
7507     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7508 
7509   case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7510     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7511     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7512       return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
7513     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7514       return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
7515     case Type::STK_Floating: {
7516       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
7517       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
7518         return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
7519       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
7520       return CK_FloatingCast;
7521     }
7522     case Type::STK_Bool:
7523       return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
7524     case Type::STK_Integral:
7525       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7526                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7527                               CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
7528       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
7529     case Type::STK_CPointer:
7530     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7531     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7532       llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
7533     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7534       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
7535     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7536       Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
7537            diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
7538           << SrcTy;
7539       return CK_IntegralCast;
7540     }
7541     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7542 
7543   case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7544     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
7545     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
7546       return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
7547     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
7548       return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
7549     case Type::STK_Integral: {
7550       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
7551       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
7552         return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
7553       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
7554       return CK_IntegralCast;
7555     }
7556     case Type::STK_Bool:
7557       return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
7558     case Type::STK_Floating:
7559       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
7560                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
7561                               CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
7562       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
7563     case Type::STK_CPointer:
7564     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
7565     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
7566       llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
7567     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
7568       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
7569     case Type::STK_FixedPoint:
7570       Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(),
7571            diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type)
7572           << SrcTy;
7573       return CK_IntegralCast;
7574     }
7575     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
7576   }
7577 
7578   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
7579 }
7580 
breakDownVectorType(QualType type,uint64_t & len,QualType & eltType)7581 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len,
7582                                 QualType &eltType) {
7583   // Vectors are simple.
7584   if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) {
7585     len = vecType->getNumElements();
7586     eltType = vecType->getElementType();
7587     assert(eltType->isScalarType() || eltType->isMFloat8Type());
7588     return true;
7589   }
7590 
7591   // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if
7592   // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types).
7593   if (!type->isRealType()) return false;
7594 
7595   len = 1;
7596   eltType = type;
7597   return true;
7598 }
7599 
isValidSveBitcast(QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)7600 bool Sema::isValidSveBitcast(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
7601   assert(srcTy->isVectorType() || destTy->isVectorType());
7602 
7603   auto ValidScalableConversion = [](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
7604     if (!FirstType->isSVESizelessBuiltinType())
7605       return false;
7606 
7607     const auto *VecTy = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
7608     return VecTy && VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData;
7609   };
7610 
7611   return ValidScalableConversion(srcTy, destTy) ||
7612          ValidScalableConversion(destTy, srcTy);
7613 }
7614 
areMatrixTypesOfTheSameDimension(QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)7615 bool Sema::areMatrixTypesOfTheSameDimension(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
7616   if (!destTy->isMatrixType() || !srcTy->isMatrixType())
7617     return false;
7618 
7619   const ConstantMatrixType *matSrcType = srcTy->getAs<ConstantMatrixType>();
7620   const ConstantMatrixType *matDestType = destTy->getAs<ConstantMatrixType>();
7621 
7622   return matSrcType->getNumRows() == matDestType->getNumRows() &&
7623          matSrcType->getNumColumns() == matDestType->getNumColumns();
7624 }
7625 
areVectorTypesSameSize(QualType SrcTy,QualType DestTy)7626 bool Sema::areVectorTypesSameSize(QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
7627   assert(DestTy->isVectorType() || SrcTy->isVectorType());
7628 
7629   uint64_t SrcLen, DestLen;
7630   QualType SrcEltTy, DestEltTy;
7631   if (!breakDownVectorType(SrcTy, SrcLen, SrcEltTy))
7632     return false;
7633   if (!breakDownVectorType(DestTy, DestLen, DestEltTy))
7634     return false;
7635 
7636   // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a
7637   // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw
7638   // element size multiplied by the element count.
7639   uint64_t SrcEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(SrcEltTy);
7640   uint64_t DestEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(DestEltTy);
7641 
7642   return (SrcLen * SrcEltSize == DestLen * DestEltSize);
7643 }
7644 
anyAltivecTypes(QualType SrcTy,QualType DestTy)7645 bool Sema::anyAltivecTypes(QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
7646   assert((DestTy->isVectorType() || SrcTy->isVectorType()) &&
7647          "expected at least one type to be a vector here");
7648 
7649   bool IsSrcTyAltivec =
7650       SrcTy->isVectorType() && ((SrcTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7651                                  VectorKind::AltiVecVector) ||
7652                                 (SrcTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7653                                  VectorKind::AltiVecBool) ||
7654                                 (SrcTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7655                                  VectorKind::AltiVecPixel));
7656 
7657   bool IsDestTyAltivec = DestTy->isVectorType() &&
7658                          ((DestTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7659                            VectorKind::AltiVecVector) ||
7660                           (DestTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7661                            VectorKind::AltiVecBool) ||
7662                           (DestTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
7663                            VectorKind::AltiVecPixel));
7664 
7665   return (IsSrcTyAltivec || IsDestTyAltivec);
7666 }
7667 
areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)7668 bool Sema::areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
7669   assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
7670 
7671   // Disallow lax conversions between scalars and ExtVectors (these
7672   // conversions are allowed for other vector types because common headers
7673   // depend on them).  Most scalar OP ExtVector cases are handled by the
7674   // splat path anyway, which does what we want (convert, not bitcast).
7675   // What this rules out for ExtVectors is crazy things like char4*float.
7676   if (srcTy->isScalarType() && destTy->isExtVectorType()) return false;
7677   if (destTy->isScalarType() && srcTy->isExtVectorType()) return false;
7678 
7679   return areVectorTypesSameSize(srcTy, destTy);
7680 }
7681 
isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)7682 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
7683   assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
7684 
7685   switch (Context.getLangOpts().getLaxVectorConversions()) {
7686   case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::None:
7687     return false;
7688 
7689   case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::Integer:
7690     if (!srcTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
7691       auto *Vec = srcTy->getAs<VectorType>();
7692       if (!Vec || !Vec->getElementType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
7693         return false;
7694     }
7695     if (!destTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
7696       auto *Vec = destTy->getAs<VectorType>();
7697       if (!Vec || !Vec->getElementType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
7698         return false;
7699     }
7700     // OK, integer (vector) -> integer (vector) bitcast.
7701     break;
7702 
7703     case LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::All:
7704     break;
7705   }
7706 
7707   return areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(srcTy, destTy);
7708 }
7709 
CheckMatrixCast(SourceRange R,QualType DestTy,QualType SrcTy,CastKind & Kind)7710 bool Sema::CheckMatrixCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, QualType SrcTy,
7711                            CastKind &Kind) {
7712   if (SrcTy->isMatrixType() && DestTy->isMatrixType()) {
7713     if (!areMatrixTypesOfTheSameDimension(SrcTy, DestTy)) {
7714       return Diag(R.getBegin(), diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_matrixes)
7715              << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
7716     }
7717   } else if (SrcTy->isMatrixType()) {
7718     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
7719                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_matrix_and_type)
7720            << SrcTy << DestTy << R;
7721   } else if (DestTy->isMatrixType()) {
7722     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
7723                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_matrix_and_type)
7724            << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
7725   }
7726 
7727   Kind = CK_MatrixCast;
7728   return false;
7729 }
7730 
CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R,QualType VectorTy,QualType Ty,CastKind & Kind)7731 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
7732                            CastKind &Kind) {
7733   assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
7734 
7735   if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegralType(Context)) {
7736     if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(Ty, VectorTy))
7737       return Diag(R.getBegin(),
7738                   Ty->isVectorType() ?
7739                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
7740                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
7741         << VectorTy << Ty << R;
7742   } else
7743     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
7744                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
7745       << VectorTy << Ty << R;
7746 
7747   Kind = CK_BitCast;
7748   return false;
7749 }
7750 
prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy,Expr * SplattedExpr)7751 ExprResult Sema::prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr) {
7752   QualType DestElemTy = VectorTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
7753 
7754   if (DestElemTy == SplattedExpr->getType())
7755     return SplattedExpr;
7756 
7757   assert(DestElemTy->isFloatingType() ||
7758          DestElemTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType());
7759 
7760   CastKind CK;
7761   if (VectorTy->isExtVectorType() && SplattedExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) {
7762     // OpenCL requires that we convert `true` boolean expressions to -1, but
7763     // only when splatting vectors.
7764     if (DestElemTy->isFloatingType()) {
7765       // To avoid having to have a CK_BooleanToSignedFloating cast kind, we cast
7766       // in two steps: boolean to signed integral, then to floating.
7767       ExprResult CastExprRes = ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, Context.IntTy,
7768                                                  CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral);
7769       SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get();
7770       CK = CK_IntegralToFloating;
7771     } else {
7772       CK = CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral;
7773     }
7774   } else {
7775     ExprResult CastExprRes = SplattedExpr;
7776     CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
7777     if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
7778       return ExprError();
7779     SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get();
7780   }
7781   return ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, DestElemTy, CK);
7782 }
7783 
CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R,QualType DestTy,Expr * CastExpr,CastKind & Kind)7784 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
7785                                     Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
7786   assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
7787 
7788   QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
7789 
7790   // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
7791   // an ExtVectorType.
7792   // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
7793   // (See OpenCL 6.2).
7794   if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
7795     if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(SrcTy, DestTy) ||
7796         (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7797          !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DestTy, SrcTy))) {
7798       Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
7799         << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
7800       return ExprError();
7801     }
7802     Kind = CK_BitCast;
7803     return CastExpr;
7804   }
7805 
7806   // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type.  The appropriate
7807   // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
7808   // splat from elt type to vector.
7809   if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
7810     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
7811                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
7812       << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
7813 
7814   Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
7815   return prepareVectorSplat(DestTy, CastExpr);
7816 }
7817 
7818 ExprResult
ActOnCastExpr(Scope * S,SourceLocation LParenLoc,Declarator & D,ParsedType & Ty,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * CastExpr)7819 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7820                     Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
7821                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
7822   assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) &&
7823          "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
7824 
7825   TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
7826   if (D.isInvalidType())
7827     return ExprError();
7828 
7829   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7830     // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
7831     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
7832   }
7833 
7834   checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
7835 
7836   QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
7837   Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
7838 
7839   bool isVectorLiteral = false;
7840 
7841   // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
7842   // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
7843   ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
7844   ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
7845   if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL)
7846        && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
7847     if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
7848       Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
7849       return ExprError();
7850     }
7851     if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
7852       Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
7853       if (!E->isTypeDependent() && !E->getType()->isVectorType())
7854         isVectorLiteral = true;
7855     }
7856     else
7857       isVectorLiteral = true;
7858   }
7859 
7860   // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
7861   // then handle it as such.
7862   if (isVectorLiteral)
7863     return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
7864 
7865   // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
7866   // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
7867   // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
7868   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
7869     ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
7870     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7871     CastExpr = Result.get();
7872   }
7873 
7874   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType())
7875     Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange();
7876 
7877   ObjC().CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr);
7878 
7879   ObjC().CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr);
7880 
7881   DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(castType.getTypePtr(), CastExpr);
7882 
7883   return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
7884 }
7885 
BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * E,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo)7886 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7887                                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
7888                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
7889   assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
7890          "Expected paren or paren list expression");
7891 
7892   Expr **exprs;
7893   unsigned numExprs;
7894   Expr *subExpr;
7895   SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc;
7896   if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
7897     LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc();
7898     LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc();
7899     exprs = PE->getExprs();
7900     numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
7901   } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance
7902     LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen();
7903     LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen();
7904     subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
7905     exprs = &subExpr;
7906     numExprs = 1;
7907   }
7908 
7909   QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
7910   assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
7911 
7912   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
7913   const VectorType *VTy = Ty->castAs<VectorType>();
7914   unsigned numElems = VTy->getNumElements();
7915 
7916   // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
7917   // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
7918   // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
7919   // replicated to all the components of the vector
7920   if (CheckAltivecInitFromScalar(E->getSourceRange(), Ty,
7921                                  VTy->getElementType()))
7922     return ExprError();
7923   if (ShouldSplatAltivecScalarInCast(VTy)) {
7924     // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
7925     // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
7926     // be replicated to all the components of the vector
7927     if (numExprs == 1) {
7928       QualType ElemTy = VTy->getElementType();
7929       ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
7930       if (Literal.isInvalid())
7931         return ExprError();
7932       Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
7933                                   PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
7934       return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
7935     }
7936     else if (numExprs < numElems) {
7937       Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
7938            diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
7939       return ExprError();
7940     }
7941     else
7942       initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
7943   }
7944   else {
7945     // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
7946     // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
7947     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic &&
7948         numExprs == 1) {
7949       QualType ElemTy = VTy->getElementType();
7950       ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
7951       if (Literal.isInvalid())
7952         return ExprError();
7953       Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
7954                                   PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
7955       return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
7956     }
7957 
7958     initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
7959   }
7960   // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
7961   // braces instead of the original commas.
7962   InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc,
7963                                                    initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc);
7964   initE->setType(Ty);
7965   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
7966 }
7967 
7968 ExprResult
MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope * S,Expr * OrigExpr)7969 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
7970   ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
7971   if (!E)
7972     return OrigExpr;
7973 
7974   ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
7975 
7976   for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
7977     Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
7978                         E->getExpr(i));
7979 
7980   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7981 
7982   return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
7983 }
7984 
ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,SourceLocation R,MultiExprArg Val)7985 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
7986                                     SourceLocation R,
7987                                     MultiExprArg Val) {
7988   return ParenListExpr::Create(Context, L, Val, R);
7989 }
7990 
ActOnCXXParenListInitExpr(ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,QualType T,unsigned NumUserSpecifiedExprs,SourceLocation InitLoc,SourceLocation LParenLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)7991 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCXXParenListInitExpr(ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, QualType T,
7992                                            unsigned NumUserSpecifiedExprs,
7993                                            SourceLocation InitLoc,
7994                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7995                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
7996   return CXXParenListInitExpr::Create(Context, Args, T, NumUserSpecifiedExprs,
7997                                       InitLoc, LParenLoc, RParenLoc);
7998 }
7999 
DiagnoseConditionalForNull(const Expr * LHSExpr,const Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8000 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(const Expr *LHSExpr, const Expr *RHSExpr,
8001                                       SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8002   const Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
8003   const Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
8004   Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
8005       NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8006                                       Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
8007 
8008   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
8009     NullExpr = RHSExpr;
8010     NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
8011     NullKind =
8012         NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8013                                         Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
8014   }
8015 
8016   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
8017     return false;
8018 
8019   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression)
8020     return false;
8021 
8022   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) {
8023     // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
8024     // string in the source code.
8025     NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8026     SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
8027     if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
8028       return false;
8029   }
8030 
8031   int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr);
8032   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
8033       << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
8034       << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
8035   return true;
8036 }
8037 
8038 /// Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
checkCondition(Sema & S,const Expr * Cond,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8039 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, const Expr *Cond,
8040                            SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8041   QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
8042 
8043   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type.
8044   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) {
8045     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
8046       << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
8047     return true;
8048   }
8049 
8050   // C99 6.5.15p2
8051   if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
8052 
8053   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
8054     << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
8055   return true;
8056 }
8057 
8058 /// Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
8059 /// true otherwise.
checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema & S,ExprResult & NullExpr,QualType PointerTy)8060 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
8061                                         QualType PointerTy) {
8062   if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
8063       !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
8064                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
8065     return true;
8066 
8067   NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
8068   return false;
8069 }
8070 
8071 /// Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
8072 /// type.
checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)8073 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8074                                                      ExprResult &RHS,
8075                                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
8076   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
8077   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
8078 
8079   if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
8080     // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
8081     return S.Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSTy, RHSTy);
8082   }
8083 
8084   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
8085 
8086   // Get the pointee types.
8087   bool IsBlockPointer = false;
8088   if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
8089     lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
8090     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8091     IsBlockPointer = true;
8092   } else {
8093     lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8094     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8095   }
8096 
8097   // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to
8098   // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
8099   // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite
8100   // type.
8101 
8102   // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified
8103   // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should
8104   // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or
8105   // anything.
8106   Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers();
8107   Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers();
8108 
8109   LangAS ResultAddrSpace = LangAS::Default;
8110   LangAS LAddrSpace = lhQual.getAddressSpace();
8111   LangAS RAddrSpace = rhQual.getAddressSpace();
8112 
8113   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5 - Conversion between pointers to distinct address
8114   // spaces is disallowed.
8115   if (lhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhQual, S.getASTContext()))
8116     ResultAddrSpace = LAddrSpace;
8117   else if (rhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(lhQual, S.getASTContext()))
8118     ResultAddrSpace = RAddrSpace;
8119   else {
8120     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
8121         << LHSTy << RHSTy << 2 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8122         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8123     return QualType();
8124   }
8125 
8126   unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers();
8127   auto LHSCastKind = CK_BitCast, RHSCastKind = CK_BitCast;
8128   lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
8129   rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
8130 
8131   if (!lhQual.getPointerAuth().isEquivalent(rhQual.getPointerAuth())) {
8132     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_ptrauth)
8133         << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8134         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8135     return QualType();
8136   }
8137 
8138   // OpenCL v2.0 specification doesn't extend compatibility of type qualifiers
8139   // (C99 6.7.3) for address spaces. We assume that the check should behave in
8140   // the same manner as it's defined for CVR qualifiers, so for OpenCL two
8141   // qual types are compatible iff
8142   //  * corresponded types are compatible
8143   //  * CVR qualifiers are equal
8144   //  * address spaces are equal
8145   // Thus for conditional operator we merge CVR and address space unqualified
8146   // pointees and if there is a composite type we return a pointer to it with
8147   // merged qualifiers.
8148   LHSCastKind =
8149       LAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
8150   RHSCastKind =
8151       RAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
8152   lhQual.removeAddressSpace();
8153   rhQual.removeAddressSpace();
8154 
8155   lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual);
8156   rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual);
8157 
8158   QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(
8159       lhptee, rhptee, /*OfBlockPointer=*/false, /*Unqualified=*/false,
8160       /*BlockReturnType=*/false, /*IsConditionalOperator=*/true);
8161 
8162   if (CompositeTy.isNull()) {
8163     // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
8164     // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
8165     // to get a consistent AST.
8166     QualType incompatTy;
8167     incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(
8168         S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(S.Context.VoidTy, ResultAddrSpace));
8169     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, LHSCastKind);
8170     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, RHSCastKind);
8171 
8172     // FIXME: For OpenCL the warning emission and cast to void* leaves a room
8173     // for casts between types with incompatible address space qualifiers.
8174     // For the following code the compiler produces casts between global and
8175     // local address spaces of the corresponded innermost pointees:
8176     // local int *global *a;
8177     // global int *global *b;
8178     // a = (0 ? a : b); // see C99 6.5.16.1.p1.
8179     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
8180         << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8181         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8182 
8183     return incompatTy;
8184   }
8185 
8186   // The pointer types are compatible.
8187   // In case of OpenCL ResultTy should have the address space qualifier
8188   // which is a superset of address spaces of both the 2nd and the 3rd
8189   // operands of the conditional operator.
8190   QualType ResultTy = [&, ResultAddrSpace]() {
8191     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8192       Qualifiers CompositeQuals = CompositeTy.getQualifiers();
8193       CompositeQuals.setAddressSpace(ResultAddrSpace);
8194       return S.Context
8195           .getQualifiedType(CompositeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), CompositeQuals)
8196           .withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
8197     }
8198     return CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
8199   }();
8200   if (IsBlockPointer)
8201     ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy);
8202   else
8203     ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy);
8204 
8205   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, LHSCastKind);
8206   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, RHSCastKind);
8207   return ResultTy;
8208 }
8209 
8210 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)8211 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
8212                                                           ExprResult &LHS,
8213                                                           ExprResult &RHS,
8214                                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
8215   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
8216   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
8217 
8218   if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
8219     if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
8220       QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
8221       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
8222       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
8223       return destType;
8224     }
8225     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
8226       << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8227       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8228     return QualType();
8229   }
8230 
8231   // We have 2 block pointer types.
8232   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
8233 }
8234 
8235 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
8236 static QualType
checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)8237 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8238                                             ExprResult &RHS,
8239                                             SourceLocation Loc) {
8240   // get the pointer types
8241   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
8242   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
8243 
8244   // get the "pointed to" types
8245   QualType lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8246   QualType rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8247 
8248   // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
8249   if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
8250     // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
8251     QualType destPointee
8252       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
8253     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
8254     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
8255     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
8256     // Promote to void*.
8257     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
8258     return destType;
8259   }
8260   if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
8261     QualType destPointee
8262       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
8263     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
8264     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
8265     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
8266     // Promote to void*.
8267     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
8268     return destType;
8269   }
8270 
8271   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
8272 }
8273 
8274 /// Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
8275 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema & S,ExprResult & Int,Expr * PointerExpr,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsIntFirstExpr)8276 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
8277                                         Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
8278                                         bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
8279   if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
8280       !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
8281     return false;
8282 
8283   Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
8284   Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
8285 
8286   S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
8287     << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
8288     << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
8289   Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(),
8290                             CK_IntegralToPointer);
8291   return true;
8292 }
8293 
8294 /// Simple conversion between integer and floating point types.
8295 ///
8296 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
8297 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
8298 ///
8299 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar
8300 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two
8301 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result
8302 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No
8303 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use
8304 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always
8305 /// promotes promotable types.
OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8306 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8307                                             ExprResult &RHS,
8308                                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8309   LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
8310   if (LHS.isInvalid())
8311     return QualType();
8312   RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
8313   if (RHS.isInvalid())
8314     return QualType();
8315 
8316   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
8317   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
8318   QualType LHSType =
8319     S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
8320   QualType RHSType =
8321     S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
8322 
8323   if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
8324     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
8325       << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8326     return QualType();
8327   }
8328 
8329   if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
8330     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
8331       << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8332     return QualType();
8333   }
8334 
8335   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
8336   if (LHSType == RHSType)
8337     return LHSType;
8338 
8339   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
8340   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
8341     return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
8342                                  /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
8343 
8344   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
8345   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
8346   (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
8347 }
8348 
8349 /// Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the
8350 ///        condition in length.
8351 ///
8352 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
8353 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
8354 ///
8355 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands
8356 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted
8357 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition
8358 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result
8359 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits.
8360 static QualType
OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType CondTy,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8361 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8362                               QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8363   QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
8364   if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
8365 
8366   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
8367   assert(CV);
8368 
8369   // Determine the vector result type
8370   unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements();
8371   QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements);
8372 
8373   // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits
8374   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType())
8375       != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) {
8376     // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print
8377     // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description.
8378     std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString();
8379     SmallString<64> Str;
8380     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
8381     OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)";
8382     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
8383       << CondTy << OS.str();
8384     return QualType();
8385   }
8386 
8387   // Convert operands to the vector result type
8388   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
8389   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
8390 
8391   return VectorTy;
8392 }
8393 
8394 /// Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector
checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema & S,Expr * Cond,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8395 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond,
8396                                        SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8397   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of
8398   // integral type.
8399   const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
8400   assert(CondTy);
8401   QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType();
8402   if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false;
8403 
8404   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
8405     << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange();
8406   return true;
8407 }
8408 
8409 /// Return false if the vector condition type and the vector
8410 ///        result type are compatible.
8411 ///
8412 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same
8413 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number
8414 /// of bits.
checkVectorResult(Sema & S,QualType CondTy,QualType VecResTy,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8415 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy,
8416                               SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8417   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
8418   const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>();
8419   assert(CV && RV);
8420 
8421   if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) {
8422     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size)
8423       << CondTy << VecResTy;
8424     return true;
8425   }
8426 
8427   QualType CVE = CV->getElementType();
8428   QualType RVE = RV->getElementType();
8429 
8430   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) {
8431     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
8432       << CondTy << VecResTy;
8433     return true;
8434   }
8435 
8436   return false;
8437 }
8438 
8439 /// Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in
8440 ///        OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1
8441 ///        s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type.
8442 static QualType
OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema & S,ExprResult & Cond,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8443 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond,
8444                              ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8445                              SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8446   Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get());
8447   if (Cond.isInvalid())
8448     return QualType();
8449   QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
8450 
8451   if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
8452     return QualType();
8453 
8454   // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the
8455   // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i.
8456   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8457       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8458     bool IsBoolVecLang =
8459         !S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && !S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus;
8460     QualType VecResTy =
8461         S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
8462                               /*isCompAssign*/ false,
8463                               /*AllowBothBool*/ true,
8464                               /*AllowBoolConversions*/ false,
8465                               /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ IsBoolVecLang,
8466                               /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
8467     if (VecResTy.isNull())
8468       return QualType();
8469     // The result type must match the condition type as specified in
8470     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6.
8471     if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc))
8472       return QualType();
8473     return VecResTy;
8474   }
8475 
8476   // Both operands are scalar.
8477   return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc);
8478 }
8479 
8480 /// Return true if the Expr is block type
checkBlockType(Sema & S,const Expr * E)8481 static bool checkBlockType(Sema &S, const Expr *E) {
8482   if (E->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
8483     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block);
8484     return true;
8485   }
8486 
8487   if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
8488     QualType Ty = CE->getCallee()->getType();
8489     if (Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
8490       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block);
8491       return true;
8492     }
8493   }
8494   return false;
8495 }
8496 
8497 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
8498 /// In that case, LHS = cond.
8499 /// C99 6.5.15
CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult & Cond,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,ExprValueKind & VK,ExprObjectKind & OK,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)8500 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
8501                                         ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
8502                                         ExprObjectKind &OK,
8503                                         SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
8504 
8505   ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
8506   if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
8507   LHS = LHSResult;
8508 
8509   ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
8510   if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
8511   RHS = RHSResult;
8512 
8513   // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
8514   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8515     return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
8516 
8517   VK = VK_PRValue;
8518   OK = OK_Ordinary;
8519 
8520   if (Context.isDependenceAllowed() &&
8521       (Cond.get()->isTypeDependent() || LHS.get()->isTypeDependent() ||
8522        RHS.get()->isTypeDependent())) {
8523     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus);
8524     assert((Cond.get()->containsErrors() || LHS.get()->containsErrors() ||
8525             RHS.get()->containsErrors()) &&
8526            "should only occur in error-recovery path.");
8527     return Context.DependentTy;
8528   }
8529 
8530   // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently
8531   // different to merit its own checker.
8532   if ((getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) ||
8533       Cond.get()->getType()->isExtVectorType())
8534     return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
8535 
8536   // First, check the condition.
8537   Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get());
8538   if (Cond.isInvalid())
8539     return QualType();
8540   if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
8541     return QualType();
8542 
8543   // Handle vectors.
8544   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8545       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8546     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/ false,
8547                                /*AllowBothBool*/ true,
8548                                /*AllowBoolConversions*/ false,
8549                                /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
8550                                /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
8551 
8552   QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
8553                                               ArithConvKind::Conditional);
8554   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
8555     return QualType();
8556 
8557   // WebAssembly tables are not allowed as conditional LHS or RHS.
8558   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
8559   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
8560   if (LHSTy->isWebAssemblyTableType() || RHSTy->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
8561     Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_wasm_table_conditional_expression)
8562         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8563     return QualType();
8564   }
8565 
8566   // Diagnose attempts to convert between __ibm128, __float128 and long double
8567   // where such conversions currently can't be handled.
8568   if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
8569     Diag(QuestionLoc,
8570          diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) << LHSTy << RHSTy
8571       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8572     return QualType();
8573   }
8574 
8575   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Blocks cannot be used as expressions of the ternary
8576   // selection operator (?:).
8577   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
8578       ((int)checkBlockType(*this, LHS.get()) | (int)checkBlockType(*this, RHS.get()))) {
8579     return QualType();
8580   }
8581 
8582   // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
8583   // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
8584   if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
8585     // Disallow invalid arithmetic conversions, such as those between bit-
8586     // precise integers types of different sizes, or between a bit-precise
8587     // integer and another type.
8588     if (ResTy.isNull() && (LHSTy->isBitIntType() || RHSTy->isBitIntType())) {
8589       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
8590           << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8591           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8592       return QualType();
8593     }
8594 
8595     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy));
8596     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy));
8597 
8598     return ResTy;
8599   }
8600 
8601   // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
8602   // type.
8603   if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {    // C99 6.5.15p3
8604     if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
8605       if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
8606         // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
8607         // that type."  This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
8608         return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
8609                                             RHSTy.getUnqualifiedType());
8610     // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
8611   }
8612 
8613   // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
8614   // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
8615   if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
8616     QualType ResTy;
8617     if (LHSTy->isVoidType() && RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
8618       ResTy = Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSTy, RHSTy);
8619     } else if (RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
8620       ResTy = RHSTy;
8621       Diag(RHS.get()->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
8622           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8623     } else {
8624       ResTy = LHSTy;
8625       Diag(LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
8626           << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8627     }
8628     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, CK_ToVoid);
8629     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, CK_ToVoid);
8630     return ResTy;
8631   }
8632 
8633   // C23 6.5.15p7:
8634   //   ... if both the second and third operands have nullptr_t type, the
8635   //   result also has that type.
8636   if (LHSTy->isNullPtrType() && Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy))
8637     return ResTy;
8638 
8639   // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
8640   // the type of the other operand."
8641   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
8642   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
8643 
8644   // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
8645   QualType compositeType =
8646       ObjC().FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
8647   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
8648     return QualType();
8649   if (!compositeType.isNull())
8650     return compositeType;
8651 
8652 
8653   // Handle block pointer types.
8654   if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
8655     return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
8656                                                      QuestionLoc);
8657 
8658   // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
8659   if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
8660     return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
8661                                                        QuestionLoc);
8662 
8663   // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.  Note that
8664   // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
8665   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
8666       /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/true))
8667     return RHSTy;
8668   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
8669       /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/false))
8670     return LHSTy;
8671 
8672   // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
8673   // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
8674   // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
8675   if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
8676     return QualType();
8677 
8678   // Finally, if the LHS and RHS types are canonically the same type, we can
8679   // use the common sugared type.
8680   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy))
8681     return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSTy, RHSTy);
8682 
8683   // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
8684   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
8685     << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8686     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8687   return QualType();
8688 }
8689 
8690 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
8691 /// ParenRange in parentheses.
SuggestParentheses(Sema & Self,SourceLocation Loc,const PartialDiagnostic & Note,SourceRange ParenRange)8692 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
8693                                const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
8694                                SourceRange ParenRange) {
8695   SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
8696   if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
8697       EndLoc.isValid()) {
8698     Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
8699       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
8700       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
8701   } else {
8702     // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
8703     Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
8704   }
8705 }
8706 
IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc)8707 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
8708   return BinaryOperator::isAdditiveOp(Opc) ||
8709          BinaryOperator::isMultiplicativeOp(Opc) ||
8710          BinaryOperator::isShiftOp(Opc) || Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or;
8711   // This only checks for bitwise-or and bitwise-and, but not bitwise-xor and
8712   // not any of the logical operators.  Bitwise-xor is commonly used as a
8713   // logical-xor because there is no logical-xor operator.  The logical
8714   // operators, including uses of xor, have a high false positive rate for
8715   // precedence warnings.
8716 }
8717 
8718 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
8719 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
8720 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
8721 /// expression.
IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(const Expr * E,BinaryOperatorKind * Opcode,const Expr ** RHSExprs)8722 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(const Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
8723                                    const Expr **RHSExprs) {
8724   // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
8725   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
8726   E = E->IgnoreConversionOperatorSingleStep();
8727   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
8728   if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(E)) {
8729     E = MTE->getSubExpr();
8730     E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
8731   }
8732 
8733   // Built-in binary operator.
8734   if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
8735       OP && IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
8736     *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
8737     *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
8738     return true;
8739   }
8740 
8741   // Overloaded operator.
8742   if (const auto *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8743     if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
8744       return false;
8745 
8746     // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
8747     // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
8748     OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
8749     if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow ||
8750         OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus)
8751       return false;
8752 
8753     BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
8754     if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
8755       *Opcode = OpKind;
8756       *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
8757       return true;
8758     }
8759   }
8760 
8761   return false;
8762 }
8763 
8764 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
8765 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
8766 /// commonly interpreted as boolean.
ExprLooksBoolean(const Expr * E)8767 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(const Expr *E) {
8768   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8769 
8770   if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
8771     return true;
8772   if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
8773     return OP->isComparisonOp() || OP->isLogicalOp();
8774   if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
8775     return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
8776   if (E->getType()->isPointerType())
8777     return true;
8778   // FIXME: What about overloaded operator calls returning "unspecified boolean
8779   // type"s (commonly pointer-to-members)?
8780 
8781   return false;
8782 }
8783 
8784 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
8785 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
8786 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
8787 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * Condition,const Expr * LHSExpr,const Expr * RHSExpr)8788 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8789                                           Expr *Condition, const Expr *LHSExpr,
8790                                           const Expr *RHSExpr) {
8791   BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
8792   const Expr *CondRHS;
8793 
8794   if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
8795     return;
8796   if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
8797     return;
8798 
8799   // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
8800   // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
8801 
8802   unsigned DiagID = BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(CondOpcode)
8803                         ? diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_conditional
8804                         : diag::warn_precedence_conditional;
8805 
8806   Self.Diag(OpLoc, DiagID)
8807       << Condition->getSourceRange()
8808       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
8809 
8810   SuggestParentheses(
8811       Self, OpLoc,
8812       Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
8813           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
8814       SourceRange(Condition->getBeginLoc(), Condition->getEndLoc()));
8815 
8816   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
8817                      Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
8818                      SourceRange(CondRHS->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()));
8819 }
8820 
8821 /// Compute the nullability of a conditional expression.
computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy,bool IsBin,QualType LHSTy,QualType RHSTy,ASTContext & Ctx)8822 static QualType computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy, bool IsBin,
8823                                               QualType LHSTy, QualType RHSTy,
8824                                               ASTContext &Ctx) {
8825   if (!ResTy->isAnyPointerType())
8826     return ResTy;
8827 
8828   auto GetNullability = [](QualType Ty) {
8829     std::optional<NullabilityKind> Kind = Ty->getNullability();
8830     if (Kind) {
8831       // For our purposes, treat _Nullable_result as _Nullable.
8832       if (*Kind == NullabilityKind::NullableResult)
8833         return NullabilityKind::Nullable;
8834       return *Kind;
8835     }
8836     return NullabilityKind::Unspecified;
8837   };
8838 
8839   auto LHSKind = GetNullability(LHSTy), RHSKind = GetNullability(RHSTy);
8840   NullabilityKind MergedKind;
8841 
8842   // Compute nullability of a binary conditional expression.
8843   if (IsBin) {
8844     if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
8845       MergedKind = NullabilityKind::NonNull;
8846     else
8847       MergedKind = RHSKind;
8848   // Compute nullability of a normal conditional expression.
8849   } else {
8850     if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable ||
8851         RHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable)
8852       MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Nullable;
8853     else if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
8854       MergedKind = RHSKind;
8855     else if (RHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull)
8856       MergedKind = LHSKind;
8857     else
8858       MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Unspecified;
8859   }
8860 
8861   // Return if ResTy already has the correct nullability.
8862   if (GetNullability(ResTy) == MergedKind)
8863     return ResTy;
8864 
8865   // Strip all nullability from ResTy.
8866   while (ResTy->getNullability())
8867     ResTy = ResTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Ctx);
8868 
8869   // Create a new AttributedType with the new nullability kind.
8870   return Ctx.getAttributedType(MergedKind, ResTy, ResTy);
8871 }
8872 
ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,SourceLocation ColonLoc,Expr * CondExpr,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)8873 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
8874                                     SourceLocation ColonLoc,
8875                                     Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
8876                                     Expr *RHSExpr) {
8877   // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
8878   // was the condition.
8879   OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr;
8880   Expr *commonExpr = nullptr;
8881   if (!LHSExpr) {
8882     commonExpr = CondExpr;
8883     // Lower out placeholder types first.  This is important so that we don't
8884     // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such
8885     // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax.
8886     if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) {
8887       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr);
8888       if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
8889       commonExpr = result.get();
8890     }
8891     // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
8892     // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
8893     if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
8894           && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
8895           && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
8896           && commonExpr->isGLValue()
8897           && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
8898           && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
8899           && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
8900       ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
8901       if (commonRes.isInvalid())
8902         return ExprError();
8903       commonExpr = commonRes.get();
8904     }
8905 
8906     // If the common expression is a class or array prvalue, materialize it
8907     // so that we can safely refer to it multiple times.
8908     if (commonExpr->isPRValue() && (commonExpr->getType()->isRecordType() ||
8909                                     commonExpr->getType()->isArrayType())) {
8910       ExprResult MatExpr = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(commonExpr);
8911       if (MatExpr.isInvalid())
8912         return ExprError();
8913       commonExpr = MatExpr.get();
8914     }
8915 
8916     opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
8917                                                 commonExpr->getType(),
8918                                                 commonExpr->getValueKind(),
8919                                                 commonExpr->getObjectKind(),
8920                                                 commonExpr);
8921     LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
8922   }
8923 
8924   QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType();
8925   ExprValueKind VK = VK_PRValue;
8926   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
8927   ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
8928   QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
8929                                              VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
8930   if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
8931       RHS.isInvalid())
8932     return ExprError();
8933 
8934   DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
8935                                 RHS.get());
8936 
8937   CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc);
8938 
8939   result = computeConditionalNullability(result, commonExpr, LHSTy, RHSTy,
8940                                          Context);
8941 
8942   if (!commonExpr)
8943     return new (Context)
8944         ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc,
8945                             RHS.get(), result, VK, OK);
8946 
8947   return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator(
8948       commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
8949       ColonLoc, result, VK, OK);
8950 }
8951 
IsInvalidSMECallConversion(QualType FromType,QualType ToType)8952 bool Sema::IsInvalidSMECallConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
8953   unsigned FromAttributes = 0, ToAttributes = 0;
8954   if (const auto *FromFn =
8955           dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Context.getCanonicalType(FromType)))
8956     FromAttributes =
8957         FromFn->getAArch64SMEAttributes() & FunctionType::SME_AttributeMask;
8958   if (const auto *ToFn =
8959           dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Context.getCanonicalType(ToType)))
8960     ToAttributes =
8961         ToFn->getAArch64SMEAttributes() & FunctionType::SME_AttributeMask;
8962 
8963   return FromAttributes != ToAttributes;
8964 }
8965 
8966 // Check if we have a conversion between incompatible cmse function pointer
8967 // types, that is, a conversion between a function pointer with the
8968 // cmse_nonsecure_call attribute and one without.
IsInvalidCmseNSCallConversion(Sema & S,QualType FromType,QualType ToType)8969 static bool IsInvalidCmseNSCallConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
8970                                           QualType ToType) {
8971   if (const auto *ToFn =
8972           dyn_cast<FunctionType>(S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType))) {
8973     if (const auto *FromFn =
8974             dyn_cast<FunctionType>(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType))) {
8975       FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
8976       FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
8977 
8978       return ToEInfo.getCmseNSCall() != FromEInfo.getCmseNSCall();
8979     }
8980   }
8981   return false;
8982 }
8983 
8984 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
8985 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
8986 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
8987 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
8988 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,SourceLocation Loc)8989 static AssignConvertType checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S,
8990                                                         QualType LHSType,
8991                                                         QualType RHSType,
8992                                                         SourceLocation Loc) {
8993   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
8994   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
8995 
8996   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
8997   const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
8998   Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
8999   std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
9000       cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
9001   std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
9002       cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
9003 
9004   AssignConvertType ConvTy = AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9005 
9006   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
9007   // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
9008   // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
9009 
9010   // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
9011   if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
9012       lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
9013     // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
9014     lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
9015     rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
9016   }
9017 
9018   if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq, S.getASTContext())) {
9019     // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal.
9020     if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq, S.getASTContext()))
9021       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9022 
9023     // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
9024     // and from void*.
9025     else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime().compatiblyIncludes(
9026                  rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime(),
9027                  S.getASTContext()) &&
9028              (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
9029       ; // keep old
9030 
9031     // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
9032     else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
9033       ConvTy = AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9034 
9035     // Treat pointer-auth mismatches as fatal.
9036     else if (!lhq.getPointerAuth().isEquivalent(rhq.getPointerAuth()))
9037       ConvTy = AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9038 
9039     // For GCC/MS compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
9040     // as still compatible in C.
9041     else
9042       ConvTy = AssignConvertType::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9043   }
9044 
9045   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
9046   // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
9047   // version of void...
9048   if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
9049     if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
9050       return ConvTy;
9051 
9052     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
9053     assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
9054     return AssignConvertType::FunctionVoidPointer;
9055   }
9056 
9057   if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
9058     // In C, void * to another pointer type is compatible, but we want to note
9059     // that there will be an implicit conversion happening here.
9060     if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
9061       return ConvTy == AssignConvertType::Compatible &&
9062                      !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
9063                  ? AssignConvertType::CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr
9064                  : ConvTy;
9065 
9066     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
9067     assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
9068     return AssignConvertType::FunctionVoidPointer;
9069   }
9070 
9071   if (!S.Diags.isIgnored(
9072           diag::warn_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer_strict,
9073           Loc) &&
9074       RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() &&
9075       !S.TryFunctionConversion(RHSType, LHSType, RHSType))
9076     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointerStrict;
9077 
9078   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
9079   // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
9080   QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
9081   if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
9082     // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
9083     // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
9084     // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
9085     if (lhptee->isCharType())
9086       ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
9087     else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
9088       ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
9089 
9090     if (rhptee->isCharType())
9091       rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
9092     else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
9093       rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
9094 
9095     if (ltrans == rtrans) {
9096       // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
9097       // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
9098       // warning can be disabled.
9099       if (!S.IsAssignConvertCompatible(ConvTy))
9100         return ConvTy;
9101 
9102       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerSign;
9103     }
9104 
9105     // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
9106     // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
9107     // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
9108     // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
9109     if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
9110       do {
9111         std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
9112           cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
9113         std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
9114           cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
9115 
9116         // Inconsistent address spaces at this point is invalid, even if the
9117         // address spaces would be compatible.
9118         // FIXME: This doesn't catch address space mismatches for pointers of
9119         // different nesting levels, like:
9120         //   __local int *** a;
9121         //   int ** b = a;
9122         // It's not clear how to actually determine when such pointers are
9123         // invalidly incompatible.
9124         if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace())
9125           return AssignConvertType::
9126               IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch;
9127 
9128       } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
9129 
9130       if (lhptee == rhptee)
9131         return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
9132     }
9133 
9134     // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
9135     if (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isFunctionPointerType())
9136       return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointer;
9137     return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9138   }
9139   bool DiscardingCFIUncheckedCallee, AddingCFIUncheckedCallee;
9140   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9141       S.IsFunctionConversion(ltrans, rtrans, &DiscardingCFIUncheckedCallee,
9142                              &AddingCFIUncheckedCallee)) {
9143     // Allow conversions between CFIUncheckedCallee-ness.
9144     if (!DiscardingCFIUncheckedCallee && !AddingCFIUncheckedCallee)
9145       return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointer;
9146   }
9147   if (IsInvalidCmseNSCallConversion(S, ltrans, rtrans))
9148     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointer;
9149   if (S.IsInvalidSMECallConversion(rtrans, ltrans))
9150     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointer;
9151   return ConvTy;
9152 }
9153 
9154 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
9155 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
9156 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
9157 // types.
checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)9158 static AssignConvertType checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S,
9159                                                              QualType LHSType,
9160                                                              QualType RHSType) {
9161   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
9162   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
9163 
9164   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
9165 
9166   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
9167   lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
9168   rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
9169 
9170   // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
9171   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9172     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
9173 
9174   AssignConvertType ConvTy = AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9175 
9176   // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
9177   Qualifiers LQuals = lhptee.getLocalQualifiers();
9178   Qualifiers RQuals = rhptee.getLocalQualifiers();
9179   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9180     LQuals.removeAddressSpace();
9181     RQuals.removeAddressSpace();
9182   }
9183   if (LQuals != RQuals)
9184     ConvTy = AssignConvertType::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9185 
9186   // FIXME: OpenCL doesn't define the exact compile time semantics for a block
9187   // assignment.
9188   // The current behavior is similar to C++ lambdas. A block might be
9189   // assigned to a variable iff its return type and parameters are compatible
9190   // (C99 6.2.7) with the corresponding return type and parameters of the LHS of
9191   // an assignment. Presumably it should behave in way that a function pointer
9192   // assignment does in C, so for each parameter and return type:
9193   //  * CVR and address space of LHS should be a superset of CVR and address
9194   //  space of RHS.
9195   //  * unqualified types should be compatible.
9196   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9197     if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(
9198             S.Context.getQualifiedType(LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), LQuals),
9199             S.Context.getQualifiedType(RHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), RQuals)))
9200       return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
9201   } else if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
9202     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
9203 
9204   return ConvTy;
9205 }
9206 
9207 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
9208 /// for assignment compatibility.
checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)9209 static AssignConvertType checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S,
9210                                                             QualType LHSType,
9211                                                             QualType RHSType) {
9212   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
9213   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
9214 
9215   if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
9216     // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
9217     if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
9218         !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
9219       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9220     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9221   }
9222   if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
9223     if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
9224         !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
9225       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9226     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9227   }
9228   QualType lhptee = LHSType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9229   QualType rhptee = RHSType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9230 
9231   if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee, S.getASTContext()) &&
9232       // make an exception for id<P>
9233       !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
9234     return AssignConvertType::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
9235 
9236   if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
9237     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9238   if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
9239     return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
9240   return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9241 }
9242 
CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)9243 AssignConvertType Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
9244                                                    QualType LHSType,
9245                                                    QualType RHSType) {
9246   // Fake up an opaque expression.  We don't actually care about what
9247   // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
9248   // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
9249   // usually happen on valid code.
9250   OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_PRValue);
9251   ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
9252   CastKind K;
9253 
9254   return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K, /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
9255 }
9256 
9257 /// This helper function returns true if QT is a vector type that has element
9258 /// type ElementType.
isVector(QualType QT,QualType ElementType)9259 static bool isVector(QualType QT, QualType ElementType) {
9260   if (const VectorType *VT = QT->getAs<VectorType>())
9261     return VT->getElementType().getCanonicalType() == ElementType;
9262   return false;
9263 }
9264 
9265 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
9266 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
9267 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
9268 ///
9269 ///  int a, *pint;
9270 ///  short *pshort;
9271 ///  struct foo *pfoo;
9272 ///
9273 ///  pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
9274 ///  a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
9275 ///  pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
9276 ///  pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
9277 ///
9278 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
9279 /// C99 spec dictates.
9280 ///
9281 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,ExprResult & RHS,CastKind & Kind,bool ConvertRHS)9282 AssignConvertType Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,
9283                                                    ExprResult &RHS,
9284                                                    CastKind &Kind,
9285                                                    bool ConvertRHS) {
9286   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
9287   QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
9288 
9289   // Get canonical types.  We're not formatting these types, just comparing
9290   // them.
9291   LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
9292   RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
9293 
9294   // Common case: no conversion required.
9295   if (LHSType == RHSType) {
9296     Kind = CK_NoOp;
9297     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9298   }
9299 
9300   // If the LHS has an __auto_type, there are no additional type constraints
9301   // to be worried about.
9302   if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(LHSType)) {
9303     if (AT->isGNUAutoType()) {
9304       Kind = CK_NoOp;
9305       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9306     }
9307   }
9308 
9309   // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an
9310   // atomic qualification step.
9311   if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) {
9312     AssignConvertType Result =
9313         CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind);
9314     if (!IsAssignConvertCompatible(Result))
9315       return Result;
9316     if (Kind != CK_NoOp && ConvertRHS)
9317       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind);
9318     Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic;
9319     return Result;
9320   }
9321 
9322   // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
9323   // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
9324   // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
9325   // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
9326   // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
9327   // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
9328   // type.
9329   if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
9330     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
9331       Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
9332       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9333     }
9334     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9335   }
9336 
9337   // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
9338   // to the same ExtVector type.
9339   if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
9340     if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
9341       return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9342     if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
9343       // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the element type.
9344       if (ConvertRHS)
9345         RHS = prepareVectorSplat(LHSType, RHS.get());
9346       Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
9347       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9348     }
9349   }
9350 
9351   // Conversions to or from vector type.
9352   if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
9353     if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
9354       // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
9355       // vector type and vice versa
9356       if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
9357         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9358         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9359       }
9360 
9361       // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
9362       // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
9363       // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
9364       if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
9365         // The default for lax vector conversions with Altivec vectors will
9366         // change, so if we are converting between vector types where
9367         // at least one is an Altivec vector, emit a warning.
9368         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC() &&
9369             anyAltivecTypes(RHSType, LHSType) &&
9370             !Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(RHSType, LHSType))
9371           Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_lax_vec_conv_all)
9372               << RHSType << LHSType;
9373         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9374         return AssignConvertType::IncompatibleVectors;
9375       }
9376     }
9377 
9378     // When the RHS comes from another lax conversion (e.g. binops between
9379     // scalars and vectors) the result is canonicalized as a vector. When the
9380     // LHS is also a vector, the lax is allowed by the condition above. Handle
9381     // the case where LHS is a scalar.
9382     if (LHSType->isScalarType()) {
9383       const VectorType *VecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
9384       if (VecType && VecType->getNumElements() == 1 &&
9385           isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
9386         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC() &&
9387             (VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecVector ||
9388              VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool ||
9389              VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecPixel))
9390           Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_lax_vec_conv_all)
9391               << RHSType << LHSType;
9392         ExprResult *VecExpr = &RHS;
9393         *VecExpr = ImpCastExprToType(VecExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
9394         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9395         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9396       }
9397     }
9398 
9399     // Allow assignments between fixed-length and sizeless SVE vectors.
9400     if ((LHSType->isSVESizelessBuiltinType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) ||
9401         (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isSVESizelessBuiltinType()))
9402       if (ARM().areCompatibleSveTypes(LHSType, RHSType) ||
9403           ARM().areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
9404         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9405         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9406       }
9407 
9408     // Allow assignments between fixed-length and sizeless RVV vectors.
9409     if ((LHSType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) ||
9410         (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType())) {
9411       if (Context.areCompatibleRVVTypes(LHSType, RHSType) ||
9412           Context.areLaxCompatibleRVVTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
9413         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9414         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9415       }
9416     }
9417 
9418     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9419   }
9420 
9421   // Diagnose attempts to convert between __ibm128, __float128 and long double
9422   // where such conversions currently can't be handled.
9423   if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType))
9424     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9425 
9426   // Disallow assigning a _Complex to a real type in C++ mode since it simply
9427   // discards the imaginary part.
9428   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>() &&
9429       !LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>())
9430     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9431 
9432   // Arithmetic conversions.
9433   if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
9434       !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
9435     if (ConvertRHS)
9436       Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
9437     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9438   }
9439 
9440   // Conversions to normal pointers.
9441   if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
9442     // U* -> T*
9443     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
9444       LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9445       LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9446       if (AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR)
9447         Kind = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
9448       else if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(RHSType, LHSType))
9449         Kind = CK_NoOp;
9450       else
9451         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9452       return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType,
9453                                             RHS.get()->getBeginLoc());
9454     }
9455 
9456     // int -> T*
9457     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9458       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
9459       return AssignConvertType::IntToPointer;
9460     }
9461 
9462     // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
9463     // with two exceptions:
9464     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
9465       //  - conversions to void*
9466       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
9467         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9468         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9469       }
9470 
9471       //  - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
9472       if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
9473           Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
9474                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
9475         Kind = CK_BitCast;
9476         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9477       }
9478 
9479       Kind = CK_BitCast;
9480       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9481     }
9482 
9483     // U^ -> void*
9484     if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
9485       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
9486         LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9487         LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
9488                                 ->getPointeeType()
9489                                 .getAddressSpace();
9490         Kind =
9491             AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
9492         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9493       }
9494     }
9495 
9496     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9497   }
9498 
9499   // Conversions to block pointers.
9500   if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
9501     // U^ -> T^
9502     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
9503       LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
9504                               ->getPointeeType()
9505                               .getAddressSpace();
9506       LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()
9507                               ->getPointeeType()
9508                               .getAddressSpace();
9509       Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
9510       return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
9511     }
9512 
9513     // int or null -> T^
9514     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9515       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
9516       return AssignConvertType::IntToBlockPointer;
9517     }
9518 
9519     // id -> T^
9520     if (getLangOpts().ObjC && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
9521       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
9522       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9523     }
9524 
9525     // void* -> T^
9526     if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
9527       if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
9528         Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
9529         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9530       }
9531 
9532     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9533   }
9534 
9535   // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
9536   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
9537     // A* -> B*
9538     if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9539       Kind = CK_BitCast;
9540       AssignConvertType result =
9541           checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
9542       if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
9543           result == AssignConvertType::Compatible &&
9544           !ObjC().CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
9545         result = AssignConvertType::IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
9546       return result;
9547     }
9548 
9549     // int or null -> A*
9550     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9551       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
9552       return AssignConvertType::IntToPointer;
9553     }
9554 
9555     // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
9556     // with two exceptions:
9557     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
9558       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
9559 
9560       //  - conversions from 'void*'
9561       if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
9562         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9563       }
9564 
9565       //  - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
9566       if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
9567           Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
9568                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
9569         return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9570       }
9571 
9572       return AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer;
9573     }
9574 
9575     // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer.
9576     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
9577         LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) {
9578       if (ConvertRHS)
9579         maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS);
9580       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
9581       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9582     }
9583 
9584     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9585   }
9586 
9587   // Conversion to nullptr_t (C23 only)
9588   if (getLangOpts().C23 && LHSType->isNullPtrType() &&
9589       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
9590                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
9591     // null -> nullptr_t
9592     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
9593     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9594   }
9595 
9596   // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
9597   if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
9598     // T* -> _Bool
9599     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
9600       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
9601       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9602     }
9603 
9604     // T* -> int
9605     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9606       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
9607       return AssignConvertType::PointerToInt;
9608     }
9609 
9610     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9611   }
9612 
9613   // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
9614   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
9615     // T* -> _Bool
9616     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
9617       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
9618       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9619     }
9620 
9621     // T* -> int
9622     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9623       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
9624       return AssignConvertType::PointerToInt;
9625     }
9626 
9627     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9628   }
9629 
9630   // struct A -> struct B
9631   if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
9632     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
9633       Kind = CK_NoOp;
9634       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9635     }
9636   }
9637 
9638   if (LHSType->isSamplerT() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
9639     Kind = CK_IntToOCLSampler;
9640     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9641   }
9642 
9643   return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9644 }
9645 
9646 /// Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
9647 /// used to initialize the transparent union.
ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema & S,ASTContext & C,ExprResult & EResult,QualType UnionType,FieldDecl * Field)9648 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
9649                                       ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
9650                                       FieldDecl *Field) {
9651   // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
9652   // of the transparent union.
9653   Expr *E = EResult.get();
9654   InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
9655                                                    E, SourceLocation());
9656   Initializer->setType(UnionType);
9657   Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
9658 
9659   // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
9660   // union type from this initializer list.
9661   TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
9662   EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
9663                                         VK_PRValue, Initializer, false);
9664 }
9665 
9666 AssignConvertType
CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,ExprResult & RHS)9667 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
9668                                                ExprResult &RHS) {
9669   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
9670 
9671   // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
9672   // transparent_union GCC extension.
9673   const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
9674   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
9675     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9676 
9677   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
9678   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
9679   FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr;
9680   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
9681   for (auto *it : UD->fields()) {
9682     if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
9683       // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
9684       // 1) void pointer
9685       // 2) null pointer constant
9686       if (RHSType->isPointerType())
9687         if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
9688           RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
9689           InitField = it;
9690           break;
9691         }
9692 
9693       if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
9694                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
9695         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(),
9696                                 CK_NullToPointer);
9697         InitField = it;
9698         break;
9699       }
9700     }
9701 
9702     CastKind Kind;
9703     if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) ==
9704         AssignConvertType::Compatible) {
9705       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind);
9706       InitField = it;
9707       break;
9708     }
9709   }
9710 
9711   if (!InitField)
9712     return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9713 
9714   ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
9715   return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9716 }
9717 
CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,ExprResult & CallerRHS,bool Diagnose,bool DiagnoseCFAudited,bool ConvertRHS)9718 AssignConvertType Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,
9719                                                          ExprResult &CallerRHS,
9720                                                          bool Diagnose,
9721                                                          bool DiagnoseCFAudited,
9722                                                          bool ConvertRHS) {
9723   // We need to be able to tell the caller whether we diagnosed a problem, if
9724   // they ask us to issue diagnostics.
9725   assert((ConvertRHS || !Diagnose) && "can't indicate whether we diagnosed");
9726 
9727   // If ConvertRHS is false, we want to leave the caller's RHS untouched. Sadly,
9728   // we can't avoid *all* modifications at the moment, so we need some somewhere
9729   // to put the updated value.
9730   ExprResult LocalRHS = CallerRHS;
9731   ExprResult &RHS = ConvertRHS ? CallerRHS : LocalRHS;
9732 
9733   if (const auto *LHSPtrType = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9734     if (const auto *RHSPtrType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9735       if (RHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) &&
9736           !LHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) {
9737         Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(),
9738              diag::warn_noderef_to_dereferenceable_pointer)
9739             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
9740       }
9741     }
9742   }
9743 
9744   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9745     if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
9746       // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
9747       // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
9748       // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
9749       QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
9750       if (Diagnose) {
9751         RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
9752                                         AssignmentAction::Assigning);
9753       } else {
9754         ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
9755             TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
9756                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
9757                                   AllowedExplicit::None,
9758                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
9759                                   /*CStyle=*/false,
9760                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
9761         if (ICS.isFailure())
9762           return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9763         RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
9764                                         ICS, AssignmentAction::Assigning);
9765       }
9766       if (RHS.isInvalid())
9767         return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9768       AssignConvertType result = AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9769       if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
9770           !ObjC().CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, RHSType))
9771         result = AssignConvertType::IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
9772       return result;
9773     }
9774 
9775     // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
9776     // structures.
9777     // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
9778     // happen there, though.
9779   } else if (RHS.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
9780     // As a set of extensions to C, we support overloading on functions. These
9781     // functions need to be resolved here.
9782     DeclAccessPair DAP;
9783     if (FunctionDecl *FD = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
9784             RHS.get(), LHSType, /*Complain=*/false, DAP))
9785       RHS = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(RHS.get(), DAP, FD);
9786     else
9787       return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9788   }
9789 
9790   // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
9791   // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
9792   // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
9793   // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). This needs
9794   // to happen before we check for null pointer conversions because C does not
9795   // undergo the same implicit conversions as C++ does above (by the calls to
9796   // TryImplicitConversion() and PerformImplicitConversion()) which insert the
9797   // lvalue to rvalue cast before checking for null pointer constraints. This
9798   // addresses code like: nullptr_t val; int *ptr; ptr = val;
9799   //
9800   // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
9801   if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
9802     // FIXME: We potentially allocate here even if ConvertRHS is false.
9803     RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get(), Diagnose);
9804     if (RHS.isInvalid())
9805       return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9806   }
9807 
9808   // The constraints are expressed in terms of the atomic, qualified, or
9809   // unqualified type of the LHS.
9810   QualType LHSTypeAfterConversion = LHSType.getAtomicUnqualifiedType();
9811 
9812   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
9813   // a null pointer constant <C23>or its type is nullptr_t;</C23>.
9814   if ((LHSTypeAfterConversion->isPointerType() ||
9815        LHSTypeAfterConversion->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
9816        LHSTypeAfterConversion->isBlockPointerType()) &&
9817       ((getLangOpts().C23 && RHS.get()->getType()->isNullPtrType()) ||
9818        RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
9819                                         Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))) {
9820     AssignConvertType Ret = AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9821     if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) {
9822       CastKind Kind;
9823       CXXCastPath Path;
9824       CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path,
9825                              /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose);
9826 
9827       // If there is a conversion of some kind, check to see what kind of
9828       // pointer conversion happened so we can diagnose a C++ compatibility
9829       // diagnostic if the conversion is invalid. This only matters if the RHS
9830       // is some kind of void pointer. We have a carve-out when the RHS is from
9831       // a macro expansion because the use of a macro may indicate different
9832       // code between C and C++. Consider: char *s = NULL; where NULL is
9833       // defined as (void *)0 in C (which would be invalid in C++), but 0 in
9834       // C++, which is valid in C++.
9835       if (Kind != CK_NoOp && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9836           !RHS.get()->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
9837         QualType CanRHS =
9838             RHS.get()->getType().getCanonicalType().getUnqualifiedType();
9839         QualType CanLHS = LHSType.getCanonicalType().getUnqualifiedType();
9840         if (CanRHS->isVoidPointerType() && CanLHS->isPointerType()) {
9841           Ret = checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, CanLHS, CanRHS,
9842                                                RHS.get()->getExprLoc());
9843           // Anything that's not considered perfectly compatible would be
9844           // incompatible in C++.
9845           if (Ret != AssignConvertType::Compatible)
9846             Ret = AssignConvertType::CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr;
9847         }
9848       }
9849 
9850       if (ConvertRHS)
9851         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_PRValue, &Path);
9852     }
9853     return Ret;
9854   }
9855   // C23 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand has type atomic, qualified, or
9856   // unqualified bool, and the right operand is a pointer or its type is
9857   // nullptr_t.
9858   if (getLangOpts().C23 && LHSType->isBooleanType() &&
9859       RHS.get()->getType()->isNullPtrType()) {
9860     // NB: T* -> _Bool is handled in CheckAssignmentConstraints, this only
9861     // only handles nullptr -> _Bool due to needing an extra conversion
9862     // step.
9863     // We model this by converting from nullptr -> void * and then let the
9864     // conversion from void * -> _Bool happen naturally.
9865     if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) {
9866       CastKind Kind;
9867       CXXCastPath Path;
9868       CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), Context.VoidPtrTy, Kind, Path,
9869                              /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose);
9870       if (ConvertRHS)
9871         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), Context.VoidPtrTy, Kind, VK_PRValue,
9872                                 &Path);
9873     }
9874   }
9875 
9876   // OpenCL queue_t type assignment.
9877   if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(
9878                                  Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
9879     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
9880     return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9881   }
9882 
9883   CastKind Kind;
9884   AssignConvertType result =
9885       CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind, ConvertRHS);
9886 
9887   // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
9888   // type of the assignment expression.
9889   // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
9890   // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
9891   // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
9892   // does not have reference type.
9893   if (result != AssignConvertType::Incompatible &&
9894       RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) {
9895     QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9896     Expr *E = RHS.get();
9897 
9898     // Check for various Objective-C errors. If we are not reporting
9899     // diagnostics and just checking for errors, e.g., during overload
9900     // resolution, return Incompatible to indicate the failure.
9901     if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() &&
9902         ObjC().CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E,
9903                                    CheckedConversionKind::Implicit, Diagnose,
9904                                    DiagnoseCFAudited) != SemaObjC::ACR_okay) {
9905       if (!Diagnose)
9906         return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9907     }
9908     if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
9909         (ObjC().CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getBeginLoc(), LHSType,
9910                                                   E->getType(), E, Diagnose) ||
9911          ObjC().CheckConversionToObjCLiteral(LHSType, E, Diagnose))) {
9912       if (!Diagnose)
9913         return AssignConvertType::Incompatible;
9914       // Replace the expression with a corrected version and continue so we
9915       // can find further errors.
9916       RHS = E;
9917       return AssignConvertType::Compatible;
9918     }
9919 
9920     if (ConvertRHS)
9921       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind);
9922   }
9923 
9924   return result;
9925 }
9926 
9927 namespace {
9928 /// The original operand to an operator, prior to the application of the usual
9929 /// arithmetic conversions and converting the arguments of a builtin operator
9930 /// candidate.
9931 struct OriginalOperand {
OriginalOperand__anon9e9a06341311::OriginalOperand9932   explicit OriginalOperand(Expr *Op) : Orig(Op), Conversion(nullptr) {
9933     if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Op))
9934       Op = MTE->getSubExpr();
9935     if (auto *BTE = dyn_cast<CXXBindTemporaryExpr>(Op))
9936       Op = BTE->getSubExpr();
9937     if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Op)) {
9938       Orig = ICE->getSubExprAsWritten();
9939       Conversion = ICE->getConversionFunction();
9940     }
9941   }
9942 
getType__anon9e9a06341311::OriginalOperand9943   QualType getType() const { return Orig->getType(); }
9944 
9945   Expr *Orig;
9946   NamedDecl *Conversion;
9947 };
9948 }
9949 
InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)9950 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
9951                                ExprResult &RHS) {
9952   OriginalOperand OrigLHS(LHS.get()), OrigRHS(RHS.get());
9953 
9954   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
9955     << OrigLHS.getType() << OrigRHS.getType()
9956     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
9957 
9958   // If a user-defined conversion was applied to either of the operands prior
9959   // to applying the built-in operator rules, tell the user about it.
9960   if (OrigLHS.Conversion) {
9961     Diag(OrigLHS.Conversion->getLocation(),
9962          diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted)
9963       << 0 << LHS.get()->getType();
9964   }
9965   if (OrigRHS.Conversion) {
9966     Diag(OrigRHS.Conversion->getLocation(),
9967          diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted)
9968       << 1 << RHS.get()->getType();
9969   }
9970 
9971   return QualType();
9972 }
9973 
InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)9974 QualType Sema::InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
9975                                             ExprResult &RHS) {
9976   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
9977   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
9978 
9979   bool LHSNatVec = LHSType->isVectorType();
9980   bool RHSNatVec = RHSType->isVectorType();
9981 
9982   if (!(LHSNatVec && RHSNatVec)) {
9983     Expr *Vector = LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get();
9984     Expr *NonVector = !LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get();
9985     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict)
9986         << 0 << Vector->getType() << NonVector->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType()
9987         << Vector->getSourceRange();
9988     return QualType();
9989   }
9990 
9991   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict)
9992       << 1 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
9993       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
9994 
9995   return QualType();
9996 }
9997 
9998 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting
9999 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat.
10000 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar
10001 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except
10002 /// for float->int.
10003 ///
10004 /// OpenCL V2.0 6.2.6.p2:
10005 /// An error shall occur if any scalar operand type has greater rank
10006 /// than the type of the vector element.
10007 ///
10008 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions
10009 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure)
tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema & S,ExprResult * scalar,QualType scalarTy,QualType vectorEltTy,QualType vectorTy,unsigned & DiagID)10010 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar,
10011                                      QualType scalarTy,
10012                                      QualType vectorEltTy,
10013                                      QualType vectorTy,
10014                                      unsigned &DiagID) {
10015   // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
10016   // if necessary.
10017   CastKind scalarCast = CK_NoOp;
10018 
10019   if (vectorEltTy->isBooleanType() && scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
10020     scalarCast = CK_IntegralToBoolean;
10021   } else if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
10022     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType() ||
10023         (scalarTy->isIntegerType() &&
10024          S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0))) {
10025       DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type;
10026       return true;
10027     }
10028     if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
10029       return true;
10030     scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
10031   } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
10032     if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
10033       if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10034           S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) {
10035         DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type;
10036         return true;
10037       }
10038       scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
10039     }
10040     else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
10041       scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
10042     else
10043       return true;
10044   } else {
10045     return true;
10046   }
10047 
10048   // Adjust scalar if desired.
10049   if (scalar) {
10050     if (scalarCast != CK_NoOp)
10051       *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast);
10052     *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
10053   }
10054   return false;
10055 }
10056 
10057 /// Convert vector E to a vector with the same number of elements but different
10058 /// element type.
convertVector(Expr * E,QualType ElementType,Sema & S)10059 static ExprResult convertVector(Expr *E, QualType ElementType, Sema &S) {
10060   const auto *VecTy = E->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
10061   assert(VecTy && "Expression E must be a vector");
10062   QualType NewVecTy =
10063       VecTy->isExtVectorType()
10064           ? S.Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, VecTy->getNumElements())
10065           : S.Context.getVectorType(ElementType, VecTy->getNumElements(),
10066                                     VecTy->getVectorKind());
10067 
10068   // Look through the implicit cast. Return the subexpression if its type is
10069   // NewVecTy.
10070   if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
10071     if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType() == NewVecTy)
10072       return ICE->getSubExpr();
10073 
10074   auto Cast = ElementType->isIntegerType() ? CK_IntegralCast : CK_FloatingCast;
10075   return S.ImpCastExprToType(E, NewVecTy, Cast);
10076 }
10077 
10078 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to another integer type
10079 /// IntTy without losing precision.
canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema & S,ExprResult * Int,QualType OtherIntTy)10080 static bool canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int,
10081                                       QualType OtherIntTy) {
10082   if (Int->get()->containsErrors())
10083     return false;
10084 
10085   QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10086 
10087   // Reject cases where the value of the Int is unknown as that would
10088   // possibly cause truncation, but accept cases where the scalar can be
10089   // demoted without loss of precision.
10090   Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
10091   bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context);
10092   int Order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(OtherIntTy, IntTy);
10093   bool IntSigned = IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
10094   bool OtherIntSigned = OtherIntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
10095 
10096   if (CstInt) {
10097     // If the scalar is constant and is of a higher order and has more active
10098     // bits that the vector element type, reject it.
10099     llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
10100     unsigned NumBits = IntSigned
10101                            ? (Result.isNegative() ? Result.getSignificantBits()
10102                                                   : Result.getActiveBits())
10103                            : Result.getActiveBits();
10104     if (Order < 0 && S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy) < NumBits)
10105       return true;
10106 
10107     // If the signedness of the scalar type and the vector element type
10108     // differs and the number of bits is greater than that of the vector
10109     // element reject it.
10110     return (IntSigned != OtherIntSigned &&
10111             NumBits > S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy));
10112   }
10113 
10114   // Reject cases where the value of the scalar is not constant and it's
10115   // order is greater than that of the vector element type.
10116   return (Order < 0);
10117 }
10118 
10119 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to floating point type
10120 /// FloatTy without losing precision.
canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema & S,ExprResult * Int,QualType FloatTy)10121 static bool canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int,
10122                                      QualType FloatTy) {
10123   if (Int->get()->containsErrors())
10124     return false;
10125 
10126   QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10127 
10128   // Determine if the integer constant can be expressed as a floating point
10129   // number of the appropriate type.
10130   Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
10131   bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context);
10132 
10133   uint64_t Bits = 0;
10134   if (CstInt) {
10135     // Reject constants that would be truncated if they were converted to
10136     // the floating point type. Test by simple to/from conversion.
10137     // FIXME: Ideally the conversion to an APFloat and from an APFloat
10138     //        could be avoided if there was a convertFromAPInt method
10139     //        which could signal back if implicit truncation occurred.
10140     llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
10141     llvm::APFloat Float(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy));
10142     Float.convertFromAPInt(Result, IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
10143                            llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero);
10144     llvm::APSInt ConvertBack(S.Context.getIntWidth(IntTy),
10145                              !IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation());
10146     bool Ignored = false;
10147     Float.convertToInteger(ConvertBack, llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven,
10148                            &Ignored);
10149     if (Result != ConvertBack)
10150       return true;
10151   } else {
10152     // Reject types that cannot be fully encoded into the mantissa of
10153     // the float.
10154     Bits = S.Context.getTypeSize(IntTy);
10155     unsigned FloatPrec = llvm::APFloat::semanticsPrecision(
10156         S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy));
10157     if (Bits > FloatPrec)
10158       return true;
10159   }
10160 
10161   return false;
10162 }
10163 
10164 /// Attempt to convert and splat Scalar into a vector whose types matches
10165 /// Vector following GCC conversion rules. The rule is that implicit
10166 /// conversion can occur when Scalar can be casted to match Vector's element
10167 /// type without causing truncation of Scalar.
tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema & S,ExprResult * Scalar,ExprResult * Vector)10168 static bool tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *Scalar,
10169                                         ExprResult *Vector) {
10170   QualType ScalarTy = Scalar->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10171   QualType VectorTy = Vector->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10172   QualType VectorEltTy;
10173 
10174   if (const auto *VT = VectorTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
10175     assert(!isa<ExtVectorType>(VT) &&
10176            "ExtVectorTypes should not be handled here!");
10177     VectorEltTy = VT->getElementType();
10178   } else if (VectorTy->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
10179     VectorEltTy =
10180         VectorTy->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getSveEltType(S.getASTContext());
10181   } else {
10182     llvm_unreachable("Only Fixed-Length and SVE Vector types are handled here");
10183   }
10184 
10185   // Reject cases where the vector element type or the scalar element type are
10186   // not integral or floating point types.
10187   if (!VectorEltTy->isArithmeticType() || !ScalarTy->isArithmeticType())
10188     return true;
10189 
10190   // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
10191   // if necessary.
10192   CastKind ScalarCast = CK_NoOp;
10193 
10194   // Accept cases where the vector elements are integers and the scalar is
10195   // an integer.
10196   // FIXME: Notionally if the scalar was a floating point value with a precise
10197   //        integral representation, we could cast it to an appropriate integer
10198   //        type and then perform the rest of the checks here. GCC will perform
10199   //        this conversion in some cases as determined by the input language.
10200   //        We should accept it on a language independent basis.
10201   if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
10202       ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
10203       S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy)) {
10204 
10205     if (canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy))
10206       return true;
10207 
10208     ScalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
10209   } else if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) &&
10210              ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
10211     if (S.Context.getTypeSize(VectorEltTy) == S.Context.getTypeSize(ScalarTy))
10212       ScalarCast = CK_FloatingToIntegral;
10213     else
10214       return true;
10215   } else if (VectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
10216     if (ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
10217 
10218       // Reject cases where the scalar type is not a constant and has a higher
10219       // Order than the vector element type.
10220       llvm::APFloat Result(0.0);
10221 
10222       // Determine whether this is a constant scalar. In the event that the
10223       // value is dependent (and thus cannot be evaluated by the constant
10224       // evaluator), skip the evaluation. This will then diagnose once the
10225       // expression is instantiated.
10226       bool CstScalar = Scalar->get()->isValueDependent() ||
10227                        Scalar->get()->EvaluateAsFloat(Result, S.Context);
10228       int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy);
10229       if (!CstScalar && Order < 0)
10230         return true;
10231 
10232       // If the scalar cannot be safely casted to the vector element type,
10233       // reject it.
10234       if (CstScalar) {
10235         bool Truncated = false;
10236         Result.convert(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(VectorEltTy),
10237                        llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &Truncated);
10238         if (Truncated)
10239           return true;
10240       }
10241 
10242       ScalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
10243     } else if (ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
10244       if (canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy))
10245         return true;
10246 
10247       ScalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
10248     } else
10249       return true;
10250   } else if (ScalarTy->isEnumeralType())
10251     return true;
10252 
10253   // Adjust scalar if desired.
10254   if (ScalarCast != CK_NoOp)
10255     *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorEltTy, ScalarCast);
10256   *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
10257   return false;
10258 }
10259 
CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign,bool AllowBothBool,bool AllowBoolConversions,bool AllowBoolOperation,bool ReportInvalid)10260 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
10261                                    SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign,
10262                                    bool AllowBothBool,
10263                                    bool AllowBoolConversions,
10264                                    bool AllowBoolOperation,
10265                                    bool ReportInvalid) {
10266   if (!IsCompAssign) {
10267     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
10268     if (LHS.isInvalid())
10269       return QualType();
10270   }
10271   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
10272   if (RHS.isInvalid())
10273     return QualType();
10274 
10275   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
10276   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
10277   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10278   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10279 
10280   const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
10281   const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
10282   assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType);
10283 
10284   if (getLangOpts().HLSL)
10285     return HLSL().handleVectorBinOpConversion(LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
10286                                               IsCompAssign);
10287 
10288   // Any operation with MFloat8 type is only possible with C intrinsics
10289   if ((LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getElementType()->isMFloat8Type()) ||
10290       (RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getElementType()->isMFloat8Type()))
10291     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10292 
10293   // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed
10294   // for some operators but not others.
10295   if (!AllowBothBool && LHSVecType &&
10296       LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool && RHSVecType &&
10297       RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool)
10298     return ReportInvalid ? InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS) : QualType();
10299 
10300   // This operation may not be performed on boolean vectors.
10301   if (!AllowBoolOperation &&
10302       (LHSType->isExtVectorBoolType() || RHSType->isExtVectorBoolType()))
10303     return ReportInvalid ? InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS) : QualType();
10304 
10305   // If the vector types are identical, return.
10306   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
10307     return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSType, RHSType);
10308 
10309   // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type.
10310   if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
10311       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
10312     if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
10313       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
10314       return LHSType;
10315     }
10316 
10317     if (!IsCompAssign)
10318       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
10319     return RHSType;
10320   }
10321 
10322   // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors
10323   // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type.  The non-bool
10324   // operand must have integer element type.
10325   if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
10326       LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() &&
10327       (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) ==
10328        Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) {
10329     if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecVector &&
10330         LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() &&
10331         RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool) {
10332       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
10333       return LHSType;
10334     }
10335     if (!IsCompAssign &&
10336         LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool &&
10337         RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecVector &&
10338         RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
10339       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
10340       return RHSType;
10341     }
10342   }
10343 
10344   // Expressions containing fixed-length and sizeless SVE/RVV vectors are
10345   // invalid since the ambiguity can affect the ABI.
10346   auto IsSveRVVConversion = [](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType,
10347                                unsigned &SVEorRVV) {
10348     const VectorType *VecType = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
10349     SVEorRVV = 0;
10350     if (FirstType->isSizelessBuiltinType() && VecType) {
10351       if (VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData ||
10352           VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate)
10353         return true;
10354       if (VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData ||
10355           VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask ||
10356           VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_1 ||
10357           VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_2 ||
10358           VecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_4) {
10359         SVEorRVV = 1;
10360         return true;
10361       }
10362     }
10363 
10364     return false;
10365   };
10366 
10367   unsigned SVEorRVV;
10368   if (IsSveRVVConversion(LHSType, RHSType, SVEorRVV) ||
10369       IsSveRVVConversion(RHSType, LHSType, SVEorRVV)) {
10370     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sve_rvv_ambiguous)
10371         << SVEorRVV << LHSType << RHSType;
10372     return QualType();
10373   }
10374 
10375   // Expressions containing GNU and SVE or RVV (fixed or sizeless) vectors are
10376   // invalid since the ambiguity can affect the ABI.
10377   auto IsSveRVVGnuConversion = [](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType,
10378                                   unsigned &SVEorRVV) {
10379     const VectorType *FirstVecType = FirstType->getAs<VectorType>();
10380     const VectorType *SecondVecType = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
10381 
10382     SVEorRVV = 0;
10383     if (FirstVecType && SecondVecType) {
10384       if (FirstVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic) {
10385         if (SecondVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::SveFixedLengthData ||
10386             SecondVecType->getVectorKind() ==
10387                 VectorKind::SveFixedLengthPredicate)
10388           return true;
10389         if (SecondVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthData ||
10390             SecondVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask ||
10391             SecondVecType->getVectorKind() ==
10392                 VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_1 ||
10393             SecondVecType->getVectorKind() ==
10394                 VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_2 ||
10395             SecondVecType->getVectorKind() ==
10396                 VectorKind::RVVFixedLengthMask_4) {
10397           SVEorRVV = 1;
10398           return true;
10399         }
10400       }
10401       return false;
10402     }
10403 
10404     if (SecondVecType &&
10405         SecondVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Generic) {
10406       if (FirstType->isSVESizelessBuiltinType())
10407         return true;
10408       if (FirstType->isRVVSizelessBuiltinType()) {
10409         SVEorRVV = 1;
10410         return true;
10411       }
10412     }
10413 
10414     return false;
10415   };
10416 
10417   if (IsSveRVVGnuConversion(LHSType, RHSType, SVEorRVV) ||
10418       IsSveRVVGnuConversion(RHSType, LHSType, SVEorRVV)) {
10419     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sve_rvv_gnu_ambiguous)
10420         << SVEorRVV << LHSType << RHSType;
10421     return QualType();
10422   }
10423 
10424   // If there's a vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to
10425   // the vector element type and splat.
10426   unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable;
10427   if (!RHSVecType) {
10428     if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
10429       if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType,
10430                                     LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType,
10431                                     DiagID))
10432         return LHSType;
10433     } else {
10434       if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS))
10435         return LHSType;
10436     }
10437   }
10438   if (!LHSVecType) {
10439     if (isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) {
10440       if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS),
10441                                     LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(),
10442                                     RHSType, DiagID))
10443         return RHSType;
10444     } else {
10445       if (LHS.get()->isLValue() ||
10446           !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS))
10447         return RHSType;
10448     }
10449   }
10450 
10451   // FIXME: The code below also handles conversion between vectors and
10452   // non-scalars, we should break this down into fine grained specific checks
10453   // and emit proper diagnostics.
10454   QualType VecType = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType;
10455   const VectorType *VT = LHSVecType ? LHSVecType : RHSVecType;
10456   QualType OtherType = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType;
10457   ExprResult *OtherExpr = LHSVecType ? &RHS : &LHS;
10458   if (isLaxVectorConversion(OtherType, VecType)) {
10459     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC() &&
10460         anyAltivecTypes(RHSType, LHSType) &&
10461         !Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(RHSType, LHSType))
10462       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_lax_vec_conv_all) << RHSType << LHSType;
10463     // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size
10464     // needs to be the same. For non compound assignment, if one of the types is
10465     // scalar, the result is always the vector type.
10466     if (!IsCompAssign) {
10467       *OtherExpr = ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr->get(), VecType, CK_BitCast);
10468       return VecType;
10469     // In a compound assignment, lhs += rhs, 'lhs' is a lvalue src, forbidding
10470     // any implicit cast. Here, the 'rhs' should be implicit casted to 'lhs'
10471     // type. Note that this is already done by non-compound assignments in
10472     // CheckAssignmentConstraints. If it's a scalar type, only bitcast for
10473     // <1 x T> -> T. The result is also a vector type.
10474     } else if (OtherType->isExtVectorType() || OtherType->isVectorType() ||
10475                (OtherType->isScalarType() && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) {
10476       ExprResult *RHSExpr = &RHS;
10477       *RHSExpr = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
10478       return VecType;
10479     }
10480   }
10481 
10482   // Okay, the expression is invalid.
10483 
10484   // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that.
10485   if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) ||
10486       (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) {
10487     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
10488       << LHSType << RHSType
10489       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10490     return QualType();
10491   }
10492 
10493   // OpenCL V1.1 6.2.6.p1:
10494   // If the operands are of more than one vector type, then an error shall
10495   // occur. Implicit conversions between vector types are not permitted, per
10496   // section 6.2.1.
10497   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10498       RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType) &&
10499       LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
10500     Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_implicit_vector_conversion) << LHSType
10501                                                            << RHSType;
10502     return QualType();
10503   }
10504 
10505 
10506   // If there is a vector type that is not a ExtVector and a scalar, we reach
10507   // this point if scalar could not be converted to the vector's element type
10508   // without truncation.
10509   if ((RHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) ||
10510       (LHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType))) {
10511     QualType Scalar = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType;
10512     QualType Vector = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType;
10513     unsigned ScalarOrVector = LHSVecType && RHSVecType ? 1 : 0;
10514     Diag(Loc,
10515          diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation)
10516         << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector;
10517 
10518     return QualType();
10519   }
10520 
10521   // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic.
10522   Diag(Loc, DiagID)
10523     << LHSType << RHSType
10524     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10525   return QualType();
10526 }
10527 
CheckSizelessVectorOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign,ArithConvKind OperationKind)10528 QualType Sema::CheckSizelessVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
10529                                            SourceLocation Loc,
10530                                            bool IsCompAssign,
10531                                            ArithConvKind OperationKind) {
10532   if (!IsCompAssign) {
10533     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
10534     if (LHS.isInvalid())
10535       return QualType();
10536   }
10537   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
10538   if (RHS.isInvalid())
10539     return QualType();
10540 
10541   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10542   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10543 
10544   const BuiltinType *LHSBuiltinTy = LHSType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
10545   const BuiltinType *RHSBuiltinTy = RHSType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
10546 
10547   unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands;
10548   if ((OperationKind == ArithConvKind::Arithmetic) &&
10549       ((LHSBuiltinTy && LHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool()) ||
10550        (RHSBuiltinTy && RHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool()))) {
10551     Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
10552                       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10553     return QualType();
10554   }
10555 
10556   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
10557     return LHSType;
10558 
10559   if (LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && !RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
10560     if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS))
10561       return LHSType;
10562   }
10563   if (RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && !LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
10564     if (LHS.get()->isLValue() ||
10565         !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS))
10566       return RHSType;
10567   }
10568 
10569   if ((!LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && !LHSType->isRealType()) ||
10570       (!RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && !RHSType->isRealType())) {
10571     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
10572         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
10573         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10574     return QualType();
10575   }
10576 
10577   if (LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() &&
10578       Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(LHSBuiltinTy).EC !=
10579           Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(RHSBuiltinTy).EC) {
10580     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
10581         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
10582         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10583     return QualType();
10584   }
10585 
10586   if (LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() || RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
10587     QualType Scalar = LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ? RHSType : LHSType;
10588     QualType Vector = LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ? LHSType : RHSType;
10589     bool ScalarOrVector =
10590         LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType();
10591 
10592     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation)
10593         << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector;
10594 
10595     return QualType();
10596   }
10597 
10598   Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
10599                     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10600   return QualType();
10601 }
10602 
10603 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
10604 // expression.  These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
10605 // integer instead of a pointer.
checkArithmeticNull(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompare)10606 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
10607                                 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
10608   // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
10609   // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
10610   // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
10611   bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
10612   bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
10613 
10614   QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
10615 
10616   // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
10617   // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
10618   if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
10619       NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
10620     return;
10621 
10622   // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
10623   // what the other expression is.
10624   if (!IsCompare) {
10625     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
10626         << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10627         << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
10628     return;
10629   }
10630 
10631   // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
10632   // if the other expression is a pointer.
10633   if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
10634       NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
10635     return;
10636 
10637   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
10638       << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
10639       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
10640 }
10641 
DetectPrecisionLossInComplexDivision(Sema & S,QualType DivisorTy,SourceLocation OpLoc)10642 static void DetectPrecisionLossInComplexDivision(Sema &S, QualType DivisorTy,
10643                                                  SourceLocation OpLoc) {
10644   // If the divisor is real, then this is real/real or complex/real division.
10645   // Either way there can be no precision loss.
10646   auto *CT = DivisorTy->getAs<ComplexType>();
10647   if (!CT)
10648     return;
10649 
10650   QualType ElementType = CT->getElementType();
10651   bool IsComplexRangePromoted = S.getLangOpts().getComplexRange() ==
10652                                 LangOptions::ComplexRangeKind::CX_Promoted;
10653   if (!ElementType->isFloatingType() || !IsComplexRangePromoted)
10654     return;
10655 
10656   ASTContext &Ctx = S.getASTContext();
10657   QualType HigherElementType = Ctx.GetHigherPrecisionFPType(ElementType);
10658   const llvm::fltSemantics &ElementTypeSemantics =
10659       Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ElementType);
10660   const llvm::fltSemantics &HigherElementTypeSemantics =
10661       Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(HigherElementType);
10662 
10663   if ((llvm::APFloat::semanticsMaxExponent(ElementTypeSemantics) * 2 + 1 >
10664        llvm::APFloat::semanticsMaxExponent(HigherElementTypeSemantics)) ||
10665       (HigherElementType == Ctx.LongDoubleTy &&
10666        !Ctx.getTargetInfo().hasLongDoubleType())) {
10667     // Retain the location of the first use of higher precision type.
10668     if (!S.LocationOfExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied.isValid())
10669       S.LocationOfExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied = OpLoc;
10670     for (auto &[Type, Num] : S.ExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied) {
10671       if (Type == HigherElementType) {
10672         Num++;
10673         return;
10674       }
10675     }
10676     S.ExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied.push_back(std::make_pair(
10677         HigherElementType, S.ExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied.size()));
10678   }
10679 }
10680 
DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointerOrArray(Sema & S,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS,SourceLocation Loc)10681 static void DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointerOrArray(Sema &S, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
10682                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
10683   const auto *LUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(LHS);
10684   const auto *RUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(RHS);
10685   if (!LUE || !RUE)
10686     return;
10687   if (LUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf || LUE->isArgumentType() ||
10688       RUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf)
10689     return;
10690 
10691   const Expr *LHSArg = LUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens();
10692   QualType LHSTy = LHSArg->getType();
10693   QualType RHSTy;
10694 
10695   if (RUE->isArgumentType())
10696     RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentType().getNonReferenceType();
10697   else
10698     RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType();
10699 
10700   if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && !RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
10701     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSTy->getPointeeType(), RHSTy))
10702       return;
10703 
10704     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_ptr) << LHS << LHS->getSourceRange();
10705     if (const auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSArg)) {
10706       if (const ValueDecl *LHSArgDecl = DRE->getDecl())
10707         S.Diag(LHSArgDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_pointer_declared_here)
10708             << LHSArgDecl;
10709     }
10710   } else if (const auto *ArrayTy = S.Context.getAsArrayType(LHSTy)) {
10711     QualType ArrayElemTy = ArrayTy->getElementType();
10712     if (ArrayElemTy != S.Context.getBaseElementType(ArrayTy) ||
10713         ArrayElemTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType() ||
10714         RHSTy->isReferenceType() || ArrayElemTy->isCharType() ||
10715         S.Context.getTypeSize(ArrayElemTy) == S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSTy))
10716       return;
10717     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_array)
10718         << LHSArg->getSourceRange() << ArrayElemTy << RHSTy;
10719     if (const auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSArg)) {
10720       if (const ValueDecl *LHSArgDecl = DRE->getDecl())
10721         S.Diag(LHSArgDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_array_declared_here)
10722             << LHSArgDecl;
10723     }
10724 
10725     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_precedence_silence) << RHS;
10726   }
10727 }
10728 
DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsDiv)10729 static void DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS,
10730                                                ExprResult &RHS,
10731                                                SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDiv) {
10732   // Check for division/remainder by zero.
10733   Expr::EvalResult RHSValue;
10734   if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
10735       RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, S.Context) &&
10736       RHSValue.Val.getInt() == 0)
10737     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
10738                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_division_by_zero)
10739                             << IsDiv << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
10740 }
10741 
CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign,bool IsDiv)10742 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
10743                                            SourceLocation Loc,
10744                                            bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
10745   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
10746 
10747   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
10748   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
10749   if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
10750     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
10751                                /*AllowBothBool*/ getLangOpts().AltiVec,
10752                                /*AllowBoolConversions*/ false,
10753                                /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
10754                                /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
10755   if (LHSTy->isSveVLSBuiltinType() || RHSTy->isSveVLSBuiltinType())
10756     return CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
10757                                        ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
10758   if (!IsDiv &&
10759       (LHSTy->isConstantMatrixType() || RHSTy->isConstantMatrixType()))
10760     return CheckMatrixMultiplyOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
10761   // For division, only matrix-by-scalar is supported. Other combinations with
10762   // matrix types are invalid.
10763   if (IsDiv && LHSTy->isConstantMatrixType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType())
10764     return CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
10765 
10766   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
10767       LHS, RHS, Loc,
10768       IsCompAssign ? ArithConvKind::CompAssign : ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
10769   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
10770     return QualType();
10771 
10772 
10773   if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType())
10774     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10775   if (IsDiv) {
10776     DetectPrecisionLossInComplexDivision(*this, RHS.get()->getType(), Loc);
10777     DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsDiv);
10778     DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointerOrArray(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc);
10779   }
10780   return compType;
10781 }
10782 
CheckRemainderOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)10783 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
10784   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
10785   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
10786 
10787   // Note: This check is here to simplify the double exclusions of
10788   // scalar and vector HLSL checks. No getLangOpts().HLSL
10789   // is needed since all languages exlcude doubles.
10790   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isDoubleType() ||
10791       RHS.get()->getType()->isDoubleType() ||
10792       (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() && LHS.get()
10793                                                    ->getType()
10794                                                    ->getAs<VectorType>()
10795                                                    ->getElementType()
10796                                                    ->isDoubleType()) ||
10797       (RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() && RHS.get()
10798                                                    ->getType()
10799                                                    ->getAs<VectorType>()
10800                                                    ->getElementType()
10801                                                    ->isDoubleType()))
10802     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10803 
10804   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
10805       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
10806     if ((LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
10807          RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) ||
10808         (getLangOpts().HLSL &&
10809          (LHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation() ||
10810           RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation())))
10811       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
10812                                  /*AllowBothBool*/ getLangOpts().AltiVec,
10813                                  /*AllowBoolConversions*/ false,
10814                                  /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
10815                                  /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
10816     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10817   }
10818 
10819   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
10820       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
10821     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
10822         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
10823       return CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
10824                                          ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
10825 
10826     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10827   }
10828 
10829   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
10830       LHS, RHS, Loc,
10831       IsCompAssign ? ArithConvKind::CompAssign : ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
10832   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
10833     return QualType();
10834 
10835   if (compType.isNull() ||
10836       (!compType->isIntegerType() &&
10837        !(getLangOpts().HLSL && compType->isFloatingType())))
10838     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
10839   DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, false /* IsDiv */);
10840   return compType;
10841 }
10842 
10843 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10844 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10845                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10846   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
10847                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
10848                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
10849     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
10850                             << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
10851 }
10852 
10853 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer)10854 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10855                                             Expr *Pointer) {
10856   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
10857                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
10858                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
10859     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
10860 }
10861 
10862 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a null pointer.
10863 ///
10864 /// If \p IsGNUIdiom is true, the operation is using the 'p = (i8*)nullptr + n'
10865 /// idiom, which we recognize as a GNU extension.
10866 ///
diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer,bool IsGNUIdiom)10867 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10868                                             Expr *Pointer, bool IsGNUIdiom) {
10869   if (IsGNUIdiom)
10870     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_gnu_null_ptr_arith)
10871       << Pointer->getSourceRange();
10872   else
10873     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_pointer_arith_null_ptr)
10874       << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus << Pointer->getSourceRange();
10875 }
10876 
10877 /// Diagnose invalid subraction on a null pointer.
10878 ///
diagnoseSubtractionOnNullPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer,bool BothNull)10879 static void diagnoseSubtractionOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10880                                              Expr *Pointer, bool BothNull) {
10881   // Null - null is valid in C++ [expr.add]p7
10882   if (BothNull && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
10883     return;
10884 
10885   // Is this s a macro from a system header?
10886   if (S.Diags.getSuppressSystemWarnings() && S.SourceMgr.isInSystemMacro(Loc))
10887     return;
10888 
10889   S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, Pointer,
10890                         S.PDiag(diag::warn_pointer_sub_null_ptr)
10891                             << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
10892                             << Pointer->getSourceRange());
10893 }
10894 
10895 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS)10896 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10897                                                     Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
10898   assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
10899   assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
10900   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
10901                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
10902                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
10903     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
10904     // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
10905     << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
10906                                                    RHS->getType())
10907     << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
10908     << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
10909 }
10910 
10911 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer)10912 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10913                                                 Expr *Pointer) {
10914   assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
10915   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
10916                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
10917                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
10918     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
10919     << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
10920     << Pointer->getSourceRange();
10921 }
10922 
10923 /// Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
10924 ///
10925 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Operand)10926 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10927                                                  Expr *Operand) {
10928   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
10929   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
10930     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
10931 
10932   assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType());
10933   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
10934   return S.RequireCompleteSizedType(
10935       Loc, PointeeTy,
10936       diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
10937       Operand->getSourceRange());
10938 }
10939 
10940 /// Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
10941 ///
10942 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
10943 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
10944 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
10945 /// extension.
10946 ///
10947 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Operand)10948 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10949                                             Expr *Operand) {
10950   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
10951   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
10952     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
10953 
10954   if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
10955 
10956   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
10957   if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
10958     diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
10959     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
10960   }
10961   if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
10962     diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
10963     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
10964   }
10965 
10966   if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
10967 
10968   return true;
10969 }
10970 
10971 /// Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
10972 /// operands.
10973 ///
10974 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
10975 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
10976 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
10977 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
10978 ///
10979 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10980 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
10981                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10982   bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
10983   bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
10984   if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
10985 
10986   QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
10987   if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
10988   if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
10989 
10990   // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces
10991   if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) {
10992     if (!LHSPointeeTy.isAddressSpaceOverlapping(RHSPointeeTy,
10993                                                 S.getASTContext())) {
10994       S.Diag(Loc,
10995              diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
10996           << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/
10997           << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
10998       return false;
10999     }
11000   }
11001 
11002   // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
11003   bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
11004   bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
11005   if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
11006     if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
11007     else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
11008     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
11009 
11010     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
11011   }
11012 
11013   bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
11014   bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
11015   if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
11016     if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
11017     else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
11018                                                                 RHSExpr);
11019     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
11020 
11021     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
11022   }
11023 
11024   if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr))
11025     return false;
11026   if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr))
11027     return false;
11028 
11029   return true;
11030 }
11031 
11032 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string
11033 /// literal.
diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)11034 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11035                                   Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
11036   StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
11037   Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr;
11038   if (!StrExpr) {
11039     StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
11040     IndexExpr = LHSExpr;
11041   }
11042 
11043   bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr &&
11044       IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
11045   if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent())
11046     return;
11047 
11048   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
11049   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int)
11050       << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
11051 
11052   // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str".
11053   if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) {
11054     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
11055     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
11056         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&")
11057         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
11058         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
11059   } else
11060     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
11061 }
11062 
11063 /// Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string.
diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)11064 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11065                                    Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
11066   const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr;
11067   const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr =
11068       dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
11069 
11070   if (!CharExpr) {
11071     CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
11072     StringRefExpr = RHSExpr;
11073   }
11074 
11075   if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr)
11076     return;
11077 
11078   const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType();
11079 
11080   // Return if not a PointerType.
11081   if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType())
11082     return;
11083 
11084   // Return if not a CharacterType.
11085   if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType())
11086     return;
11087 
11088   ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext();
11089   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
11090 
11091   const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType();
11092   if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() &&
11093       CharType->isIntegerType() &&
11094       llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) {
11095     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
11096         << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy;
11097   } else {
11098     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
11099         << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType();
11100   }
11101 
11102   // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str.
11103   if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) {
11104     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
11105     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
11106         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&")
11107         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
11108         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
11109   } else {
11110     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
11111   }
11112 }
11113 
11114 /// Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)11115 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11116                                            Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
11117   assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
11118   assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
11119   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
11120     << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
11121     << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
11122 }
11123 
11124 // C99 6.5.6
CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,QualType * CompLHSTy)11125 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11126                                      SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
11127                                      QualType* CompLHSTy) {
11128   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
11129 
11130   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
11131       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
11132     QualType compType =
11133         CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
11134                             /*AllowBothBool*/ getLangOpts().AltiVec,
11135                             /*AllowBoolConversions*/ getLangOpts().ZVector,
11136                             /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
11137                             /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
11138     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
11139     return compType;
11140   }
11141 
11142   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
11143       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
11144     QualType compType = CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
11145                                                     ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
11146     if (CompLHSTy)
11147       *CompLHSTy = compType;
11148     return compType;
11149   }
11150 
11151   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isConstantMatrixType() ||
11152       RHS.get()->getType()->isConstantMatrixType()) {
11153     QualType compType =
11154         CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
11155     if (CompLHSTy)
11156       *CompLHSTy = compType;
11157     return compType;
11158   }
11159 
11160   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
11161       LHS, RHS, Loc,
11162       CompLHSTy ? ArithConvKind::CompAssign : ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
11163   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
11164     return QualType();
11165 
11166   // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal".
11167   if (Opc == BO_Add) {
11168     diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
11169     diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
11170   }
11171 
11172   // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
11173   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
11174     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
11175     return compType;
11176   }
11177 
11178   // Type-checking.  Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp;
11179   // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer.
11180   Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
11181 
11182   bool isObjCPointer;
11183   if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
11184     isObjCPointer = false;
11185   } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
11186     isObjCPointer = true;
11187   } else {
11188     std::swap(PExp, IExp);
11189     if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
11190       isObjCPointer = false;
11191     } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
11192       isObjCPointer = true;
11193     } else {
11194       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11195     }
11196   }
11197   assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
11198 
11199   if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
11200     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11201 
11202   // Adding to a null pointer results in undefined behavior.
11203   if (PExp->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
11204           Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) {
11205     // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined.
11206     Expr::EvalResult KnownVal;
11207     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
11208         (!IExp->isValueDependent() &&
11209          (!IExp->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) ||
11210           KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) {
11211       // Check the conditions to see if this is the 'p = nullptr + n' idiom.
11212       bool IsGNUIdiom = BinaryOperator::isNullPointerArithmeticExtension(
11213           Context, BO_Add, PExp, IExp);
11214       diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, PExp, IsGNUIdiom);
11215     }
11216   }
11217 
11218   if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
11219     return QualType();
11220 
11221   if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp))
11222     return QualType();
11223 
11224   // Arithmetic on label addresses is normally allowed, except when we add
11225   // a ptrauth signature to the addresses.
11226   if (isa<AddrLabelExpr>(PExp) && getLangOpts().PointerAuthIndirectGotos) {
11227     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ptrauth_indirect_goto_addrlabel_arithmetic)
11228         << /*addition*/ 1;
11229     return QualType();
11230   }
11231 
11232   // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
11233   CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
11234 
11235   if (CompLHSTy) {
11236     QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
11237     if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
11238       LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
11239       if (Context.isPromotableIntegerType(LHSTy))
11240         LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
11241     }
11242     *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
11243   }
11244 
11245   return PExp->getType();
11246 }
11247 
11248 // C99 6.5.6
CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,QualType * CompLHSTy)11249 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11250                                         SourceLocation Loc,
11251                                         QualType* CompLHSTy) {
11252   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
11253 
11254   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
11255       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
11256     QualType compType =
11257         CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
11258                             /*AllowBothBool*/ getLangOpts().AltiVec,
11259                             /*AllowBoolConversions*/ getLangOpts().ZVector,
11260                             /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
11261                             /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
11262     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
11263     return compType;
11264   }
11265 
11266   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
11267       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
11268     QualType compType = CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
11269                                                     ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
11270     if (CompLHSTy)
11271       *CompLHSTy = compType;
11272     return compType;
11273   }
11274 
11275   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isConstantMatrixType() ||
11276       RHS.get()->getType()->isConstantMatrixType()) {
11277     QualType compType =
11278         CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
11279     if (CompLHSTy)
11280       *CompLHSTy = compType;
11281     return compType;
11282   }
11283 
11284   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
11285       LHS, RHS, Loc,
11286       CompLHSTy ? ArithConvKind::CompAssign : ArithConvKind::Arithmetic);
11287   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
11288     return QualType();
11289 
11290   // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
11291 
11292   // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
11293   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
11294     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
11295     return compType;
11296   }
11297 
11298   // Either ptr - int   or   ptr - ptr.
11299   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
11300     QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
11301 
11302     // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
11303     if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
11304         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
11305       return QualType();
11306 
11307     // Arithmetic on label addresses is normally allowed, except when we add
11308     // a ptrauth signature to the addresses.
11309     if (isa<AddrLabelExpr>(LHS.get()) &&
11310         getLangOpts().PointerAuthIndirectGotos) {
11311       Diag(Loc, diag::err_ptrauth_indirect_goto_addrlabel_arithmetic)
11312           << /*subtraction*/ 0;
11313       return QualType();
11314     }
11315 
11316     // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
11317     if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
11318       // Subtracting from a null pointer should produce a warning.
11319       // The last argument to the diagnose call says this doesn't match the
11320       // GNU int-to-pointer idiom.
11321       if (LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
11322                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) {
11323         // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined.
11324         Expr::EvalResult KnownVal;
11325         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
11326             (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
11327              (!RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) ||
11328               KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) {
11329           diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), false);
11330         }
11331       }
11332 
11333       if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
11334         return QualType();
11335 
11336       // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
11337       CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr,
11338                        /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true);
11339 
11340       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
11341       return LHS.get()->getType();
11342     }
11343 
11344     // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
11345     if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
11346           = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
11347       QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
11348 
11349       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11350         // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
11351         if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
11352           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
11353         }
11354       } else {
11355         // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
11356         if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
11357                 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
11358                 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
11359           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
11360           return QualType();
11361         }
11362       }
11363 
11364       if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
11365                                                LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
11366         return QualType();
11367 
11368       bool LHSIsNullPtr = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
11369           Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
11370       bool RHSIsNullPtr = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(
11371           Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
11372 
11373       // Subtracting nullptr or from nullptr is suspect
11374       if (LHSIsNullPtr)
11375         diagnoseSubtractionOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHSIsNullPtr);
11376       if (RHSIsNullPtr)
11377         diagnoseSubtractionOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, RHS.get(), LHSIsNullPtr);
11378 
11379       // The pointee type may have zero size.  As an extension, a structure or
11380       // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length.  In this
11381       // case subtraction does not make sense.
11382       if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
11383         CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee);
11384         if (ElementSize.isZero()) {
11385           Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types)
11386             << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType()
11387             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11388         }
11389       }
11390 
11391       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
11392       return Context.getPointerDiffType();
11393     }
11394   }
11395 
11396   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11397 }
11398 
isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T)11399 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
11400   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
11401     return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
11402   return false;
11403 }
11404 
DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,QualType LHSType)11405 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11406                                    SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
11407                                    QualType LHSType) {
11408   // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined),
11409   // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema.
11410   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
11411     return;
11412 
11413   if (Opc == BO_Shr &&
11414       LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->isBooleanType())
11415     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_bool) << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11416 
11417   // Check right/shifter operand
11418   Expr::EvalResult RHSResult;
11419   if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
11420       !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSResult, S.Context))
11421     return;
11422   llvm::APSInt Right = RHSResult.Val.getInt();
11423 
11424   if (Right.isNegative()) {
11425     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
11426                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
11427                               << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
11428     return;
11429   }
11430 
11431   QualType LHSExprType = LHS.get()->getType();
11432   uint64_t LeftSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSExprType);
11433   if (LHSExprType->isBitIntType())
11434     LeftSize = S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSExprType);
11435   else if (LHSExprType->isFixedPointType()) {
11436     auto FXSema = S.Context.getFixedPointSemantics(LHSExprType);
11437     LeftSize = FXSema.getWidth() - (unsigned)FXSema.hasUnsignedPadding();
11438   }
11439   if (Right.uge(LeftSize)) {
11440     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
11441                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
11442                               << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
11443     return;
11444   }
11445 
11446   // FIXME: We probably need to handle fixed point types specially here.
11447   if (Opc != BO_Shl || LHSExprType->isFixedPointType())
11448     return;
11449 
11450   // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
11451   // according to C++ standards prior to C++2a has undefined behavior
11452   // ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned integers have defined behavior modulo one
11453   // more than the maximum value representable in the result type, so never
11454   // warn for those. (FIXME: Unsigned left-shift overflow in a constant
11455   // expression is still probably a bug.)
11456   Expr::EvalResult LHSResult;
11457   if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
11458       LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() ||
11459       !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(LHSResult, S.Context))
11460     return;
11461   llvm::APSInt Left = LHSResult.Val.getInt();
11462 
11463   // Don't warn if signed overflow is defined, then all the rest of the
11464   // diagnostics will not be triggered because the behavior is defined.
11465   // Also don't warn in C++20 mode (and newer), as signed left shifts
11466   // always wrap and never overflow.
11467   if (S.getLangOpts().isSignedOverflowDefined() || S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
11468     return;
11469 
11470   // If LHS does not have a non-negative value then, the
11471   // behavior is undefined before C++2a. Warn about it.
11472   if (Left.isNegative()) {
11473     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(),
11474                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative)
11475                               << LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
11476     return;
11477   }
11478 
11479   llvm::APInt ResultBits =
11480       static_cast<llvm::APInt &>(Right) + Left.getSignificantBits();
11481   if (ResultBits.ule(LeftSize))
11482     return;
11483   llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
11484   Result = Result.shl(Right);
11485 
11486   // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
11487   // hexadecimal number.
11488   SmallString<40> HexResult;
11489   Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
11490 
11491   // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
11492   // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
11493   // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
11494   // turned off separately if needed.
11495   if (ResultBits - 1 == LeftSize) {
11496     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
11497         << HexResult << LHSType
11498         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11499     return;
11500   }
11501 
11502   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
11503       << HexResult.str() << Result.getSignificantBits() << LHSType
11504       << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
11505       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11506 }
11507 
11508 /// Return the resulting type when a vector is shifted
11509 ///        by a scalar or vector shift amount.
checkVectorShift(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)11510 static QualType checkVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11511                                  SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
11512   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector.
11513   if ((S.LangOpts.OpenCL || S.LangOpts.ZVector) &&
11514       !LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
11515     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector)
11516       << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType()
11517       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11518     return QualType();
11519   }
11520 
11521   if (!IsCompAssign) {
11522     LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
11523     if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
11524   }
11525 
11526   RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
11527   if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
11528 
11529   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
11530   // Note that LHS might be a scalar because the routine calls not only in
11531   // OpenCL case.
11532   const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
11533   QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy ? LHSVecTy->getElementType() : LHSType;
11534 
11535   // Note that RHS might not be a vector.
11536   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
11537   const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
11538   QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType;
11539 
11540   // Do not allow shifts for boolean vectors.
11541   if ((LHSVecTy && LHSVecTy->isExtVectorBoolType()) ||
11542       (RHSVecTy && RHSVecTy->isExtVectorBoolType())) {
11543     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
11544         << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
11545         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11546     return QualType();
11547   }
11548 
11549   // The operands need to be integers.
11550   if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
11551     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
11552       << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11553     return QualType();
11554   }
11555 
11556   if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
11557     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
11558       << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11559     return QualType();
11560   }
11561 
11562   if (!LHSVecTy) {
11563     assert(RHSVecTy);
11564     if (IsCompAssign)
11565       return RHSType;
11566     if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) {
11567       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(),RHSEleType, CK_IntegralCast);
11568       LHSEleType = RHSEleType;
11569     }
11570     QualType VecTy =
11571         S.Context.getExtVectorType(LHSEleType, RHSVecTy->getNumElements());
11572     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
11573     LHSType = VecTy;
11574   } else if (RHSVecTy) {
11575     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators
11576     // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure
11577     // that the number of elements is the same as LHS...
11578     if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) {
11579       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
11580         << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
11581         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11582       return QualType();
11583     }
11584     if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL && !S.LangOpts.ZVector) {
11585       const BuiltinType *LHSBT = LHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>();
11586       const BuiltinType *RHSBT = RHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>();
11587       if (LHSBT != RHSBT &&
11588           S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBT) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBT)) {
11589         S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_vector_element_sizes_not_equal)
11590             << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
11591             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11592       }
11593     }
11594   } else {
11595     // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS.
11596     QualType VecTy =
11597       S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements());
11598     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
11599   }
11600 
11601   return LHSType;
11602 }
11603 
checkSizelessVectorShift(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)11604 static QualType checkSizelessVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
11605                                          ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
11606                                          bool IsCompAssign) {
11607   if (!IsCompAssign) {
11608     LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
11609     if (LHS.isInvalid())
11610       return QualType();
11611   }
11612 
11613   RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
11614   if (RHS.isInvalid())
11615     return QualType();
11616 
11617   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
11618   const BuiltinType *LHSBuiltinTy = LHSType->castAs<BuiltinType>();
11619   QualType LHSEleType = LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()
11620                             ? LHSBuiltinTy->getSveEltType(S.getASTContext())
11621                             : LHSType;
11622 
11623   // Note that RHS might not be a vector
11624   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
11625   const BuiltinType *RHSBuiltinTy = RHSType->castAs<BuiltinType>();
11626   QualType RHSEleType = RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()
11627                             ? RHSBuiltinTy->getSveEltType(S.getASTContext())
11628                             : RHSType;
11629 
11630   if ((LHSBuiltinTy && LHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool()) ||
11631       (RHSBuiltinTy && RHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool())) {
11632     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
11633         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11634     return QualType();
11635   }
11636 
11637   if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
11638     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
11639         << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11640     return QualType();
11641   }
11642 
11643   if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
11644     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
11645         << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11646     return QualType();
11647   }
11648 
11649   if (LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() && RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType() &&
11650       (S.Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(LHSBuiltinTy).EC !=
11651        S.Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(RHSBuiltinTy).EC)) {
11652     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
11653         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
11654         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11655     return QualType();
11656   }
11657 
11658   if (!LHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
11659     assert(RHSType->isSveVLSBuiltinType());
11660     if (IsCompAssign)
11661       return RHSType;
11662     if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) {
11663       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSEleType, clang::CK_IntegralCast);
11664       LHSEleType = RHSEleType;
11665     }
11666     const llvm::ElementCount VecSize =
11667         S.Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(RHSBuiltinTy).EC;
11668     QualType VecTy =
11669         S.Context.getScalableVectorType(LHSEleType, VecSize.getKnownMinValue());
11670     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, clang::CK_VectorSplat);
11671     LHSType = VecTy;
11672   } else if (RHSBuiltinTy && RHSBuiltinTy->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
11673     if (S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBuiltinTy) !=
11674         S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBuiltinTy)) {
11675       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
11676           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
11677           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11678       return QualType();
11679     }
11680   } else {
11681     const llvm::ElementCount VecSize =
11682         S.Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(LHSBuiltinTy).EC;
11683     if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) {
11684       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSEleType, clang::CK_IntegralCast);
11685       RHSEleType = LHSEleType;
11686     }
11687     QualType VecTy =
11688         S.Context.getScalableVectorType(RHSEleType, VecSize.getKnownMinValue());
11689     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
11690   }
11691 
11692   return LHSType;
11693 }
11694 
11695 // C99 6.5.7
CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,bool IsCompAssign)11696 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11697                                   SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
11698                                   bool IsCompAssign) {
11699   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
11700 
11701   // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
11702   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
11703       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
11704     if (LangOpts.ZVector) {
11705       // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically
11706       // like general shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is
11707       // allowed to be a "vector bool".
11708       if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
11709         if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool)
11710           return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11711       if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
11712         if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::AltiVecBool)
11713           return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11714     }
11715     return checkVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
11716   }
11717 
11718   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
11719       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType())
11720     return checkSizelessVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
11721 
11722   // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
11723   // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
11724 
11725   // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
11726   // if this is a compound assignment.
11727   ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
11728   LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
11729   if (LHS.isInvalid())
11730     return QualType();
11731   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
11732   if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
11733 
11734   // The RHS is simpler.
11735   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
11736   if (RHS.isInvalid())
11737     return QualType();
11738   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
11739 
11740   // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
11741   // Embedded-C 4.1.6.2.2: The LHS may also be fixed-point.
11742   if ((!LHSType->isFixedPointOrIntegerType() &&
11743        !LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) ||
11744       !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
11745     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11746 
11747   // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
11748   // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
11749   if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) ||
11750       isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) {
11751     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11752   }
11753   DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
11754 
11755   // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
11756   return LHSType;
11757 }
11758 
11759 /// Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,bool IsError)11760 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11761                                               ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11762                                               bool IsError) {
11763   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
11764                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
11765     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
11766     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11767 }
11768 
11769 /// Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
11770 /// true otherwise.
convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)11771 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11772                                            ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
11773   // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
11774   //   [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
11775   //   conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
11776   //   a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
11777   //   them to their composite pointer type. [...]
11778   //
11779   // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
11780   // comparisons of pointers.
11781 
11782   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
11783   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
11784   assert(LHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isPointerType() ||
11785          LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType());
11786 
11787   QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11788   if (T.isNull()) {
11789     if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isMemberPointerType()) &&
11790         (RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType()))
11791       diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
11792     else
11793       S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
11794     return true;
11795   }
11796 
11797   return false;
11798 }
11799 
diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,bool IsError)11800 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11801                                                     ExprResult &LHS,
11802                                                     ExprResult &RHS,
11803                                                     bool IsError) {
11804   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
11805                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
11806     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
11807     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
11808 }
11809 
isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult & E)11810 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) {
11811   switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) {
11812   case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
11813   case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
11814   case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
11815   case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass:
11816     return true;
11817   default:
11818     // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal!
11819     return false;
11820   }
11821 }
11822 
hasIsEqualMethod(Sema & S,const Expr * LHS,const Expr * RHS)11823 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) {
11824   const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type =
11825     LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11826 
11827   // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out.
11828   if (!Type)
11829     return false;
11830 
11831   // Get the LHS object's interface type.
11832   QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType();
11833 
11834   // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out.
11835   if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
11836     return false;
11837 
11838   // Try to find the -isEqual: method.
11839   Selector IsEqualSel = S.ObjC().NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector();
11840   ObjCMethodDecl *Method =
11841       S.ObjC().LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, InterfaceType,
11842                                         /*IsInstance=*/true);
11843   if (!Method) {
11844     if (Type->isObjCIdType()) {
11845       // For 'id', just check the global pool.
11846       Method =
11847           S.ObjC().LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(),
11848                                                     /*receiverId=*/true);
11849     } else {
11850       // Check protocols.
11851       Method = S.ObjC().LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type,
11852                                                     /*IsInstance=*/true);
11853     }
11854   }
11855 
11856   if (!Method)
11857     return false;
11858 
11859   QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType();
11860   if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType())
11861     return false;
11862 
11863   QualType R = Method->getReturnType();
11864   if (!R->isScalarType())
11865     return false;
11866 
11867   return true;
11868 }
11869 
diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc)11870 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11871                                           ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
11872                                           BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){
11873   Expr *Literal;
11874   Expr *Other;
11875   if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) {
11876     Literal = LHS.get();
11877     Other = RHS.get();
11878   } else {
11879     Literal = RHS.get();
11880     Other = LHS.get();
11881   }
11882 
11883   // Don't warn on comparisons against nil.
11884   Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts();
11885   if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(),
11886                                    Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
11887     return;
11888 
11889   // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison.
11890   // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own
11891   // warning flag.
11892   SemaObjC::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.ObjC().CheckLiteralKind(Literal);
11893   assert(LiteralKind != SemaObjC::LK_Block);
11894   if (LiteralKind == SemaObjC::LK_None) {
11895     llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind");
11896   }
11897 
11898   if (LiteralKind == SemaObjC::LK_String)
11899     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison)
11900       << Literal->getSourceRange();
11901   else
11902     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison)
11903       << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange();
11904 
11905   if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
11906       hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) {
11907     SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc();
11908     SourceLocation End = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc());
11909     CharSourceRange OpRange =
11910       CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
11911 
11912     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal)
11913       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![")
11914       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:")
11915       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]");
11916   }
11917 }
11918 
11919 /// Warns on !x < y, !x & y where !(x < y), !(x & y) was probably intended.
diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)11920 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
11921                                            ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
11922                                            BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
11923   // Check that left hand side is !something.
11924   UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts());
11925   if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return;
11926 
11927   // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type.
11928   if (RHS.get()->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return;
11929 
11930   // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool.
11931   Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
11932   if (SubExpr->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return;
11933 
11934   // Emit warning.
11935   bool IsBitwiseOp = Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor;
11936   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_check)
11937       << Loc << IsBitwiseOp;
11938 
11939   // First note suggest !(x < y)
11940   SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getBeginLoc();
11941   SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getEndLoc();
11942   FirstClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose);
11943   if (FirstClose.isInvalid())
11944     FirstOpen = SourceLocation();
11945   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix)
11946       << IsBitwiseOp
11947       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(")
11948       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")");
11949 
11950   // Second note suggests (!x) < y
11951   SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc();
11952   SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getEndLoc();
11953   SecondClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose);
11954   if (SecondClose.isInvalid())
11955     SecondOpen = SourceLocation();
11956   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens)
11957       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(")
11958       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")");
11959 }
11960 
11961 // Returns true if E refers to a non-weak array.
checkForArray(const Expr * E)11962 static bool checkForArray(const Expr *E) {
11963   const ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
11964   if (const DeclRefExpr *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
11965     D = DR->getDecl();
11966   } else if (const MemberExpr *Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
11967     if (Mem->isImplicitAccess())
11968       D = Mem->getMemberDecl();
11969   }
11970   if (!D)
11971     return false;
11972   return D->getType()->isArrayType() && !D->isWeak();
11973 }
11974 
11975 /// Detect patterns ptr + size >= ptr and ptr + size < ptr, where ptr is a
11976 /// pointer and size is an unsigned integer. Return whether the result is
11977 /// always true/false.
isTautologicalBoundsCheck(Sema & S,const Expr * LHS,const Expr * RHS,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)11978 static std::optional<bool> isTautologicalBoundsCheck(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS,
11979                                                      const Expr *RHS,
11980                                                      BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
11981   if (!LHS->getType()->isPointerType() ||
11982       S.getLangOpts().PointerOverflowDefined)
11983     return std::nullopt;
11984 
11985   // Canonicalize to >= or < predicate.
11986   switch (Opc) {
11987   case BO_GE:
11988   case BO_LT:
11989     break;
11990   case BO_GT:
11991     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
11992     Opc = BO_LT;
11993     break;
11994   case BO_LE:
11995     std::swap(LHS, RHS);
11996     Opc = BO_GE;
11997     break;
11998   default:
11999     return std::nullopt;
12000   }
12001 
12002   auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS);
12003   if (!BO || BO->getOpcode() != BO_Add)
12004     return std::nullopt;
12005 
12006   Expr *Other;
12007   if (Expr::isSameComparisonOperand(BO->getLHS(), RHS))
12008     Other = BO->getRHS();
12009   else if (Expr::isSameComparisonOperand(BO->getRHS(), RHS))
12010     Other = BO->getLHS();
12011   else
12012     return std::nullopt;
12013 
12014   if (!Other->getType()->isUnsignedIntegerType())
12015     return std::nullopt;
12016 
12017   return Opc == BO_GE;
12018 }
12019 
12020 /// Diagnose some forms of syntactically-obvious tautological comparison.
diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)12021 static void diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
12022                                            Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
12023                                            BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
12024   Expr *LHSStripped = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
12025   Expr *RHSStripped = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
12026 
12027   QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
12028   QualType RHSType = RHS->getType();
12029   if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() ||
12030       (LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && !BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) ||
12031       S.inTemplateInstantiation())
12032     return;
12033 
12034   // WebAssembly Tables cannot be compared, therefore shouldn't emit
12035   // Tautological diagnostics.
12036   if (LHSType->isWebAssemblyTableType() || RHSType->isWebAssemblyTableType())
12037     return;
12038 
12039   // Comparisons between two array types are ill-formed for operator<=>, so
12040   // we shouldn't emit any additional warnings about it.
12041   if (Opc == BO_Cmp && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType())
12042     return;
12043 
12044   // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
12045   // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
12046   // often indicate logic errors in the program.
12047   //
12048   // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
12049   // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
12050   // comparisons within a template instantiation. The warnings should catch
12051   // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
12052   // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
12053   // result.
12054 
12055   // Used for indexing into %select in warn_comparison_always
12056   enum {
12057     AlwaysConstant,
12058     AlwaysTrue,
12059     AlwaysFalse,
12060     AlwaysEqual, // std::strong_ordering::equal from operator<=>
12061   };
12062 
12063   // C++1a [array.comp]:
12064   //   Equality and relational comparisons ([expr.eq], [expr.rel]) between two
12065   //   operands of array type.
12066   // C++2a [depr.array.comp]:
12067   //   Equality and relational comparisons ([expr.eq], [expr.rel]) between two
12068   //   operands of array type are deprecated.
12069   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSStripped->getType()->isArrayType() &&
12070       RHSStripped->getType()->isArrayType()) {
12071     auto IsDeprArrayComparionIgnored =
12072         S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_depr_array_comparison, Loc);
12073     auto DiagID = S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus26
12074                       ? diag::warn_array_comparison_cxx26
12075                   : !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || IsDeprArrayComparionIgnored
12076                       ? diag::warn_array_comparison
12077                       : diag::warn_depr_array_comparison;
12078     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange()
12079                         << LHSStripped->getType() << RHSStripped->getType();
12080     // Carry on to produce the tautological comparison warning, if this
12081     // expression is potentially-evaluated, we can resolve the array to a
12082     // non-weak declaration, and so on.
12083   }
12084 
12085   if (!LHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() && !RHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
12086     if (Expr::isSameComparisonOperand(LHS, RHS)) {
12087       unsigned Result;
12088       switch (Opc) {
12089       case BO_EQ:
12090       case BO_LE:
12091       case BO_GE:
12092         Result = AlwaysTrue;
12093         break;
12094       case BO_NE:
12095       case BO_LT:
12096       case BO_GT:
12097         Result = AlwaysFalse;
12098         break;
12099       case BO_Cmp:
12100         Result = AlwaysEqual;
12101         break;
12102       default:
12103         Result = AlwaysConstant;
12104         break;
12105       }
12106       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
12107                             S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
12108                                 << 0 /*self-comparison*/
12109                                 << Result);
12110     } else if (checkForArray(LHSStripped) && checkForArray(RHSStripped)) {
12111       // What is it always going to evaluate to?
12112       unsigned Result;
12113       switch (Opc) {
12114       case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
12115         Result = AlwaysFalse;
12116         break;
12117       case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
12118         Result = AlwaysTrue;
12119         break;
12120       default: // e.g. array1 <= array2
12121         // The best we can say is 'a constant'
12122         Result = AlwaysConstant;
12123         break;
12124       }
12125       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
12126                             S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
12127                                 << 1 /*array comparison*/
12128                                 << Result);
12129     } else if (std::optional<bool> Res =
12130                    isTautologicalBoundsCheck(S, LHS, RHS, Opc)) {
12131       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
12132                             S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
12133                                 << 2 /*pointer comparison*/
12134                                 << (*Res ? AlwaysTrue : AlwaysFalse));
12135     }
12136   }
12137 
12138   if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
12139     LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
12140   if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
12141     RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
12142 
12143   // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
12144   // operand is null); the user probably wants string comparison function.
12145   Expr *LiteralString = nullptr;
12146   Expr *LiteralStringStripped = nullptr;
12147   if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
12148       !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
12149                                           Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
12150     LiteralString = LHS;
12151     LiteralStringStripped = LHSStripped;
12152   } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
12153               isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
12154              !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
12155                                           Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
12156     LiteralString = RHS;
12157     LiteralStringStripped = RHSStripped;
12158   }
12159 
12160   if (LiteralString) {
12161     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
12162                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
12163                               << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LiteralStringStripped)
12164                               << LiteralString->getSourceRange());
12165   }
12166 }
12167 
castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK)12168 static ImplicitConversionKind castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK) {
12169   switch (CK) {
12170   default: {
12171 #ifndef NDEBUG
12172     llvm::errs() << "unhandled cast kind: " << CastExpr::getCastKindName(CK)
12173                  << "\n";
12174 #endif
12175     llvm_unreachable("unhandled cast kind");
12176   }
12177   case CK_UserDefinedConversion:
12178     return ICK_Identity;
12179   case CK_LValueToRValue:
12180     return ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
12181   case CK_ArrayToPointerDecay:
12182     return ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
12183   case CK_FunctionToPointerDecay:
12184     return ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
12185   case CK_IntegralCast:
12186     return ICK_Integral_Conversion;
12187   case CK_FloatingCast:
12188     return ICK_Floating_Conversion;
12189   case CK_IntegralToFloating:
12190   case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
12191     return ICK_Floating_Integral;
12192   case CK_IntegralComplexCast:
12193   case CK_FloatingComplexCast:
12194   case CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex:
12195   case CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex:
12196     return ICK_Complex_Conversion;
12197   case CK_FloatingComplexToReal:
12198   case CK_FloatingRealToComplex:
12199   case CK_IntegralComplexToReal:
12200   case CK_IntegralRealToComplex:
12201     return ICK_Complex_Real;
12202   case CK_HLSLArrayRValue:
12203     return ICK_HLSL_Array_RValue;
12204   }
12205 }
12206 
checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema & S,QualType ToType,Expr * E,QualType FromType,SourceLocation Loc)12207 static bool checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema &S, QualType ToType, Expr *E,
12208                                              QualType FromType,
12209                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
12210   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
12211   StandardConversionSequence SCS;
12212   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
12213   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
12214   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
12215   if (const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
12216     SCS.Second = castKindToImplicitConversionKind(ICE->getCastKind());
12217 
12218   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
12219   QualType PreNarrowingType;
12220   switch (SCS.getNarrowingKind(S.Context, E, PreNarrowingValue,
12221                                PreNarrowingType,
12222                                /*IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion*/ true)) {
12223   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
12224     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
12225     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
12226   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
12227     return false;
12228 
12229   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
12230     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
12231     // expression.
12232     S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing)
12233         << /*Constant*/ 1
12234         << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << ToType;
12235     return true;
12236 
12237   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
12238     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
12239     // expression.
12240   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
12241     S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing)
12242         << /*Constant*/ 0 << FromType << ToType;
12243     // TODO: It's not a constant expression, but what if the user intended it
12244     // to be? Can we produce notes to help them figure out why it isn't?
12245     return true;
12246   }
12247   llvm_unreachable("unhandled case in switch");
12248 }
12249 
checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)12250 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema &S,
12251                                                          ExprResult &LHS,
12252                                                          ExprResult &RHS,
12253                                                          SourceLocation Loc) {
12254   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
12255   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
12256   // Dig out the original argument type and expression before implicit casts
12257   // were applied. These are the types/expressions we need to check the
12258   // [expr.spaceship] requirements against.
12259   ExprResult LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
12260   ExprResult RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
12261   QualType LHSStrippedType = LHSStripped.get()->getType();
12262   QualType RHSStrippedType = RHSStripped.get()->getType();
12263 
12264   // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p3: If one of the operands is of type bool and the
12265   // other is not, the program is ill-formed.
12266   if (LHSStrippedType->isBooleanType() != RHSStrippedType->isBooleanType()) {
12267     S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped);
12268     return QualType();
12269   }
12270 
12271   // FIXME: Consider combining this with checkEnumArithmeticConversions.
12272   int NumEnumArgs = (int)LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType() +
12273                     RHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType();
12274   if (NumEnumArgs == 1) {
12275     bool LHSIsEnum = LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType();
12276     QualType OtherTy = LHSIsEnum ? RHSStrippedType : LHSStrippedType;
12277     if (OtherTy->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
12278       S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped);
12279       return QualType();
12280     }
12281   }
12282   if (NumEnumArgs == 2) {
12283     // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p5: If both operands have the same enumeration
12284     // type E, the operator yields the result of converting the operands
12285     // to the underlying type of E and applying <=> to the converted operands.
12286     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) {
12287       S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12288       return QualType();
12289     }
12290     QualType IntType =
12291         LHSStrippedType->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
12292     assert(IntType->isArithmeticType());
12293 
12294     // We can't use `CK_IntegralCast` when the underlying type is 'bool', so we
12295     // promote the boolean type, and all other promotable integer types, to
12296     // avoid this.
12297     if (S.Context.isPromotableIntegerType(IntType))
12298       IntType = S.Context.getPromotedIntegerType(IntType);
12299 
12300     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast);
12301     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast);
12302     LHSType = RHSType = IntType;
12303   }
12304 
12305   // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p4: If both operands have arithmetic types, the
12306   // usual arithmetic conversions are applied to the operands.
12307   QualType Type =
12308       S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, Loc, ArithConvKind::Comparison);
12309   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
12310     return QualType();
12311   if (Type.isNull())
12312     return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12313 
12314   std::optional<ComparisonCategoryType> CCT =
12315       getComparisonCategoryForBuiltinCmp(Type);
12316   if (!CCT)
12317     return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12318 
12319   bool HasNarrowing = checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(
12320       S, Type, LHS.get(), LHSType, LHS.get()->getBeginLoc());
12321   HasNarrowing |= checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(S, Type, RHS.get(), RHSType,
12322                                                    RHS.get()->getBeginLoc());
12323   if (HasNarrowing)
12324     return QualType();
12325 
12326   assert(!Type.isNull() && "composite type for <=> has not been set");
12327 
12328   return S.CheckComparisonCategoryType(
12329       *CCT, Loc, Sema::ComparisonCategoryUsage::OperatorInExpression);
12330 }
12331 
checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)12332 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
12333                                                  ExprResult &RHS,
12334                                                  SourceLocation Loc,
12335                                                  BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
12336   if (Opc == BO_Cmp)
12337     return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
12338 
12339   // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
12340   QualType Type =
12341       S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, Loc, ArithConvKind::Comparison);
12342   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
12343     return QualType();
12344   if (Type.isNull())
12345     return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12346   assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType());
12347 
12348   if (Type->isAnyComplexType() && BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc))
12349     return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12350 
12351   // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
12352   if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation())
12353     S.CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
12354 
12355   // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
12356   return S.Context.getLogicalOperationType();
12357 }
12358 
CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult & E,ExprResult & NullE)12359 void Sema::CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult &E, ExprResult &NullE) {
12360   if (!NullE.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
12361     return;
12362   int NullValue = PP.isMacroDefined("NULL") ? 0 : 1;
12363   if (!E.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
12364       E.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
12365                                      Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
12366         Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
12367     if (const auto *CL = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(E.get())) {
12368       if (CL->getValue() == 0)
12369         Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare)
12370             << NullValue
12371             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(),
12372                                             NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0");
12373     } else if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CStyleCastExpr>(E.get())) {
12374         TypeSourceInfo *TI = CE->getTypeInfoAsWritten();
12375         QualType T = Context.getCanonicalType(TI->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
12376         if (T == Context.CharTy)
12377           Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare)
12378               << NullValue
12379               << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(),
12380                                               NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0");
12381       }
12382   }
12383 }
12384 
12385 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)12386 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
12387                                     SourceLocation Loc,
12388                                     BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
12389   bool IsRelational = BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc);
12390   bool IsThreeWay = Opc == BO_Cmp;
12391   bool IsOrdered = IsRelational || IsThreeWay;
12392   auto IsAnyPointerType = [](ExprResult E) {
12393     QualType Ty = E.get()->getType();
12394     return Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType();
12395   };
12396 
12397   // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p6: If at least one of the operands is of pointer
12398   // type, array-to-pointer, ..., conversions are performed on both operands to
12399   // bring them to their composite type.
12400   // Otherwise, all comparisons expect an rvalue, so convert to rvalue before
12401   // any type-related checks.
12402   if (!IsThreeWay || IsAnyPointerType(LHS) || IsAnyPointerType(RHS)) {
12403     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
12404     if (LHS.isInvalid())
12405       return QualType();
12406     RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
12407     if (RHS.isInvalid())
12408       return QualType();
12409   } else {
12410     LHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
12411     if (LHS.isInvalid())
12412       return QualType();
12413     RHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
12414     if (RHS.isInvalid())
12415       return QualType();
12416   }
12417 
12418   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/true);
12419   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) {
12420     CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(LHS, RHS);
12421     CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(RHS, LHS);
12422   }
12423 
12424   // Handle vector comparisons separately.
12425   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
12426       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
12427     return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
12428 
12429   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
12430       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType())
12431     return CheckSizelessVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
12432 
12433   diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
12434   diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
12435 
12436   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
12437   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
12438   if ((LHSType->isArithmeticType() || LHSType->isEnumeralType()) &&
12439       (RHSType->isArithmeticType() || RHSType->isEnumeralType()))
12440     return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
12441 
12442   if ((LHSType->isPointerType() &&
12443        LHSType->getPointeeType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) ||
12444       (RHSType->isPointerType() &&
12445        RHSType->getPointeeType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType()))
12446     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12447 
12448   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind =
12449       LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
12450   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind =
12451       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
12452   bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
12453   bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
12454 
12455   auto computeResultTy = [&]() {
12456     if (Opc != BO_Cmp)
12457       return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
12458     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus);
12459     assert(Context.hasSameType(LHS.get()->getType(), RHS.get()->getType()));
12460 
12461     QualType CompositeTy = LHS.get()->getType();
12462     assert(!CompositeTy->isReferenceType());
12463 
12464     std::optional<ComparisonCategoryType> CCT =
12465         getComparisonCategoryForBuiltinCmp(CompositeTy);
12466     if (!CCT)
12467       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12468 
12469     if (CompositeTy->isPointerType() && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
12470       // P0946R0: Comparisons between a null pointer constant and an object
12471       // pointer result in std::strong_equality, which is ill-formed under
12472       // P1959R0.
12473       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_three_way_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero)
12474           << (LHSIsNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12475                         : RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
12476       return QualType();
12477     }
12478 
12479     return CheckComparisonCategoryType(
12480         *CCT, Loc, ComparisonCategoryUsage::OperatorInExpression);
12481   };
12482 
12483   if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
12484     bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ;
12485     if (RHSIsNull)
12486       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality,
12487                                    RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
12488     else
12489       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality,
12490                                    LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
12491   }
12492 
12493   if (IsOrdered && LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() &&
12494       RHSType->isFunctionPointerType()) {
12495     // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
12496     bool IsError = Opc == BO_Cmp;
12497     auto DiagID =
12498         IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers
12499         : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
12500             ? diag::warn_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers
12501             : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers;
12502     Diag(Loc, DiagID) << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12503                       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
12504     if (IsError)
12505       return QualType();
12506   }
12507 
12508   if ((LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSIsNull) ||
12509       (RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSIsNull)) {
12510     // Skip normal pointer conversion checks in this case; we have better
12511     // diagnostics for this below.
12512   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12513     // Equality comparison of a function pointer to a void pointer is invalid,
12514     // but we allow it as an extension.
12515     // FIXME: If we really want to allow this, should it be part of composite
12516     // pointer type computation so it works in conditionals too?
12517     if (!IsOrdered &&
12518         ((LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) ||
12519          (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isVoidPointerType()))) {
12520       // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
12521       // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
12522       // conformance with the C++ standard.
12523       diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
12524           *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext());
12525 
12526       if (isSFINAEContext())
12527         return QualType();
12528 
12529       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
12530       return computeResultTy();
12531     }
12532 
12533     // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
12534     //   If at least one operand is a pointer [...] bring them to their
12535     //   composite pointer type.
12536     // C++ [expr.spaceship]p6
12537     //  If at least one of the operands is of pointer type, [...] bring them
12538     //  to their composite pointer type.
12539     // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
12540     //   If both operands are pointers, [...] bring them to their composite
12541     //   pointer type.
12542     // For <=>, the only valid non-pointer types are arrays and functions, and
12543     // we already decayed those, so this is really the same as the relational
12544     // comparison rule.
12545     if ((int)LHSType->isPointerType() + (int)RHSType->isPointerType() >=
12546             (IsOrdered ? 2 : 1) &&
12547         (!LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount || !(LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
12548                                          RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) {
12549       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
12550         return QualType();
12551       return computeResultTy();
12552     }
12553   } else if (LHSType->isPointerType() &&
12554              RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
12555     // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
12556     // when handling null pointer constants.
12557     QualType LCanPointeeTy =
12558       LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
12559     QualType RCanPointeeTy =
12560       RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
12561 
12562     // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
12563     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
12564                                    RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
12565       if (IsRelational) {
12566         // Pointers both need to point to complete or incomplete types
12567         if ((LCanPointeeTy->isIncompleteType() !=
12568              RCanPointeeTy->isIncompleteType()) &&
12569             !getLangOpts().C11) {
12570           Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_compare_complete_incomplete_pointers)
12571               << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12572               << LHSType << RHSType << LCanPointeeTy->isIncompleteType()
12573               << RCanPointeeTy->isIncompleteType();
12574         }
12575       }
12576     } else if (!IsRelational &&
12577                (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
12578       // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
12579       if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
12580           && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
12581         diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
12582                                                 /*isError*/false);
12583     } else {
12584       // Invalid
12585       diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
12586     }
12587     if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
12588       // Treat NULL constant as a special case in OpenCL.
12589       if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
12590         if (!LCanPointeeTy.isAddressSpaceOverlapping(RCanPointeeTy,
12591                                                      getASTContext())) {
12592           Diag(Loc,
12593                diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
12594               << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */
12595               << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
12596         }
12597       }
12598       LangAS AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
12599       LangAS AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
12600       CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion
12601                                                : CK_BitCast;
12602 
12603       const FunctionType *LFn = LCanPointeeTy->getAs<FunctionType>();
12604       const FunctionType *RFn = RCanPointeeTy->getAs<FunctionType>();
12605       bool LHSHasCFIUncheckedCallee = LFn && LFn->getCFIUncheckedCalleeAttr();
12606       bool RHSHasCFIUncheckedCallee = RFn && RFn->getCFIUncheckedCalleeAttr();
12607       bool ChangingCFIUncheckedCallee =
12608           LHSHasCFIUncheckedCallee != RHSHasCFIUncheckedCallee;
12609 
12610       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
12611         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind);
12612       else if (!ChangingCFIUncheckedCallee)
12613         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind);
12614     }
12615     return computeResultTy();
12616   }
12617 
12618 
12619   // C++ [expr.eq]p4:
12620   //   Two operands of type std::nullptr_t or one operand of type
12621   //   std::nullptr_t and the other a null pointer constant compare
12622   //   equal.
12623   // C23 6.5.9p5:
12624   //   If both operands have type nullptr_t or one operand has type nullptr_t
12625   //   and the other is a null pointer constant, they compare equal if the
12626   //   former is a null pointer.
12627   if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull && RHSIsNull) {
12628     if (LHSType->isNullPtrType()) {
12629       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12630       return computeResultTy();
12631     }
12632     if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) {
12633       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12634       return computeResultTy();
12635     }
12636   }
12637 
12638   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsOrdered && (LHSIsNull || RHSIsNull)) {
12639     // C23 6.5.9p6:
12640     //   Otherwise, at least one operand is a pointer. If one is a pointer and
12641     //   the other is a null pointer constant or has type nullptr_t, they
12642     //   compare equal
12643     if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isPointerType()) {
12644       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12645       return computeResultTy();
12646     }
12647     if (RHSIsNull && LHSType->isPointerType()) {
12648       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12649       return computeResultTy();
12650     }
12651   }
12652 
12653   // Comparison of Objective-C pointers and block pointers against nullptr_t.
12654   // These aren't covered by the composite pointer type rules.
12655   if (!IsOrdered && RHSType->isNullPtrType() &&
12656       (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())) {
12657     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12658     return computeResultTy();
12659   }
12660   if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isNullPtrType() &&
12661       (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())) {
12662     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12663     return computeResultTy();
12664   }
12665 
12666   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12667     if (IsRelational &&
12668         ((LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
12669          (RHSType->isNullPtrType() && LHSType->isPointerType()))) {
12670       // HACK: Relational comparison of nullptr_t against a pointer type is
12671       // invalid per DR583, but we allow it within std::less<> and friends,
12672       // since otherwise common uses of it break.
12673       // FIXME: Consider removing this hack once LWG fixes std::less<> and
12674       // friends to have std::nullptr_t overload candidates.
12675       DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
12676       if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC))
12677         DC = DC->getParent();
12678       if (auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) {
12679         if (CTSD->isInStdNamespace() &&
12680             llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(CTSD->getName())
12681                 .Cases("less", "less_equal", "greater", "greater_equal", true)
12682                 .Default(false)) {
12683           if (RHSType->isNullPtrType())
12684             RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12685           else
12686             LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12687           return computeResultTy();
12688         }
12689       }
12690     }
12691 
12692     // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
12693     //   If at least one operand is a pointer to member, [...] bring them to
12694     //   their composite pointer type.
12695     if (!IsOrdered &&
12696         (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) {
12697       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
12698         return QualType();
12699       else
12700         return computeResultTy();
12701     }
12702   }
12703 
12704   // Handle block pointer types.
12705   if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
12706       RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
12707     QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
12708     QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
12709 
12710     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
12711         !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
12712       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
12713         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12714         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
12715     }
12716     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
12717     return computeResultTy();
12718   }
12719 
12720   // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
12721   if (!IsOrdered
12722       && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
12723           || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
12724     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
12725       if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
12726              ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
12727             || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
12728                 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
12729         Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
12730           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12731           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
12732     }
12733     if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
12734       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
12735                               RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
12736                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
12737     else
12738       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
12739                               LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
12740                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
12741     return computeResultTy();
12742   }
12743 
12744   if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
12745       RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
12746     const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
12747     const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
12748     if (LPT || RPT) {
12749       bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
12750       bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
12751 
12752       if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
12753           !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
12754         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
12755                                           /*isError*/false);
12756       }
12757       // FIXME: If LPtrToVoid, we should presumably convert the LHS rather than
12758       // the RHS, but we have test coverage for this behavior.
12759       // FIXME: Consider using convertPointersToCompositeType in C++.
12760       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
12761         Expr *E = LHS.get();
12762         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
12763           ObjC().CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E,
12764                                      CheckedConversionKind::Implicit);
12765         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType,
12766                                 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
12767       }
12768       else {
12769         Expr *E = RHS.get();
12770         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
12771           ObjC().CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E,
12772                                      CheckedConversionKind::Implicit,
12773                                      /*Diagnose=*/true,
12774                                      /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, Opc);
12775         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType,
12776                                 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
12777       }
12778       return computeResultTy();
12779     }
12780     if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
12781         RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
12782       if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
12783         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
12784                                           /*isError*/false);
12785       if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS))
12786         diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc);
12787 
12788       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
12789         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
12790       else
12791         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
12792       return computeResultTy();
12793     }
12794 
12795     if (!IsOrdered && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
12796         RHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) {
12797       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
12798                               CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast);
12799       return computeResultTy();
12800     } else if (!IsOrdered &&
12801                LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context) &&
12802                RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
12803       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
12804                               CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast);
12805       return computeResultTy();
12806     }
12807   }
12808   if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
12809       (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
12810     unsigned DiagID = 0;
12811     bool isError = false;
12812     if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) {
12813       // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers,
12814       // since users tend to want to compare addresses.
12815     } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
12816                (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
12817       if (IsOrdered) {
12818         isError = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
12819         DiagID =
12820           isError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero
12821                   : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
12822       }
12823     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12824       DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
12825       isError = true;
12826     } else if (IsOrdered)
12827       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
12828     else
12829       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
12830 
12831     if (DiagID) {
12832       Diag(Loc, DiagID)
12833         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
12834         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
12835       if (isError)
12836         return QualType();
12837     }
12838 
12839     if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
12840       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
12841                         LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
12842     else
12843       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
12844                         RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
12845     return computeResultTy();
12846   }
12847 
12848   // Handle block pointers.
12849   if (!IsOrdered && RHSIsNull
12850       && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
12851     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12852     return computeResultTy();
12853   }
12854   if (!IsOrdered && LHSIsNull
12855       && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
12856     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12857     return computeResultTy();
12858   }
12859 
12860   if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) {
12861     if (LHSType->isClkEventT() && RHSType->isClkEventT()) {
12862       return computeResultTy();
12863     }
12864 
12865     if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSType->isQueueT()) {
12866       return computeResultTy();
12867     }
12868 
12869     if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isQueueT()) {
12870       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12871       return computeResultTy();
12872     }
12873 
12874     if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSIsNull) {
12875       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
12876       return computeResultTy();
12877     }
12878   }
12879 
12880   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
12881 }
12882 
GetSignedVectorType(QualType V)12883 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) {
12884   const VectorType *VTy = V->castAs<VectorType>();
12885   unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
12886 
12887   if (isa<ExtVectorType>(VTy)) {
12888     if (VTy->isExtVectorBoolType())
12889       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.BoolTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12890     if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy))
12891       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12892     if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
12893       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12894     if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
12895       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12896     if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.Int128Ty))
12897       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.Int128Ty, VTy->getNumElements());
12898     if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
12899       return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12900     assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
12901            "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
12902     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
12903   }
12904 
12905   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.Int128Ty))
12906     return Context.getVectorType(Context.Int128Ty, VTy->getNumElements(),
12907                                  VectorKind::Generic);
12908   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy))
12909     return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
12910                                  VectorKind::Generic);
12911   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
12912     return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
12913                                  VectorKind::Generic);
12914   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
12915     return Context.getVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
12916                                  VectorKind::Generic);
12917   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
12918     return Context.getVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
12919                                  VectorKind::Generic);
12920   assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy) &&
12921          "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
12922   return Context.getVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements(),
12923                                VectorKind::Generic);
12924 }
12925 
GetSignedSizelessVectorType(QualType V)12926 QualType Sema::GetSignedSizelessVectorType(QualType V) {
12927   const BuiltinType *VTy = V->castAs<BuiltinType>();
12928   assert(VTy->isSizelessBuiltinType() && "expected sizeless type");
12929 
12930   const QualType ETy = V->getSveEltType(Context);
12931   const auto TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(ETy);
12932 
12933   const QualType IntTy = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(TypeSize, true);
12934   const llvm::ElementCount VecSize = Context.getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(VTy).EC;
12935   return Context.getScalableVectorType(IntTy, VecSize.getKnownMinValue());
12936 }
12937 
CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)12938 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
12939                                           SourceLocation Loc,
12940                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
12941   if (Opc == BO_Cmp) {
12942     Diag(Loc, diag::err_three_way_vector_comparison);
12943     return QualType();
12944   }
12945 
12946   // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
12947   // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
12948   QualType vType =
12949       CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/ false,
12950                           /*AllowBothBool*/ true,
12951                           /*AllowBoolConversions*/ getLangOpts().ZVector,
12952                           /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ true,
12953                           /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
12954   if (vType.isNull())
12955     return vType;
12956 
12957   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
12958 
12959   // Determine the return type of a vector compare. By default clang will return
12960   // a scalar for all vector compares except vector bool and vector pixel.
12961   // With the gcc compiler we will always return a vector type and with the xl
12962   // compiler we will always return a scalar type. This switch allows choosing
12963   // which behavior is prefered.
12964   if (getLangOpts().AltiVec) {
12965     switch (getLangOpts().getAltivecSrcCompat()) {
12966     case LangOptions::AltivecSrcCompatKind::Mixed:
12967       // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
12968       // bool for C++, int for C
12969       if (vType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() ==
12970           VectorKind::AltiVecVector)
12971         return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
12972       else
12973         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_altivec_src_compat);
12974       break;
12975     case LangOptions::AltivecSrcCompatKind::GCC:
12976       // For GCC we always return the vector type.
12977       break;
12978     case LangOptions::AltivecSrcCompatKind::XL:
12979       return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
12980       break;
12981     }
12982   }
12983 
12984   // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
12985   // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
12986   // often indicate logic errors in the program.
12987   diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
12988 
12989   // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
12990   if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
12991     assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
12992     CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
12993   }
12994 
12995   // Return a signed type for the vector.
12996   return GetSignedVectorType(vType);
12997 }
12998 
CheckSizelessVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)12999 QualType Sema::CheckSizelessVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS,
13000                                                   ExprResult &RHS,
13001                                                   SourceLocation Loc,
13002                                                   BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13003   if (Opc == BO_Cmp) {
13004     Diag(Loc, diag::err_three_way_vector_comparison);
13005     return QualType();
13006   }
13007 
13008   // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
13009   // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
13010   QualType vType = CheckSizelessVectorOperands(
13011       LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/ false, ArithConvKind::Comparison);
13012 
13013   if (vType.isNull())
13014     return vType;
13015 
13016   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
13017 
13018   // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
13019   // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
13020   // often indicate logic errors in the program.
13021   diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
13022 
13023   // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
13024   if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
13025     assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
13026     CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
13027   }
13028 
13029   const BuiltinType *LHSBuiltinTy = LHSType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
13030   const BuiltinType *RHSBuiltinTy = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
13031 
13032   if (LHSBuiltinTy && RHSBuiltinTy && LHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool() &&
13033       RHSBuiltinTy->isSVEBool())
13034     return LHSType;
13035 
13036   // Return a signed type for the vector.
13037   return GetSignedSizelessVectorType(vType);
13038 }
13039 
diagnoseXorMisusedAsPow(Sema & S,const ExprResult & XorLHS,const ExprResult & XorRHS,const SourceLocation Loc)13040 static void diagnoseXorMisusedAsPow(Sema &S, const ExprResult &XorLHS,
13041                                     const ExprResult &XorRHS,
13042                                     const SourceLocation Loc) {
13043   // Do not diagnose macros.
13044   if (Loc.isMacroID())
13045     return;
13046 
13047   // Do not diagnose if both LHS and RHS are macros.
13048   if (XorLHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID() &&
13049       XorRHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID())
13050     return;
13051 
13052   bool Negative = false;
13053   bool ExplicitPlus = false;
13054   const auto *LHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(XorLHS.get());
13055   const auto *RHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(XorRHS.get());
13056 
13057   if (!LHSInt)
13058     return;
13059   if (!RHSInt) {
13060     // Check negative literals.
13061     if (const auto *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(XorRHS.get())) {
13062       UnaryOperatorKind Opc = UO->getOpcode();
13063       if (Opc != UO_Minus && Opc != UO_Plus)
13064         return;
13065       RHSInt = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(UO->getSubExpr());
13066       if (!RHSInt)
13067         return;
13068       Negative = (Opc == UO_Minus);
13069       ExplicitPlus = !Negative;
13070     } else {
13071       return;
13072     }
13073   }
13074 
13075   const llvm::APInt &LeftSideValue = LHSInt->getValue();
13076   llvm::APInt RightSideValue = RHSInt->getValue();
13077   if (LeftSideValue != 2 && LeftSideValue != 10)
13078     return;
13079 
13080   if (LeftSideValue.getBitWidth() != RightSideValue.getBitWidth())
13081     return;
13082 
13083   CharSourceRange ExprRange = CharSourceRange::getCharRange(
13084       LHSInt->getBeginLoc(), S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSInt->getLocation()));
13085   llvm::StringRef ExprStr =
13086       Lexer::getSourceText(ExprRange, S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts());
13087 
13088   CharSourceRange XorRange =
13089       CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
13090   llvm::StringRef XorStr =
13091       Lexer::getSourceText(XorRange, S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts());
13092   // Do not diagnose if xor keyword/macro is used.
13093   if (XorStr == "xor")
13094     return;
13095 
13096   std::string LHSStr = std::string(Lexer::getSourceText(
13097       CharSourceRange::getTokenRange(LHSInt->getSourceRange()),
13098       S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts()));
13099   std::string RHSStr = std::string(Lexer::getSourceText(
13100       CharSourceRange::getTokenRange(RHSInt->getSourceRange()),
13101       S.getSourceManager(), S.getLangOpts()));
13102 
13103   if (Negative) {
13104     RightSideValue = -RightSideValue;
13105     RHSStr = "-" + RHSStr;
13106   } else if (ExplicitPlus) {
13107     RHSStr = "+" + RHSStr;
13108   }
13109 
13110   StringRef LHSStrRef = LHSStr;
13111   StringRef RHSStrRef = RHSStr;
13112   // Do not diagnose literals with digit separators, binary, hexadecimal, octal
13113   // literals.
13114   if (LHSStrRef.starts_with("0b") || LHSStrRef.starts_with("0B") ||
13115       RHSStrRef.starts_with("0b") || RHSStrRef.starts_with("0B") ||
13116       LHSStrRef.starts_with("0x") || LHSStrRef.starts_with("0X") ||
13117       RHSStrRef.starts_with("0x") || RHSStrRef.starts_with("0X") ||
13118       (LHSStrRef.size() > 1 && LHSStrRef.starts_with("0")) ||
13119       (RHSStrRef.size() > 1 && RHSStrRef.starts_with("0")) ||
13120       LHSStrRef.contains('\'') || RHSStrRef.contains('\''))
13121     return;
13122 
13123   bool SuggestXor =
13124       S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || S.getPreprocessor().isMacroDefined("xor");
13125   const llvm::APInt XorValue = LeftSideValue ^ RightSideValue;
13126   int64_t RightSideIntValue = RightSideValue.getSExtValue();
13127   if (LeftSideValue == 2 && RightSideIntValue >= 0) {
13128     std::string SuggestedExpr = "1 << " + RHSStr;
13129     bool Overflow = false;
13130     llvm::APInt One = (LeftSideValue - 1);
13131     llvm::APInt PowValue = One.sshl_ov(RightSideValue, Overflow);
13132     if (Overflow) {
13133       if (RightSideIntValue < 64)
13134         S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base)
13135             << ExprStr << toString(XorValue, 10, true) << ("1LL << " + RHSStr)
13136             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(ExprRange, "1LL << " + RHSStr);
13137       else if (RightSideIntValue == 64)
13138         S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow)
13139             << ExprStr << toString(XorValue, 10, true);
13140       else
13141         return;
13142     } else {
13143       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base_extra)
13144           << ExprStr << toString(XorValue, 10, true) << SuggestedExpr
13145           << toString(PowValue, 10, true)
13146           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
13147                  ExprRange, (RightSideIntValue == 0) ? "1" : SuggestedExpr);
13148     }
13149 
13150     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_xor_used_as_pow_silence)
13151         << ("0x2 ^ " + RHSStr) << SuggestXor;
13152   } else if (LeftSideValue == 10) {
13153     std::string SuggestedValue = "1e" + std::to_string(RightSideIntValue);
13154     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_xor_used_as_pow_base)
13155         << ExprStr << toString(XorValue, 10, true) << SuggestedValue
13156         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(ExprRange, SuggestedValue);
13157     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_xor_used_as_pow_silence)
13158         << ("0xA ^ " + RHSStr) << SuggestXor;
13159   }
13160 }
13161 
CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)13162 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
13163                                           SourceLocation Loc,
13164                                           BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13165   // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or
13166   // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type.
13167   QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false,
13168                                        /*AllowBothBool*/ true,
13169                                        /*AllowBoolConversions*/ false,
13170                                        /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ false,
13171                                        /*ReportInvalid*/ false);
13172   if (vType.isNull())
13173     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13174   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13175       getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() < 120 &&
13176       vType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
13177     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13178   // FIXME: The check for C++ here is for GCC compatibility. GCC rejects the
13179   //        usage of the logical operators && and || with vectors in C. This
13180   //        check could be notionally dropped.
13181   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
13182       !(isa<ExtVectorType>(vType->getAs<VectorType>())))
13183     return InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13184   // Beginning with HLSL 2021, HLSL disallows logical operators on vector
13185   // operands and instead requires the use of the `and`, `or`, `any`, `all`, and
13186   // `select` functions.
13187   if (getLangOpts().HLSL &&
13188       getLangOpts().getHLSLVersion() >= LangOptionsBase::HLSL_2021) {
13189     (void)InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13190     HLSL().emitLogicalOperatorFixIt(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc);
13191     return QualType();
13192   }
13193 
13194   return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType());
13195 }
13196 
CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)13197 QualType Sema::CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
13198                                               SourceLocation Loc,
13199                                               bool IsCompAssign) {
13200   if (!IsCompAssign) {
13201     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
13202     if (LHS.isInvalid())
13203       return QualType();
13204   }
13205   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
13206   if (RHS.isInvalid())
13207     return QualType();
13208 
13209   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
13210   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
13211   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
13212   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
13213 
13214   const MatrixType *LHSMatType = LHSType->getAs<MatrixType>();
13215   const MatrixType *RHSMatType = RHSType->getAs<MatrixType>();
13216   assert((LHSMatType || RHSMatType) && "At least one operand must be a matrix");
13217 
13218   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
13219     return Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSType, RHSType);
13220 
13221   // Type conversion may change LHS/RHS. Keep copies to the original results, in
13222   // case we have to return InvalidOperands.
13223   ExprResult OriginalLHS = LHS;
13224   ExprResult OriginalRHS = RHS;
13225   if (LHSMatType && !RHSMatType) {
13226     RHS = tryConvertExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSMatType->getElementType());
13227     if (!RHS.isInvalid())
13228       return LHSType;
13229 
13230     return InvalidOperands(Loc, OriginalLHS, OriginalRHS);
13231   }
13232 
13233   if (!LHSMatType && RHSMatType) {
13234     LHS = tryConvertExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSMatType->getElementType());
13235     if (!LHS.isInvalid())
13236       return RHSType;
13237     return InvalidOperands(Loc, OriginalLHS, OriginalRHS);
13238   }
13239 
13240   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13241 }
13242 
CheckMatrixMultiplyOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)13243 QualType Sema::CheckMatrixMultiplyOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
13244                                            SourceLocation Loc,
13245                                            bool IsCompAssign) {
13246   if (!IsCompAssign) {
13247     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
13248     if (LHS.isInvalid())
13249       return QualType();
13250   }
13251   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
13252   if (RHS.isInvalid())
13253     return QualType();
13254 
13255   auto *LHSMatType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<ConstantMatrixType>();
13256   auto *RHSMatType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<ConstantMatrixType>();
13257   assert((LHSMatType || RHSMatType) && "At least one operand must be a matrix");
13258 
13259   if (LHSMatType && RHSMatType) {
13260     if (LHSMatType->getNumColumns() != RHSMatType->getNumRows())
13261       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13262 
13263     if (Context.hasSameType(LHSMatType, RHSMatType))
13264       return Context.getCommonSugaredType(
13265           LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(),
13266           RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
13267 
13268     QualType LHSELTy = LHSMatType->getElementType(),
13269              RHSELTy = RHSMatType->getElementType();
13270     if (!Context.hasSameType(LHSELTy, RHSELTy))
13271       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13272 
13273     return Context.getConstantMatrixType(
13274         Context.getCommonSugaredType(LHSELTy, RHSELTy),
13275         LHSMatType->getNumRows(), RHSMatType->getNumColumns());
13276   }
13277   return CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
13278 }
13279 
isLegalBoolVectorBinaryOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc)13280 static bool isLegalBoolVectorBinaryOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13281   switch (Opc) {
13282   default:
13283     return false;
13284   case BO_And:
13285   case BO_AndAssign:
13286   case BO_Or:
13287   case BO_OrAssign:
13288   case BO_Xor:
13289   case BO_XorAssign:
13290     return true;
13291   }
13292 }
13293 
CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)13294 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
13295                                            SourceLocation Loc,
13296                                            BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13297   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false);
13298 
13299   bool IsCompAssign =
13300       Opc == BO_AndAssign || Opc == BO_OrAssign || Opc == BO_XorAssign;
13301 
13302   bool LegalBoolVecOperator = isLegalBoolVectorBinaryOp(Opc);
13303 
13304   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
13305       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
13306     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
13307         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
13308       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
13309                                  /*AllowBothBool*/ true,
13310                                  /*AllowBoolConversions*/ getLangOpts().ZVector,
13311                                  /*AllowBooleanOperation*/ LegalBoolVecOperator,
13312                                  /*ReportInvalid*/ true);
13313     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13314   }
13315 
13316   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
13317       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
13318     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
13319         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
13320       return CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
13321                                          ArithConvKind::BitwiseOp);
13322     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13323   }
13324 
13325   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType() ||
13326       RHS.get()->getType()->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) {
13327     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
13328         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
13329       return CheckSizelessVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
13330                                          ArithConvKind::BitwiseOp);
13331     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13332   }
13333 
13334   if (Opc == BO_And)
13335     diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
13336 
13337   if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation() ||
13338       RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation())
13339     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13340 
13341   ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS;
13342   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(
13343       LHSResult, RHSResult, Loc,
13344       IsCompAssign ? ArithConvKind::CompAssign : ArithConvKind::BitwiseOp);
13345   if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
13346     return QualType();
13347   LHS = LHSResult.get();
13348   RHS = RHSResult.get();
13349 
13350   if (Opc == BO_Xor)
13351     diagnoseXorMisusedAsPow(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc);
13352 
13353   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
13354     return compType;
13355   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13356 }
13357 
13358 // C99 6.5.[13,14]
CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)13359 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
13360                                            SourceLocation Loc,
13361                                            BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13362   // Check vector operands differently.
13363   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
13364       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
13365     return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc);
13366 
13367   bool EnumConstantInBoolContext = false;
13368   for (const ExprResult &HS : {LHS, RHS}) {
13369     if (const auto *DREHS = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(HS.get())) {
13370       const auto *ECDHS = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DREHS->getDecl());
13371       if (ECDHS && ECDHS->getInitVal() != 0 && ECDHS->getInitVal() != 1)
13372         EnumConstantInBoolContext = true;
13373     }
13374   }
13375 
13376   if (EnumConstantInBoolContext)
13377     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_enum_constant_in_bool_context);
13378 
13379   // WebAssembly tables can't be used with logical operators.
13380   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
13381   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
13382   const auto *LHSATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(LHSTy);
13383   const auto *RHSATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(RHSTy);
13384   if ((LHSATy && LHSATy->getElementType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) ||
13385       (RHSATy && RHSATy->getElementType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType())) {
13386     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13387   }
13388 
13389   // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
13390   // bitwise one.  We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
13391   // is a constant.
13392   if (!EnumConstantInBoolContext && LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
13393       !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
13394       RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
13395       // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
13396       !Loc.isMacroID() && !inTemplateInstantiation()) {
13397     // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
13398     // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
13399     // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
13400     // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
13401     Expr::EvalResult EVResult;
13402     if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, Context)) {
13403       llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt();
13404       if ((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
13405            !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) ||
13406           (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) {
13407         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
13408             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
13409         // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
13410         Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
13411             << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
13412             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
13413                    SourceRange(Loc, getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)),
13414                    Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
13415         if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
13416           // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
13417           Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
13418               << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
13419                      SourceRange(getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getEndLoc()),
13420                                  RHS.get()->getEndLoc()));
13421       }
13422     }
13423   }
13424 
13425   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
13426     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do
13427     // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types.
13428     if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13429         Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
13430       if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() ||
13431           RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType())
13432         return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13433     }
13434 
13435     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
13436     if (LHS.isInvalid())
13437       return QualType();
13438 
13439     RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
13440     if (RHS.isInvalid())
13441       return QualType();
13442 
13443     if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
13444         !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
13445       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13446 
13447     return Context.IntTy;
13448   }
13449 
13450   // The following is safe because we only use this method for
13451   // non-overloadable operands.
13452 
13453   // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
13454   // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
13455   // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
13456   ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
13457   if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
13458     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13459   LHS = LHSRes;
13460 
13461   ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
13462   if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
13463     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
13464   RHS = RHSRes;
13465 
13466   // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
13467   // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
13468   // The result is a bool.
13469   return Context.BoolTy;
13470 }
13471 
IsReadonlyMessage(Expr * E,Sema & S)13472 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
13473   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
13474   if (!ME) return false;
13475   if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false;
13476   ObjCMessageExpr *Base = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(
13477       ME->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
13478   if (!Base) return false;
13479   return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr;
13480 }
13481 
13482 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a
13483 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become
13484 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block?
13485 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda };
isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema & S,Expr * E)13486 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
13487   assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified());
13488   E = E->IgnoreParens();
13489 
13490   // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope.
13491   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
13492   if (!DRE) return NCCK_None;
13493   if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None;
13494 
13495   ValueDecl *Value = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13496 
13497   // The declaration must be a value which is not declared 'const'.
13498   if (!Value || Value->getType().isConstQualified())
13499     return NCCK_None;
13500 
13501   BindingDecl *Binding = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(Value);
13502   if (Binding) {
13503     assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "BindingDecl outside of C++?");
13504     assert(!isa<BlockDecl>(Binding->getDeclContext()));
13505     return NCCK_Lambda;
13506   }
13507 
13508   VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Value);
13509   if (!Var)
13510     return NCCK_None;
13511 
13512   assert(Var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?");
13513 
13514   // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
13515   DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr;
13516   // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
13517   while (DC) {
13518     // For init-capture, it is possible that the variable belongs to the
13519     // template pattern of the current context.
13520     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
13521       if (Var->isInitCapture() &&
13522           FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern() == Var->getDeclContext())
13523         break;
13524     if (DC == Var->getDeclContext())
13525       break;
13526     Prev = DC;
13527     DC = DC->getParent();
13528   }
13529   // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far.
13530   if (!Var->isInitCapture())
13531     DC = Prev;
13532   return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda);
13533 }
13534 
IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty,bool IsDereference)13535 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) {
13536   Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType();
13537   if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType())
13538     Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
13539   return !Ty.isConstQualified();
13540 }
13541 
13542 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const
13543 // when this enum is changed.
13544 enum {
13545   ConstFunction,
13546   ConstVariable,
13547   ConstMember,
13548   ConstMethod,
13549   NestedConstMember,
13550   ConstUnknown,  // Keep as last element
13551 };
13552 
13553 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give
13554 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing
13555 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or
13556 /// that the function is returning a const reference.
DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema & S,const Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc)13557 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
13558                                     SourceLocation Loc) {
13559   SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange();
13560 
13561   // Only emit one error on the first const found.  All other consts will emit
13562   // a note to the error.
13563   bool DiagnosticEmitted = false;
13564 
13565   // Track if the current expression is the result of a dereference, and if the
13566   // next checked expression is the result of a dereference.
13567   bool IsDereference = false;
13568   bool NextIsDereference = false;
13569 
13570   // Loop to process MemberExpr chains.
13571   while (true) {
13572     IsDereference = NextIsDereference;
13573 
13574     E = E->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
13575     if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
13576       NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow();
13577       const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl();
13578       if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
13579         // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const.
13580         if (Field->isMutable()) {
13581           assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted.");
13582           break;
13583         }
13584 
13585         if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) {
13586           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13587             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
13588                 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field
13589                 << Field->getType();
13590             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13591           }
13592           S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13593               << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType()
13594               << Field->getSourceRange();
13595         }
13596         E = ME->getBase();
13597         continue;
13598       } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) {
13599         if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) {
13600           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13601             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
13602                 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl
13603                 << VDecl->getType();
13604             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13605           }
13606           S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13607               << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType()
13608               << VDecl->getSourceRange();
13609         }
13610         // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents.
13611         break;
13612       }
13613       break; // End MemberExpr
13614     } else if (const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE =
13615                    dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)) {
13616       E = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
13617       continue;
13618     } else if (const ExtVectorElementExpr *EVE =
13619                    dyn_cast<ExtVectorElementExpr>(E)) {
13620       E = EVE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
13621       continue;
13622     }
13623     break;
13624   }
13625 
13626   if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
13627     // Function calls
13628     const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee();
13629     if (FD && !IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) {
13630       if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13631         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
13632                                                       << ConstFunction << FD;
13633         DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13634       }
13635       S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
13636              diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13637           << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType()
13638           << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
13639     }
13640   } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
13641     // Point to variable declaration.
13642     if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) {
13643       if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) {
13644         if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13645           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
13646               << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType();
13647           DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13648         }
13649         S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13650             << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange();
13651       }
13652     }
13653   } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) {
13654     if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) {
13655       if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
13656         if (MD->isConst()) {
13657           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13658             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
13659                                                           << ConstMethod << MD;
13660             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13661           }
13662           S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13663               << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange();
13664         }
13665       }
13666     }
13667   }
13668 
13669   if (DiagnosticEmitted)
13670     return;
13671 
13672   // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error.
13673   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown;
13674 }
13675 
13676 enum OriginalExprKind {
13677   OEK_Variable,
13678   OEK_Member,
13679   OEK_LValue
13680 };
13681 
DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema & S,const ValueDecl * VD,const RecordType * Ty,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange Range,OriginalExprKind OEK,bool & DiagnosticEmitted)13682 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const ValueDecl *VD,
13683                                          const RecordType *Ty,
13684                                          SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range,
13685                                          OriginalExprKind OEK,
13686                                          bool &DiagnosticEmitted) {
13687   std::vector<const RecordType *> RecordTypeList;
13688   RecordTypeList.push_back(Ty);
13689   unsigned NextToCheckIndex = 0;
13690   // We walk the record hierarchy breadth-first to ensure that we print
13691   // diagnostics in field nesting order.
13692   while (RecordTypeList.size() > NextToCheckIndex) {
13693     bool IsNested = NextToCheckIndex > 0;
13694     for (const FieldDecl *Field :
13695          RecordTypeList[NextToCheckIndex]->getDecl()->fields()) {
13696       // First, check every field for constness.
13697       QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
13698       if (FieldTy.isConstQualified()) {
13699         if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
13700           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
13701               << Range << NestedConstMember << OEK << VD
13702               << IsNested << Field;
13703           DiagnosticEmitted = true;
13704         }
13705         S.Diag(Field->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
13706             << NestedConstMember << IsNested << Field
13707             << FieldTy << Field->getSourceRange();
13708       }
13709 
13710       // Then we append it to the list to check next in order.
13711       FieldTy = FieldTy.getCanonicalType();
13712       if (const auto *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13713         if (!llvm::is_contained(RecordTypeList, FieldRecTy))
13714           RecordTypeList.push_back(FieldRecTy);
13715       }
13716     }
13717     ++NextToCheckIndex;
13718   }
13719 }
13720 
13721 /// Emit an error for the case where a record we are trying to assign to has a
13722 /// const-qualified field somewhere in its hierarchy.
DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema & S,const Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc)13723 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
13724                                          SourceLocation Loc) {
13725   QualType Ty = E->getType();
13726   assert(Ty->isRecordType() && "lvalue was not record?");
13727   SourceRange Range = E->getSourceRange();
13728   const RecordType *RTy = Ty.getCanonicalType()->getAs<RecordType>();
13729   bool DiagEmitted = false;
13730 
13731   if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
13732     DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, ME->getMemberDecl(), RTy, Loc,
13733             Range, OEK_Member, DiagEmitted);
13734   else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
13735     DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, DRE->getDecl(), RTy, Loc,
13736             Range, OEK_Variable, DiagEmitted);
13737   else
13738     DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, nullptr, RTy, Loc,
13739             Range, OEK_LValue, DiagEmitted);
13740   if (!DiagEmitted)
13741     DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
13742 }
13743 
13744 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue.  If not,
13745 /// emit an error and return true.  If so, return false.
CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc,Sema & S)13746 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
13747   assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
13748 
13749   S.CheckShadowingDeclModification(E, Loc);
13750 
13751   SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
13752   Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
13753                                                               &Loc);
13754   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
13755     IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
13756   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
13757     return false;
13758 
13759   unsigned DiagID = 0;
13760   bool NeedType = false;
13761   switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
13762   case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
13763     // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object
13764     // from an enclosing function or block.
13765     if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) {
13766       if (NCCK == NCCK_Block)
13767         DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
13768       else
13769         DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
13770       break;
13771     }
13772 
13773     // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
13774     // infer 'const'.  These are always pseudo-strong variables.
13775     if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
13776       DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
13777       if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
13778         VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
13779 
13780         // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
13781         // user actually wrote 'const'.
13782         if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
13783             (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
13784              !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
13785           // There are three pseudo-strong cases:
13786           //  - self
13787           ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
13788           if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) {
13789             DiagID = method->isClassMethod()
13790               ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method
13791               : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self;
13792 
13793           //  - Objective-C externally_retained attribute.
13794           } else if (var->hasAttr<ObjCExternallyRetainedAttr>() ||
13795                      isa<ParmVarDecl>(var)) {
13796             DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_externally_retained;
13797 
13798           //  - fast enumeration variables
13799           } else {
13800             DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
13801           }
13802 
13803           SourceRange Assign;
13804           if (Loc != OrigLoc)
13805             Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
13806           S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
13807           // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
13808           // can do its job.
13809           return false;
13810         }
13811       }
13812     }
13813 
13814     // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a
13815     // simple const assignment.
13816     if (DiagID == 0) {
13817       DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
13818       return true;
13819     }
13820 
13821     break;
13822   case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace:
13823     DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
13824     return true;
13825   case Expr::MLV_ConstQualifiedField:
13826     DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, E, Loc);
13827     return true;
13828   case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
13829   case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary:
13830     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
13831     NeedType = true;
13832     break;
13833   case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
13834     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
13835     NeedType = true;
13836     break;
13837   case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
13838     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
13839     break;
13840   case Expr::MLV_Valid:
13841     llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
13842   case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
13843   case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
13844   case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
13845     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
13846     break;
13847   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
13848   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
13849     return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
13850              diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E);
13851   case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
13852     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
13853     break;
13854   case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
13855     llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently");
13856   case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
13857     DiagID = diag::err_readonly_message_assignment;
13858     break;
13859   case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
13860     DiagID = diag::err_no_subobject_property_setting;
13861     break;
13862   }
13863 
13864   SourceRange Assign;
13865   if (Loc != OrigLoc)
13866     Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
13867   if (NeedType)
13868     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
13869   else
13870     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
13871   return true;
13872 }
13873 
CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation Loc,Sema & Sema)13874 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
13875                                          SourceLocation Loc,
13876                                          Sema &Sema) {
13877   if (Sema.inTemplateInstantiation())
13878     return;
13879   if (Sema.isUnevaluatedContext())
13880     return;
13881   if (Loc.isInvalid() || Loc.isMacroID())
13882     return;
13883   if (LHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID() || RHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID())
13884     return;
13885 
13886   // C / C++ fields
13887   MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr);
13888   MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr);
13889   if (ML && MR) {
13890     if (!(isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase())))
13891       return;
13892     const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
13893         cast<ValueDecl>(ML->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
13894     const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
13895         cast<ValueDecl>(MR->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
13896     if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
13897       return;
13898     if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
13899       return;
13900     if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
13901       if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
13902         return;
13903 
13904     Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0;
13905   }
13906 
13907   // Objective-C instance variables
13908   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
13909   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
13910   if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) {
13911     DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
13912     DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
13913     if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl())
13914       Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1;
13915   }
13916 }
13917 
13918 // C99 6.5.16.1
CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr * LHSExpr,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,QualType CompoundType,BinaryOperatorKind Opc)13919 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
13920                                        SourceLocation Loc,
13921                                        QualType CompoundType,
13922                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
13923   assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
13924 
13925   // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
13926   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
13927     return QualType();
13928 
13929   QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
13930   QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
13931                                              CompoundType;
13932 
13933   if (RHS.isUsable()) {
13934     // Even if this check fails don't return early to allow the best
13935     // possible error recovery and to allow any subsequent diagnostics to
13936     // work.
13937     const ValueDecl *Assignee = nullptr;
13938     bool ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName = false;
13939     // In simple cases describe what is being assigned to
13940     if (auto *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
13941       Assignee = DR->getDecl();
13942     } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
13943       Assignee = ME->getMemberDecl();
13944       ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName = true;
13945     }
13946 
13947     BoundsSafetyCheckAssignmentToCountAttrPtr(
13948         LHSType, RHS.get(), AssignmentAction::Assigning, Loc, Assignee,
13949         ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName);
13950   }
13951 
13952   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1 p2:
13953   // The half data type can only be used to declare a pointer to a buffer that
13954   // contains half values
13955   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13956       !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", getLangOpts()) &&
13957       LHSType->isHalfType()) {
13958     Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) << 1
13959         << LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
13960     return QualType();
13961   }
13962 
13963   // WebAssembly tables can't be used on RHS of an assignment expression.
13964   if (RHSType->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
13965     Diag(Loc, diag::err_wasm_table_art) << 0;
13966     return QualType();
13967   }
13968 
13969   AssignConvertType ConvTy;
13970   if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
13971     Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
13972 
13973     CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this);
13974 
13975     QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
13976     ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
13977     if (RHS.isInvalid())
13978       return QualType();
13979     // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
13980     if (ConvTy == AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer &&
13981         ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
13982           RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
13983          (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
13984           LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
13985       ConvTy = AssignConvertType::Compatible;
13986 
13987     if (IsAssignConvertCompatible(ConvTy) && LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
13988       Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) << LHSType;
13989 
13990     // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
13991     // right next to each other.  If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
13992     // instead of "x += 4".
13993     if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
13994       RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
13995     if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
13996       if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
13997           Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
13998           // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
13999           Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
14000           // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
14001           // unary +/-.  We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
14002           Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc() &&
14003           UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc().isFileID()) {
14004         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
14005           << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
14006           << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
14007       }
14008     }
14009 
14010     if (IsAssignConvertCompatible(ConvTy)) {
14011       if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) {
14012         // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but
14013         // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is
14014         // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference!
14015         const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
14016         const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS);
14017         if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
14018           ObjC().checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
14019       }
14020 
14021       if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
14022           LHSType.isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) {
14023         // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
14024         // Although this code can still have problems:
14025         //   id x = self.weakProp;
14026         //   id y = self.weakProp;
14027         // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
14028         // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
14029         // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
14030         // For ObjCWeak only, we do not warn if the assign is to a non-weak
14031         // variable, which will be valid for the current autorelease scope.
14032         if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
14033                              RHS.get()->getBeginLoc()))
14034           getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get());
14035 
14036       } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || getLangOpts().ObjCWeak) {
14037         checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
14038       }
14039     }
14040   } else {
14041     // Compound assignment "x += y"
14042     ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
14043   }
14044 
14045   if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, RHS.get(),
14046                                AssignmentAction::Assigning))
14047     return QualType();
14048 
14049   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
14050 
14051   AssignedEntity AE{LHSExpr};
14052   checkAssignmentLifetime(*this, AE, RHS.get());
14053 
14054   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && LHSType.isVolatileQualified()) {
14055     if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
14056       // C++2a [expr.ass]p5:
14057       //   A simple-assignment whose left operand is of a volatile-qualified
14058       //   type is deprecated unless the assignment is either a discarded-value
14059       //   expression or an unevaluated operand
14060       ExprEvalContexts.back().VolatileAssignmentLHSs.push_back(LHSExpr);
14061     }
14062   }
14063 
14064   // C11 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
14065   // left operand would have after lvalue conversion.
14066   // C11 6.3.2.1p2: ...this is called lvalue conversion. If the lvalue has
14067   // qualified type, the value has the unqualified version of the type of the
14068   // lvalue; additionally, if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the
14069   // non-atomic version of the type of the lvalue.
14070   // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
14071   // operand.
14072   return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? LHSType : LHSType.getAtomicUnqualifiedType();
14073 }
14074 
14075 // Scenarios to ignore if expression E is:
14076 // 1. an explicit cast expression into void
14077 // 2. a function call expression that returns void
IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr * E,const ASTContext & Context)14078 static bool IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr *E, const ASTContext &Context) {
14079   E = E->IgnoreParens();
14080 
14081   if (const CastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(E)) {
14082     if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_ToVoid) {
14083       return true;
14084     }
14085 
14086     // static_cast<void> on a dependent type will not show up as CK_ToVoid.
14087     if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_Dependent && E->getType()->isVoidType() &&
14088         CE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isDependentType()) {
14089       return true;
14090     }
14091   }
14092 
14093   if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E))
14094     return CE->getCallReturnType(Context)->isVoidType();
14095   return false;
14096 }
14097 
DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr * LHS,SourceLocation Loc)14098 void Sema::DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
14099   // No warnings in macros
14100   if (Loc.isMacroID())
14101     return;
14102 
14103   // Don't warn in template instantiations.
14104   if (inTemplateInstantiation())
14105     return;
14106 
14107   // Scope isn't fine-grained enough to explicitly list the specific cases, so
14108   // instead, skip more than needed, then call back into here with the
14109   // CommaVisitor in SemaStmt.cpp.
14110   // The listed locations are the initialization and increment portions
14111   // of a for loop.  The additional checks are on the condition of
14112   // if statements, do/while loops, and for loops.
14113   // Differences in scope flags for C89 mode requires the extra logic.
14114   const unsigned ForIncrementFlags =
14115       getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
14116           ? Scope::ControlScope | Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope
14117           : Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope;
14118   const unsigned ForInitFlags = Scope::ControlScope | Scope::DeclScope;
14119   const unsigned ScopeFlags = getCurScope()->getFlags();
14120   if ((ScopeFlags & ForIncrementFlags) == ForIncrementFlags ||
14121       (ScopeFlags & ForInitFlags) == ForInitFlags)
14122     return;
14123 
14124   // If there are multiple comma operators used together, get the RHS of the
14125   // of the comma operator as the LHS.
14126   while (const BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS)) {
14127     if (BO->getOpcode() != BO_Comma)
14128       break;
14129     LHS = BO->getRHS();
14130   }
14131 
14132   // Only allow some expressions on LHS to not warn.
14133   if (IgnoreCommaOperand(LHS, Context))
14134     return;
14135 
14136   Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comma_operator);
14137   Diag(LHS->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_cast_to_void)
14138       << LHS->getSourceRange()
14139       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS->getBeginLoc(),
14140                                     LangOpts.CPlusPlus ? "static_cast<void>("
14141                                                        : "(void)(")
14142       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(LHS->getEndLoc()),
14143                                     ")");
14144 }
14145 
14146 // C99 6.5.17
CheckCommaOperands(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)14147 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
14148                                    SourceLocation Loc) {
14149   LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
14150   RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
14151   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
14152     return QualType();
14153 
14154   // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
14155   // operands, but not unary promotions.
14156   // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
14157 
14158   // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
14159   // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
14160   LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get());
14161   if (LHS.isInvalid())
14162     return QualType();
14163 
14164   S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get(), diag::warn_unused_comma_left_operand);
14165 
14166   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
14167     RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
14168     if (RHS.isInvalid())
14169       return QualType();
14170     if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
14171       S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
14172                             diag::err_incomplete_type);
14173   }
14174 
14175   if (!S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_comma_operator, Loc))
14176     S.DiagnoseCommaOperator(LHS.get(), Loc);
14177 
14178   return RHS.get()->getType();
14179 }
14180 
14181 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
14182 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema & S,Expr * Op,ExprValueKind & VK,ExprObjectKind & OK,SourceLocation OpLoc,bool IsInc,bool IsPrefix)14183 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
14184                                                ExprValueKind &VK,
14185                                                ExprObjectKind &OK,
14186                                                SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsInc,
14187                                                bool IsPrefix) {
14188   QualType ResType = Op->getType();
14189   // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic
14190   // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of
14191   // checking.
14192   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
14193     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
14194 
14195   assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
14196 
14197   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
14198     // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
14199     if (!IsInc) {
14200       S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
14201       return QualType();
14202     }
14203     // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
14204     S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_increment_bool
14205                                               : diag::warn_increment_bool)
14206       << Op->getSourceRange();
14207   } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) {
14208     // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode
14209     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType;
14210     return QualType();
14211   } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
14212     // OK!
14213   } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) {
14214     // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
14215     if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
14216       return QualType();
14217   } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
14218     // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden.
14219     // Otherwise, we just need a complete type.
14220     if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) ||
14221         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op))
14222       return QualType();
14223   } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
14224     // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
14225     S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().C2y ? diag::warn_c2y_compat_increment_complex
14226                                       : diag::ext_c2y_increment_complex)
14227         << IsInc << Op->getSourceRange();
14228   } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
14229     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
14230     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
14231     return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
14232                                           IsInc, IsPrefix);
14233   } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
14234     // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
14235   } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() &&
14236              (ResType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
14237               VectorKind::AltiVecBool)) {
14238     // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors.
14239   } else if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() &&
14240              ResType->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
14241     // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types.
14242   } else {
14243     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
14244       << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
14245     return QualType();
14246   }
14247   // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
14248   // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
14249   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
14250     return QualType();
14251   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && ResType.isVolatileQualified()) {
14252     // C++2a [expr.pre.inc]p1, [expr.post.inc]p1:
14253     //   An operand with volatile-qualified type is deprecated
14254     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_deprecated_increment_decrement_volatile)
14255         << IsInc << ResType;
14256   }
14257   // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
14258   // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
14259   // operand.
14260   if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
14261     VK = VK_LValue;
14262     OK = Op->getObjectKind();
14263     return ResType;
14264   } else {
14265     VK = VK_PRValue;
14266     return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
14267   }
14268 }
14269 
14270 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
14271 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
14272 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
14273 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
14274 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
14275 ///  - &(x) => x
14276 ///  - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
14277 ///  - &s.xx => s
14278 ///  - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
14279 ///  - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
14280 ///  - &"123"[2] -> 0
14281 ///  - & __real__ x -> x
14282 ///
14283 /// FIXME: We don't recurse to the RHS of a comma, nor handle pointers to
14284 /// members.
getPrimaryDecl(Expr * E)14285 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
14286   switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
14287   case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
14288     return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
14289   case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
14290     // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
14291     // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
14292     // irrelevant.
14293     if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
14294       return nullptr;
14295     // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
14296     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
14297   case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
14298     // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary!  We should catch the implicit
14299     // promotion of register arrays earlier.
14300     Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
14301     if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
14302       if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
14303         return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
14304     }
14305     return nullptr;
14306   }
14307   case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
14308     UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
14309 
14310     switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
14311     case UO_Real:
14312     case UO_Imag:
14313     case UO_Extension:
14314       return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
14315     default:
14316       return nullptr;
14317     }
14318   }
14319   case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
14320     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
14321   case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
14322     // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
14323     // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
14324     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
14325   case Stmt::CXXUuidofExprClass:
14326     return cast<CXXUuidofExpr>(E)->getGuidDecl();
14327   default:
14328     return nullptr;
14329   }
14330 }
14331 
14332 namespace {
14333 enum {
14334   AO_Bit_Field = 0,
14335   AO_Vector_Element = 1,
14336   AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
14337   AO_Register_Variable = 3,
14338   AO_Matrix_Element = 4,
14339   AO_No_Error = 5
14340 };
14341 }
14342 /// Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
14343 ///
14344 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * E,unsigned Type)14345 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
14346                                          Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
14347   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
14348 }
14349 
CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(SourceLocation OpLoc,const Expr * Op,const CXXMethodDecl * MD)14350 bool Sema::CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(SourceLocation OpLoc,
14351                                                  const Expr *Op,
14352                                                  const CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
14353   const auto *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(Op->IgnoreParens());
14354 
14355   if (Op != DRE)
14356     return Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
14357            << Op->getSourceRange();
14358 
14359   // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2.
14360   if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD))
14361     return Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor)
14362            << DRE->getSourceRange();
14363 
14364   if (DRE->getQualifier())
14365     return false;
14366 
14367   if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty())
14368     return Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
14369            << DRE->getSourceRange();
14370 
14371   SmallString<32> Str;
14372   StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str);
14373   return Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
14374          << DRE->getSourceRange()
14375          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DRE->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual);
14376 }
14377 
CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult & OrigOp,SourceLocation OpLoc)14378 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
14379   if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){
14380     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
14381       Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
14382       if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) {
14383         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf);
14384         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function)
14385           << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14386         return QualType();
14387       }
14388 
14389       OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E);
14390       if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl))
14391         if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) {
14392           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
14393             << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14394           return QualType();
14395         }
14396 
14397       return Context.OverloadTy;
14398     }
14399 
14400     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny)
14401       return Context.UnknownAnyTy;
14402 
14403     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) {
14404       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
14405         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14406       return QualType();
14407     }
14408 
14409     OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get());
14410     if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType();
14411   }
14412 
14413   if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent())
14414     return Context.DependentTy;
14415 
14416   assert(!OrigOp.get()->hasPlaceholderType());
14417 
14418   // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
14419   Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
14420 
14421   // In OpenCL captures for blocks called as lambda functions
14422   // are located in the private address space. Blocks used in
14423   // enqueue_kernel can be located in a different address space
14424   // depending on a vendor implementation. Thus preventing
14425   // taking an address of the capture to avoid invalid AS casts.
14426   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
14427     auto* VarRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
14428     if (VarRef && VarRef->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) {
14429       Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_address_capture);
14430       return QualType();
14431     }
14432   }
14433 
14434   if (getLangOpts().C99) {
14435     // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
14436     if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
14437       if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
14438         // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
14439         // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
14440         return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
14441     }
14442     // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
14443     // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
14444   }
14445   ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
14446 
14447   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
14448     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
14449                                            op->getBeginLoc()))
14450       return QualType();
14451 
14452   Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context);
14453   unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
14454 
14455   if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) {
14456     bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext();
14457     Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary
14458                                   : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary)
14459       << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
14460     if (sfinae)
14461       return QualType();
14462     // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address.
14463     OrigOp = op =
14464         CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true);
14465   } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
14466     return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
14467   } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
14468     // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
14469     // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
14470 
14471     // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
14472     if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
14473       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
14474         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14475       return QualType();
14476     }
14477     DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
14478     CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
14479 
14480     CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(OpLoc, OrigOp.get(), MD);
14481     QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
14482         op->getType(), DRE->getQualifier(), MD->getParent());
14483 
14484     if (getLangOpts().PointerAuthCalls && MD->isVirtual() &&
14485         !isUnevaluatedContext() && !MPTy->isDependentType()) {
14486       // When pointer authentication is enabled, argument and return types of
14487       // vitual member functions must be complete. This is because vitrual
14488       // member function pointers are implemented using virtual dispatch
14489       // thunks and the thunks cannot be emitted if the argument or return
14490       // types are incomplete.
14491       auto ReturnOrParamTypeIsIncomplete = [&](QualType T,
14492                                                SourceLocation DeclRefLoc,
14493                                                SourceLocation RetArgTypeLoc) {
14494         if (RequireCompleteType(DeclRefLoc, T, diag::err_incomplete_type)) {
14495           Diag(DeclRefLoc,
14496                diag::note_ptrauth_virtual_function_pointer_incomplete_arg_ret);
14497           Diag(RetArgTypeLoc,
14498                diag::note_ptrauth_virtual_function_incomplete_arg_ret_type)
14499               << T;
14500           return true;
14501         }
14502         return false;
14503       };
14504       QualType RetTy = MD->getReturnType();
14505       bool IsIncomplete =
14506           !RetTy->isVoidType() &&
14507           ReturnOrParamTypeIsIncomplete(
14508               RetTy, OpLoc, MD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin());
14509       for (auto *PVD : MD->parameters())
14510         IsIncomplete |= ReturnOrParamTypeIsIncomplete(PVD->getType(), OpLoc,
14511                                                       PVD->getBeginLoc());
14512       if (IsIncomplete)
14513         return QualType();
14514     }
14515 
14516     // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
14517     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
14518       (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy);
14519     return MPTy;
14520   } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
14521     // C99 6.5.3.2p1
14522     // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
14523     if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
14524       // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references.
14525       if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) {
14526         AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
14527       } else {
14528         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
14529           << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
14530         return QualType();
14531       }
14532     } else if (const auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
14533       if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
14534         CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(OpLoc, OrigOp.get(), MD);
14535     }
14536 
14537   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
14538     // The operand cannot be a bit-field
14539     AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
14540   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
14541     // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
14542     AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
14543   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_MatrixComponent) {
14544     // The operand cannot be an element of a matrix.
14545     AddressOfError = AO_Matrix_Element;
14546   } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
14547     // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
14548     // with the register storage-class specifier.
14549     if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
14550       // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
14551       // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
14552       if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
14553           !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
14554         AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
14555       }
14556     } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) {
14557       AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
14558     } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
14559       return Context.OverloadTy;
14560     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
14561       // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
14562       // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
14563       // scope qualifier for the class.
14564 
14565       // [C++26] [expr.prim.id.general]
14566       // If an id-expression E denotes a non-static non-type member
14567       // of some class C [...] and if E is a qualified-id, E is
14568       // not the un-parenthesized operand of the unary & operator [...]
14569       // the id-expression is transformed into a class member access expression.
14570       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
14571           DRE && DRE->getQualifier() && !isa<ParenExpr>(OrigOp.get())) {
14572         DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
14573         if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
14574           if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
14575             Diag(OpLoc,
14576                  diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
14577               << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
14578             return QualType();
14579           }
14580 
14581           while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
14582             Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
14583 
14584           QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
14585               op->getType(), DRE->getQualifier(), cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctx));
14586           // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
14587           if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
14588             (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy);
14589           return MPTy;
14590         }
14591       }
14592     } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl, NonTypeTemplateParmDecl, BindingDecl,
14593                     MSGuidDecl, UnnamedGlobalConstantDecl>(dcl))
14594       llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
14595   }
14596 
14597   if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
14598     diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
14599     return QualType();
14600   }
14601 
14602   if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
14603     // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
14604     // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
14605     // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
14606     Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
14607   }
14608 
14609   // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
14610   if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
14611     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
14612 
14613   // Cannot take the address of WebAssembly references or tables.
14614   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm()) {
14615     QualType OpTy = op->getType();
14616     if (OpTy.isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) {
14617       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_wasm_ca_reference)
14618           << 1 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14619       return QualType();
14620     }
14621     if (OpTy->isWebAssemblyTableType()) {
14622       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_wasm_table_pr)
14623           << 1 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
14624       return QualType();
14625     }
14626   }
14627 
14628   CheckAddressOfPackedMember(op);
14629 
14630   return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
14631 }
14632 
RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema & S,const Expr * Exp)14633 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) {
14634   const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp);
14635   if (!DRE)
14636     return;
14637   const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl();
14638   if (!D)
14639     return;
14640   const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D);
14641   if (!Param)
14642     return;
14643   if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext()))
14644     if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>())
14645       return;
14646   if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction())
14647     FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param);
14648 }
14649 
14650 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema & S,Expr * Op,ExprValueKind & VK,SourceLocation OpLoc,bool IsAfterAmp=false)14651 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
14652                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
14653                                         bool IsAfterAmp = false) {
14654   ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
14655   if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
14656     return QualType();
14657   Op = ConvResult.get();
14658   QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
14659   QualType Result;
14660 
14661   if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
14662     QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
14663     S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
14664                                      Op->getSourceRange());
14665   }
14666 
14667   if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
14668   {
14669     Result = PT->getPointeeType();
14670   }
14671   else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
14672              OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
14673     Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
14674   else {
14675     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
14676     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
14677     if (PR.get() != Op)
14678       return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc);
14679   }
14680 
14681   if (Result.isNull()) {
14682     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
14683       << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
14684     return QualType();
14685   }
14686 
14687   if (Result->isVoidType()) {
14688     // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1:
14689     //   [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall
14690     //   be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type
14691     LangOptions LO = S.getLangOpts();
14692     if (LO.CPlusPlus)
14693       S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer_cpp)
14694           << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
14695     else if (!(LO.C99 && IsAfterAmp) && !S.isUnevaluatedContext())
14696       S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer)
14697           << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
14698   }
14699 
14700   // Dereferences are usually l-values...
14701   VK = VK_LValue;
14702 
14703   // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
14704   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
14705     VK = VK_PRValue;
14706 
14707   return Result;
14708 }
14709 
ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind)14710 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
14711   BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
14712   switch (Kind) {
14713   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
14714   case tok::periodstar:           Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
14715   case tok::arrowstar:            Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
14716   case tok::star:                 Opc = BO_Mul; break;
14717   case tok::slash:                Opc = BO_Div; break;
14718   case tok::percent:              Opc = BO_Rem; break;
14719   case tok::plus:                 Opc = BO_Add; break;
14720   case tok::minus:                Opc = BO_Sub; break;
14721   case tok::lessless:             Opc = BO_Shl; break;
14722   case tok::greatergreater:       Opc = BO_Shr; break;
14723   case tok::lessequal:            Opc = BO_LE; break;
14724   case tok::less:                 Opc = BO_LT; break;
14725   case tok::greaterequal:         Opc = BO_GE; break;
14726   case tok::greater:              Opc = BO_GT; break;
14727   case tok::exclaimequal:         Opc = BO_NE; break;
14728   case tok::equalequal:           Opc = BO_EQ; break;
14729   case tok::spaceship:            Opc = BO_Cmp; break;
14730   case tok::amp:                  Opc = BO_And; break;
14731   case tok::caret:                Opc = BO_Xor; break;
14732   case tok::pipe:                 Opc = BO_Or; break;
14733   case tok::ampamp:               Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
14734   case tok::pipepipe:             Opc = BO_LOr; break;
14735   case tok::equal:                Opc = BO_Assign; break;
14736   case tok::starequal:            Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
14737   case tok::slashequal:           Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
14738   case tok::percentequal:         Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
14739   case tok::plusequal:            Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
14740   case tok::minusequal:           Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
14741   case tok::lesslessequal:        Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
14742   case tok::greatergreaterequal:  Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
14743   case tok::ampequal:             Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
14744   case tok::caretequal:           Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
14745   case tok::pipeequal:            Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
14746   case tok::comma:                Opc = BO_Comma; break;
14747   }
14748   return Opc;
14749 }
14750 
ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind)14751 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
14752   tok::TokenKind Kind) {
14753   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
14754   switch (Kind) {
14755   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
14756   case tok::plusplus:     Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
14757   case tok::minusminus:   Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
14758   case tok::amp:          Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
14759   case tok::star:         Opc = UO_Deref; break;
14760   case tok::plus:         Opc = UO_Plus; break;
14761   case tok::minus:        Opc = UO_Minus; break;
14762   case tok::tilde:        Opc = UO_Not; break;
14763   case tok::exclaim:      Opc = UO_LNot; break;
14764   case tok::kw___real:    Opc = UO_Real; break;
14765   case tok::kw___imag:    Opc = UO_Imag; break;
14766   case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
14767   }
14768   return Opc;
14769 }
14770 
14771 const FieldDecl *
getSelfAssignmentClassMemberCandidate(const ValueDecl * SelfAssigned)14772 Sema::getSelfAssignmentClassMemberCandidate(const ValueDecl *SelfAssigned) {
14773   // Explore the case for adding 'this->' to the LHS of a self assignment, very
14774   // common for setters.
14775   // struct A {
14776   // int X;
14777   // -void setX(int X) { X = X; }
14778   // +void setX(int X) { this->X = X; }
14779   // };
14780 
14781   // Only consider parameters for self assignment fixes.
14782   if (!isa<ParmVarDecl>(SelfAssigned))
14783     return nullptr;
14784   const auto *Method =
14785       dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(getCurFunctionDecl(true));
14786   if (!Method)
14787     return nullptr;
14788 
14789   const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent();
14790   // In theory this is fixable if the lambda explicitly captures this, but
14791   // that's added complexity that's rarely going to be used.
14792   if (Parent->isLambda())
14793     return nullptr;
14794 
14795   // FIXME: Use an actual Lookup operation instead of just traversing fields
14796   // in order to get base class fields.
14797   auto Field =
14798       llvm::find_if(Parent->fields(),
14799                     [Name(SelfAssigned->getDeclName())](const FieldDecl *F) {
14800                       return F->getDeclName() == Name;
14801                     });
14802   return (Field != Parent->field_end()) ? *Field : nullptr;
14803 }
14804 
14805 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
14806 /// This warning suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema & S,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation OpLoc,bool IsBuiltin)14807 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
14808                                    SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsBuiltin) {
14809   if (S.inTemplateInstantiation())
14810     return;
14811   if (S.isUnevaluatedContext())
14812     return;
14813   if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
14814     return;
14815   LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
14816   RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
14817   const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
14818   const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
14819   if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
14820       LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
14821       RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
14822     return;
14823   const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
14824     cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
14825   const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
14826     cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
14827   if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
14828     return;
14829   if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
14830     return;
14831   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
14832     if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
14833       return;
14834 
14835   auto Diag = S.Diag(OpLoc, IsBuiltin ? diag::warn_self_assignment_builtin
14836                                       : diag::warn_self_assignment_overloaded)
14837               << LHSDeclRef->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
14838               << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
14839   if (const FieldDecl *SelfAssignField =
14840           S.getSelfAssignmentClassMemberCandidate(RHSDecl))
14841     Diag << 1 << SelfAssignField
14842          << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSDeclRef->getBeginLoc(), "this->");
14843   else
14844     Diag << 0;
14845 }
14846 
14847 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer.  This
14848 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer.
checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema & S,ExprResult & L,ExprResult & R,SourceLocation OpLoc)14849 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R,
14850                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
14851   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC)
14852     return;
14853 
14854   const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr;
14855   const Expr *LHS = L.get();
14856   const Expr *RHS = R.get();
14857 
14858   if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
14859     ObjCPointerExpr = LHS;
14860     OtherExpr = RHS;
14861   }
14862   else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
14863     ObjCPointerExpr = RHS;
14864     OtherExpr = LHS;
14865   }
14866 
14867   // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false
14868   // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing.  This logic mainly
14869   // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which
14870   // code should generally never do.
14871   if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
14872     unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking;
14873     // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX.
14874     const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
14875     // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which
14876     // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value.
14877     // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase.
14878     if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) {
14879       Selector S = ME->getSelector();
14880       StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0);
14881       if (SelArg0.starts_with("performSelector"))
14882         Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector;
14883     }
14884 
14885     S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag)
14886       << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
14887   }
14888 }
14889 
14890 // This helper function promotes a binary operator's operands (which are of a
14891 // half vector type) to a vector of floats and then truncates the result to
14892 // a vector of either half or short.
convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema & S,ExprResult LHS,ExprResult RHS,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,QualType ResultTy,ExprValueKind VK,ExprObjectKind OK,bool IsCompAssign,SourceLocation OpLoc,FPOptionsOverride FPFeatures)14893 static ExprResult convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema &S, ExprResult LHS, ExprResult RHS,
14894                                       BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType ResultTy,
14895                                       ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK,
14896                                       bool IsCompAssign, SourceLocation OpLoc,
14897                                       FPOptionsOverride FPFeatures) {
14898   auto &Context = S.getASTContext();
14899   assert((isVector(ResultTy, Context.HalfTy) ||
14900           isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) &&
14901          "Result must be a vector of half or short");
14902   assert(isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) &&
14903          isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) &&
14904          "both operands expected to be a half vector");
14905 
14906   RHS = convertVector(RHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S);
14907   QualType BinOpResTy = RHS.get()->getType();
14908 
14909   // If Opc is a comparison, ResultType is a vector of shorts. In that case,
14910   // change BinOpResTy to a vector of ints.
14911   if (isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy))
14912     BinOpResTy = S.GetSignedVectorType(BinOpResTy);
14913 
14914   if (IsCompAssign)
14915     return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(Context, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc,
14916                                           ResultTy, VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures,
14917                                           BinOpResTy, BinOpResTy);
14918 
14919   LHS = convertVector(LHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S);
14920   auto *BO = BinaryOperator::Create(Context, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc,
14921                                     BinOpResTy, VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures);
14922   return convertVector(BO, ResultTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(), S);
14923 }
14924 
14925 /// Returns true if conversion between vectors of halfs and vectors of floats
14926 /// is needed.
needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion,ASTContext & Ctx,Expr * E0,Expr * E1=nullptr)14927 static bool needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion, ASTContext &Ctx,
14928                                      Expr *E0, Expr *E1 = nullptr) {
14929   if (!OpRequiresConversion || Ctx.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType ||
14930       Ctx.getTargetInfo().useFP16ConversionIntrinsics())
14931     return false;
14932 
14933   auto HasVectorOfHalfType = [&Ctx](Expr *E) {
14934     QualType Ty = E->IgnoreImplicit()->getType();
14935 
14936     // Don't promote half precision neon vectors like float16x4_t in arm_neon.h
14937     // to vectors of floats. Although the element type of the vectors is __fp16,
14938     // the vectors shouldn't be treated as storage-only types. See the
14939     // discussion here: https://reviews.llvm.org/rG825235c140e7
14940     if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
14941       if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorKind::Neon)
14942         return false;
14943       return VT->getElementType().getCanonicalType() == Ctx.HalfTy;
14944     }
14945     return false;
14946   };
14947 
14948   return HasVectorOfHalfType(E0) && (!E1 || HasVectorOfHalfType(E1));
14949 }
14950 
CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,bool ForFoldExpression)14951 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
14952                                     BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr,
14953                                     Expr *RHSExpr, bool ForFoldExpression) {
14954   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) {
14955     // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment,
14956     // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for
14957     // non-assignment operators.
14958     // C++11 5.17p9:
14959     //   The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning
14960     //   of x = {} is x = T().
14961     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(
14962         RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
14963     InitializedEntity Entity =
14964         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType());
14965     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
14966     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
14967     if (Init.isInvalid())
14968       return Init;
14969     RHSExpr = Init.get();
14970   }
14971 
14972   ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
14973   QualType ResultTy;     // Result type of the binary operator.
14974   // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
14975   QualType CompLHSTy;    // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
14976   QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
14977   ExprValueKind VK = VK_PRValue;
14978   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
14979   bool ConvertHalfVec = false;
14980 
14981   if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
14982     return ExprError();
14983 
14984   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
14985     QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType();
14986     QualType RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType();
14987     // OpenCLC v2.0 s6.13.11.1 allows atomic variables to be initialized by
14988     // the ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro.
14989     if (LHSTy->isAtomicType() || RHSTy->isAtomicType()) {
14990       SourceRange SR(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
14991       if (BO_Assign == Opc)
14992         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_opencl_atomic_init) << 0 << SR;
14993       else
14994         ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS);
14995       return ExprError();
14996     }
14997 
14998     // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used
14999     // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here.
15000     if (LHSTy->isImageType() || RHSTy->isImageType() ||
15001         LHSTy->isSamplerT() || RHSTy->isSamplerT() ||
15002         LHSTy->isPipeType() || RHSTy->isPipeType() ||
15003         LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
15004       ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS);
15005       return ExprError();
15006     }
15007   }
15008 
15009   checkTypeSupport(LHSExpr->getType(), OpLoc, /*ValueDecl*/ nullptr);
15010   checkTypeSupport(RHSExpr->getType(), OpLoc, /*ValueDecl*/ nullptr);
15011 
15012   switch (Opc) {
15013   case BO_Assign:
15014     ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType(), Opc);
15015     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15016         LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
15017       VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
15018       OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
15019     }
15020     if (!ResultTy.isNull()) {
15021       DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true);
15022       DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
15023 
15024       // Avoid copying a block to the heap if the block is assigned to a local
15025       // auto variable that is declared in the same scope as the block. This
15026       // optimization is unsafe if the local variable is declared in an outer
15027       // scope. For example:
15028       //
15029       // BlockTy b;
15030       // {
15031       //   b = ^{...};
15032       // }
15033       // // It is unsafe to invoke the block here if it wasn't copied to the
15034       // // heap.
15035       // b();
15036 
15037       if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
15038         if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
15039           if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
15040             if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && getCurScope()->isDeclScope(VD))
15041               BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap();
15042 
15043       if (LHS.get()->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
15044         checkNonTrivialCUnion(LHS.get()->getType(), LHS.get()->getExprLoc(),
15045                               NonTrivialCUnionContext::Assignment, NTCUK_Copy);
15046     }
15047     RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get());
15048     break;
15049   case BO_PtrMemD:
15050   case BO_PtrMemI:
15051     ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
15052                                             Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
15053     break;
15054   case BO_Mul:
15055   case BO_Div:
15056     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15057     ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
15058                                            Opc == BO_Div);
15059     break;
15060   case BO_Rem:
15061     ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
15062     break;
15063   case BO_Add:
15064     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15065     ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15066     break;
15067   case BO_Sub:
15068     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15069     ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
15070     break;
15071   case BO_Shl:
15072   case BO_Shr:
15073     ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15074     break;
15075   case BO_LE:
15076   case BO_LT:
15077   case BO_GE:
15078   case BO_GT:
15079     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15080     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15081 
15082     if (const auto *BI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
15083         !ForFoldExpression && BI && BI->isComparisonOp())
15084       Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_consecutive_comparison)
15085           << BI->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
15086 
15087     break;
15088   case BO_EQ:
15089   case BO_NE:
15090     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15091     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15092     break;
15093   case BO_Cmp:
15094     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15095     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15096     assert(ResultTy.isNull() || ResultTy->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
15097     break;
15098   case BO_And:
15099     checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
15100     [[fallthrough]];
15101   case BO_Xor:
15102   case BO_Or:
15103     ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15104     break;
15105   case BO_LAnd:
15106   case BO_LOr:
15107     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15108     ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15109     break;
15110   case BO_MulAssign:
15111   case BO_DivAssign:
15112     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15113     CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
15114                                                Opc == BO_DivAssign);
15115     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
15116     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15117       ResultTy =
15118           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15119     break;
15120   case BO_RemAssign:
15121     CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
15122     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
15123     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15124       ResultTy =
15125           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15126     break;
15127   case BO_AddAssign:
15128     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15129     CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy);
15130     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15131       ResultTy =
15132           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15133     break;
15134   case BO_SubAssign:
15135     ConvertHalfVec = true;
15136     CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
15137     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15138       ResultTy =
15139           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15140     break;
15141   case BO_ShlAssign:
15142   case BO_ShrAssign:
15143     CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
15144     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
15145     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15146       ResultTy =
15147           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15148     break;
15149   case BO_AndAssign:
15150   case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough
15151     DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true);
15152     [[fallthrough]];
15153   case BO_XorAssign:
15154     CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
15155     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
15156     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
15157       ResultTy =
15158           CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy, Opc);
15159     break;
15160   case BO_Comma:
15161     ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
15162     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
15163       VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
15164       OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
15165     }
15166     break;
15167   }
15168   if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
15169     return ExprError();
15170 
15171   // Some of the binary operations require promoting operands of half vector to
15172   // float vectors and truncating the result back to half vector. For now, we do
15173   // this only when HalfArgsAndReturn is set (that is, when the target is arm or
15174   // arm64).
15175   assert(
15176       (Opc == BO_Comma || isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) ==
15177                               isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy)) &&
15178       "both sides are half vectors or neither sides are");
15179   ConvertHalfVec =
15180       needsConversionOfHalfVec(ConvertHalfVec, Context, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
15181 
15182   // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
15183   CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
15184   CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
15185 
15186   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
15187     NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
15188                                                  &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
15189                                                  SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
15190     if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) {
15191       SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc());
15192       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign)
15193           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(),
15194                                         "object_setClass(")
15195           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc),
15196                                           ",")
15197           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
15198     }
15199     else
15200       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
15201   }
15202   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
15203            dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()))
15204     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get());
15205 
15206   // Opc is not a compound assignment if CompResultTy is null.
15207   if (CompResultTy.isNull()) {
15208     if (ConvertHalfVec)
15209       return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, false,
15210                                  OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15211     return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy,
15212                                   VK, OK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15213   }
15214 
15215   // Handle compound assignments.
15216   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
15217       OK_ObjCProperty) {
15218     VK = VK_LValue;
15219     OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
15220   }
15221 
15222   // The LHS is not converted to the result type for fixed-point compound
15223   // assignment as the common type is computed on demand. Reset the CompLHSTy
15224   // to the LHS type we would have gotten after unary conversions.
15225   if (CompResultTy->isFixedPointType())
15226     CompLHSTy = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()).get()->getType();
15227 
15228   if (ConvertHalfVec)
15229     return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, true,
15230                                OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15231 
15232   return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
15233       Context, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, OpLoc,
15234       CurFPFeatureOverrides(), CompLHSTy, CompResultTy);
15235 }
15236 
15237 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
15238 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
15239 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
15240 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema & Self,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15241 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
15242                                       SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
15243                                       Expr *RHSExpr) {
15244   BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
15245   BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr);
15246 
15247   // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator and the other isn't.
15248   bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp();
15249   bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp();
15250   if (isLeftComp == isRightComp)
15251     return;
15252 
15253   // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
15254   // Don't diagnose this.
15255   bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
15256   bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
15257   if (isLeftBitwise || isRightBitwise)
15258     return;
15259 
15260   SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp
15261                               ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), OpLoc)
15262                               : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getEndLoc());
15263   StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr();
15264   SourceRange ParensRange =
15265       isLeftComp
15266           ? SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())
15267           : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getEndLoc());
15268 
15269   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
15270     << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
15271   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
15272     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr,
15273     (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange());
15274   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
15275     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
15276       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
15277     ParensRange);
15278 }
15279 
15280 /// It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
15281 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
15282 /// in parentheses.
15283 static void
EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperator * Bop)15284 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15285                                        BinaryOperator *Bop) {
15286   assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
15287   Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
15288       << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
15289   SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
15290     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
15291       << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
15292     Bop->getSourceRange());
15293 }
15294 
15295 /// Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15296 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15297                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
15298   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
15299     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
15300       // If it's "string_literal && a || b" don't warn since the precedence
15301       // doesn't matter.
15302       if (!isa<StringLiteral>(Bop->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
15303         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
15304     } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
15305       if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
15306         // If it's "a || b && string_literal || c" we didn't warn earlier for
15307         // "a || b && string_literal", but warn now.
15308         if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd &&
15309             isa<StringLiteral>(RBop->getRHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
15310           return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
15311       }
15312     }
15313   }
15314 }
15315 
15316 /// Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15317 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15318                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
15319   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
15320     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
15321       // If it's "a || b && string_literal" don't warn since the precedence
15322       // doesn't matter.
15323       if (!isa<StringLiteral>(Bop->getRHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
15324         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
15325     }
15326   }
15327 }
15328 
15329 /// Look for bitwise op in the left or right hand of a bitwise op with
15330 /// lower precedence and emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
15331 /// the '&' expression in parentheses.
DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema & S,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * SubExpr)15332 static void DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
15333                                          SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *SubExpr) {
15334   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
15335     if (Bop->isBitwiseOp() && Bop->getOpcode() < Opc) {
15336       S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_op_in_bitwise_op)
15337         << Bop->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
15338         << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
15339       SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
15340         S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
15341           << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
15342         Bop->getSourceRange());
15343     }
15344   }
15345 }
15346 
DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * SubExpr,StringRef Shift)15347 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15348                                     Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) {
15349   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
15350     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) {
15351       StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr();
15352       S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift)
15353           << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op;
15354       SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
15355           S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op,
15356           Bop->getSourceRange());
15357     }
15358   }
15359 }
15360 
DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15361 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15362                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
15363   CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr);
15364   if (!OCE)
15365     return;
15366 
15367   FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee();
15368   if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator())
15369     return;
15370 
15371   OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator();
15372   if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater)
15373     return;
15374 
15375   S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison)
15376       << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange()
15377       << (Kind == OO_LessLess);
15378   SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(),
15379                      S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
15380                          << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"),
15381                      OCE->getSourceRange());
15382   SuggestParentheses(
15383       S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first),
15384       SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()));
15385 }
15386 
15387 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
15388 /// precedence.
DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema & Self,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15389 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
15390                                     SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
15391                                     Expr *RHSExpr){
15392   // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
15393   if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
15394     DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15395 
15396   // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
15397   if ((Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor) &&
15398       !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
15399     DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
15400     DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
15401   }
15402 
15403   // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
15404   // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
15405   if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
15406     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15407     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15408   }
15409 
15410   if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext()))
15411       || Opc == BO_Shr) {
15412     StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
15413     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift);
15414     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift);
15415   }
15416 
15417   // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as:
15418   // cout << 5 == 4;
15419   if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc))
15420     DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15421 }
15422 
ActOnBinOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation TokLoc,tok::TokenKind Kind,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)15423 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
15424                             tok::TokenKind Kind,
15425                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
15426   BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
15427   assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
15428   assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
15429 
15430   // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
15431   DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15432 
15433   BuiltinCountedByRefKind K = BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)
15434                                   ? BuiltinCountedByRefKind::Assignment
15435                                   : BuiltinCountedByRefKind::BinaryExpr;
15436 
15437   CheckInvalidBuiltinCountedByRef(LHSExpr, K);
15438   CheckInvalidBuiltinCountedByRef(RHSExpr, K);
15439 
15440   return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15441 }
15442 
LookupBinOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,UnresolvedSetImpl & Functions)15443 void Sema::LookupBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
15444                        UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
15445   OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
15446   if (OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal)
15447     LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Functions);
15448 
15449   // In C++20 onwards, we may have a second operator to look up.
15450   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) {
15451     if (OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(OverOp))
15452       LookupOverloadedOperatorName(ExtraOp, S, Functions);
15453   }
15454 }
15455 
15456 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope.
BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema & S,Scope * Sc,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS)15457 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15458                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
15459                                        Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
15460   switch (Opc) {
15461   case BO_Assign:
15462     // In the non-overloaded case, we warn about self-assignment (x = x) for
15463     // both simple assignment and certain compound assignments where algebra
15464     // tells us the operation yields a constant result.  When the operator is
15465     // overloaded, we can't do the latter because we don't want to assume that
15466     // those algebraic identities still apply; for example, a path-building
15467     // library might use operator/= to append paths.  But it's still reasonable
15468     // to assume that simple assignment is just moving/copying values around
15469     // and so self-assignment is likely a bug.
15470     DiagnoseSelfAssignment(S, LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false);
15471     [[fallthrough]];
15472   case BO_DivAssign:
15473   case BO_RemAssign:
15474   case BO_SubAssign:
15475   case BO_AndAssign:
15476   case BO_OrAssign:
15477   case BO_XorAssign:
15478     CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, S);
15479     break;
15480   default:
15481     break;
15482   }
15483 
15484   // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this point.
15485   UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
15486   S.LookupBinOp(Sc, OpLoc, Opc, Functions);
15487 
15488   // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
15489   // binary operation.
15490   return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS);
15491 }
15492 
BuildBinOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,bool ForFoldExpression)15493 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15494                             BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr,
15495                             Expr *RHSExpr, bool ForFoldExpression) {
15496   if (!LHSExpr || !RHSExpr)
15497     return ExprError();
15498 
15499   // We want to end up calling one of SemaPseudoObject::checkAssignment
15500   // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if
15501   // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent),
15502   // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case).  We also want to get
15503   // any placeholder types out of the way.
15504 
15505   // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS.
15506   if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
15507     // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis.
15508     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
15509         BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc))
15510       return PseudoObject().checkAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15511 
15512     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
15513     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
15514       // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder,
15515       // though.  Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that
15516       // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set.  Note
15517       // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never
15518       // instantiates to having an overloadable type.
15519       ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
15520       if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
15521       RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
15522 
15523       if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
15524           RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
15525         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15526     }
15527 
15528     // If we're instantiating "a.x < b" or "A::x < b" and 'x' names a function
15529     // template, diagnose the missing 'template' keyword instead of diagnosing
15530     // an invalid use of a bound member function.
15531     //
15532     // Note that "A::x < b" might be valid if 'b' has an overloadable type due
15533     // to C++1z [over.over]/1.4, but we already checked for that case above.
15534     if (Opc == BO_LT && inTemplateInstantiation() &&
15535         (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember ||
15536          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload)) {
15537       auto *OE = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(LHSExpr);
15538       if (OE && !OE->hasTemplateKeyword() && !OE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
15539           llvm::any_of(OE->decls(), [](NamedDecl *ND) {
15540             return isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND);
15541           })) {
15542         Diag(OE->getQualifier() ? OE->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc()
15543                                 : OE->getNameLoc(),
15544              diag::err_template_kw_missing)
15545             << OE->getName().getAsIdentifierInfo();
15546         return ExprError();
15547       }
15548     }
15549 
15550     ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr);
15551     if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
15552     LHSExpr = LHS.get();
15553   }
15554 
15555   // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS.
15556   if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
15557     // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type
15558     // being assigned to.
15559     if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
15560       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15561           (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
15562            LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()))
15563         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15564 
15565       return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
15566                                 ForFoldExpression);
15567     }
15568 
15569     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
15570     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload &&
15571         LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
15572       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15573 
15574     ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
15575     if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
15576     RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
15577   }
15578 
15579   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
15580     // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression is type-dependent
15581     // or has an overloadable type.
15582     if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
15583         LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
15584         RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
15585       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
15586   }
15587 
15588   if (getLangOpts().RecoveryAST &&
15589       (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())) {
15590     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus);
15591     assert((LHSExpr->containsErrors() || RHSExpr->containsErrors()) &&
15592            "Should only occur in error-recovery path.");
15593     if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc))
15594       // C [6.15.16] p3:
15595       // An assignment expression has the value of the left operand after the
15596       // assignment, but is not an lvalue.
15597       return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
15598           Context, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, Opc,
15599           LHSExpr->getType().getUnqualifiedType(), VK_PRValue, OK_Ordinary,
15600           OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15601     QualType ResultType;
15602     switch (Opc) {
15603     case BO_Assign:
15604       ResultType = LHSExpr->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
15605       break;
15606     case BO_LT:
15607     case BO_GT:
15608     case BO_LE:
15609     case BO_GE:
15610     case BO_EQ:
15611     case BO_NE:
15612     case BO_LAnd:
15613     case BO_LOr:
15614       // These operators have a fixed result type regardless of operands.
15615       ResultType = Context.IntTy;
15616       break;
15617     case BO_Comma:
15618       ResultType = RHSExpr->getType();
15619       break;
15620     default:
15621       ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
15622       break;
15623     }
15624     return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, Opc, ResultType,
15625                                   VK_PRValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc,
15626                                   CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15627   }
15628 
15629   // Build a built-in binary operation.
15630   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, ForFoldExpression);
15631 }
15632 
isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext & Ctx,QualType T)15633 static bool isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
15634   if (T.isNull() || T->isDependentType())
15635     return false;
15636 
15637   if (!Ctx.isPromotableIntegerType(T))
15638     return true;
15639 
15640   return Ctx.getIntWidth(T) >= Ctx.getIntWidth(Ctx.IntTy);
15641 }
15642 
CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * InputExpr,bool IsAfterAmp)15643 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
15644                                       UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *InputExpr,
15645                                       bool IsAfterAmp) {
15646   ExprResult Input = InputExpr;
15647   ExprValueKind VK = VK_PRValue;
15648   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
15649   QualType resultType;
15650   bool CanOverflow = false;
15651 
15652   bool ConvertHalfVec = false;
15653   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
15654     QualType Ty = InputExpr->getType();
15655     // The only legal unary operation for atomics is '&'.
15656     if ((Opc != UO_AddrOf && Ty->isAtomicType()) ||
15657     // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used
15658     // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here.
15659         (Ty->isImageType() || Ty->isSamplerT() || Ty->isPipeType()
15660         || Ty->isBlockPointerType())) {
15661       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15662                        << InputExpr->getType()
15663                        << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15664     }
15665   }
15666 
15667   if (getLangOpts().HLSL && OpLoc.isValid()) {
15668     if (Opc == UO_AddrOf)
15669       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_hlsl_operator_unsupported) << 0);
15670     if (Opc == UO_Deref)
15671       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_hlsl_operator_unsupported) << 1);
15672   }
15673 
15674   if (InputExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
15675       InputExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Dependent)) {
15676     resultType = Context.DependentTy;
15677   } else {
15678     switch (Opc) {
15679     case UO_PreInc:
15680     case UO_PreDec:
15681     case UO_PostInc:
15682     case UO_PostDec:
15683       resultType =
15684           CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
15685                                          Opc == UO_PreInc || Opc == UO_PostInc,
15686                                          Opc == UO_PreInc || Opc == UO_PreDec);
15687       CanOverflow = isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, resultType);
15688       break;
15689     case UO_AddrOf:
15690       resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
15691       CheckAddressOfNoDeref(InputExpr);
15692       RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr);
15693       break;
15694     case UO_Deref: {
15695       Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
15696       if (Input.isInvalid())
15697         return ExprError();
15698       resultType =
15699           CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc, IsAfterAmp);
15700       break;
15701     }
15702     case UO_Plus:
15703     case UO_Minus:
15704       CanOverflow = Opc == UO_Minus &&
15705                     isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, Input.get()->getType());
15706       Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
15707       if (Input.isInvalid())
15708         return ExprError();
15709       // Unary plus and minus require promoting an operand of half vector to a
15710       // float vector and truncating the result back to a half vector. For now,
15711       // we do this only when HalfArgsAndReturns is set (that is, when the
15712       // target is arm or arm64).
15713       ConvertHalfVec = needsConversionOfHalfVec(true, Context, Input.get());
15714 
15715       // If the operand is a half vector, promote it to a float vector.
15716       if (ConvertHalfVec)
15717         Input = convertVector(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, *this);
15718       resultType = Input.get()->getType();
15719       if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
15720         break;
15721       else if (resultType->isVectorType() &&
15722                // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors.
15723                (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector ||
15724                 resultType->castAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
15725                     VectorKind::AltiVecBool))
15726         break;
15727       else if (resultType->isSveVLSBuiltinType()) // SVE vectors allow + and -
15728         break;
15729       else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
15730                Opc == UO_Plus && resultType->isPointerType())
15731         break;
15732 
15733       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15734                        << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15735 
15736     case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
15737       Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
15738       if (Input.isInvalid())
15739         return ExprError();
15740       resultType = Input.get()->getType();
15741       // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
15742       if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
15743         // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
15744         Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
15745             << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
15746       else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
15747         break;
15748       else if (resultType->isExtVectorType() && Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
15749         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate
15750         // on vector float types.
15751         QualType T = resultType->castAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
15752         if (!T->isIntegerType())
15753           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15754                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15755       } else {
15756         return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15757                          << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15758       }
15759       break;
15760 
15761     case UO_LNot: // logical negation
15762       // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
15763       Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
15764       if (Input.isInvalid())
15765         return ExprError();
15766       resultType = Input.get()->getType();
15767 
15768       // Though we still have to promote half FP to float...
15769       if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) {
15770         Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast)
15771                     .get();
15772         resultType = Context.FloatTy;
15773       }
15774 
15775       // WebAsembly tables can't be used in unary expressions.
15776       if (resultType->isPointerType() &&
15777           resultType->getPointeeType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) {
15778         return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15779                          << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15780       }
15781 
15782       if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) {
15783         // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
15784         if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
15785           // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
15786           // operand contextually converted to bool.
15787           Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy,
15788                                     ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
15789         } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
15790                    Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
15791           // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
15792           // operate on scalar float types.
15793           if (!resultType->isIntegerType() && !resultType->isPointerType())
15794             return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15795                              << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15796         }
15797       } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
15798         if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
15799             Context.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() < 120) {
15800           // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
15801           // operate on vector float types.
15802           QualType T = resultType->castAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
15803           if (!T->isIntegerType())
15804             return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15805                              << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15806         }
15807         // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
15808         resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
15809         break;
15810       } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15811                  resultType->isVectorType()) {
15812         const VectorType *VTy = resultType->castAs<VectorType>();
15813         if (VTy->getVectorKind() != VectorKind::Generic)
15814           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15815                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15816 
15817         // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
15818         resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
15819         break;
15820       } else {
15821         return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
15822                          << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
15823       }
15824 
15825       // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
15826       // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
15827       resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
15828       break;
15829     case UO_Real:
15830     case UO_Imag:
15831       resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
15832       // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps
15833       // ordinary complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to
15834       // r-values.
15835       if (Input.isInvalid())
15836         return ExprError();
15837       if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) {
15838         if (Input.get()->isGLValue() &&
15839             Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
15840           VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
15841       } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
15842         // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not.
15843         Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get());
15844       }
15845       break;
15846     case UO_Extension:
15847       resultType = Input.get()->getType();
15848       VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
15849       OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
15850       break;
15851     case UO_Coawait:
15852       // It's unnecessary to represent the pass-through operator co_await in the
15853       // AST; just return the input expression instead.
15854       assert(!Input.get()->getType()->isDependentType() &&
15855              "the co_await expression must be non-dependant before "
15856              "building operator co_await");
15857       return Input;
15858     }
15859   }
15860   if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
15861     return ExprError();
15862 
15863   // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
15864   // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
15865   // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
15866   // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
15867   if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
15868     CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
15869 
15870   auto *UO =
15871       UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK,
15872                             OpLoc, CanOverflow, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15873 
15874   if (Opc == UO_Deref && UO->getType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) &&
15875       !isa<ArrayType>(UO->getType().getDesugaredType(Context)) &&
15876       !isUnevaluatedContext())
15877     ExprEvalContexts.back().PossibleDerefs.insert(UO);
15878 
15879   // Convert the result back to a half vector.
15880   if (ConvertHalfVec)
15881     return convertVector(UO, Context.HalfTy, *this);
15882   return UO;
15883 }
15884 
isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr * E)15885 bool Sema::isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) {
15886   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
15887     if (!DRE->getQualifier())
15888       return false;
15889 
15890     ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl();
15891     if (!VD->isCXXClassMember())
15892       return false;
15893 
15894     if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
15895       return true;
15896     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD))
15897       return Method->isImplicitObjectMemberFunction();
15898 
15899     return false;
15900   }
15901 
15902   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
15903     if (!ULE->getQualifier())
15904       return false;
15905 
15906     for (NamedDecl *D : ULE->decls()) {
15907       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
15908         if (Method->isImplicitObjectMemberFunction())
15909           return true;
15910       } else {
15911         // Overload set does not contain methods.
15912         break;
15913       }
15914     }
15915 
15916     return false;
15917   }
15918 
15919   return false;
15920 }
15921 
BuildUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * Input,bool IsAfterAmp)15922 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
15923                               UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input,
15924                               bool IsAfterAmp) {
15925   // First things first: handle placeholders so that the
15926   // overloaded-operator check considers the right type.
15927   if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
15928     // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references.
15929     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
15930         UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc))
15931       return PseudoObject().checkIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
15932 
15933     // extension is always a builtin operator.
15934     if (Opc == UO_Extension)
15935       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
15936 
15937     // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder.
15938     // The builtin code knows what to do.
15939     if (Opc == UO_AddrOf &&
15940         (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload ||
15941          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny ||
15942          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember))
15943       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
15944 
15945     // Anything else needs to be handled now.
15946     ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input);
15947     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
15948     Input = Result.get();
15949   }
15950 
15951   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
15952       UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None &&
15953       !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) {
15954     // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this point.
15955     UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
15956     OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
15957     if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
15958       LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Functions);
15959 
15960     return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
15961   }
15962 
15963   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input, IsAfterAmp);
15964 }
15965 
ActOnUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,tok::TokenKind Op,Expr * Input,bool IsAfterAmp)15966 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Op,
15967                               Expr *Input, bool IsAfterAmp) {
15968   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input,
15969                       IsAfterAmp);
15970 }
15971 
ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceLocation LabLoc,LabelDecl * TheDecl)15972 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
15973                                 LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
15974   TheDecl->markUsed(Context);
15975   // Create the AST node.  The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
15976   auto *Res = new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(
15977       OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy));
15978 
15979   if (getCurFunction())
15980     getCurFunction()->AddrLabels.push_back(Res);
15981 
15982   return Res;
15983 }
15984 
ActOnStartStmtExpr()15985 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() {
15986   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
15987   // Make sure we diagnose jumping into a statement expression.
15988   setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
15989 }
15990 
ActOnStmtExprError()15991 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() {
15992   // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a
15993   // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything.
15994 
15995   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
15996   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
15997 }
15998 
ActOnStmtExpr(Scope * S,SourceLocation LPLoc,Stmt * SubStmt,SourceLocation RPLoc)15999 ExprResult Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
16000                                SourceLocation RPLoc) {
16001   return BuildStmtExpr(LPLoc, SubStmt, RPLoc, getTemplateDepth(S));
16002 }
16003 
BuildStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc,Stmt * SubStmt,SourceLocation RPLoc,unsigned TemplateDepth)16004 ExprResult Sema::BuildStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
16005                                SourceLocation RPLoc, unsigned TemplateDepth) {
16006   assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
16007   CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
16008 
16009   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
16010     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
16011   assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
16012          "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!");
16013   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
16014 
16015   // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
16016   // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
16017   // More semantic analysis is needed.
16018 
16019   // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
16020   // as the type of the stmtexpr.
16021   QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
16022   bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
16023   if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
16024     // For GCC compatibility we get the last Stmt excluding trailing NullStmts.
16025     if (const auto *LastStmt =
16026             dyn_cast<ValueStmt>(Compound->getStmtExprResult())) {
16027       if (const Expr *Value = LastStmt->getExprStmt()) {
16028         StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
16029         Ty = Value->getType();
16030       }
16031     }
16032   }
16033 
16034   // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
16035   // expressions are not lvalues.
16036   Expr *ResStmtExpr =
16037       new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc, TemplateDepth);
16038   if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
16039     return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
16040   return ResStmtExpr;
16041 }
16042 
ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult ER)16043 ExprResult Sema::ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult ER) {
16044   if (ER.isInvalid())
16045     return ExprError();
16046 
16047   // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
16048   // lvalue-to-rvalue.  However, initialize an unqualified type.
16049   ER = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(ER.get());
16050   if (ER.isInvalid())
16051     return ExprError();
16052   Expr *E = ER.get();
16053 
16054   if (E->isTypeDependent())
16055     return E;
16056 
16057   // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
16058   // the consume out and bind it later.  In the alternate case
16059   // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
16060   // initialization will create a produce.  In both cases the
16061   // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
16062   // a bind.
16063   auto *Cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
16064   if (Cast && Cast->getCastKind() == CK_ARCConsumeObject)
16065     return Cast->getSubExpr();
16066 
16067   // FIXME: Provide a better location for the initialization.
16068   return PerformCopyInitialization(
16069       InitializedEntity::InitializeStmtExprResult(
16070           E->getBeginLoc(), E->getType().getAtomicUnqualifiedType()),
16071       SourceLocation(), E);
16072 }
16073 
BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,SourceLocation RParenLoc)16074 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16075                                       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
16076                                       ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
16077                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
16078   QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
16079   bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
16080   SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
16081 
16082   // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
16083   // one is known to be a field designator.  Verify that the ArgTy represents
16084   // a struct/union/class.
16085   if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
16086     return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
16087                        << ArgTy << TypeRange);
16088 
16089   // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
16090   // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
16091   if (!Dependent
16092       && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
16093                              diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange))
16094     return ExprError();
16095 
16096   bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
16097   QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
16098   SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
16099   SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
16100   for (const OffsetOfComponent &OC : Components) {
16101     if (OC.isBrackets) {
16102       // Offset of an array sub-field.  TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
16103       if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
16104         const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
16105         if(!AT)
16106           return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
16107                            << CurrentType);
16108         CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
16109       } else
16110         CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
16111 
16112       ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E));
16113       if (IdxRval.isInvalid())
16114         return ExprError();
16115       Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get();
16116 
16117       // The expression must be an integral expression.
16118       // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
16119       if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
16120           !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
16121         return ExprError(
16122             Diag(Idx->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
16123             << Idx->getSourceRange());
16124 
16125       // Record this array index.
16126       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
16127       Exprs.push_back(Idx);
16128       continue;
16129     }
16130 
16131     // Offset of a field.
16132     if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
16133       // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
16134       // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
16135       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
16136       CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
16137       continue;
16138     }
16139 
16140     // We need to have a complete type to look into.
16141     if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
16142                             diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
16143       return ExprError();
16144 
16145     // Look for the designated field.
16146     const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
16147     if (!RC)
16148       return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
16149                        << CurrentType);
16150     RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
16151 
16152     // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
16153     //   The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
16154     //   International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
16155     //   (clause 9).
16156     // C++11 [support.types]p4:
16157     //   If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are
16158     //   undefined.
16159     if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
16160       bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD();
16161       unsigned DiagID =
16162         LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type
16163                             : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type;
16164 
16165       if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
16166         Diag(BuiltinLoc, DiagID)
16167             << SourceRange(Components[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) << CurrentType;
16168         DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
16169       }
16170     }
16171 
16172     // Look for the field.
16173     LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
16174     LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
16175     FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
16176     IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr;
16177     if (!MemberDecl) {
16178       if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
16179         MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
16180     }
16181 
16182     if (!MemberDecl) {
16183       // Lookup could be ambiguous when looking up a placeholder variable
16184       // __builtin_offsetof(S, _).
16185       // In that case we would already have emitted a diagnostic
16186       if (!R.isAmbiguous())
16187         Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
16188             << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd);
16189       return ExprError();
16190     }
16191 
16192     // C99 7.17p3:
16193     //   (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
16194     //
16195     // We diagnose this as an error.
16196     if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
16197       Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
16198         << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
16199         << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
16200       Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
16201       return ExprError();
16202     }
16203 
16204     RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
16205     if (IndirectMemberDecl)
16206       Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
16207 
16208     // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
16209     // the base class indirections.
16210     CXXBasePaths Paths;
16211     if (IsDerivedFrom(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent),
16212                       Paths)) {
16213       if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
16214         Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base)
16215           << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
16216           << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
16217         return ExprError();
16218       }
16219 
16220       CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
16221       for (const CXXBasePathElement &B : Path)
16222         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B.Base));
16223     }
16224 
16225     if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
16226       for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) {
16227         assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI));
16228         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
16229                                      cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd));
16230       }
16231     } else
16232       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
16233 
16234     CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
16235   }
16236 
16237   return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo,
16238                               Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc);
16239 }
16240 
ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope * S,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation TypeLoc,ParsedType ParsedArgTy,ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,SourceLocation RParenLoc)16241 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
16242                                       SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16243                                       SourceLocation TypeLoc,
16244                                       ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
16245                                       ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
16246                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
16247 
16248   TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
16249   QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
16250   if (ArgTy.isNull())
16251     return ExprError();
16252 
16253   if (!ArgTInfo)
16254     ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
16255 
16256   return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, Components, RParenLoc);
16257 }
16258 
16259 
ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * CondExpr,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation RPLoc)16260 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16261                                  Expr *CondExpr,
16262                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
16263                                  SourceLocation RPLoc) {
16264   assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
16265 
16266   ExprValueKind VK = VK_PRValue;
16267   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
16268   QualType resType;
16269   bool CondIsTrue = false;
16270   if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
16271     resType = Context.DependentTy;
16272   } else {
16273     // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
16274     llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
16275     ExprResult CondICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(
16276         CondExpr, &condEval, diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant);
16277     if (CondICE.isInvalid())
16278       return ExprError();
16279     CondExpr = CondICE.get();
16280     CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue();
16281 
16282     // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LHSExpr.
16283     Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
16284 
16285     resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
16286     VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
16287     OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
16288   }
16289 
16290   return new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
16291                                   resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, CondIsTrue);
16292 }
16293 
16294 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
16295 // Clang Extensions.
16296 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
16297 
ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Scope * CurScope)16298 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
16299   BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
16300 
16301   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
16302     MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
16303     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
16304     std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
16305         getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext());
16306     if (MCtx) {
16307       unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block);
16308       Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl);
16309     }
16310   }
16311 
16312   PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
16313   CurContext->addDecl(Block);
16314   if (CurScope)
16315     PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
16316   else
16317     CurContext = Block;
16318 
16319   getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true;
16320 
16321   // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any
16322   // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression.
16323   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
16324       ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated);
16325 }
16326 
ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Declarator & ParamInfo,Scope * CurScope)16327 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
16328                                Scope *CurScope) {
16329   assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
16330          "block-id should have no identifier!");
16331   assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral);
16332   BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
16333 
16334   TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo);
16335   QualType T = Sig->getType();
16336   DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block);
16337 
16338   // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
16339   // literal signature.  Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
16340   // unless the function was written with a typedef.
16341   assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
16342          "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
16343 
16344   // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
16345   FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
16346 
16347   if ((ExplicitSignature = Sig->getTypeLoc()
16348                                .getAsAdjusted<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) {
16349 
16350     // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
16351     // GetTypeForDeclarator.  If so, don't save that as part of the
16352     // written signature.
16353     if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
16354         ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
16355       // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
16356       // TypeSourceInfos.
16357       TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc();
16358       unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
16359       Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
16360       Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
16361 
16362       ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
16363     }
16364   }
16365 
16366   CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
16367   CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
16368 
16369   const auto *Fn = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
16370   QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType();
16371   bool isVariadic =
16372       (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
16373 
16374   CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
16375 
16376   // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
16377   // return type.  TODO:  what should we do with declarators like:
16378   //   ^ * { ... }
16379   // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
16380   if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) {
16381     CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
16382     CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false);
16383     CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false;
16384   }
16385 
16386   // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
16387   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
16388   if (ExplicitSignature) {
16389     for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) {
16390       ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I);
16391       if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && !Param->isImplicit() &&
16392           !Param->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16393         // Diagnose this as an extension in C17 and earlier.
16394         if (!getLangOpts().C23)
16395           Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::ext_parameter_name_omitted_c23);
16396       }
16397       Params.push_back(Param);
16398     }
16399 
16400   // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
16401   //   ^ fntype { ... }
16402   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
16403     for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) {
16404       ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(
16405           CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getBeginLoc(), I);
16406       Params.push_back(Param);
16407     }
16408   }
16409 
16410   // Set the parameters on the block decl.
16411   if (!Params.empty()) {
16412     CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
16413     CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters(),
16414                              /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
16415   }
16416 
16417   // Finally we can process decl attributes.
16418   ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
16419 
16420   // Put the parameter variables in scope.
16421   for (auto *AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters()) {
16422     AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
16423 
16424     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
16425     if (AI->getIdentifier()) {
16426       CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI);
16427 
16428       PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
16429     }
16430 
16431     if (AI->isInvalidDecl())
16432       CurBlock->TheDecl->setInvalidDecl();
16433   }
16434 }
16435 
ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Scope * CurScope)16436 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
16437   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
16438   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
16439   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
16440 
16441   // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
16442   PopDeclContext();
16443   PopFunctionScopeInfo();
16444 }
16445 
ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Stmt * Body,Scope * CurScope)16446 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
16447                                     Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
16448   // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
16449   if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
16450     Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL;
16451 
16452   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
16453   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
16454     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
16455   assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
16456          "cleanups within block not correctly bound!");
16457   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
16458 
16459   BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
16460   BlockDecl *BD = BSI->TheDecl;
16461 
16462   maybeAddDeclWithEffects(BD);
16463 
16464   if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType)
16465     deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI);
16466 
16467   QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
16468   if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
16469     RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
16470 
16471   bool NoReturn = BD->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
16472   QualType BlockTy;
16473 
16474   // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
16475   if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
16476     const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->castAs<FunctionType>();
16477 
16478     FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
16479     if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
16480 
16481     // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
16482     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
16483       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
16484       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
16485       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, {}, EPI);
16486 
16487       // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
16488       // preserve its sugar structure.
16489     } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy &&
16490                (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
16491       BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
16492 
16493     // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
16494     } else {
16495       const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
16496       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
16497       EPI.TypeQuals = Qualifiers();
16498       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
16499       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
16500     }
16501 
16502   // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
16503   } else {
16504     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
16505     EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
16506     BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, {}, EPI);
16507   }
16508 
16509   DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BD->parameters());
16510   BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
16511 
16512   // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
16513   if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
16514       !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
16515     DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
16516 
16517   BD->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
16518 
16519   if (Body && getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations)
16520     DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(BD);
16521 
16522   // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again
16523   // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around
16524   // to deduce an implicit return type.
16525   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() &&
16526       !BD->isDependentContext())
16527     computeNRVO(Body, BSI);
16528 
16529   if (RetTy.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
16530       RetTy.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
16531     checkNonTrivialCUnion(RetTy, BD->getCaretLocation(),
16532                           NonTrivialCUnionContext::FunctionReturn,
16533                           NTCUK_Destruct | NTCUK_Copy);
16534 
16535   PopDeclContext();
16536 
16537   // Set the captured variables on the block.
16538   SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures;
16539   for (Capture &Cap : BSI->Captures) {
16540     if (Cap.isInvalid() || Cap.isThisCapture())
16541       continue;
16542     // Cap.getVariable() is always a VarDecl because
16543     // blocks cannot capture structured bindings or other ValueDecl kinds.
16544     auto *Var = cast<VarDecl>(Cap.getVariable());
16545     Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
16546     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Cap.isCopyCapture()) {
16547       if (const RecordType *Record =
16548               Cap.getCaptureType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
16549         // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
16550         // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
16551         // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
16552         // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
16553         // actually requires the destructor.
16554         if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
16555           FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record);
16556 
16557         // Enter a separate potentially-evaluated context while building block
16558         // initializers to isolate their cleanups from those of the block
16559         // itself.
16560         // FIXME: Is this appropriate even when the block itself occurs in an
16561         // unevaluated operand?
16562         EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
16563             *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated);
16564 
16565         SourceLocation Loc = Cap.getLocation();
16566 
16567         ExprResult Result = BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
16568             CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(Var->getDeclName(), Loc), Var);
16569 
16570         // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
16571         // the stack requires a const copy constructor.  This is not true
16572         // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
16573         if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
16574             !Result.get()->getType().isConstQualified()) {
16575           Result = ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(),
16576                                      Result.get()->getType().withConst(),
16577                                      CK_NoOp, VK_LValue);
16578         }
16579 
16580         if (!Result.isInvalid()) {
16581           Result = PerformCopyInitialization(
16582               InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(),
16583                                                  Cap.getCaptureType()),
16584               Loc, Result.get());
16585         }
16586 
16587         // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
16588         // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor.  Recover from
16589         // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
16590         if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
16591             !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor()
16592                 ->isTrivial()) {
16593           Result = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result);
16594           CopyExpr = Result.get();
16595         }
16596       }
16597     }
16598 
16599     BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Var, Cap.isBlockCapture(), Cap.isNested(),
16600                               CopyExpr);
16601     Captures.push_back(NewCap);
16602   }
16603   BD->setCaptures(Context, Captures, BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0);
16604 
16605   // Pop the block scope now but keep it alive to the end of this function.
16606   AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP =
16607       AnalysisWarnings.getPolicyInEffectAt(Body->getEndLoc());
16608   PoppedFunctionScopePtr ScopeRAII = PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, BD, BlockTy);
16609 
16610   BlockExpr *Result = new (Context)
16611       BlockExpr(BD, BlockTy, BSI->ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
16612 
16613   // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at
16614   // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context:
16615   if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) {
16616     // First, this expression has a new cleanup object.
16617     ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl());
16618     Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true);
16619 
16620     // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured
16621     // variables needs destruction.
16622     for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) {
16623       const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable();
16624       if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) {
16625         setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
16626         break;
16627       }
16628     }
16629   }
16630 
16631   if (getCurFunction())
16632     getCurFunction()->addBlock(BD);
16633 
16634   // This can happen if the block's return type is deduced, but
16635   // the return expression is invalid.
16636   if (BD->isInvalidDecl())
16637     return CreateRecoveryExpr(Result->getBeginLoc(), Result->getEndLoc(),
16638                               {Result}, Result->getType());
16639   return Result;
16640 }
16641 
ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * E,ParsedType Ty,SourceLocation RPLoc)16642 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
16643                             SourceLocation RPLoc) {
16644   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
16645   GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
16646   return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
16647 }
16648 
BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * E,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation RPLoc)16649 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16650                                 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
16651                                 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
16652   Expr *OrigExpr = E;
16653   bool IsMS = false;
16654 
16655   // CUDA device code does not support varargs.
16656   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) {
16657     if (const FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) {
16658       CUDAFunctionTarget T = CUDA().IdentifyTarget(F);
16659       if (T == CUDAFunctionTarget::Global || T == CUDAFunctionTarget::Device ||
16660           T == CUDAFunctionTarget::HostDevice)
16661         return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device));
16662     }
16663   }
16664 
16665   // NVPTX does not support va_arg expression.
16666   if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsTargetDevice &&
16667       Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isNVPTX())
16668     targetDiag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device);
16669 
16670   // It might be a __builtin_ms_va_list. (But don't ever mark a va_arg()
16671   // as Microsoft ABI on an actual Microsoft platform, where
16672   // __builtin_ms_va_list and __builtin_va_list are the same.)
16673   if (!E->isTypeDependent() && Context.getTargetInfo().hasBuiltinMSVaList() &&
16674       Context.getTargetInfo().getBuiltinVaListKind() != TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList) {
16675     QualType MSVaListType = Context.getBuiltinMSVaListType();
16676     if (Context.hasSameType(MSVaListType, E->getType())) {
16677       if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
16678         return ExprError();
16679       IsMS = true;
16680     }
16681   }
16682 
16683   // Get the va_list type
16684   QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
16685   if (!IsMS) {
16686     if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
16687       // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
16688       // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
16689       // a pointer for va_arg.
16690       VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
16691       // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
16692       ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
16693       if (Result.isInvalid())
16694         return ExprError();
16695       E = Result.get();
16696     } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16697       // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode,
16698       // check the argument using reference binding.
16699       InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
16700           Context, Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false);
16701       ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E);
16702       if (Init.isInvalid())
16703         return ExprError();
16704       E = Init.getAs<Expr>();
16705     } else {
16706       // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
16707       // it is modified by va_arg.
16708       if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
16709           CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
16710         return ExprError();
16711     }
16712   }
16713 
16714   if (!IsMS && !E->isTypeDependent() &&
16715       !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType()))
16716     return ExprError(
16717         Diag(E->getBeginLoc(),
16718              diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
16719         << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
16720 
16721   if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
16722     if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
16723                             diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete,
16724                             TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
16725       return ExprError();
16726 
16727     if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
16728                                TInfo->getType(),
16729                                diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract,
16730                                TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
16731       return ExprError();
16732 
16733     if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
16734       Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
16735            TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
16736              ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
16737              : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
16738         << TInfo->getType()
16739         << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
16740     }
16741 
16742     if (TInfo->getType()->isArrayType()) {
16743       DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
16744                           PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_array)
16745                               << TInfo->getType()
16746                               << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
16747     }
16748 
16749     // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
16750     // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
16751     QualType PromoteType;
16752     if (Context.isPromotableIntegerType(TInfo->getType())) {
16753       PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
16754       // [cstdarg.syn]p1 defers the C++ behavior to what the C standard says,
16755       // and C23 7.16.1.1p2 says, in part:
16756       //   If type is not compatible with the type of the actual next argument
16757       //   (as promoted according to the default argument promotions), the
16758       //   behavior is undefined, except for the following cases:
16759       //     - both types are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
16760       //       compatible types;
16761       //     - one type is compatible with a signed integer type, the other
16762       //       type is compatible with the corresponding unsigned integer type,
16763       //       and the value is representable in both types;
16764       //     - one type is pointer to qualified or unqualified void and the
16765       //       other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified character type;
16766       //     - or, the type of the next argument is nullptr_t and type is a
16767       //       pointer type that has the same representation and alignment
16768       //       requirements as a pointer to a character type.
16769       // Given that type compatibility is the primary requirement (ignoring
16770       // qualifications), you would think we could call typesAreCompatible()
16771       // directly to test this. However, in C++, that checks for *same type*,
16772       // which causes false positives when passing an enumeration type to
16773       // va_arg. Instead, get the underlying type of the enumeration and pass
16774       // that.
16775       QualType UnderlyingType = TInfo->getType();
16776       if (const auto *ET = UnderlyingType->getAs<EnumType>())
16777         UnderlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
16778       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, UnderlyingType,
16779                                      /*CompareUnqualified*/ true))
16780         PromoteType = QualType();
16781 
16782       // If the types are still not compatible, we need to test whether the
16783       // promoted type and the underlying type are the same except for
16784       // signedness. Ask the AST for the correctly corresponding type and see
16785       // if that's compatible.
16786       if (!PromoteType.isNull() && !UnderlyingType->isBooleanType() &&
16787           PromoteType->isUnsignedIntegerType() !=
16788               UnderlyingType->isUnsignedIntegerType()) {
16789         UnderlyingType =
16790             UnderlyingType->isUnsignedIntegerType()
16791                 ? Context.getCorrespondingSignedType(UnderlyingType)
16792                 : Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(UnderlyingType);
16793         if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, UnderlyingType,
16794                                        /*CompareUnqualified*/ true))
16795           PromoteType = QualType();
16796       }
16797     }
16798     if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
16799       PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
16800     if (!PromoteType.isNull())
16801       DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
16802                   PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
16803                           << TInfo->getType()
16804                           << PromoteType
16805                           << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
16806   }
16807 
16808   QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
16809   return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T, IsMS);
16810 }
16811 
ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc)16812 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
16813   // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
16814   // pointers on the target.
16815   QualType Ty;
16816   unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(LangAS::Default);
16817   if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
16818     Ty = Context.IntTy;
16819   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
16820     Ty = Context.LongTy;
16821   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
16822     Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
16823   else {
16824     llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
16825   }
16826 
16827   return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc);
16828 }
16829 
LookupStdSourceLocationImpl(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc)16830 static CXXRecordDecl *LookupStdSourceLocationImpl(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
16831   CXXRecordDecl *ImplDecl = nullptr;
16832 
16833   // Fetch the std::source_location::__impl decl.
16834   if (NamespaceDecl *Std = S.getStdNamespace()) {
16835     LookupResult ResultSL(S, &S.PP.getIdentifierTable().get("source_location"),
16836                           Loc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
16837     if (S.LookupQualifiedName(ResultSL, Std)) {
16838       if (auto *SLDecl = ResultSL.getAsSingle<RecordDecl>()) {
16839         LookupResult ResultImpl(S, &S.PP.getIdentifierTable().get("__impl"),
16840                                 Loc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
16841         if ((SLDecl->isCompleteDefinition() || SLDecl->isBeingDefined()) &&
16842             S.LookupQualifiedName(ResultImpl, SLDecl)) {
16843           ImplDecl = ResultImpl.getAsSingle<CXXRecordDecl>();
16844         }
16845       }
16846     }
16847   }
16848 
16849   if (!ImplDecl || !ImplDecl->isCompleteDefinition()) {
16850     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_std_source_location_impl_not_found);
16851     return nullptr;
16852   }
16853 
16854   // Verify that __impl is a trivial struct type, with no base classes, and with
16855   // only the four expected fields.
16856   if (ImplDecl->isUnion() || !ImplDecl->isStandardLayout() ||
16857       ImplDecl->getNumBases() != 0) {
16858     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_std_source_location_impl_malformed);
16859     return nullptr;
16860   }
16861 
16862   unsigned Count = 0;
16863   for (FieldDecl *F : ImplDecl->fields()) {
16864     StringRef Name = F->getName();
16865 
16866     if (Name == "_M_file_name") {
16867       if (F->getType() !=
16868           S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.CharTy.withConst()))
16869         break;
16870       Count++;
16871     } else if (Name == "_M_function_name") {
16872       if (F->getType() !=
16873           S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.CharTy.withConst()))
16874         break;
16875       Count++;
16876     } else if (Name == "_M_line") {
16877       if (!F->getType()->isIntegerType())
16878         break;
16879       Count++;
16880     } else if (Name == "_M_column") {
16881       if (!F->getType()->isIntegerType())
16882         break;
16883       Count++;
16884     } else {
16885       Count = 100; // invalid
16886       break;
16887     }
16888   }
16889   if (Count != 4) {
16890     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_std_source_location_impl_malformed);
16891     return nullptr;
16892   }
16893 
16894   return ImplDecl;
16895 }
16896 
ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RPLoc)16897 ExprResult Sema::ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind,
16898                                     SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16899                                     SourceLocation RPLoc) {
16900   QualType ResultTy;
16901   switch (Kind) {
16902   case SourceLocIdentKind::File:
16903   case SourceLocIdentKind::FileName:
16904   case SourceLocIdentKind::Function:
16905   case SourceLocIdentKind::FuncSig: {
16906     QualType ArrTy = Context.getStringLiteralArrayType(Context.CharTy, 0);
16907     ResultTy =
16908         Context.getPointerType(ArrTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType());
16909     break;
16910   }
16911   case SourceLocIdentKind::Line:
16912   case SourceLocIdentKind::Column:
16913     ResultTy = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
16914     break;
16915   case SourceLocIdentKind::SourceLocStruct:
16916     if (!StdSourceLocationImplDecl) {
16917       StdSourceLocationImplDecl =
16918           LookupStdSourceLocationImpl(*this, BuiltinLoc);
16919       if (!StdSourceLocationImplDecl)
16920         return ExprError();
16921     }
16922     ResultTy = Context.getPointerType(
16923         Context.getRecordType(StdSourceLocationImplDecl).withConst());
16924     break;
16925   }
16926 
16927   return BuildSourceLocExpr(Kind, ResultTy, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, CurContext);
16928 }
16929 
BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind,QualType ResultTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RPLoc,DeclContext * ParentContext)16930 ExprResult Sema::BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind, QualType ResultTy,
16931                                     SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
16932                                     SourceLocation RPLoc,
16933                                     DeclContext *ParentContext) {
16934   return new (Context)
16935       SourceLocExpr(Context, Kind, ResultTy, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, ParentContext);
16936 }
16937 
ActOnEmbedExpr(SourceLocation EmbedKeywordLoc,StringLiteral * BinaryData,StringRef FileName)16938 ExprResult Sema::ActOnEmbedExpr(SourceLocation EmbedKeywordLoc,
16939                                 StringLiteral *BinaryData, StringRef FileName) {
16940   EmbedDataStorage *Data = new (Context) EmbedDataStorage;
16941   Data->BinaryData = BinaryData;
16942   Data->FileName = FileName;
16943   return new (Context)
16944       EmbedExpr(Context, EmbedKeywordLoc, Data, /*NumOfElements=*/0,
16945                 Data->getDataElementCount());
16946 }
16947 
maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema & S,QualType DstType,const Expr * SrcExpr)16948 static bool maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema &S, QualType DstType,
16949                                               const Expr *SrcExpr) {
16950   if (!DstType->isFunctionPointerType() ||
16951       !SrcExpr->getType()->isFunctionType())
16952     return false;
16953 
16954   auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
16955   if (!DRE)
16956     return false;
16957 
16958   auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
16959   if (!FD)
16960     return false;
16961 
16962   return !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD,
16963                                               /*Complain=*/true,
16964                                               SrcExpr->getBeginLoc());
16965 }
16966 
DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,SourceLocation Loc,QualType DstType,QualType SrcType,Expr * SrcExpr,AssignmentAction Action,bool * Complained)16967 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
16968                                     SourceLocation Loc,
16969                                     QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
16970                                     Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
16971                                     bool *Complained) {
16972   if (Complained)
16973     *Complained = false;
16974 
16975   // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
16976   bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
16977   bool isInvalid = false;
16978   unsigned DiagKind = 0;
16979   ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
16980   bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
16981   bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false;
16982   const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
16983   const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr;
16984 
16985   switch (ConvTy) {
16986   case AssignConvertType::Compatible:
16987     DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr);
16988     return false;
16989   case AssignConvertType::CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr:
16990     // Still a valid conversion, but we may want to diagnose for C++
16991     // compatibility reasons.
16992     DiagKind = diag::warn_compatible_implicit_pointer_conv;
16993     break;
16994   case AssignConvertType::PointerToInt:
16995     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16996       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
16997       isInvalid = true;
16998     } else {
16999       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
17000     }
17001     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17002     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17003     break;
17004   case AssignConvertType::IntToPointer:
17005     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17006       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
17007       isInvalid = true;
17008     } else {
17009       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
17010     }
17011     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17012     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17013     break;
17014   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointerStrict:
17015     DiagKind =
17016         diag::warn_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer_strict;
17017     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17018     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17019     break;
17020   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleFunctionPointer:
17021     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17022       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer;
17023       isInvalid = true;
17024     } else {
17025       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer;
17026     }
17027     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17028     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17029     break;
17030   case AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer:
17031     if (Action == AssignmentAction::Passing_CFAudited) {
17032       DiagKind = diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
17033     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17034       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
17035       isInvalid = true;
17036     } else {
17037       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
17038     }
17039     CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
17040       SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
17041     if (CheckInferredResultType) {
17042       SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType();
17043       DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType();
17044     } else {
17045       ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17046     }
17047     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17048     break;
17049   case AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerSign:
17050     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17051       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
17052       isInvalid = true;
17053     } else {
17054       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
17055     }
17056     break;
17057   case AssignConvertType::FunctionVoidPointer:
17058     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17059       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
17060       isInvalid = true;
17061     } else {
17062       DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
17063     }
17064     break;
17065   case AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
17066     // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
17067     if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
17068 
17069     isInvalid = true;
17070 
17071     Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
17072     Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
17073     if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
17074       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
17075       break;
17076     } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
17077       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
17078       break;
17079     } else if (!lhq.getPointerAuth().isEquivalent(rhq.getPointerAuth())) {
17080       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ptrauth;
17081       break;
17082     }
17083 
17084     llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
17085     // fallthrough
17086   }
17087   case AssignConvertType::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
17088     // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
17089     // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
17090     // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2).  FIXME:
17091     // Ideally, this check would be performed in
17092     // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
17093     // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
17094     // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
17095     // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
17096     // C++ semantics.
17097     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
17098         IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
17099       return false;
17100     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17101       DiagKind =  diag::err_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
17102       isInvalid = true;
17103     } else {
17104       DiagKind =  diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
17105     }
17106 
17107     break;
17108   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
17109     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17110       isInvalid = true;
17111       DiagKind = diag::err_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
17112     } else {
17113       DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
17114     }
17115     break;
17116   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch:
17117     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_nested_address_space;
17118     isInvalid = true;
17119     break;
17120   case AssignConvertType::IntToBlockPointer:
17121     DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
17122     isInvalid = true;
17123     break;
17124   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleBlockPointer:
17125     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
17126     isInvalid = true;
17127     break;
17128   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: {
17129     if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
17130       const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT =
17131                 SrcType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
17132       for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) {
17133         PDecl = srcProto;
17134         break;
17135       }
17136       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
17137             DstType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
17138         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
17139     }
17140     else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
17141       const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT =
17142         DstType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
17143       for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) {
17144         PDecl = dstProto;
17145         break;
17146       }
17147       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
17148             SrcType->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
17149         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
17150     }
17151     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17152       DiagKind = diag::err_incompatible_qualified_id;
17153       isInvalid = true;
17154     } else {
17155       DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
17156     }
17157     break;
17158   }
17159   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleVectors:
17160     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17161       DiagKind = diag::err_incompatible_vectors;
17162       isInvalid = true;
17163     } else {
17164       DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
17165     }
17166     break;
17167   case AssignConvertType::IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
17168     DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
17169     isInvalid = true;
17170     break;
17171   case AssignConvertType::Incompatible:
17172     if (maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(*this, DstType, SrcExpr)) {
17173       if (Complained)
17174         *Complained = true;
17175       return true;
17176     }
17177 
17178     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
17179     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
17180     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
17181     isInvalid = true;
17182     MayHaveFunctionDiff = true;
17183     break;
17184   }
17185 
17186   QualType FirstType, SecondType;
17187   switch (Action) {
17188   case AssignmentAction::Assigning:
17189   case AssignmentAction::Initializing:
17190     // The destination type comes first.
17191     FirstType = DstType;
17192     SecondType = SrcType;
17193     break;
17194 
17195   case AssignmentAction::Returning:
17196   case AssignmentAction::Passing:
17197   case AssignmentAction::Passing_CFAudited:
17198   case AssignmentAction::Converting:
17199   case AssignmentAction::Sending:
17200   case AssignmentAction::Casting:
17201     // The source type comes first.
17202     FirstType = SrcType;
17203     SecondType = DstType;
17204     break;
17205   }
17206 
17207   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
17208   AssignmentAction ActionForDiag = Action;
17209   if (Action == AssignmentAction::Passing_CFAudited)
17210     ActionForDiag = AssignmentAction::Passing;
17211 
17212   FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << ActionForDiag
17213         << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
17214 
17215   if (DiagKind == diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign ||
17216       DiagKind == diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign) {
17217     auto isPlainChar = [](const clang::Type *Type) {
17218       return Type->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
17219              Type->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U);
17220     };
17221     FDiag << (isPlainChar(FirstType->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()) ||
17222               isPlainChar(SecondType->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()));
17223   }
17224 
17225   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
17226   if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
17227     for (FixItHint &H : ConvHints.Hints)
17228       FDiag << H;
17229   }
17230 
17231   if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
17232 
17233   if (MayHaveFunctionDiff)
17234     HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType);
17235 
17236   Diag(Loc, FDiag);
17237   if ((DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id ||
17238        DiagKind == diag::err_incompatible_qualified_id) &&
17239       PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition())
17240     Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id)
17241         << IFace << PDecl;
17242 
17243   if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy)
17244     NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression,
17245                               FirstType, /*TakingAddress=*/true);
17246 
17247   if (CheckInferredResultType)
17248     ObjC().EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
17249 
17250   if (Action == AssignmentAction::Returning &&
17251       ConvTy == AssignConvertType::IncompatiblePointer)
17252     ObjC().EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType);
17253 
17254   if (Complained)
17255     *Complained = true;
17256   return isInvalid;
17257 }
17258 
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result,AllowFoldKind CanFold)17259 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
17260                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result,
17261                                                  AllowFoldKind CanFold) {
17262   class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
17263   public:
17264     SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICEType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
17265                                              QualType T) override {
17266       return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral)
17267              << T << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
17268     }
17269     SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) override {
17270       return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
17271     }
17272   } Diagnoser;
17273 
17274   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, CanFold);
17275 }
17276 
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result,unsigned DiagID,AllowFoldKind CanFold)17277 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
17278                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result,
17279                                                  unsigned DiagID,
17280                                                  AllowFoldKind CanFold) {
17281   class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
17282     unsigned DiagID;
17283 
17284   public:
17285     IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID)
17286       : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { }
17287 
17288     SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) override {
17289       return S.Diag(Loc, DiagID);
17290     }
17291   } Diagnoser(DiagID);
17292 
17293   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, CanFold);
17294 }
17295 
17296 Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder
diagnoseNotICEType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,QualType T)17297 Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseNotICEType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
17298                                              QualType T) {
17299   return diagnoseNotICE(S, Loc);
17300 }
17301 
17302 Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder
diagnoseFold(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc)17303 Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
17304   return S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
17305 }
17306 
17307 ExprResult
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result,VerifyICEDiagnoser & Diagnoser,AllowFoldKind CanFold)17308 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result,
17309                                       VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
17310                                       AllowFoldKind CanFold) {
17311   SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getBeginLoc();
17312 
17313   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
17314     // C++11 [expr.const]p5:
17315     //   If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an
17316     //   integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall
17317     //   have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or
17318     //   unscoped enumeration type
17319     ExprResult Converted;
17320     class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser {
17321       VerifyICEDiagnoser &BaseDiagnoser;
17322     public:
17323       CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(VerifyICEDiagnoser &BaseDiagnoser)
17324           : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/ false,
17325                                 BaseDiagnoser.Suppress, true),
17326             BaseDiagnoser(BaseDiagnoser) {}
17327 
17328       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
17329                                            QualType T) override {
17330         return BaseDiagnoser.diagnoseNotICEType(S, Loc, T);
17331       }
17332 
17333       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(
17334           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
17335         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T;
17336       }
17337 
17338       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(
17339           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
17340         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy;
17341       }
17342 
17343       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(
17344           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
17345         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
17346                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
17347       }
17348 
17349       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(
17350           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
17351         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T;
17352       }
17353 
17354       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(
17355           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
17356         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
17357                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
17358       }
17359 
17360       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(
17361           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
17362         llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted");
17363       }
17364     } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser);
17365 
17366     Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E,
17367                                                     ConvertDiagnoser);
17368     if (Converted.isInvalid())
17369       return Converted;
17370     E = Converted.get();
17371     // The 'explicit' case causes us to get a RecoveryExpr.  Give up here so we
17372     // don't try to evaluate it later. We also don't want to return the
17373     // RecoveryExpr here, as it results in this call succeeding, thus callers of
17374     // this function will attempt to use 'Value'.
17375     if (isa<RecoveryExpr>(E))
17376       return ExprError();
17377     if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
17378       return ExprError();
17379   } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
17380     // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type.
17381     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
17382       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICEType(*this, DiagLoc, E->getType())
17383           << E->getSourceRange();
17384     return ExprError();
17385   }
17386 
17387   ExprResult RValueExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(E);
17388   if (RValueExpr.isInvalid())
17389     return ExprError();
17390 
17391   E = RValueExpr.get();
17392 
17393   // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice
17394   // in the non-ICE case.
17395   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
17396     SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
17397     if (Result)
17398       *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstIntCheckOverflow(Context, &Notes);
17399     if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E))
17400       E = Result ? ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E, APValue(*Result))
17401                  : ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E);
17402 
17403     if (Notes.empty())
17404       return E;
17405 
17406     // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
17407     // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
17408     // redundant note.
17409     if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
17410           diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
17411       DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
17412       Notes.clear();
17413     }
17414 
17415     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17416       if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
17417         Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc) << E->getSourceRange();
17418         for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
17419           Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
17420       }
17421       return ExprError();
17422     }
17423 
17424     Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc) << E->getSourceRange();
17425     for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
17426       Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
17427 
17428     return E;
17429   }
17430 
17431   Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
17432   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
17433   EvalResult.Diag = &Notes;
17434 
17435   // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's
17436   // not a constant expression as a side-effect.
17437   bool Folded =
17438       E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context, /*isConstantContext*/ true) &&
17439       EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects &&
17440       (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !EvalResult.HasUndefinedBehavior);
17441 
17442   if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E))
17443     E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E, EvalResult.Val);
17444 
17445   // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression
17446   // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then
17447   // this is a constant expression.
17448   if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) {
17449     if (Result)
17450       *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
17451     return E;
17452   }
17453 
17454   // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
17455   // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
17456   // redundant note.
17457   if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
17458         diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
17459     DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
17460     Notes.clear();
17461   }
17462 
17463   if (!Folded || CanFold == AllowFoldKind::No) {
17464     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
17465       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc) << E->getSourceRange();
17466       for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
17467         Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
17468     }
17469 
17470     return ExprError();
17471   }
17472 
17473   Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc) << E->getSourceRange();
17474   for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes)
17475     Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
17476 
17477   if (Result)
17478     *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
17479   return E;
17480 }
17481 
17482 namespace {
17483   // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively
17484   // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated.
17485   class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> {
17486     typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform;
17487 
17488   public:
TransformToPE(Sema & SemaRef)17489     TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { }
17490 
17491     // Make sure we redo semantic analysis
AlwaysRebuild()17492     bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
ReplacingOriginal()17493     bool ReplacingOriginal() { return true; }
17494 
17495     // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which
17496     // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming
17497     // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST.
17498     // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this
17499     // case?
17500     //
17501     // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls.
TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr * E)17502     ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
17503       if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) &&
17504           !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
17505         return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(),
17506                             diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
17507             << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
17508 
17509       return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E);
17510     }
17511 
17512     // Exception: filter out member pointer formation
TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator * E)17513     ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
17514       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType())
17515         return E;
17516 
17517       return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E);
17518     }
17519 
17520     // The body of a lambda-expression is in a separate expression evaluation
17521     // context so never needs to be transformed.
17522     // FIXME: Ideally we wouldn't transform the closure type either, and would
17523     // just recreate the capture expressions and lambda expression.
TransformLambdaBody(LambdaExpr * E,Stmt * Body)17524     StmtResult TransformLambdaBody(LambdaExpr *E, Stmt *Body) {
17525       return SkipLambdaBody(E, Body);
17526     }
17527   };
17528 }
17529 
TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr * E)17530 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) {
17531   assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
17532          "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
17533   ExprEvalContexts.back().Context =
17534       ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context;
17535   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
17536     return E;
17537   return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E);
17538 }
17539 
TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(TypeSourceInfo * TInfo)17540 TypeSourceInfo *Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
17541   assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
17542          "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
17543   ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = parentEvaluationContext().Context;
17544   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
17545     return TInfo;
17546   return TransformToPE(*this).TransformType(TInfo);
17547 }
17548 
17549 void
PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,Decl * LambdaContextDecl,ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext)17550 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
17551     ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl,
17552     ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) {
17553   ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), Cleanup,
17554                                 LambdaContextDecl, ExprContext);
17555 
17556   // Discarded statements and immediate contexts nested in other
17557   // discarded statements or immediate context are themselves
17558   // a discarded statement or an immediate context, respectively.
17559   ExprEvalContexts.back().InDiscardedStatement =
17560       parentEvaluationContext().isDiscardedStatementContext();
17561 
17562   // C++23 [expr.const]/p15
17563   // An expression or conversion is in an immediate function context if [...]
17564   // it is a subexpression of a manifestly constant-evaluated expression or
17565   // conversion.
17566   const auto &Prev = parentEvaluationContext();
17567   ExprEvalContexts.back().InImmediateFunctionContext =
17568       Prev.isImmediateFunctionContext() || Prev.isConstantEvaluated();
17569 
17570   ExprEvalContexts.back().InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext =
17571       Prev.InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext;
17572 
17573   Cleanup.reset();
17574   if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty())
17575     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
17576 }
17577 
17578 void
PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext)17579 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
17580     ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
17581     ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) {
17582   Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl;
17583   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, ExprContext);
17584 }
17585 
PushExpressionEvaluationContextForFunction(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,FunctionDecl * FD)17586 void Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContextForFunction(
17587     ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, FunctionDecl *FD) {
17588   // [expr.const]/p14.1
17589   // An expression or conversion is in an immediate function context if it is
17590   // potentially evaluated and either: its innermost enclosing non-block scope
17591   // is a function parameter scope of an immediate function.
17592   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
17593       FD && FD->isConsteval()
17594           ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext
17595           : NewContext);
17596   const Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Parent =
17597       parentEvaluationContext();
17598   Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Current = currentEvaluationContext();
17599 
17600   Current.InDiscardedStatement = false;
17601 
17602   if (FD) {
17603 
17604     // Each ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord also keeps track of whether the
17605     // context is nested in an immediate function context, so smaller contexts
17606     // that appear inside immediate functions (like variable initializers) are
17607     // considered to be inside an immediate function context even though by
17608     // themselves they are not immediate function contexts. But when a new
17609     // function is entered, we need to reset this tracking, since the entered
17610     // function might be not an immediate function.
17611 
17612     Current.InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext =
17613         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && FD->isImmediateEscalating();
17614 
17615     if (isLambdaMethod(FD))
17616       Current.InImmediateFunctionContext =
17617           FD->isConsteval() ||
17618           (isLambdaMethod(FD) && (Parent.isConstantEvaluated() ||
17619                                   Parent.isImmediateFunctionContext()));
17620     else
17621       Current.InImmediateFunctionContext = FD->isConsteval();
17622   }
17623 }
17624 
17625 namespace {
17626 
CheckPossibleDeref(Sema & S,const Expr * PossibleDeref)17627 const DeclRefExpr *CheckPossibleDeref(Sema &S, const Expr *PossibleDeref) {
17628   PossibleDeref = PossibleDeref->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
17629   if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(PossibleDeref)) {
17630     if (E->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
17631       return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getSubExpr());
17632   } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
17633     return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase());
17634   } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
17635     return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase());
17636   } else if (const auto E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(PossibleDeref)) {
17637     QualType Inner;
17638     QualType Ty = E->getType();
17639     if (const auto *Ptr = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
17640       Inner = Ptr->getPointeeType();
17641     else if (const auto *Arr = S.Context.getAsArrayType(Ty))
17642       Inner = Arr->getElementType();
17643     else
17644       return nullptr;
17645 
17646     if (Inner->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref))
17647       return E;
17648   }
17649   return nullptr;
17650 }
17651 
17652 } // namespace
17653 
WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & Rec)17654 void Sema::WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec) {
17655   for (const Expr *E : Rec.PossibleDerefs) {
17656     const DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = CheckPossibleDeref(*this, E);
17657     if (DeclRef) {
17658       const ValueDecl *Decl = DeclRef->getDecl();
17659       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type)
17660           << Decl->getName() << E->getSourceRange();
17661       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Decl->getName();
17662     } else {
17663       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type_no_decl)
17664           << E->getSourceRange();
17665     }
17666   }
17667   Rec.PossibleDerefs.clear();
17668 }
17669 
CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment(Expr * E)17670 void Sema::CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment(Expr *E) {
17671   if (!E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
17672     return;
17673 
17674   // Note: ignoring parens here is not justified by the standard rules, but
17675   // ignoring parentheses seems like a more reasonable approach, and this only
17676   // drives a deprecation warning so doesn't affect conformance.
17677   if (auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
17678     if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Assign) {
17679       auto &LHSs = ExprEvalContexts.back().VolatileAssignmentLHSs;
17680       llvm::erase(LHSs, BO->getLHS());
17681     }
17682   }
17683 }
17684 
MarkExpressionAsImmediateEscalating(Expr * E)17685 void Sema::MarkExpressionAsImmediateEscalating(Expr *E) {
17686   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 &&
17687          ExprEvalContexts.back().InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext &&
17688          "Cannot mark an immediate escalating expression outside of an "
17689          "immediate escalating context");
17690   if (auto *Call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E->IgnoreImplicit());
17691       Call && Call->getCallee()) {
17692     if (auto *DeclRef =
17693             dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Call->getCallee()->IgnoreImplicit()))
17694       DeclRef->setIsImmediateEscalating(true);
17695   } else if (auto *Ctr = dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(E->IgnoreImplicit())) {
17696     Ctr->setIsImmediateEscalating(true);
17697   } else if (auto *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreImplicit())) {
17698     DeclRef->setIsImmediateEscalating(true);
17699   } else {
17700     assert(false && "expected an immediately escalating expression");
17701   }
17702   if (FunctionScopeInfo *FI = getCurFunction())
17703     FI->FoundImmediateEscalatingExpression = true;
17704 }
17705 
CheckForImmediateInvocation(ExprResult E,FunctionDecl * Decl)17706 ExprResult Sema::CheckForImmediateInvocation(ExprResult E, FunctionDecl *Decl) {
17707   if (isUnevaluatedContext() || !E.isUsable() || !Decl ||
17708       !Decl->isImmediateFunction() || isAlwaysConstantEvaluatedContext() ||
17709       isCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer() ||
17710       RebuildingImmediateInvocation || isImmediateFunctionContext())
17711     return E;
17712 
17713   /// Opportunistically remove the callee from ReferencesToConsteval if we can.
17714   /// It's OK if this fails; we'll also remove this in
17715   /// HandleImmediateInvocations, but catching it here allows us to avoid
17716   /// walking the AST looking for it in simple cases.
17717   if (auto *Call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E.get()->IgnoreImplicit()))
17718     if (auto *DeclRef =
17719             dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Call->getCallee()->IgnoreImplicit()))
17720       ExprEvalContexts.back().ReferenceToConsteval.erase(DeclRef);
17721 
17722   // C++23 [expr.const]/p16
17723   // An expression or conversion is immediate-escalating if it is not initially
17724   // in an immediate function context and it is [...] an immediate invocation
17725   // that is not a constant expression and is not a subexpression of an
17726   // immediate invocation.
17727   APValue Cached;
17728   auto CheckConstantExpressionAndKeepResult = [&]() {
17729     llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
17730     Expr::EvalResult Eval;
17731     Eval.Diag = &Notes;
17732     bool Res = E.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(
17733         Eval, getASTContext(), ConstantExprKind::ImmediateInvocation);
17734     if (Res && Notes.empty()) {
17735       Cached = std::move(Eval.Val);
17736       return true;
17737     }
17738     return false;
17739   };
17740 
17741   if (!E.get()->isValueDependent() &&
17742       ExprEvalContexts.back().InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext &&
17743       !CheckConstantExpressionAndKeepResult()) {
17744     MarkExpressionAsImmediateEscalating(E.get());
17745     return E;
17746   }
17747 
17748   if (Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups()) {
17749     // Since an immediate invocation is a full expression itself - it requires
17750     // an additional ExprWithCleanups node, but it can participate to a bigger
17751     // full expression which actually requires cleanups to be run after so
17752     // create ExprWithCleanups without using MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups as it
17753     // may discard cleanups for outer expression too early.
17754 
17755     // Note that ExprWithCleanups created here must always have empty cleanup
17756     // objects:
17757     // - compound literals do not create cleanup objects in C++ and immediate
17758     // invocations are C++-only.
17759     // - blocks are not allowed inside constant expressions and compiler will
17760     // issue an error if they appear there.
17761     //
17762     // Hence, in correct code any cleanup objects created inside current
17763     // evaluation context must be outside the immediate invocation.
17764     E = ExprWithCleanups::Create(getASTContext(), E.get(),
17765                                  Cleanup.cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), {});
17766   }
17767 
17768   ConstantExpr *Res = ConstantExpr::Create(
17769       getASTContext(), E.get(),
17770       ConstantExpr::getStorageKind(Decl->getReturnType().getTypePtr(),
17771                                    getASTContext()),
17772       /*IsImmediateInvocation*/ true);
17773   if (Cached.hasValue())
17774     Res->MoveIntoResult(Cached, getASTContext());
17775   /// Value-dependent constant expressions should not be immediately
17776   /// evaluated until they are instantiated.
17777   if (!Res->isValueDependent())
17778     ExprEvalContexts.back().ImmediateInvocationCandidates.emplace_back(Res, 0);
17779   return Res;
17780 }
17781 
EvaluateAndDiagnoseImmediateInvocation(Sema & SemaRef,Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate Candidate)17782 static void EvaluateAndDiagnoseImmediateInvocation(
17783     Sema &SemaRef, Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate Candidate) {
17784   llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
17785   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
17786   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
17787   ConstantExpr *CE = Candidate.getPointer();
17788   bool Result = CE->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(
17789       Eval, SemaRef.getASTContext(), ConstantExprKind::ImmediateInvocation);
17790   if (!Result || !Notes.empty()) {
17791     SemaRef.FailedImmediateInvocations.insert(CE);
17792     Expr *InnerExpr = CE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicit();
17793     if (auto *FunctionalCast = dyn_cast<CXXFunctionalCastExpr>(InnerExpr))
17794       InnerExpr = FunctionalCast->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicit();
17795     FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr;
17796     if (auto *Call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(InnerExpr))
17797       FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(Call->getCalleeDecl());
17798     else if (auto *Call = dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(InnerExpr))
17799       FD = Call->getConstructor();
17800     else if (auto *Cast = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(InnerExpr))
17801       FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(Cast->getConversionFunction());
17802 
17803     assert(FD && FD->isImmediateFunction() &&
17804            "could not find an immediate function in this expression");
17805     if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
17806       return;
17807     SemaRef.Diag(CE->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_invalid_consteval_call)
17808         << FD << FD->isConsteval();
17809     if (auto Context =
17810             SemaRef.InnermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations()) {
17811       SemaRef.Diag(Context->Loc, diag::note_invalid_consteval_initializer)
17812           << Context->Decl;
17813       SemaRef.Diag(Context->Decl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_declared_at);
17814     }
17815     if (!FD->isConsteval())
17816       SemaRef.DiagnoseImmediateEscalatingReason(FD);
17817     for (auto &Note : Notes)
17818       SemaRef.Diag(Note.first, Note.second);
17819     return;
17820   }
17821   CE->MoveIntoResult(Eval.Val, SemaRef.getASTContext());
17822 }
17823 
RemoveNestedImmediateInvocation(Sema & SemaRef,Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & Rec,SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate,4>::reverse_iterator It)17824 static void RemoveNestedImmediateInvocation(
17825     Sema &SemaRef, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec,
17826     SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate, 4>::reverse_iterator It) {
17827   struct ComplexRemove : TreeTransform<ComplexRemove> {
17828     using Base = TreeTransform<ComplexRemove>;
17829     llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<DeclRefExpr *> &DRSet;
17830     SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate, 4> &IISet;
17831     SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate, 4>::reverse_iterator
17832         CurrentII;
17833     ComplexRemove(Sema &SemaRef, llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<DeclRefExpr *> &DR,
17834                   SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate, 4> &II,
17835                   SmallVector<Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate,
17836                               4>::reverse_iterator Current)
17837         : Base(SemaRef), DRSet(DR), IISet(II), CurrentII(Current) {}
17838     void RemoveImmediateInvocation(ConstantExpr* E) {
17839       auto It = std::find_if(CurrentII, IISet.rend(),
17840                              [E](Sema::ImmediateInvocationCandidate Elem) {
17841                                return Elem.getPointer() == E;
17842                              });
17843       // It is possible that some subexpression of the current immediate
17844       // invocation was handled from another expression evaluation context. Do
17845       // not handle the current immediate invocation if some of its
17846       // subexpressions failed before.
17847       if (It == IISet.rend()) {
17848         if (SemaRef.FailedImmediateInvocations.contains(E))
17849           CurrentII->setInt(1);
17850       } else {
17851         It->setInt(1); // Mark as deleted
17852       }
17853     }
17854     ExprResult TransformConstantExpr(ConstantExpr *E) {
17855       if (!E->isImmediateInvocation())
17856         return Base::TransformConstantExpr(E);
17857       RemoveImmediateInvocation(E);
17858       return Base::TransformExpr(E->getSubExpr());
17859     }
17860     /// Base::TransfromCXXOperatorCallExpr doesn't traverse the callee so
17861     /// we need to remove its DeclRefExpr from the DRSet.
17862     ExprResult TransformCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) {
17863       DRSet.erase(cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->getCallee()->IgnoreImplicit()));
17864       return Base::TransformCXXOperatorCallExpr(E);
17865     }
17866     /// Base::TransformUserDefinedLiteral doesn't preserve the
17867     /// UserDefinedLiteral node.
17868     ExprResult TransformUserDefinedLiteral(UserDefinedLiteral *E) { return E; }
17869     /// Base::TransformInitializer skips ConstantExpr so we need to visit them
17870     /// here.
17871     ExprResult TransformInitializer(Expr *Init, bool NotCopyInit) {
17872       if (!Init)
17873         return Init;
17874 
17875       // We cannot use IgnoreImpCasts because we need to preserve
17876       // full expressions.
17877       while (true) {
17878         if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Init))
17879           Init = ICE->getSubExpr();
17880         else if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init))
17881           Init = ICE->getSubExpr();
17882         else
17883           break;
17884       }
17885       /// ConstantExprs are the first layer of implicit node to be removed so if
17886       /// Init isn't a ConstantExpr, no ConstantExpr will be skipped.
17887       if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init);
17888           CE && CE->isImmediateInvocation())
17889         RemoveImmediateInvocation(CE);
17890       return Base::TransformInitializer(Init, NotCopyInit);
17891     }
17892     ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
17893       DRSet.erase(E);
17894       return E;
17895     }
17896     ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) {
17897       // Do not rebuild lambdas to avoid creating a new type.
17898       // Lambdas have already been processed inside their eval contexts.
17899       return E;
17900     }
17901     bool AlwaysRebuild() { return false; }
17902     bool ReplacingOriginal() { return true; }
17903     bool AllowSkippingCXXConstructExpr() {
17904       bool Res = AllowSkippingFirstCXXConstructExpr;
17905       AllowSkippingFirstCXXConstructExpr = true;
17906       return Res;
17907     }
17908     bool AllowSkippingFirstCXXConstructExpr = true;
17909   } Transformer(SemaRef, Rec.ReferenceToConsteval,
17910                 Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates, It);
17911 
17912   /// CXXConstructExpr with a single argument are getting skipped by
17913   /// TreeTransform in some situtation because they could be implicit. This
17914   /// can only occur for the top-level CXXConstructExpr because it is used
17915   /// nowhere in the expression being transformed therefore will not be rebuilt.
17916   /// Setting AllowSkippingFirstCXXConstructExpr to false will prevent from
17917   /// skipping the first CXXConstructExpr.
17918   if (isa<CXXConstructExpr>(It->getPointer()->IgnoreImplicit()))
17919     Transformer.AllowSkippingFirstCXXConstructExpr = false;
17920 
17921   ExprResult Res = Transformer.TransformExpr(It->getPointer()->getSubExpr());
17922   // The result may not be usable in case of previous compilation errors.
17923   // In this case evaluation of the expression may result in crash so just
17924   // don't do anything further with the result.
17925   if (Res.isUsable()) {
17926     Res = SemaRef.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Res);
17927     It->getPointer()->setSubExpr(Res.get());
17928   }
17929 }
17930 
17931 static void
HandleImmediateInvocations(Sema & SemaRef,Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & Rec)17932 HandleImmediateInvocations(Sema &SemaRef,
17933                            Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec) {
17934   if ((Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.size() == 0 &&
17935        Rec.ReferenceToConsteval.size() == 0) ||
17936       Rec.isImmediateFunctionContext() || SemaRef.RebuildingImmediateInvocation)
17937     return;
17938 
17939   // An expression or conversion is 'manifestly constant-evaluated' if it is:
17940   // [...]
17941   // - the initializer of a variable that is usable in constant expressions or
17942   //   has constant initialization.
17943   if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus23 &&
17944       Rec.ExprContext ==
17945           Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_VariableInit) {
17946     auto *VD = cast<VarDecl>(Rec.ManglingContextDecl);
17947     if (VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context) ||
17948         VD->hasConstantInitialization()) {
17949       // An expression or conversion is in an 'immediate function context' if it
17950       // is potentially evaluated and either:
17951       // [...]
17952       // - it is a subexpression of a manifestly constant-evaluated expression
17953       //   or conversion.
17954       return;
17955     }
17956   }
17957 
17958   /// When we have more than 1 ImmediateInvocationCandidates or previously
17959   /// failed immediate invocations, we need to check for nested
17960   /// ImmediateInvocationCandidates in order to avoid duplicate diagnostics.
17961   /// Otherwise we only need to remove ReferenceToConsteval in the immediate
17962   /// invocation.
17963   if (Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.size() > 1 ||
17964       !SemaRef.FailedImmediateInvocations.empty()) {
17965 
17966     /// Prevent sema calls during the tree transform from adding pointers that
17967     /// are already in the sets.
17968     llvm::SaveAndRestore DisableIITracking(
17969         SemaRef.RebuildingImmediateInvocation, true);
17970 
17971     /// Prevent diagnostic during tree transfrom as they are duplicates
17972     Sema::TentativeAnalysisScope DisableDiag(SemaRef);
17973 
17974     for (auto It = Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.rbegin();
17975          It != Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.rend(); It++)
17976       if (!It->getInt())
17977         RemoveNestedImmediateInvocation(SemaRef, Rec, It);
17978   } else if (Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.size() == 1 &&
17979              Rec.ReferenceToConsteval.size()) {
17980     struct SimpleRemove : DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor {
17981       llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<DeclRefExpr *> &DRSet;
17982       SimpleRemove(llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<DeclRefExpr *> &S) : DRSet(S) {}
17983       bool VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) override {
17984         DRSet.erase(E);
17985         return DRSet.size();
17986       }
17987     } Visitor(Rec.ReferenceToConsteval);
17988     Visitor.TraverseStmt(
17989         Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates.front().getPointer()->getSubExpr());
17990   }
17991   for (auto CE : Rec.ImmediateInvocationCandidates)
17992     if (!CE.getInt())
17993       EvaluateAndDiagnoseImmediateInvocation(SemaRef, CE);
17994   for (auto *DR : Rec.ReferenceToConsteval) {
17995     // If the expression is immediate escalating, it is not an error;
17996     // The outer context itself becomes immediate and further errors,
17997     // if any, will be handled by DiagnoseImmediateEscalatingReason.
17998     if (DR->isImmediateEscalating())
17999       continue;
18000     auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DR->getDecl());
18001     const NamedDecl *ND = FD;
18002     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ND);
18003         MD && (MD->isLambdaStaticInvoker() || isLambdaCallOperator(MD)))
18004       ND = MD->getParent();
18005 
18006     // C++23 [expr.const]/p16
18007     // An expression or conversion is immediate-escalating if it is not
18008     // initially in an immediate function context and it is [...] a
18009     // potentially-evaluated id-expression that denotes an immediate function
18010     // that is not a subexpression of an immediate invocation.
18011     bool ImmediateEscalating = false;
18012     bool IsPotentiallyEvaluated =
18013         Rec.Context ==
18014             Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated ||
18015         Rec.Context ==
18016             Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed;
18017     if (SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() && IsPotentiallyEvaluated)
18018       ImmediateEscalating = Rec.InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext;
18019 
18020     if (!Rec.InImmediateEscalatingFunctionContext ||
18021         (SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() && !ImmediateEscalating)) {
18022       SemaRef.Diag(DR->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_invalid_consteval_take_address)
18023           << ND << isa<CXXRecordDecl>(ND) << FD->isConsteval();
18024       if (!FD->getBuiltinID())
18025         SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
18026       if (auto Context =
18027               SemaRef.InnermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations()) {
18028         SemaRef.Diag(Context->Loc, diag::note_invalid_consteval_initializer)
18029             << Context->Decl;
18030         SemaRef.Diag(Context->Decl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_declared_at);
18031       }
18032       if (FD->isImmediateEscalating() && !FD->isConsteval())
18033         SemaRef.DiagnoseImmediateEscalatingReason(FD);
18034 
18035     } else {
18036       SemaRef.MarkExpressionAsImmediateEscalating(DR);
18037     }
18038   }
18039 }
18040 
PopExpressionEvaluationContext()18041 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
18042   ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
18043   if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) {
18044     using ExpressionKind = ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind;
18045     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 &&
18046         (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument ||
18047          Rec.isUnevaluated() ||
18048          (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17))) {
18049       unsigned D;
18050       if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) {
18051         // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2:
18052         //   A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand
18053         //   (Clause 5).
18054         D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand;
18055       } else if (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) {
18056         // C++1y [expr.const]p2:
18057         //   A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the
18058         //   evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would
18059         //   evaluate [...] a lambda-expression.
18060         D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression;
18061       } else if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument) {
18062         // C++17 [expr.prim.lamda]p2:
18063         // A lambda-expression shall not appear [...] in a template-argument.
18064         D = diag::err_lambda_in_invalid_context;
18065       } else
18066         llvm_unreachable("Couldn't infer lambda error message.");
18067 
18068       for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas)
18069         Diag(L->getBeginLoc(), D);
18070     }
18071   }
18072 
18073   // Append the collected materialized temporaries into previous context before
18074   // exit if the previous also is a lifetime extending context.
18075   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus23 && Rec.InLifetimeExtendingContext &&
18076       parentEvaluationContext().InLifetimeExtendingContext &&
18077       !Rec.ForRangeLifetimeExtendTemps.empty()) {
18078     parentEvaluationContext().ForRangeLifetimeExtendTemps.append(
18079         Rec.ForRangeLifetimeExtendTemps);
18080   }
18081 
18082   WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(Rec);
18083   HandleImmediateInvocations(*this, Rec);
18084 
18085   // Warn on any volatile-qualified simple-assignments that are not discarded-
18086   // value expressions nor unevaluated operands (those cases get removed from
18087   // this list by CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment).
18088   for (auto *BO : Rec.VolatileAssignmentLHSs)
18089     Diag(BO->getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_simple_assign_volatile)
18090         << BO->getType();
18091 
18092   // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
18093   // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
18094   // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
18095   // will never be constructed.
18096   if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.isConstantEvaluated()) {
18097     ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects,
18098                              ExprCleanupObjects.end());
18099     Cleanup = Rec.ParentCleanup;
18100     CleanupVarDeclMarking();
18101     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
18102   // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
18103   } else {
18104     Cleanup.mergeFrom(Rec.ParentCleanup);
18105     MaybeODRUseExprs.insert_range(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
18106   }
18107 
18108   // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
18109   ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
18110 }
18111 
DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext()18112 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
18113   ExprCleanupObjects.erase(
18114          ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects,
18115          ExprCleanupObjects.end());
18116   Cleanup.reset();
18117   MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
18118 }
18119 
HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr * E)18120 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) {
18121   ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
18122   if (Result.isInvalid())
18123     return ExprError();
18124   E = Result.get();
18125   if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
18126     return E;
18127   return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
18128 }
18129 
18130 /// Are we in a context that is potentially constant evaluated per C++20
18131 /// [expr.const]p12?
isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(Sema & SemaRef)18132 static bool isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
18133   /// C++2a [expr.const]p12:
18134   //   An expression or conversion is potentially constant evaluated if it is
18135   switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
18136     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated:
18137     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext:
18138 
18139       // -- a manifestly constant-evaluated expression,
18140     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated:
18141     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
18142     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement:
18143       // -- a potentially-evaluated expression,
18144     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList:
18145       // -- an immediate subexpression of a braced-init-list,
18146 
18147       // -- [FIXME] an expression of the form & cast-expression that occurs
18148       //    within a templated entity
18149       // -- a subexpression of one of the above that is not a subexpression of
18150       // a nested unevaluated operand.
18151       return true;
18152 
18153     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated:
18154     case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract:
18155       // Expressions in this context are never evaluated.
18156       return false;
18157   }
18158   llvm_unreachable("Invalid context");
18159 }
18160 
18161 /// Return true if this function has a calling convention that requires mangling
18162 /// in the size of the parameter pack.
funcHasParameterSizeMangling(Sema & S,FunctionDecl * FD)18163 static bool funcHasParameterSizeMangling(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) {
18164   // These manglings are only applicable for targets whcih use Microsoft
18165   // mangling scheme for C.
18166   if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldUseMicrosoftCCforMangling())
18167     return false;
18168 
18169   // If this is C++ and this isn't an extern "C" function, parameters do not
18170   // need to be complete. In this case, C++ mangling will apply, which doesn't
18171   // use the size of the parameters.
18172   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->isExternC())
18173     return false;
18174 
18175   // Stdcall, fastcall, and vectorcall need this special treatment.
18176   CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
18177   switch (CC) {
18178   case CC_X86StdCall:
18179   case CC_X86FastCall:
18180   case CC_X86VectorCall:
18181     return true;
18182   default:
18183     break;
18184   }
18185   return false;
18186 }
18187 
18188 /// Require that all of the parameter types of function be complete. Normally,
18189 /// parameter types are only required to be complete when a function is called
18190 /// or defined, but to mangle functions with certain calling conventions, the
18191 /// mangler needs to know the size of the parameter list. In this situation,
18192 /// MSVC doesn't emit an error or instantiate templates. Instead, MSVC mangles
18193 /// the function as _foo@0, i.e. zero bytes of parameters, which will usually
18194 /// result in a linker error. Clang doesn't implement this behavior, and instead
18195 /// attempts to error at compile time.
CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(Sema & S,FunctionDecl * FD,SourceLocation Loc)18196 static void CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD,
18197                                                   SourceLocation Loc) {
18198   class ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser : public Sema::TypeDiagnoser {
18199     FunctionDecl *FD;
18200     ParmVarDecl *Param;
18201 
18202   public:
18203     ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param)
18204         : FD(FD), Param(Param) {}
18205 
18206     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
18207       CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
18208       StringRef CCName;
18209       switch (CC) {
18210       case CC_X86StdCall:
18211         CCName = "stdcall";
18212         break;
18213       case CC_X86FastCall:
18214         CCName = "fastcall";
18215         break;
18216       case CC_X86VectorCall:
18217         CCName = "vectorcall";
18218         break;
18219       default:
18220         llvm_unreachable("CC does not need mangling");
18221       }
18222 
18223       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_cconv_incomplete_param_type)
18224           << Param->getDeclName() << FD->getDeclName() << CCName;
18225     }
18226   };
18227 
18228   for (ParmVarDecl *Param : FD->parameters()) {
18229     ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser Diagnoser(FD, Param);
18230     S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Param->getType(), Diagnoser);
18231   }
18232 }
18233 
18234 namespace {
18235 enum class OdrUseContext {
18236   /// Declarations in this context are not odr-used.
18237   None,
18238   /// Declarations in this context are formally odr-used, but this is a
18239   /// dependent context.
18240   Dependent,
18241   /// Declarations in this context are odr-used but not actually used (yet).
18242   FormallyOdrUsed,
18243   /// Declarations in this context are used.
18244   Used
18245 };
18246 }
18247 
18248 /// Are we within a context in which references to resolved functions or to
18249 /// variables result in odr-use?
isOdrUseContext(Sema & SemaRef)18250 static OdrUseContext isOdrUseContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
18251   const Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Context =
18252       SemaRef.currentEvaluationContext();
18253 
18254   if (Context.isUnevaluated())
18255     return OdrUseContext::None;
18256 
18257   if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext())
18258     return OdrUseContext::Dependent;
18259 
18260   if (Context.isDiscardedStatementContext())
18261     return OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
18262 
18263   else if (Context.Context ==
18264            Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed)
18265     return OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
18266 
18267   return OdrUseContext::Used;
18268 }
18269 
isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl * Func)18270 static bool isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl *Func) {
18271   if (!Func->isConstexpr())
18272     return false;
18273 
18274   if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() || !Func->isUserProvided())
18275     return true;
18276 
18277   // Lambda conversion operators are never user provided.
18278   if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Func))
18279     return isLambdaConversionOperator(Conv);
18280 
18281   auto *CCD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func);
18282   return CCD && CCD->getInheritedConstructor();
18283 }
18284 
MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,FunctionDecl * Func,bool MightBeOdrUse)18285 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func,
18286                                   bool MightBeOdrUse) {
18287   assert(Func && "No function?");
18288 
18289   Func->setReferenced();
18290 
18291   // Recursive functions aren't really used until they're used from some other
18292   // context.
18293   bool IsRecursiveCall = CurContext == Func;
18294 
18295   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3:
18296   //   A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is
18297   //   odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a
18298   //   set of overloaded functions [...].
18299   //
18300   // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we
18301   // can just check that here.
18302   OdrUseContext OdrUse =
18303       MightBeOdrUse ? isOdrUseContext(*this) : OdrUseContext::None;
18304   if (IsRecursiveCall && OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used)
18305     OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
18306 
18307   // Trivial default constructors and destructors are never actually used.
18308   // FIXME: What about other special members?
18309   if (Func->isTrivial() && !Func->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() &&
18310       OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used) {
18311     if (auto *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func))
18312       if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor())
18313         OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
18314     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func))
18315       OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed;
18316   }
18317 
18318   // C++20 [expr.const]p12:
18319   //   A function [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a
18320   //   constexpr function that is named by an expression that is potentially
18321   //   constant evaluated
18322   bool NeededForConstantEvaluation =
18323       isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(*this) &&
18324       isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(Func);
18325 
18326   // Determine whether we require a function definition to exist, per
18327   // C++11 [temp.inst]p3:
18328   //   Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly
18329   //   instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template
18330   //   specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is
18331   //   referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist.
18332   // C++20 [temp.inst]p7:
18333   //   The existence of a definition of a [...] function is considered to
18334   //   affect the semantics of the program if the [...] function is needed for
18335   //   constant evaluation by an expression
18336   // C++20 [basic.def.odr]p10:
18337   //   Every program shall contain exactly one definition of every non-inline
18338   //   function or variable that is odr-used in that program outside of a
18339   //   discarded statement
18340   // C++20 [special]p1:
18341   //   The implementation will implicitly define [defaulted special members]
18342   //   if they are odr-used or needed for constant evaluation.
18343   //
18344   // Note that we skip the implicit instantiation of templates that are only
18345   // used in unused default arguments or by recursive calls to themselves.
18346   // This is formally non-conforming, but seems reasonable in practice.
18347   bool NeedDefinition =
18348       !IsRecursiveCall &&
18349       (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used ||
18350        (NeededForConstantEvaluation && !Func->isPureVirtual()));
18351 
18352   // C++14 [temp.expl.spec]p6:
18353   //   If a template [...] is explicitly specialized then that specialization
18354   //   shall be declared before the first use of that specialization that would
18355   //   cause an implicit instantiation to take place, in every translation unit
18356   //   in which such a use occurs
18357   if (NeedDefinition &&
18358       (Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_Undeclared ||
18359        Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()))
18360     checkSpecializationReachability(Loc, Func);
18361 
18362   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
18363     CUDA().CheckCall(Loc, Func);
18364 
18365   // If we need a definition, try to create one.
18366   if (NeedDefinition && !Func->getBody()) {
18367     runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] {
18368       if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
18369               dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
18370         Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl());
18371         if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) {
18372           if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
18373             if (Constructor->isTrivial() &&
18374                 !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
18375               return;
18376             DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
18377           } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
18378             DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
18379           } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
18380             DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
18381           }
18382         } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) {
18383           DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
18384         }
18385       } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
18386                      dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
18387         Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl());
18388         if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) {
18389           if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
18390             return;
18391           DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
18392         }
18393         if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
18394           MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
18395       } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) {
18396         if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
18397             MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
18398           MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
18399           if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) {
18400             if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
18401               DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
18402             else if (MethodDecl->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
18403               DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
18404           }
18405         } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) &&
18406                    MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) {
18407           CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
18408               cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
18409           if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion())
18410             DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
18411           else
18412             DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
18413         } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
18414           MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
18415       }
18416 
18417       if (Func->isDefaulted() && !Func->isDeleted()) {
18418         DefaultedComparisonKind DCK = getDefaultedComparisonKind(Func);
18419         if (DCK != DefaultedComparisonKind::None)
18420           DefineDefaultedComparison(Loc, Func, DCK);
18421       }
18422 
18423       // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
18424       // class templates.
18425       if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
18426         TemplateSpecializationKind TSK =
18427             Func->getTemplateSpecializationKindForInstantiation();
18428         SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Func->getPointOfInstantiation();
18429         bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid();
18430         if (FirstInstantiation) {
18431           PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
18432           if (auto *MSI = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
18433             MSI->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
18434             // FIXME: Notify listener.
18435           else
18436             Func->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation);
18437         } else if (TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
18438           // Use the point of use as the point of instantiation, instead of the
18439           // point of explicit instantiation (which we track as the actual point
18440           // of instantiation). This gives better backtraces in diagnostics.
18441           PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
18442         }
18443 
18444         if (FirstInstantiation || TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
18445             Func->isConstexpr()) {
18446           if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) &&
18447               cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() &&
18448               CodeSynthesisContexts.size())
18449             PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(
18450                 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
18451           else if (Func->isConstexpr())
18452             // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the
18453             // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a
18454             // call to such a function.
18455             InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func);
18456           else {
18457             Func->setInstantiationIsPending(true);
18458             PendingInstantiations.push_back(
18459                 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
18460             if (llvm::isTimeTraceVerbose()) {
18461               llvm::timeTraceAddInstantEvent("DeferInstantiation", [&] {
18462                 std::string Name;
18463                 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Name);
18464                 Func->getNameForDiagnostic(OS, getPrintingPolicy(),
18465                                            /*Qualified=*/true);
18466                 return Name;
18467               });
18468             }
18469             // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated.
18470             Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func);
18471           }
18472         }
18473       } else {
18474         // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
18475         for (auto *i : Func->redecls()) {
18476           if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
18477             MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i, MightBeOdrUse);
18478         }
18479       }
18480     });
18481   }
18482 
18483   // If a constructor was defined in the context of a default parameter
18484   // or of another default member initializer (ie a PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed
18485   // context), its initializers may not be referenced yet.
18486   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
18487     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(
18488         *this,
18489         Constructor->isImmediateFunction()
18490             ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext
18491             : ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated,
18492         Constructor);
18493     for (CXXCtorInitializer *Init : Constructor->inits()) {
18494       if (Init->isInClassMemberInitializer())
18495         runWithSufficientStackSpace(Init->getSourceLocation(), [&]() {
18496           MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Init->getInit());
18497         });
18498     }
18499   }
18500 
18501   // C++14 [except.spec]p17:
18502   //   An exception-specification is considered to be needed when:
18503   //   - the function is odr-used or, if it appears in an unevaluated operand,
18504   //     would be odr-used if the expression were potentially-evaluated;
18505   //
18506   // Note, we do this even if MightBeOdrUse is false. That indicates that the
18507   // function is a pure virtual function we're calling, and in that case the
18508   // function was selected by overload resolution and we need to resolve its
18509   // exception specification for a different reason.
18510   const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
18511   if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()))
18512     ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
18513 
18514   // A callee could be called by a host function then by a device function.
18515   // If we only try recording once, we will miss recording the use on device
18516   // side. Therefore keep trying until it is recorded.
18517   if (LangOpts.OffloadImplicitHostDeviceTemplates && LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
18518       !getASTContext().CUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunUsedByDevice.count(Func))
18519     CUDA().RecordImplicitHostDeviceFuncUsedByDevice(Func);
18520 
18521   // If this is the first "real" use, act on that.
18522   if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used && !Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false)) {
18523     // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
18524     if (!Func->isDefined() && !Func->isInAnotherModuleUnit()) {
18525       if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func))
18526         UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
18527       else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() &&
18528                !LangOpts.GNUInline &&
18529                !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
18530         UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
18531       else if (isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Func))
18532         UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
18533     }
18534 
18535     // Some x86 Windows calling conventions mangle the size of the parameter
18536     // pack into the name. Computing the size of the parameters requires the
18537     // parameter types to be complete. Check that now.
18538     if (funcHasParameterSizeMangling(*this, Func))
18539       CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(*this, Func, Loc);
18540 
18541     // In the MS C++ ABI, the compiler emits destructor variants where they are
18542     // used. If the destructor is used here but defined elsewhere, mark the
18543     // virtual base destructors referenced. If those virtual base destructors
18544     // are inline, this will ensure they are defined when emitting the complete
18545     // destructor variant. This checking may be redundant if the destructor is
18546     // provided later in this TU.
18547     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
18548       if (auto *Dtor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
18549         CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Dtor->getParent();
18550         if (Parent->getNumVBases() > 0 && !Dtor->getBody())
18551           CheckCompleteDestructorVariant(Loc, Dtor);
18552       }
18553     }
18554 
18555     Func->markUsed(Context);
18556   }
18557 }
18558 
18559 /// Directly mark a variable odr-used. Given a choice, prefer to use
18560 /// MarkVariableReferenced since it does additional checks and then
18561 /// calls MarkVarDeclODRUsed.
18562 /// If the variable must be captured:
18563 ///  - if FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt is null, capture it in the CurContext
18564 ///  - else capture it in the DeclContext that maps to the
18565 ///    *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt on the FunctionScopeInfo stack.
18566 static void
MarkVarDeclODRUsed(ValueDecl * V,SourceLocation Loc,Sema & SemaRef,const unsigned * const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt=nullptr)18567 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(ValueDecl *V, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &SemaRef,
18568                    const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt = nullptr) {
18569   // Keep track of used but undefined variables.
18570   // FIXME: We shouldn't suppress this warning for static data members.
18571   VarDecl *Var = V->getPotentiallyDecomposedVarDecl();
18572   assert(Var && "expected a capturable variable");
18573 
18574   if (Var->hasDefinition(SemaRef.Context) == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
18575       (!Var->isExternallyVisible() || Var->isInline() ||
18576        SemaRef.isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Var)) &&
18577       !(Var->isStaticDataMember() && Var->hasInit())) {
18578     SourceLocation &old = SemaRef.UndefinedButUsed[Var->getCanonicalDecl()];
18579     if (old.isInvalid())
18580       old = Loc;
18581   }
18582   QualType CaptureType, DeclRefType;
18583   if (SemaRef.LangOpts.OpenMP)
18584     SemaRef.OpenMP().tryCaptureOpenMPLambdas(V);
18585   SemaRef.tryCaptureVariable(V, Loc, TryCaptureKind::Implicit,
18586                              /*EllipsisLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
18587                              /*BuildAndDiagnose*/ true, CaptureType,
18588                              DeclRefType, FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt);
18589 
18590   if (SemaRef.LangOpts.CUDA && Var->hasGlobalStorage()) {
18591     auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext);
18592     auto VarTarget = SemaRef.CUDA().IdentifyTarget(Var);
18593     auto UserTarget = SemaRef.CUDA().IdentifyTarget(FD);
18594     if (VarTarget == SemaCUDA::CVT_Host &&
18595         (UserTarget == CUDAFunctionTarget::Device ||
18596          UserTarget == CUDAFunctionTarget::HostDevice ||
18597          UserTarget == CUDAFunctionTarget::Global)) {
18598       // Diagnose ODR-use of host global variables in device functions.
18599       // Reference of device global variables in host functions is allowed
18600       // through shadow variables therefore it is not diagnosed.
18601       if (SemaRef.LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && !SemaRef.LangOpts.HIPStdPar) {
18602         SemaRef.targetDiag(Loc, diag::err_ref_bad_target)
18603             << /*host*/ 2 << /*variable*/ 1 << Var << UserTarget;
18604         SemaRef.targetDiag(Var->getLocation(),
18605                            Var->getType().isConstQualified()
18606                                ? diag::note_cuda_const_var_unpromoted
18607                                : diag::note_cuda_host_var);
18608       }
18609     } else if (VarTarget == SemaCUDA::CVT_Device &&
18610                !Var->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() &&
18611                (UserTarget == CUDAFunctionTarget::Host ||
18612                 UserTarget == CUDAFunctionTarget::HostDevice)) {
18613       // Record a CUDA/HIP device side variable if it is ODR-used
18614       // by host code. This is done conservatively, when the variable is
18615       // referenced in any of the following contexts:
18616       //   - a non-function context
18617       //   - a host function
18618       //   - a host device function
18619       // This makes the ODR-use of the device side variable by host code to
18620       // be visible in the device compilation for the compiler to be able to
18621       // emit template variables instantiated by host code only and to
18622       // externalize the static device side variable ODR-used by host code.
18623       if (!Var->hasExternalStorage())
18624         SemaRef.getASTContext().CUDADeviceVarODRUsedByHost.insert(Var);
18625       else if (SemaRef.LangOpts.GPURelocatableDeviceCode &&
18626                (!FD || (!FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
18627                         SemaRef.getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) ==
18628                             GVA_StrongExternal)))
18629         SemaRef.getASTContext().CUDAExternalDeviceDeclODRUsedByHost.insert(Var);
18630     }
18631   }
18632 
18633   V->markUsed(SemaRef.Context);
18634 }
18635 
MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(ValueDecl * Capture,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned CapturingScopeIndex)18636 void Sema::MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(ValueDecl *Capture,
18637                                              SourceLocation Loc,
18638                                              unsigned CapturingScopeIndex) {
18639   MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Capture, Loc, *this, &CapturingScopeIndex);
18640 }
18641 
diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(Sema & S,SourceLocation loc,ValueDecl * var)18642 void diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
18643                                                  ValueDecl *var) {
18644   DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext();
18645 
18646   //  If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
18647   //  we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
18648   //  the next.
18649   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) &&
18650       isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC))
18651     return;
18652 
18653   // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code
18654   // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of
18655   // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later.
18656   //
18657   // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this
18658   // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound
18659   // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious.
18660   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
18661     return;
18662 
18663   unsigned ValueKind = isa<BindingDecl>(var) ? 1 : 0;
18664   unsigned ContextKind = 3; // unknown
18665   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) &&
18666       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) {
18667     ContextKind = 2;
18668   } else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) {
18669     ContextKind = 0;
18670   } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) {
18671     ContextKind = 1;
18672   }
18673 
18674   S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_in_enclosing_context)
18675     << var << ValueKind << ContextKind << VarDC;
18676   S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
18677       << var;
18678 
18679   // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents
18680   // capture.
18681 }
18682 
isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo * CSI,ValueDecl * Var,bool & SubCapturesAreNested,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType)18683 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI,
18684                                                  ValueDecl *Var,
18685                                                  bool &SubCapturesAreNested,
18686                                                  QualType &CaptureType,
18687                                                  QualType &DeclRefType) {
18688   // Check whether we've already captured it.
18689   if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) {
18690     // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested.
18691     SubCapturesAreNested = true;
18692 
18693     // Retrieve the capture type for this variable.
18694     CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType();
18695 
18696     // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable.
18697     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
18698 
18699     // Similarly to mutable captures in lambda, all the OpenMP captures by copy
18700     // are mutable in the sense that user can change their value - they are
18701     // private instances of the captured declarations.
18702     const Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var);
18703     // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p10:
18704     //   The type of such a data member is [...] an lvalue reference to the
18705     //   referenced function type if the entity is a reference to a function.
18706     //   [...]
18707     if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && !DeclRefType->isFunctionType() &&
18708         !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) &&
18709           !cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->lambdaCaptureShouldBeConst()) &&
18710         !(isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) &&
18711           cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP))
18712       DeclRefType.addConst();
18713     return true;
18714   }
18715   return false;
18716 }
18717 
18718 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
18719 // capture; other scopes don't work.
getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext * DC,ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool Diagnose,Sema & S)18720 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC,
18721                                                       ValueDecl *Var,
18722                                                       SourceLocation Loc,
18723                                                       const bool Diagnose,
18724                                                       Sema &S) {
18725   if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC))
18726     return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
18727 
18728   VarDecl *Underlying = Var->getPotentiallyDecomposedVarDecl();
18729   if (Underlying) {
18730     if (Underlying->hasLocalStorage() && Diagnose)
18731       diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(S, Loc, Var);
18732   }
18733   return nullptr;
18734 }
18735 
18736 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
18737 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
18738 // so check for eligibility.
isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo * CSI,ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool Diagnose,Sema & S)18739 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, ValueDecl *Var,
18740                                  SourceLocation Loc, const bool Diagnose,
18741                                  Sema &S) {
18742 
18743   assert((isa<VarDecl, BindingDecl>(Var)) &&
18744          "Only variables and structured bindings can be captured");
18745 
18746   bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI);
18747   bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
18748 
18749   // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables
18750   // (e.g. anonymous unions).
18751   // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm
18752   // assuming that's the intent.
18753   if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) {
18754     if (Diagnose) {
18755       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var);
18756       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
18757     }
18758     return false;
18759   }
18760 
18761   // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with.
18762   if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) {
18763     if (Diagnose) {
18764       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
18765       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
18766     }
18767     return false;
18768   }
18769   // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too.
18770   // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct.
18771   if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
18772     if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
18773       if (Diagnose) {
18774         if (IsBlock)
18775           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type);
18776         else
18777           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) << Var;
18778         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
18779       }
18780       return false;
18781     }
18782   }
18783   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
18784   // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block
18785   // variables; they don't support the expected semantics.
18786   if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) {
18787     if (Diagnose) {
18788       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) << Var << !IsLambda;
18789       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
18790     }
18791     return false;
18792   }
18793   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5: Blocks cannot reference/capture other blocks
18794   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && IsBlock &&
18795       Var->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
18796     if (Diagnose)
18797       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_block_ref_block);
18798     return false;
18799   }
18800 
18801   if (isa<BindingDecl>(Var)) {
18802     if (!IsLambda || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18803       if (Diagnose)
18804         diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(S, Loc, Var);
18805       return false;
18806     } else if (Diagnose && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18807       S.Diag(Loc, S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus20
18808                       ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_capture_binding
18809                       : diag::ext_capture_binding)
18810           << Var;
18811       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << Var;
18812     }
18813   }
18814 
18815   return true;
18816 }
18817 
18818 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful.
captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo * BSI,ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool Nested,Sema & S,bool Invalid)18819 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, ValueDecl *Var,
18820                            SourceLocation Loc, const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
18821                            QualType &CaptureType, QualType &DeclRefType,
18822                            const bool Nested, Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
18823   bool ByRef = false;
18824 
18825   // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays, excepting OpenCL.
18826   // OpenCL v2.0 s1.12.5 (revision 40): arrays are captured by reference
18827   // (decayed to pointers).
18828   if (!Invalid && !S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CaptureType->isArrayType()) {
18829     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
18830       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
18831       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
18832       Invalid = true;
18833     } else {
18834       return false;
18835     }
18836   }
18837 
18838   // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables.
18839   if (!Invalid &&
18840       CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
18841     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
18842       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture)
18843         << /*block*/ 0;
18844       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
18845       Invalid = true;
18846     } else {
18847       return false;
18848     }
18849   }
18850 
18851   // Warn about implicitly autoreleasing indirect parameters captured by blocks.
18852   if (const auto *PT = CaptureType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
18853     QualType PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
18854 
18855     if (!Invalid && PointeeTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
18856         PointeeTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing &&
18857         !S.Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(PointeeTy)) {
18858       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
18859         SourceLocation VarLoc = Var->getLocation();
18860         S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_block_capture_autoreleasing);
18861         S.Diag(VarLoc, diag::note_declare_parameter_strong);
18862       }
18863     }
18864   }
18865 
18866   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
18867   if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType() ||
18868       (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.OpenMP().isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) {
18869     // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or
18870     // declaration reference types.
18871     ByRef = true;
18872   } else {
18873     // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'.
18874     CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst();
18875     DeclRefType = CaptureType;
18876   }
18877 
18878   // Actually capture the variable.
18879   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
18880     BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, SourceLocation(),
18881                     CaptureType, Invalid);
18882 
18883   return !Invalid;
18884 }
18885 
18886 /// Capture the given variable in the captured region.
captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo * RSI,ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,TryCaptureKind Kind,bool IsTopScope,Sema & S,bool Invalid)18887 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(
18888     CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
18889     const bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, QualType &DeclRefType,
18890     const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, TryCaptureKind Kind, bool IsTopScope,
18891     Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
18892   // By default, capture variables by reference.
18893   bool ByRef = true;
18894   if (IsTopScope && Kind != TryCaptureKind::Implicit) {
18895     ByRef = (Kind == TryCaptureKind::ExplicitByRef);
18896   } else if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) {
18897     // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below).
18898     if (S.OpenMP().isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var)) {
18899       bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified();
18900       DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
18901       // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const.
18902       if (HasConst)
18903         DeclRefType.addConst();
18904     }
18905     // Do not capture firstprivates in tasks.
18906     if (S.OpenMP().isOpenMPPrivateDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel,
18907                                        RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel) != OMPC_unknown)
18908       return true;
18909     ByRef = S.OpenMP().isOpenMPCapturedByRef(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel,
18910                                              RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
18911   }
18912 
18913   if (ByRef)
18914     CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
18915   else
18916     CaptureType = DeclRefType;
18917 
18918   // Actually capture the variable.
18919   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
18920     RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/ false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
18921                     Loc, SourceLocation(), CaptureType, Invalid);
18922 
18923   return !Invalid;
18924 }
18925 
18926 /// Capture the given variable in the lambda.
captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo * LSI,ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,const TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,const bool IsTopScope,Sema & S,bool Invalid)18927 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, ValueDecl *Var,
18928                             SourceLocation Loc, const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
18929                             QualType &CaptureType, QualType &DeclRefType,
18930                             const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
18931                             const TryCaptureKind Kind,
18932                             SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, const bool IsTopScope,
18933                             Sema &S, bool Invalid) {
18934   // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value.
18935   bool ByRef = false;
18936   if (IsTopScope && Kind != TryCaptureKind::Implicit) {
18937     ByRef = (Kind == TryCaptureKind::ExplicitByRef);
18938   } else {
18939     ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref);
18940   }
18941 
18942   if (BuildAndDiagnose && S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWasm() &&
18943       CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().isWebAssemblyReferenceType()) {
18944     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_wasm_ca_reference) << 0;
18945     Invalid = true;
18946   }
18947 
18948   // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable.
18949   if (ByRef) {
18950     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15:
18951     //   An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or
18952     //   explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is
18953     //   unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data
18954     //   members are declared in the closure type for entities
18955     //   captured by reference.
18956     //
18957     // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference
18958     // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears
18959     // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will
18960     // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and
18961     // easily defensible position.
18962     CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
18963   } else {
18964     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14:
18965     //   For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static
18966     //   data member is declared in the closure type. The
18967     //   declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type
18968     //   of such a data member is the type of the corresponding
18969     //   captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an
18970     //   object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the
18971     //   captured entity is a reference to a function, the
18972     //   corresponding data member is also a reference to a
18973     //   function. - end note ]
18974     if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){
18975       if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
18976         CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType();
18977     }
18978 
18979     // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables.
18980     if (!Invalid &&
18981         CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
18982       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
18983         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1;
18984         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
18985           << Var->getDeclName();
18986         Invalid = true;
18987       } else {
18988         return false;
18989       }
18990     }
18991 
18992     // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type.
18993     if (!Invalid && BuildAndDiagnose) {
18994       if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() &&
18995           S.RequireCompleteSizedType(
18996               Loc, CaptureType,
18997               diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_or_sizeless_type,
18998               Var->getDeclName()))
18999         Invalid = true;
19000       else if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType,
19001                                         diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type))
19002         Invalid = true;
19003     }
19004   }
19005 
19006   // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable.
19007   if (ByRef)
19008     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
19009   else {
19010     // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5:
19011     //   The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline
19012     //   function call operator [...]. This function call operator is
19013     //   declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression's
19014     //   parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable.
19015     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
19016     bool Const = LSI->lambdaCaptureShouldBeConst();
19017     // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p10:
19018     //   The type of such a data member is [...] an lvalue reference to the
19019     //   referenced function type if the entity is a reference to a function.
19020     //   [...]
19021     if (Const && !CaptureType->isReferenceType() &&
19022         !DeclRefType->isFunctionType())
19023       DeclRefType.addConst();
19024   }
19025 
19026   // Add the capture.
19027   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
19028     LSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
19029                     Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, Invalid);
19030 
19031   return !Invalid;
19032 }
19033 
canCaptureVariableByCopy(ValueDecl * Var,const ASTContext & Context)19034 static bool canCaptureVariableByCopy(ValueDecl *Var,
19035                                      const ASTContext &Context) {
19036   // Offer a Copy fix even if the type is dependent.
19037   if (Var->getType()->isDependentType())
19038     return true;
19039   QualType T = Var->getType().getNonReferenceType();
19040   if (T.isTriviallyCopyableType(Context))
19041     return true;
19042   if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
19043 
19044     if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
19045       return false;
19046     if (RD->hasSimpleCopyConstructor())
19047       return true;
19048     if (RD->hasUserDeclaredCopyConstructor())
19049       for (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors())
19050         if (Ctor->isCopyConstructor())
19051           return !Ctor->isDeleted();
19052   }
19053   return false;
19054 }
19055 
19056 /// Create up to 4 fix-its for explicit reference and value capture of \p Var or
19057 /// default capture. Fixes may be omitted if they aren't allowed by the
19058 /// standard, for example we can't emit a default copy capture fix-it if we
19059 /// already explicitly copy capture capture another variable.
buildLambdaCaptureFixit(Sema & Sema,LambdaScopeInfo * LSI,ValueDecl * Var)19060 static void buildLambdaCaptureFixit(Sema &Sema, LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
19061                                     ValueDecl *Var) {
19062   assert(LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None);
19063   // Don't offer Capture by copy of default capture by copy fixes if Var is
19064   // known not to be copy constructible.
19065   bool ShouldOfferCopyFix = canCaptureVariableByCopy(Var, Sema.getASTContext());
19066 
19067   SmallString<32> FixBuffer;
19068   StringRef Separator = LSI->NumExplicitCaptures > 0 ? ", " : "";
19069   if (Var->getDeclName().isIdentifier() && !Var->getName().empty()) {
19070     SourceLocation VarInsertLoc = LSI->IntroducerRange.getEnd();
19071     if (ShouldOfferCopyFix) {
19072       // Offer fixes to insert an explicit capture for the variable.
19073       // [] -> [VarName]
19074       // [OtherCapture] -> [OtherCapture, VarName]
19075       FixBuffer.assign({Separator, Var->getName()});
19076       Sema.Diag(VarInsertLoc, diag::note_lambda_variable_capture_fixit)
19077           << Var << /*value*/ 0
19078           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VarInsertLoc, FixBuffer);
19079     }
19080     // As above but capture by reference.
19081     FixBuffer.assign({Separator, "&", Var->getName()});
19082     Sema.Diag(VarInsertLoc, diag::note_lambda_variable_capture_fixit)
19083         << Var << /*reference*/ 1
19084         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VarInsertLoc, FixBuffer);
19085   }
19086 
19087   // Only try to offer default capture if there are no captures excluding this
19088   // and init captures.
19089   // [this]: OK.
19090   // [X = Y]: OK.
19091   // [&A, &B]: Don't offer.
19092   // [A, B]: Don't offer.
19093   if (llvm::any_of(LSI->Captures, [](Capture &C) {
19094         return !C.isThisCapture() && !C.isInitCapture();
19095       }))
19096     return;
19097 
19098   // The default capture specifiers, '=' or '&', must appear first in the
19099   // capture body.
19100   SourceLocation DefaultInsertLoc =
19101       LSI->IntroducerRange.getBegin().getLocWithOffset(1);
19102 
19103   if (ShouldOfferCopyFix) {
19104     bool CanDefaultCopyCapture = true;
19105     // [=, *this] OK since c++17
19106     // [=, this] OK since c++20
19107     if (LSI->isCXXThisCaptured() && !Sema.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
19108       CanDefaultCopyCapture = Sema.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17
19109                                   ? LSI->getCXXThisCapture().isCopyCapture()
19110                                   : false;
19111     // We can't use default capture by copy if any captures already specified
19112     // capture by copy.
19113     if (CanDefaultCopyCapture && llvm::none_of(LSI->Captures, [](Capture &C) {
19114           return !C.isThisCapture() && !C.isInitCapture() && C.isCopyCapture();
19115         })) {
19116       FixBuffer.assign({"=", Separator});
19117       Sema.Diag(DefaultInsertLoc, diag::note_lambda_default_capture_fixit)
19118           << /*value*/ 0
19119           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DefaultInsertLoc, FixBuffer);
19120     }
19121   }
19122 
19123   // We can't use default capture by reference if any captures already specified
19124   // capture by reference.
19125   if (llvm::none_of(LSI->Captures, [](Capture &C) {
19126         return !C.isInitCapture() && C.isReferenceCapture() &&
19127                !C.isThisCapture();
19128       })) {
19129     FixBuffer.assign({"&", Separator});
19130     Sema.Diag(DefaultInsertLoc, diag::note_lambda_default_capture_fixit)
19131         << /*reference*/ 1
19132         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DefaultInsertLoc, FixBuffer);
19133   }
19134 }
19135 
tryCaptureVariable(ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation ExprLoc,TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const unsigned * const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt)19136 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(
19137     ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind,
19138     SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType,
19139     QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
19140   // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its
19141   // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class.
19142   DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext();
19143   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
19144 
19145   // Skip past RequiresExprBodys because they don't constitute function scopes.
19146   while (DC->isRequiresExprBody())
19147     DC = DC->getParent();
19148 
19149   // tryCaptureVariable is called every time a DeclRef is formed,
19150   // it can therefore have non-negigible impact on performances.
19151   // For local variables and when there is no capturing scope,
19152   // we can bailout early.
19153   if (CapturingFunctionScopes == 0 && (!BuildAndDiagnose || VarDC == DC))
19154     return true;
19155 
19156   // Exception: Function parameters are not tied to the function's DeclContext
19157   // until we enter the function definition. Capturing them anyway would result
19158   // in an out-of-bounds error while traversing DC and its parents.
19159   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var) && !VarDC->isFunctionOrMethod())
19160     return true;
19161 
19162   const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Var);
19163   if (VD) {
19164     if (VD->isInitCapture())
19165       VarDC = VarDC->getParent();
19166   } else {
19167     VD = Var->getPotentiallyDecomposedVarDecl();
19168   }
19169   assert(VD && "Cannot capture a null variable");
19170 
19171   const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
19172       ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
19173   // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the
19174   // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
19175   if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
19176     assert(!FunctionScopes.empty() && "No function scopes to stop at?");
19177     unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
19178     // When we're parsing the lambda parameter list, the current DeclContext is
19179     // NOT the lambda but its parent. So move away the current LSI before
19180     // aligning DC and FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt.
19181     if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[FSIndex]);
19182         FSIndex && LSI && !LSI->AfterParameterList)
19183       --FSIndex;
19184     assert(MaxFunctionScopesIndex <= FSIndex &&
19185            "FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt should be no greater than FSIndex into "
19186            "FunctionScopes.");
19187     while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) {
19188       DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
19189       --FSIndex;
19190     }
19191   }
19192 
19193   // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this
19194   // variable.
19195   bool IsGlobal = !VD->hasLocalStorage();
19196   if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP &&
19197                     OpenMP().isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var, /*CheckScopeInfo=*/true,
19198                                                   MaxFunctionScopesIndex)))
19199     return true;
19200 
19201   if (isa<VarDecl>(Var))
19202     Var = cast<VarDecl>(Var->getCanonicalDecl());
19203 
19204   // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable,
19205   // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when
19206   // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing
19207   // capture of that variable.  We start from the innermost capturing-entity
19208   // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities
19209   // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s
19210   // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured
19211   // the variable.
19212   CaptureType = Var->getType();
19213   DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
19214   bool Nested = false;
19215   bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCaptureKind::Implicit);
19216   unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex;
19217   do {
19218 
19219     LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = nullptr;
19220     if (!FunctionScopes.empty())
19221       LSI = dyn_cast_or_null<LambdaScopeInfo>(
19222           FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]);
19223 
19224     bool IsInScopeDeclarationContext =
19225         !LSI || LSI->AfterParameterList || CurContext == LSI->CallOperator;
19226 
19227     if (LSI && !LSI->AfterParameterList) {
19228       // This allows capturing parameters from a default value which does not
19229       // seems correct
19230       if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var) && !Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
19231         return true;
19232     }
19233     // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to
19234     // capture it.
19235     if (IsInScopeDeclarationContext &&
19236         FunctionScopesIndex == MaxFunctionScopesIndex && VarDC == DC)
19237       return true;
19238 
19239     // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
19240     // capture; other scopes don't work.
19241     DeclContext *ParentDC =
19242         !IsInScopeDeclarationContext
19243             ? DC->getParent()
19244             : getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, ExprLoc,
19245                                                 BuildAndDiagnose, *this);
19246     // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have*
19247     // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in
19248     // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc.
19249     if (!ParentDC) {
19250       if (IsGlobal) {
19251         FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1;
19252         break;
19253       }
19254       return true;
19255     }
19256 
19257     FunctionScopeInfo  *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex];
19258     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI);
19259 
19260     // Check whether we've already captured it.
19261     if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType,
19262                                              DeclRefType)) {
19263       CSI->getCapture(Var).markUsed(BuildAndDiagnose);
19264       break;
19265     }
19266 
19267     // When evaluating some attributes (like enable_if) we might refer to a
19268     // function parameter appertaining to the same declaration as that
19269     // attribute.
19270     if (const auto *Parm = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(Var);
19271         Parm && Parm->getDeclContext() == DC)
19272       return true;
19273 
19274     // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body,
19275     // we do not want to capture new variables.  What was captured
19276     // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing
19277     // should be used.
19278     if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) {
19279       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
19280         LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
19281         if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) {
19282           Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var;
19283           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
19284           Diag(LSI->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
19285           buildLambdaCaptureFixit(*this, LSI, Var);
19286         } else
19287           diagnoseUncapturableValueReferenceOrBinding(*this, ExprLoc, Var);
19288       }
19289       return true;
19290     }
19291 
19292     // Try to capture variable-length arrays types.
19293     if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
19294       // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA
19295       // expressions.
19296       QualType QTy = Var->getType();
19297       if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
19298         QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
19299       captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, CSI);
19300     }
19301 
19302     if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) {
19303       if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
19304         // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so
19305         // just break here. Similarly, global variables that are captured in a
19306         // target region should not be captured outside the scope of the region.
19307         if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) {
19308           // FIXME: We should support capturing structured bindings in OpenMP.
19309           if (isa<BindingDecl>(Var)) {
19310             if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
19311               Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_capture_binding_openmp) << Var;
19312               Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << Var;
19313             }
19314             return true;
19315           }
19316           OpenMPClauseKind IsOpenMPPrivateDecl = OpenMP().isOpenMPPrivateDecl(
19317               Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel, RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
19318           // If the variable is private (i.e. not captured) and has variably
19319           // modified type, we still need to capture the type for correct
19320           // codegen in all regions, associated with the construct. Currently,
19321           // it is captured in the innermost captured region only.
19322           if (IsOpenMPPrivateDecl != OMPC_unknown &&
19323               Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
19324             QualType QTy = Var->getType();
19325             if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
19326               QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
19327             for (int I = 1,
19328                      E = OpenMP().getNumberOfConstructScopes(RSI->OpenMPLevel);
19329                  I < E; ++I) {
19330               auto *OuterRSI = cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(
19331                   FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex - I]);
19332               assert(RSI->OpenMPLevel == OuterRSI->OpenMPLevel &&
19333                      "Wrong number of captured regions associated with the "
19334                      "OpenMP construct.");
19335               captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, OuterRSI);
19336             }
19337           }
19338           bool IsTargetCap =
19339               IsOpenMPPrivateDecl != OMPC_private &&
19340               OpenMP().isOpenMPTargetCapturedDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel,
19341                                                   RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
19342           // Do not capture global if it is not privatized in outer regions.
19343           bool IsGlobalCap =
19344               IsGlobal && OpenMP().isOpenMPGlobalCapturedDecl(
19345                               Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel, RSI->OpenMPCaptureLevel);
19346 
19347           // When we detect target captures we are looking from inside the
19348           // target region, therefore we need to propagate the capture from the
19349           // enclosing region. Therefore, the capture is not initially nested.
19350           if (IsTargetCap)
19351             OpenMP().adjustOpenMPTargetScopeIndex(FunctionScopesIndex,
19352                                                   RSI->OpenMPLevel);
19353 
19354           if (IsTargetCap || IsOpenMPPrivateDecl == OMPC_private ||
19355               (IsGlobal && !IsGlobalCap)) {
19356             Nested = !IsTargetCap;
19357             bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified();
19358             DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
19359             // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const.
19360             if (HasConst)
19361               DeclRefType.addConst();
19362             CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
19363             break;
19364           }
19365         }
19366       }
19367     }
19368     if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) {
19369       // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture
19370       // so cannot capture this variable.
19371       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
19372         Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var;
19373         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Var;
19374         auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
19375         if (LSI->Lambda) {
19376           Diag(LSI->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
19377           buildLambdaCaptureFixit(*this, LSI, Var);
19378         }
19379         // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly
19380         // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we
19381         // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because
19382         // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later.  This would purely be done
19383         // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable
19384         // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured
19385         // explicitly.  Suggestion:
19386         //  - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit
19387         //    at the function head
19388         //  - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda
19389         //  - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable.
19390       }
19391       return true;
19392     }
19393     Explicit = false;
19394     FunctionScopesIndex--;
19395     if (IsInScopeDeclarationContext)
19396       DC = ParentDC;
19397   } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC));
19398 
19399   // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda)
19400   // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific
19401   // requirements, and adding captures if requested.
19402   // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing
19403   // at the lambda nested within that one.
19404   bool Invalid = false;
19405   for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N;
19406        ++I) {
19407     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]);
19408 
19409     // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
19410     // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
19411     // so check for eligibility.
19412     if (!Invalid)
19413       Invalid =
19414           !isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this);
19415 
19416     // After encountering an error, if we're actually supposed to capture, keep
19417     // capturing in nested contexts to suppress any follow-on diagnostics.
19418     if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose)
19419       return true;
19420 
19421     if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
19422       Invalid = !captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
19423                                DeclRefType, Nested, *this, Invalid);
19424       Nested = true;
19425     } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
19426       Invalid = !captureInCapturedRegion(
19427           RSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, DeclRefType, Nested,
19428           Kind, /*IsTopScope*/ I == N - 1, *this, Invalid);
19429       Nested = true;
19430     } else {
19431       LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
19432       Invalid =
19433           !captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
19434                            DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
19435                            /*IsTopScope*/ I == N - 1, *this, Invalid);
19436       Nested = true;
19437     }
19438 
19439     if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose)
19440       return true;
19441   }
19442   return Invalid;
19443 }
19444 
tryCaptureVariable(ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)19445 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
19446                               TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) {
19447   QualType CaptureType;
19448   QualType DeclRefType;
19449   return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
19450                             /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType,
19451                             DeclRefType, nullptr);
19452 }
19453 
NeedToCaptureVariable(ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc)19454 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
19455   QualType CaptureType;
19456   QualType DeclRefType;
19457   return !tryCaptureVariable(
19458       Var, Loc, TryCaptureKind::Implicit, SourceLocation(),
19459       /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, DeclRefType, nullptr);
19460 }
19461 
getCapturedDeclRefType(ValueDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc)19462 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
19463   assert(Var && "Null value cannot be captured");
19464 
19465   QualType CaptureType;
19466   QualType DeclRefType;
19467 
19468   // Determine whether we can capture this variable.
19469   if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCaptureKind::Implicit, SourceLocation(),
19470                          /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, DeclRefType,
19471                          nullptr))
19472     return QualType();
19473 
19474   return DeclRefType;
19475 }
19476 
19477 namespace {
19478 // Helper to copy the template arguments from a DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr.
19479 // The produced TemplateArgumentListInfo* points to data stored within this
19480 // object, so should only be used in contexts where the pointer will not be
19481 // used after the CopiedTemplateArgs object is destroyed.
19482 class CopiedTemplateArgs {
19483   bool HasArgs;
19484   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgStorage;
19485 public:
19486   template<typename RefExpr>
CopiedTemplateArgs(RefExpr * E)19487   CopiedTemplateArgs(RefExpr *E) : HasArgs(E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
19488     if (HasArgs)
19489       E->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgStorage);
19490   }
operator TemplateArgumentListInfo*()19491   operator TemplateArgumentListInfo*()
19492 #ifdef __has_cpp_attribute
19493 #if __has_cpp_attribute(clang::lifetimebound)
19494   [[clang::lifetimebound]]
19495 #endif
19496 #endif
19497   {
19498     return HasArgs ? &TemplateArgStorage : nullptr;
19499   }
19500 };
19501 }
19502 
19503 /// Walk the set of potential results of an expression and mark them all as
19504 /// non-odr-uses if they satisfy the side-conditions of the NonOdrUseReason.
19505 ///
19506 /// \return A new expression if we found any potential results, ExprEmpty() if
19507 ///         not, and ExprError() if we diagnosed an error.
rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(Sema & S,Expr * E,NonOdrUseReason NOUR)19508 static ExprResult rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(Sema &S, Expr *E,
19509                                                       NonOdrUseReason NOUR) {
19510   // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is
19511   // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a
19512   // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
19513   // is immediately applied."  This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue
19514   // conversion part.
19515   //
19516   // If we encounter a node that claims to be an odr-use but shouldn't be, we
19517   // transform it into the relevant kind of non-odr-use node and rebuild the
19518   // tree of nodes leading to it.
19519   //
19520   // This is a mini-TreeTransform that only transforms a restricted subset of
19521   // nodes (and only certain operands of them).
19522 
19523   // Rebuild a subexpression.
19524   auto Rebuild = [&](Expr *Sub) {
19525     return rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(S, Sub, NOUR);
19526   };
19527 
19528   // Check whether a potential result satisfies the requirements of NOUR.
19529   auto IsPotentialResultOdrUsed = [&](NamedDecl *D) {
19530     // Any entity other than a VarDecl is always odr-used whenever it's named
19531     // in a potentially-evaluated expression.
19532     auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
19533     if (!VD)
19534       return true;
19535 
19536     // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
19537     //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evalauted expression
19538     //   e is odr-used by e unless
19539     //   -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions, or
19540     //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant
19541     //      expressions and has no mutable subobjects, and e is an element of
19542     //      the set of potential results of an expression of
19543     //      non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue
19544     //      conversion is applied, or
19545     //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the
19546     //      set of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which
19547     //      the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied
19548     //
19549     // We check the first bullet and the "potentially-evaluated" condition in
19550     // BuildDeclRefExpr. We check the type requirements in the second bullet
19551     // in CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand below.
19552     switch (NOUR) {
19553     case NOUR_None:
19554     case NOUR_Unevaluated:
19555       llvm_unreachable("unexpected non-odr-use-reason");
19556 
19557     case NOUR_Constant:
19558       // Constant references were handled when they were built.
19559       if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType())
19560         return true;
19561       if (auto *RD = VD->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
19562         if (RD->hasDefinition() && RD->hasMutableFields())
19563           return true;
19564       if (!VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(S.Context))
19565         return true;
19566       break;
19567 
19568     case NOUR_Discarded:
19569       if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType())
19570         return true;
19571       break;
19572     }
19573     return false;
19574   };
19575 
19576   // Check whether this expression may be odr-used in CUDA/HIP.
19577   auto MaybeCUDAODRUsed = [&]() -> bool {
19578     if (!S.LangOpts.CUDA)
19579       return false;
19580     LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.getCurLambda();
19581     if (!LSI)
19582       return false;
19583     auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
19584     if (!DRE)
19585       return false;
19586     auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
19587     if (!VD)
19588       return false;
19589     return LSI->CUDAPotentialODRUsedVars.count(VD);
19590   };
19591 
19592   // Mark that this expression does not constitute an odr-use.
19593   auto MarkNotOdrUsed = [&] {
19594     if (!MaybeCUDAODRUsed()) {
19595       S.MaybeODRUseExprs.remove(E);
19596       if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.getCurLambda())
19597         LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(E);
19598     }
19599   };
19600 
19601   // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p2:
19602   //   The set of potential results of an expression e is defined as follows:
19603   switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
19604   //   -- If e is an id-expression, ...
19605   case Expr::DeclRefExprClass: {
19606     auto *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
19607     if (DRE->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(DRE->getDecl()))
19608       break;
19609 
19610     // Rebuild as a non-odr-use DeclRefExpr.
19611     MarkNotOdrUsed();
19612     return DeclRefExpr::Create(
19613         S.Context, DRE->getQualifierLoc(), DRE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
19614         DRE->getDecl(), DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture(),
19615         DRE->getNameInfo(), DRE->getType(), DRE->getValueKind(),
19616         DRE->getFoundDecl(), CopiedTemplateArgs(DRE), NOUR);
19617   }
19618 
19619   case Expr::FunctionParmPackExprClass: {
19620     auto *FPPE = cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E);
19621     // If any of the declarations in the pack is odr-used, then the expression
19622     // as a whole constitutes an odr-use.
19623     for (ValueDecl *D : *FPPE)
19624       if (IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(D))
19625         return ExprEmpty();
19626 
19627     // FIXME: Rebuild as a non-odr-use FunctionParmPackExpr? In practice,
19628     // nothing cares about whether we marked this as an odr-use, but it might
19629     // be useful for non-compiler tools.
19630     MarkNotOdrUsed();
19631     break;
19632   }
19633 
19634   //   -- If e is a subscripting operation with an array operand...
19635   case Expr::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
19636     auto *ASE = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E);
19637     Expr *OldBase = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit();
19638     if (!OldBase->getType()->isArrayType())
19639       break;
19640     ExprResult Base = Rebuild(OldBase);
19641     if (!Base.isUsable())
19642       return Base;
19643     Expr *LHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getLHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getLHS();
19644     Expr *RHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getRHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getRHS();
19645     SourceLocation LBracketLoc = ASE->getBeginLoc(); // FIXME: Not stored.
19646     return S.ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(nullptr, LHS, LBracketLoc, RHS,
19647                                      ASE->getRBracketLoc());
19648   }
19649 
19650   case Expr::MemberExprClass: {
19651     auto *ME = cast<MemberExpr>(E);
19652     // -- If e is a class member access expression [...] naming a non-static
19653     //    data member...
19654     if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
19655       ExprResult Base = Rebuild(ME->getBase());
19656       if (!Base.isUsable())
19657         return Base;
19658       return MemberExpr::Create(
19659           S.Context, Base.get(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(),
19660           ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
19661           ME->getMemberDecl(), ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(),
19662           CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(),
19663           ME->getObjectKind(), ME->isNonOdrUse());
19664     }
19665 
19666     if (ME->getMemberDecl()->isCXXInstanceMember())
19667       break;
19668 
19669     // -- If e is a class member access expression naming a static data member,
19670     //    ...
19671     if (ME->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(ME->getMemberDecl()))
19672       break;
19673 
19674     // Rebuild as a non-odr-use MemberExpr.
19675     MarkNotOdrUsed();
19676     return MemberExpr::Create(
19677         S.Context, ME->getBase(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(),
19678         ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), ME->getMemberDecl(),
19679         ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), CopiedTemplateArgs(ME),
19680         ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), ME->getObjectKind(), NOUR);
19681   }
19682 
19683   case Expr::BinaryOperatorClass: {
19684     auto *BO = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
19685     Expr *LHS = BO->getLHS();
19686     Expr *RHS = BO->getRHS();
19687     // -- If e is a pointer-to-member expression of the form e1 .* e2 ...
19688     if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD) {
19689       ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(LHS);
19690       if (!Sub.isUsable())
19691         return Sub;
19692       BO->setLHS(Sub.get());
19693     //   -- If e is a comma expression, ...
19694     } else if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) {
19695       ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(RHS);
19696       if (!Sub.isUsable())
19697         return Sub;
19698       BO->setRHS(Sub.get());
19699     } else {
19700       break;
19701     }
19702     return ExprResult(BO);
19703   }
19704 
19705   //   -- If e has the form (e1)...
19706   case Expr::ParenExprClass: {
19707     auto *PE = cast<ParenExpr>(E);
19708     ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(PE->getSubExpr());
19709     if (!Sub.isUsable())
19710       return Sub;
19711     return S.ActOnParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), Sub.get());
19712   }
19713 
19714   //   -- If e is a glvalue conditional expression, ...
19715   // We don't apply this to a binary conditional operator. FIXME: Should we?
19716   case Expr::ConditionalOperatorClass: {
19717     auto *CO = cast<ConditionalOperator>(E);
19718     ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CO->getLHS());
19719     if (LHS.isInvalid())
19720       return ExprError();
19721     ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CO->getRHS());
19722     if (RHS.isInvalid())
19723       return ExprError();
19724     if (!LHS.isUsable() && !RHS.isUsable())
19725       return ExprEmpty();
19726     if (!LHS.isUsable())
19727       LHS = CO->getLHS();
19728     if (!RHS.isUsable())
19729       RHS = CO->getRHS();
19730     return S.ActOnConditionalOp(CO->getQuestionLoc(), CO->getColonLoc(),
19731                                 CO->getCond(), LHS.get(), RHS.get());
19732   }
19733 
19734   // [Clang extension]
19735   //   -- If e has the form __extension__ e1...
19736   case Expr::UnaryOperatorClass: {
19737     auto *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
19738     if (UO->getOpcode() != UO_Extension)
19739       break;
19740     ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(UO->getSubExpr());
19741     if (!Sub.isUsable())
19742       return Sub;
19743     return S.BuildUnaryOp(nullptr, UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO_Extension,
19744                           Sub.get());
19745   }
19746 
19747   // [Clang extension]
19748   //   -- If e has the form _Generic(...), the set of potential results is the
19749   //      union of the sets of potential results of the associated expressions.
19750   case Expr::GenericSelectionExprClass: {
19751     auto *GSE = cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E);
19752 
19753     SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs;
19754     bool AnyChanged = false;
19755     for (Expr *OrigAssocExpr : GSE->getAssocExprs()) {
19756       ExprResult AssocExpr = Rebuild(OrigAssocExpr);
19757       if (AssocExpr.isInvalid())
19758         return ExprError();
19759       if (AssocExpr.isUsable()) {
19760         AssocExprs.push_back(AssocExpr.get());
19761         AnyChanged = true;
19762       } else {
19763         AssocExprs.push_back(OrigAssocExpr);
19764       }
19765     }
19766 
19767     void *ExOrTy = nullptr;
19768     bool IsExpr = GSE->isExprPredicate();
19769     if (IsExpr)
19770       ExOrTy = GSE->getControllingExpr();
19771     else
19772       ExOrTy = GSE->getControllingType();
19773     return AnyChanged ? S.CreateGenericSelectionExpr(
19774                             GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
19775                             GSE->getRParenLoc(), IsExpr, ExOrTy,
19776                             GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs)
19777                       : ExprEmpty();
19778   }
19779 
19780   // [Clang extension]
19781   //   -- If e has the form __builtin_choose_expr(...), the set of potential
19782   //      results is the union of the sets of potential results of the
19783   //      second and third subexpressions.
19784   case Expr::ChooseExprClass: {
19785     auto *CE = cast<ChooseExpr>(E);
19786 
19787     ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS());
19788     if (LHS.isInvalid())
19789       return ExprError();
19790 
19791     ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS());
19792     if (RHS.isInvalid())
19793       return ExprError();
19794 
19795     if (!LHS.get() && !RHS.get())
19796       return ExprEmpty();
19797     if (!LHS.isUsable())
19798       LHS = CE->getLHS();
19799     if (!RHS.isUsable())
19800       RHS = CE->getRHS();
19801 
19802     return S.ActOnChooseExpr(CE->getBuiltinLoc(), CE->getCond(), LHS.get(),
19803                              RHS.get(), CE->getRParenLoc());
19804   }
19805 
19806   // Step through non-syntactic nodes.
19807   case Expr::ConstantExprClass: {
19808     auto *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(E);
19809     ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(CE->getSubExpr());
19810     if (!Sub.isUsable())
19811       return Sub;
19812     return ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Sub.get());
19813   }
19814 
19815   // We could mostly rely on the recursive rebuilding to rebuild implicit
19816   // casts, but not at the top level, so rebuild them here.
19817   case Expr::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
19818     auto *ICE = cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
19819     // Only step through the narrow set of cast kinds we expect to encounter.
19820     // Anything else suggests we've left the region in which potential results
19821     // can be found.
19822     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
19823     case CK_NoOp:
19824     case CK_DerivedToBase:
19825     case CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase: {
19826       ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(ICE->getSubExpr());
19827       if (!Sub.isUsable())
19828         return Sub;
19829       CXXCastPath Path(ICE->path());
19830       return S.ImpCastExprToType(Sub.get(), ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
19831                                  ICE->getValueKind(), &Path);
19832     }
19833 
19834     default:
19835       break;
19836     }
19837     break;
19838   }
19839 
19840   default:
19841     break;
19842   }
19843 
19844   // Can't traverse through this node. Nothing to do.
19845   return ExprEmpty();
19846 }
19847 
CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr * E)19848 ExprResult Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr *E) {
19849   // Check whether the operand is or contains an object of non-trivial C union
19850   // type.
19851   if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() &&
19852       (E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
19853        E->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()))
19854     checkNonTrivialCUnion(E->getType(), E->getExprLoc(),
19855                           NonTrivialCUnionContext::LValueToRValueVolatile,
19856                           NTCUK_Destruct | NTCUK_Copy);
19857 
19858   // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
19859   //   [...] an expression of non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which
19860   //   the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is applied [...]
19861   if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || E->getType()->getAs<RecordType>())
19862     return E;
19863 
19864   ExprResult Result =
19865       rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(*this, E, NOUR_Constant);
19866   if (Result.isInvalid())
19867     return ExprError();
19868   return Result.get() ? Result : E;
19869 }
19870 
ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res)19871 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) {
19872   if (!Res.isUsable())
19873     return Res;
19874 
19875   // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay
19876   // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the
19877   // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion.  In the one case where this doesn't happen
19878   // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway.
19879   return CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Res.get());
19880 }
19881 
CleanupVarDeclMarking()19882 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() {
19883   // Iterate through a local copy in case MarkVarDeclODRUsed makes a recursive
19884   // call.
19885   MaybeODRUseExprSet LocalMaybeODRUseExprs;
19886   std::swap(LocalMaybeODRUseExprs, MaybeODRUseExprs);
19887 
19888   for (Expr *E : LocalMaybeODRUseExprs) {
19889     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
19890       MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()),
19891                          DRE->getLocation(), *this);
19892     } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
19893       MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()), ME->getMemberLoc(),
19894                          *this);
19895     } else if (auto *FP = dyn_cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) {
19896       for (ValueDecl *VD : *FP)
19897         MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VD, FP->getParameterPackLocation(), *this);
19898     } else {
19899       llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression");
19900     }
19901   }
19902 
19903   assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() &&
19904          "MarkVarDeclODRUsed failed to cleanup MaybeODRUseExprs?");
19905 }
19906 
DoMarkPotentialCapture(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,ValueDecl * Var,Expr * E)19907 static void DoMarkPotentialCapture(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
19908                                    ValueDecl *Var, Expr *E) {
19909   VarDecl *VD = Var->getPotentiallyDecomposedVarDecl();
19910   if (!VD)
19911     return;
19912 
19913   const bool RefersToEnclosingScope =
19914       (SemaRef.CurContext != VD->getDeclContext() &&
19915        VD->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && VD->hasLocalStorage());
19916   if (RefersToEnclosingScope) {
19917     LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI =
19918         SemaRef.getCurLambda(/*IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=*/true);
19919     if (LSI && (!LSI->CallOperator ||
19920                 !LSI->CallOperator->Encloses(Var->getDeclContext()))) {
19921       // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so
19922       // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any
19923       // lvalue-to-rvalue
19924       // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use.
19925       // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed
19926       // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking
19927       // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant
19928       // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used).
19929       //
19930       // FIXME: We can simplify this a lot after implementing P0588R1.
19931       assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression.");
19932       if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() ||
19933           !VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
19934         LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens());
19935     }
19936   }
19937 }
19938 
DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,VarDecl * Var,Expr * E,llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *,int> & RefsMinusAssignments)19939 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(
19940     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var, Expr *E,
19941     llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, int> &RefsMinusAssignments) {
19942   assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E) ||
19943           isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) &&
19944          "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced");
19945   Var->setReferenced();
19946 
19947   if (Var->isInvalidDecl())
19948     return;
19949 
19950   auto *MSI = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
19951   TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = MSI ? MSI->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
19952                                        : Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
19953 
19954   OdrUseContext OdrUse = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef);
19955   bool UsableInConstantExpr =
19956       Var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context);
19957 
19958   if (Var->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && !Var->hasExternalStorage()) {
19959     RefsMinusAssignments.insert({Var, 0}).first->getSecond()++;
19960   }
19961 
19962   // C++20 [expr.const]p12:
19963   //   A variable [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a
19964   //   variable whose name appears as a potentially constant evaluated
19965   //   expression that is either a contexpr variable or is of non-volatile
19966   //   const-qualified integral type or of reference type
19967   bool NeededForConstantEvaluation =
19968       isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(SemaRef) && UsableInConstantExpr;
19969 
19970   bool NeedDefinition =
19971       OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || NeededForConstantEvaluation;
19972 
19973   assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) &&
19974          "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization.");
19975 
19976   // If this might be a member specialization of a static data member, check
19977   // the specialization is visible. We already did the checks for variable
19978   // template specializations when we created them.
19979   if (NeedDefinition && TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
19980       !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var))
19981     SemaRef.checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Var);
19982 
19983   // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member
19984   // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay
19985   // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used
19986   // in a constant expression.
19987   if (NeedDefinition && isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) {
19988     // Per C++17 [temp.explicit]p10, we may instantiate despite an explicit
19989     // instantiation declaration if a variable is usable in a constant
19990     // expression (among other cases).
19991     bool TryInstantiating =
19992         TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
19993         (TSK == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration && UsableInConstantExpr);
19994 
19995     if (TryInstantiating) {
19996       SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation =
19997           MSI ? MSI->getPointOfInstantiation() : Var->getPointOfInstantiation();
19998       bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid();
19999       if (FirstInstantiation) {
20000         PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
20001         if (MSI)
20002           MSI->setPointOfInstantiation(PointOfInstantiation);
20003           // FIXME: Notify listener.
20004         else
20005           Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation);
20006       }
20007 
20008       if (UsableInConstantExpr || Var->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
20009         // Do not defer instantiations of variables that could be used in a
20010         // constant expression.
20011         // The type deduction also needs a complete initializer.
20012         SemaRef.runWithSufficientStackSpace(PointOfInstantiation, [&] {
20013           SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var);
20014         });
20015 
20016         // The size of an incomplete array type can be updated by
20017         // instantiating the initializer. The DeclRefExpr's type should be
20018         // updated accordingly too, or users of it would be confused!
20019         if (E)
20020           SemaRef.getCompletedType(E);
20021 
20022         // Re-set the member to trigger a recomputation of the dependence bits
20023         // for the expression.
20024         if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclRefExpr>(E))
20025           DRE->setDecl(DRE->getDecl());
20026         else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast_or_null<MemberExpr>(E))
20027           ME->setMemberDecl(ME->getMemberDecl());
20028       } else if (FirstInstantiation) {
20029         SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
20030             .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
20031       } else {
20032         bool Inserted = false;
20033         for (auto &I : SemaRef.SavedPendingInstantiations) {
20034           auto Iter = llvm::find_if(
20035               I, [Var](const Sema::PendingImplicitInstantiation &P) {
20036                 return P.first == Var;
20037               });
20038           if (Iter != I.end()) {
20039             SemaRef.PendingInstantiations.push_back(*Iter);
20040             I.erase(Iter);
20041             Inserted = true;
20042             break;
20043           }
20044         }
20045 
20046         // FIXME: For a specialization of a variable template, we don't
20047         // distinguish between "declaration and type implicitly instantiated"
20048         // and "implicit instantiation of definition requested", so we have
20049         // no direct way to avoid enqueueing the pending instantiation
20050         // multiple times.
20051         if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var) && !Inserted)
20052           SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
20053             .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
20054       }
20055     }
20056   }
20057 
20058   // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4:
20059   //   A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e
20060   //   is odr-used by e unless
20061   //   -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions
20062   //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant
20063   //      expressions and has no mutable subobjects [FIXME], and e is an
20064   //      element of the set of potential results of an expression of
20065   //      non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue
20066   //      conversion is applied
20067   //   -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the set
20068   //      of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which the
20069   //      lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied [FIXME]
20070   //
20071   // We check the first part of the second bullet here, and
20072   // Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand deals with the second part.
20073   // FIXME: To get the third bullet right, we need to delay this even for
20074   // variables that are not usable in constant expressions.
20075 
20076   // If we already know this isn't an odr-use, there's nothing more to do.
20077   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclRefExpr>(E))
20078     if (DRE->isNonOdrUse())
20079       return;
20080   if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast_or_null<MemberExpr>(E))
20081     if (ME->isNonOdrUse())
20082       return;
20083 
20084   switch (OdrUse) {
20085   case OdrUseContext::None:
20086     // In some cases, a variable may not have been marked unevaluated, if it
20087     // appears in a defaukt initializer.
20088     assert((!E || isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E) ||
20089             SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) &&
20090            "missing non-odr-use marking for unevaluated decl ref");
20091     break;
20092 
20093   case OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed:
20094     // FIXME: Ignoring formal odr-uses results in incorrect lambda capture
20095     // behavior.
20096     break;
20097 
20098   case OdrUseContext::Used:
20099     // If we might later find that this expression isn't actually an odr-use,
20100     // delay the marking.
20101     if (E && Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
20102       SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E);
20103     else
20104       MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef);
20105     break;
20106 
20107   case OdrUseContext::Dependent:
20108     // If this is a dependent context, we don't need to mark variables as
20109     // odr-used, but we may still need to track them for lambda capture.
20110     // FIXME: Do we also need to do this inside dependent typeid expressions
20111     // (which are modeled as unevaluated at this point)?
20112     DoMarkPotentialCapture(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E);
20113     break;
20114   }
20115 }
20116 
DoMarkBindingDeclReferenced(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,BindingDecl * BD,Expr * E)20117 static void DoMarkBindingDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
20118                                         BindingDecl *BD, Expr *E) {
20119   BD->setReferenced();
20120 
20121   if (BD->isInvalidDecl())
20122     return;
20123 
20124   OdrUseContext OdrUse = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef);
20125   if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used) {
20126     QualType CaptureType, DeclRefType;
20127     SemaRef.tryCaptureVariable(BD, Loc, TryCaptureKind::Implicit,
20128                                /*EllipsisLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
20129                                /*BuildAndDiagnose*/ true, CaptureType,
20130                                DeclRefType,
20131                                /*FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt*/ nullptr);
20132   } else if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Dependent) {
20133     DoMarkPotentialCapture(SemaRef, Loc, BD, E);
20134   }
20135 }
20136 
MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,VarDecl * Var)20137 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) {
20138   DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr, RefsMinusAssignments);
20139 }
20140 
20141 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
20142 //   An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
20143 //     - an identifier associated by name lookup with an entity captured by copy
20144 //       in a lambda-expression that has an explicit object parameter whose type
20145 //       is dependent ([dcl.fct]),
FixDependencyOfIdExpressionsInLambdaWithDependentObjectParameter(Sema & SemaRef,ValueDecl * D,Expr * E)20146 static void FixDependencyOfIdExpressionsInLambdaWithDependentObjectParameter(
20147     Sema &SemaRef, ValueDecl *D, Expr *E) {
20148   auto *ID = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
20149   if (!ID || ID->isTypeDependent() || !ID->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture())
20150     return;
20151 
20152   // If any enclosing lambda with a dependent explicit object parameter either
20153   // explicitly captures the variable by value, or has a capture default of '='
20154   // and does not capture the variable by reference, then the type of the DRE
20155   // is dependent on the type of that lambda's explicit object parameter.
20156   auto IsDependent = [&]() {
20157     for (auto *Scope : llvm::reverse(SemaRef.FunctionScopes)) {
20158       auto *LSI = dyn_cast<sema::LambdaScopeInfo>(Scope);
20159       if (!LSI)
20160         continue;
20161 
20162       if (LSI->Lambda && !LSI->Lambda->Encloses(SemaRef.CurContext) &&
20163           LSI->AfterParameterList)
20164         return false;
20165 
20166       const auto *MD = LSI->CallOperator;
20167       if (MD->getType().isNull())
20168         continue;
20169 
20170       const auto *Ty = MD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
20171       if (!Ty || !MD->isExplicitObjectMemberFunction() ||
20172           !Ty->getParamType(0)->isDependentType())
20173         continue;
20174 
20175       if (auto *C = LSI->CaptureMap.count(D) ? &LSI->getCapture(D) : nullptr) {
20176         if (C->isCopyCapture())
20177           return true;
20178         continue;
20179       }
20180 
20181       if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval)
20182         return true;
20183     }
20184     return false;
20185   }();
20186 
20187   ID->setCapturedByCopyInLambdaWithExplicitObjectParameter(
20188       IsDependent, SemaRef.getASTContext());
20189 }
20190 
20191 static void
MarkExprReferenced(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,Decl * D,Expr * E,bool MightBeOdrUse,llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *,int> & RefsMinusAssignments)20192 MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, Expr *E,
20193                    bool MightBeOdrUse,
20194                    llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, int> &RefsMinusAssignments) {
20195   if (SemaRef.OpenMP().isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext())
20196     SemaRef.OpenMP().checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(E, D);
20197 
20198   if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().OpenACC)
20199     SemaRef.OpenACC().CheckDeclReference(Loc, E, D);
20200 
20201   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
20202     DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E, RefsMinusAssignments);
20203     if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
20204       FixDependencyOfIdExpressionsInLambdaWithDependentObjectParameter(SemaRef,
20205                                                                        Var, E);
20206     return;
20207   }
20208 
20209   if (BindingDecl *Decl = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D)) {
20210     DoMarkBindingDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Decl, E);
20211     if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
20212       FixDependencyOfIdExpressionsInLambdaWithDependentObjectParameter(SemaRef,
20213                                                                        Decl, E);
20214     return;
20215   }
20216   SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, MightBeOdrUse);
20217 
20218   // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the
20219   // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call.
20220   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
20221   if (!ME)
20222     return;
20223   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
20224   if (!MD)
20225     return;
20226   // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call.
20227   bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() &&
20228                           ME->performsVirtualDispatch(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
20229   if (!IsVirtualCall)
20230     return;
20231 
20232   // If it's possible to devirtualize the call, mark the called function
20233   // referenced.
20234   CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getDevirtualizedMethod(
20235       ME->getBase(), SemaRef.getLangOpts().AppleKext);
20236   if (DM)
20237     SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, MightBeOdrUse);
20238 }
20239 
MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr * E,const Expr * Base)20240 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base) {
20241   // [basic.def.odr] (CWG 1614)
20242   // A function is named by an expression or conversion [...]
20243   // unless it is a pure virtual function and either the expression is not an
20244   // id-expression naming the function with an explicitly qualified name or
20245   // the expression forms a pointer to member
20246   bool OdrUse = true;
20247   if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl()))
20248     if (Method->isVirtual() &&
20249         !Method->getDevirtualizedMethod(Base, getLangOpts().AppleKext))
20250       OdrUse = false;
20251 
20252   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(E->getDecl())) {
20253     if (!isUnevaluatedContext() && !isConstantEvaluatedContext() &&
20254         !isImmediateFunctionContext() &&
20255         !isCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer() &&
20256         FD->isImmediateFunction() && !RebuildingImmediateInvocation &&
20257         !FD->isDependentContext())
20258       ExprEvalContexts.back().ReferenceToConsteval.insert(E);
20259   }
20260   MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse,
20261                      RefsMinusAssignments);
20262 }
20263 
MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr * E)20264 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) {
20265   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2:
20266   //   A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated
20267   //   expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by
20268   //   overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated
20269   //   expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its
20270   //   name is not explicitly qualified.
20271   bool MightBeOdrUse = true;
20272   if (E->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
20273     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()))
20274       if (Method->isPureVirtual())
20275         MightBeOdrUse = false;
20276   }
20277   SourceLocation Loc =
20278       E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? E->getMemberLoc() : E->getBeginLoc();
20279   MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, MightBeOdrUse,
20280                      RefsMinusAssignments);
20281 }
20282 
MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr * E)20283 void Sema::MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr *E) {
20284   for (ValueDecl *VD : *E)
20285     MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getParameterPackLocation(), VD, E, true,
20286                        RefsMinusAssignments);
20287 }
20288 
20289 /// Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration.  It
20290 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for
20291 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a
20292 /// normal expression which refers to a variable.
MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,Decl * D,bool MightBeOdrUse)20293 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D,
20294                                  bool MightBeOdrUse) {
20295   if (MightBeOdrUse) {
20296     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
20297       MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD);
20298       return;
20299     }
20300   }
20301   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
20302     MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, MightBeOdrUse);
20303     return;
20304   }
20305   D->setReferenced();
20306 }
20307 
20308 namespace {
20309   // Mark all of the declarations used by a type as referenced.
20310   // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
20311   // of when we're entering a context we should not recurse into.
20312   // FIXME: This is and EvaluatedExprMarker are more-or-less equivalent to
20313   // TreeTransforms rebuilding the type in a new context. Rather than
20314   // duplicating the TreeTransform logic, we should consider reusing it here.
20315   // Currently that causes problems when rebuilding LambdaExprs.
20316 class MarkReferencedDecls : public DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor {
20317   Sema &S;
20318   SourceLocation Loc;
20319 
20320 public:
MarkReferencedDecls(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc)20321   MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) {}
20322 
20323   bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) override;
20324 };
20325 }
20326 
TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument & Arg)20327 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
20328     const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
20329   {
20330     // A non-type template argument is a constant-evaluated context.
20331     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Evaluated(
20332         S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated);
20333     if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
20334       if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl())
20335         S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true);
20336     } else if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Expression) {
20337       S.MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Arg.getAsExpr(), false);
20338     }
20339   }
20340 
20341   return DynamicRecursiveASTVisitor::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
20342 }
20343 
MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc,QualType T)20344 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
20345   MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
20346   Marker.TraverseType(T);
20347 }
20348 
20349 namespace {
20350 /// Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
20351 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
20352 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public UsedDeclVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
20353 public:
20354   typedef UsedDeclVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
20355   bool SkipLocalVariables;
20356   ArrayRef<const Expr *> StopAt;
20357 
EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema & S,bool SkipLocalVariables,ArrayRef<const Expr * > StopAt)20358   EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables,
20359                       ArrayRef<const Expr *> StopAt)
20360       : Inherited(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables), StopAt(StopAt) {}
20361 
visitUsedDecl(SourceLocation Loc,Decl * D)20362   void visitUsedDecl(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
20363     S.MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, cast<FunctionDecl>(D));
20364   }
20365 
Visit(Expr * E)20366   void Visit(Expr *E) {
20367     if (llvm::is_contained(StopAt, E))
20368       return;
20369     Inherited::Visit(E);
20370   }
20371 
VisitConstantExpr(ConstantExpr * E)20372   void VisitConstantExpr(ConstantExpr *E) {
20373     // Don't mark declarations within a ConstantExpression, as this expression
20374     // will be evaluated and folded to a value.
20375   }
20376 
VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr * E)20377   void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
20378     // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't.
20379     if (SkipLocalVariables) {
20380       if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl()))
20381         if (VD->hasLocalStorage())
20382           return;
20383     }
20384 
20385     // FIXME: This can trigger the instantiation of the initializer of a
20386     // variable, which can cause the expression to become value-dependent
20387     // or error-dependent. Do we need to propagate the new dependence bits?
20388     S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
20389   }
20390 
VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr * E)20391   void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
20392     S.MarkMemberReferenced(E);
20393     Visit(E->getBase());
20394   }
20395 };
20396 } // namespace
20397 
MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr * E,bool SkipLocalVariables,ArrayRef<const Expr * > StopAt)20398 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E,
20399                                             bool SkipLocalVariables,
20400                                             ArrayRef<const Expr*> StopAt) {
20401   EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables, StopAt).Visit(E);
20402 }
20403 
20404 /// Emit a diagnostic when statements are reachable.
20405 /// FIXME: check for reachability even in expressions for which we don't build a
20406 ///        CFG (eg, in the initializer of a global or in a constant expression).
20407 ///        For example,
20408 ///        namespace { auto *p = new double[3][false ? (1, 2) : 3]; }
DiagIfReachable(SourceLocation Loc,ArrayRef<const Stmt * > Stmts,const PartialDiagnostic & PD)20409 bool Sema::DiagIfReachable(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt *> Stmts,
20410                            const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
20411   if (!Stmts.empty() && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
20412     if (!FunctionScopes.empty())
20413       FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.push_back(
20414           sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Stmts));
20415     return true;
20416   }
20417 
20418   // The initializer of a constexpr variable or of the first declaration of a
20419   // static data member is not syntactically a constant evaluated constant,
20420   // but nonetheless is always required to be a constant expression, so we
20421   // can skip diagnosing.
20422   // FIXME: Using the mangling context here is a hack.
20423   if (auto *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(
20424           ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl)) {
20425     if (VD->isConstexpr() ||
20426         (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isInline()))
20427       return false;
20428     // FIXME: For any other kind of variable, we should build a CFG for its
20429     // initializer and check whether the context in question is reachable.
20430   }
20431 
20432   Diag(Loc, PD);
20433   return true;
20434 }
20435 
20436 /// Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
20437 /// of the program being compiled.
20438 ///
20439 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
20440 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
20441 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
20442 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
20443 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
20444 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
20445 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
20446 /// later.
20447 ///
20448 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
20449 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
20450 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
20451 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,ArrayRef<const Stmt * > Stmts,const PartialDiagnostic & PD)20452 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt*> Stmts,
20453                                const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
20454 
20455   if (ExprEvalContexts.back().isDiscardedStatementContext())
20456     return false;
20457 
20458   switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
20459   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated:
20460   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList:
20461   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract:
20462   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement:
20463     // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
20464     break;
20465 
20466   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated:
20467   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ImmediateFunctionContext:
20468     // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation.
20469     break;
20470 
20471   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated:
20472   case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
20473     return DiagIfReachable(Loc, Stmts, PD);
20474   }
20475 
20476   return false;
20477 }
20478 
DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,const Stmt * Statement,const PartialDiagnostic & PD)20479 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
20480                                const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
20481   return DiagRuntimeBehavior(
20482       Loc, Statement ? llvm::ArrayRef(Statement) : llvm::ArrayRef<Stmt *>(),
20483       PD);
20484 }
20485 
CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType,SourceLocation Loc,CallExpr * CE,FunctionDecl * FD)20486 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
20487                                CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
20488   if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
20489     return false;
20490 
20491   // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return
20492   // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call.
20493   if (ExprEvalContexts.back().ExprContext ==
20494       ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Decltype) {
20495     ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE);
20496     return false;
20497   }
20498 
20499   class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
20500     FunctionDecl *FD;
20501     CallExpr *CE;
20502 
20503   public:
20504     CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE)
20505       : FD(FD), CE(CE) { }
20506 
20507     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
20508       if (!FD) {
20509         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
20510           << T << CE->getSourceRange();
20511         return;
20512       }
20513 
20514       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
20515           << CE->getSourceRange() << FD << T;
20516       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
20517           << FD->getDeclName();
20518     }
20519   } Diagnoser(FD, CE);
20520 
20521   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser))
20522     return true;
20523 
20524   return false;
20525 }
20526 
20527 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
20528 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr * E)20529 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
20530   SourceLocation Loc;
20531 
20532   unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
20533   bool IsOrAssign = false;
20534 
20535   if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
20536     if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
20537       return;
20538 
20539     IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
20540 
20541     // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
20542     if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
20543           = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
20544       Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
20545 
20546       // self = [<foo> init...]
20547       if (ObjC().isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init)
20548         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
20549 
20550       // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
20551       else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
20552         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
20553     }
20554 
20555     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
20556   } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
20557     if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
20558       return;
20559 
20560     IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
20561     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
20562   } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
20563     return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm());
20564   else {
20565     // Not an assignment.
20566     return;
20567   }
20568 
20569   Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
20570 
20571   SourceLocation Open = E->getBeginLoc();
20572   SourceLocation Close = getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
20573   Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
20574         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
20575         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
20576 
20577   if (IsOrAssign)
20578     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
20579       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
20580   else
20581     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
20582       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
20583 }
20584 
DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr * ParenE)20585 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
20586   // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
20587   SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getBeginLoc();
20588   if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
20589     return;
20590   // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
20591   if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
20592     return;
20593 
20594   Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
20595   if (ParenE->isProducedByFoldExpansion() && ParenE->getSubExpr() == E)
20596     return;
20597 
20598   if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
20599     if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
20600         opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
20601                                                            == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
20602       SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
20603 
20604       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
20605       SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange();
20606       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
20607         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin())
20608         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd());
20609       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
20610         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
20611     }
20612 }
20613 
CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc,Expr * E,bool IsConstexpr)20614 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E,
20615                                        bool IsConstexpr) {
20616   DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
20617   if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
20618     DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
20619 
20620   ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
20621   if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20622   E = result.get();
20623 
20624   if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
20625     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
20626       return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E, IsConstexpr); // C++ 6.4p4
20627 
20628     ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
20629     if (ERes.isInvalid())
20630       return ExprError();
20631     E = ERes.get();
20632 
20633     QualType T = E->getType();
20634     if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
20635       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
20636         << T << E->getSourceRange();
20637       return ExprError();
20638     }
20639     CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc);
20640   }
20641 
20642   return E;
20643 }
20644 
ActOnCondition(Scope * S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * SubExpr,ConditionKind CK,bool MissingOK)20645 Sema::ConditionResult Sema::ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
20646                                            Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK,
20647                                            bool MissingOK) {
20648   // MissingOK indicates whether having no condition expression is valid
20649   // (for loop) or invalid (e.g. while loop).
20650   if (!SubExpr)
20651     return MissingOK ? ConditionResult() : ConditionError();
20652 
20653   ExprResult Cond;
20654   switch (CK) {
20655   case ConditionKind::Boolean:
20656     Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr);
20657     break;
20658 
20659   case ConditionKind::ConstexprIf:
20660     // Note: this might produce a FullExpr
20661     Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr, true);
20662     break;
20663 
20664   case ConditionKind::Switch:
20665     Cond = CheckSwitchCondition(Loc, SubExpr);
20666     break;
20667   }
20668   if (Cond.isInvalid()) {
20669     Cond = CreateRecoveryExpr(SubExpr->getBeginLoc(), SubExpr->getEndLoc(),
20670                               {SubExpr}, PreferredConditionType(CK));
20671     if (!Cond.get())
20672       return ConditionError();
20673   } else if (Cond.isUsable() && !isa<FullExpr>(Cond.get()))
20674     Cond = ActOnFinishFullExpr(Cond.get(), Loc, /*DiscardedValue*/ false);
20675 
20676   if (!Cond.isUsable())
20677     return ConditionError();
20678 
20679   return ConditionResult(*this, nullptr, Cond,
20680                          CK == ConditionKind::ConstexprIf);
20681 }
20682 
20683 namespace {
20684   /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
20685   /// to have an appropriate type.
20686   struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
20687     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
20688 
20689     Sema &S;
20690 
RebuildUnknownAnyFunction__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20691     RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
20692 
VisitStmt__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20693     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
20694       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
20695     }
20696 
VisitExpr__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20697     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
20698       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
20699         << E->getSourceRange();
20700       return ExprError();
20701     }
20702 
20703     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
20704     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
rebuildSugarExpr__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20705     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
20706       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
20707       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20708 
20709       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
20710       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
20711       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
20712       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
20713       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20714       return E;
20715     }
20716 
VisitParenExpr__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20717     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
20718       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
20719     }
20720 
VisitUnaryExtension__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20721     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
20722       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
20723     }
20724 
VisitUnaryAddrOf__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20725     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
20726       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
20727       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20728 
20729       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
20730       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
20731       E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
20732       assert(E->isPRValue());
20733       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20734       return E;
20735     }
20736 
resolveDecl__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20737     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
20738       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
20739 
20740       E->setType(VD->getType());
20741 
20742       assert(E->isPRValue());
20743       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
20744           !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
20745             cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
20746         E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
20747 
20748       return E;
20749     }
20750 
VisitMemberExpr__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20751     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
20752       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
20753     }
20754 
VisitDeclRefExpr__anon9e9a06343611::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction20755     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
20756       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
20757     }
20758   };
20759 }
20760 
20761 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
20762 /// to have a function type.
rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema & S,Expr * FunctionExpr)20763 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
20764   ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
20765   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20766   return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get());
20767 }
20768 
20769 namespace {
20770   /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
20771   /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
20772   /// expression.  Strict preservation of the original source
20773   /// structure is not a goal.
20774   struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
20775     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
20776 
20777     Sema &S;
20778 
20779     /// The current destination type.
20780     QualType DestType;
20781 
RebuildUnknownAnyExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20782     RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
20783       : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
20784 
VisitStmt__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20785     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
20786       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
20787     }
20788 
VisitExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20789     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
20790       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
20791         << E->getSourceRange();
20792       return ExprError();
20793     }
20794 
20795     ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
20796     ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
20797 
20798     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
20799     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
rebuildSugarExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20800     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
20801       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
20802       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20803       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
20804       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
20805       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
20806       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
20807       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20808       return E;
20809     }
20810 
VisitParenExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20811     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
20812       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
20813     }
20814 
VisitUnaryExtension__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20815     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
20816       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
20817     }
20818 
VisitUnaryAddrOf__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20819     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
20820       const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
20821       if (!Ptr) {
20822         S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
20823           << E->getSourceRange();
20824         return ExprError();
20825       }
20826 
20827       if (isa<CallExpr>(E->getSubExpr())) {
20828         S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof_call)
20829           << E->getSourceRange();
20830         return ExprError();
20831       }
20832 
20833       assert(E->isPRValue());
20834       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20835       E->setType(DestType);
20836 
20837       // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
20838       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
20839       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
20840       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
20841       E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get());
20842       return E;
20843     }
20844 
20845     ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
20846 
20847     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
20848 
VisitMemberExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20849     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
20850       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
20851     }
20852 
VisitDeclRefExpr__anon9e9a06343711::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr20853     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
20854       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
20855     }
20856   };
20857 }
20858 
20859 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
VisitCallExpr(CallExpr * E)20860 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
20861   Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
20862 
20863   enum FnKind {
20864     FK_MemberFunction,
20865     FK_FunctionPointer,
20866     FK_BlockPointer
20867   };
20868 
20869   FnKind Kind;
20870   QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
20871   if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
20872     assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
20873     Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
20874     CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
20875   } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
20876     CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
20877     Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
20878   } else {
20879     CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
20880     Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
20881   }
20882   const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
20883 
20884   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
20885   if ((DestType->isArrayType() && !S.getLangOpts().allowArrayReturnTypes()) ||
20886       DestType->isFunctionType()) {
20887     unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
20888     if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
20889       diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
20890 
20891     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
20892       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
20893     return ExprError();
20894   }
20895 
20896   // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
20897   E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
20898   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
20899   assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20900 
20901   // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
20902   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
20903   if (Proto) {
20904     // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when
20905     // it has no idea what a function's signature is.
20906     //
20907     // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R
20908     // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++
20909     // would foul up all sorts of assumptions.  However, we cannot
20910     // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we
20911     // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see
20912     // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic.
20913     // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to
20914     // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype
20915     // "A foo(B,C,D,...);".  The only known exception is with the
20916     // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl
20917     // regardless of its normal CC.  Therefore we change the parameter
20918     // types to match the types of the arguments.
20919     //
20920     // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the
20921     // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST.
20922 
20923     ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes();
20924     SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
20925     if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case
20926       ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs());
20927       for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) {
20928         ArgTypes.push_back(S.Context.getReferenceQualifiedType(E->getArg(i)));
20929       }
20930       ParamTypes = ArgTypes;
20931     }
20932     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes,
20933                                          Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
20934   } else {
20935     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
20936                                                 FnType->getExtInfo());
20937   }
20938 
20939   // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
20940   switch (Kind) {
20941   case FK_MemberFunction:
20942     // Nothing to do.
20943     break;
20944 
20945   case FK_FunctionPointer:
20946     DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
20947     break;
20948 
20949   case FK_BlockPointer:
20950     DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
20951     break;
20952   }
20953 
20954   // Finally, we can recurse.
20955   ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
20956   if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
20957   E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get());
20958 
20959   // Bind a temporary if necessary.
20960   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
20961 }
20962 
VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr * E)20963 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
20964   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
20965   if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
20966     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
20967       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
20968     return ExprError();
20969   }
20970 
20971   // Rewrite the method result type if available.
20972   if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
20973     assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
20974     Method->setReturnType(DestType);
20975   }
20976 
20977   // Change the type of the message.
20978   E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
20979   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
20980 
20981   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
20982 }
20983 
VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr * E)20984 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
20985   // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
20986   if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) {
20987     assert(E->isPRValue());
20988     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
20989 
20990     E->setType(DestType);
20991 
20992     // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
20993     DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
20994 
20995     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
20996     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
20997 
20998     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
20999     return E;
21000   } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
21001     assert(E->isPRValue());
21002     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
21003 
21004     assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType()));
21005 
21006     E->setType(DestType);
21007 
21008     // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such.
21009     DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType);
21010 
21011     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
21012     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
21013 
21014     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
21015     return E;
21016   } else {
21017     llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!");
21018   }
21019 }
21020 
resolveDecl(Expr * E,ValueDecl * VD)21021 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
21022   ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
21023   QualType Type = DestType;
21024 
21025   // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
21026 
21027   //  - functions
21028   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
21029     if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
21030       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
21031       ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
21032       if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
21033       return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
21034                                  VK_PRValue);
21035     }
21036 
21037     if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
21038       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
21039         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
21040       return ExprError();
21041     }
21042     if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
21043       // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in
21044       // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown
21045       // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine.
21046       QualType FDT = FD->getType();
21047       const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>();
21048       const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
21049       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
21050       if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) {
21051         SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
21052         FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(
21053             S.Context, FD->getDeclContext(), Loc, Loc,
21054             FD->getNameInfo().getName(), DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
21055             SC_None, S.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
21056             false /*isInlineSpecified*/, FD->hasPrototype(),
21057             /*ConstexprKind*/ ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified);
21058 
21059         if (FD->getQualifier())
21060           NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc());
21061 
21062         SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
21063         for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
21064           ParmVarDecl *Param =
21065             S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI);
21066           Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
21067           Params.push_back(Param);
21068         }
21069         NewFD->setParams(Params);
21070         DRE->setDecl(NewFD);
21071         VD = DRE->getDecl();
21072       }
21073     }
21074 
21075     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
21076       if (MD->isInstance()) {
21077         ValueKind = VK_PRValue;
21078         Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
21079       }
21080 
21081     // Function references aren't l-values in C.
21082     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
21083       ValueKind = VK_PRValue;
21084 
21085   //  - variables
21086   } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
21087     if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
21088       Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
21089     } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
21090       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
21091         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
21092       return ExprError();
21093     }
21094 
21095   //  - nothing else
21096   } else {
21097     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
21098       << VD << E->getSourceRange();
21099     return ExprError();
21100   }
21101 
21102   // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but
21103   // also really dangerous.
21104   VD->setType(DestType);
21105   E->setType(Type);
21106   E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
21107   return E;
21108 }
21109 
checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange,QualType CastType,Expr * CastExpr,CastKind & CastKind,ExprValueKind & VK,CXXCastPath & Path)21110 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
21111                                      Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
21112                                      ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
21113   // The type we're casting to must be either void or complete.
21114   if (!CastType->isVoidType() &&
21115       RequireCompleteType(TypeRange.getBegin(), CastType,
21116                           diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
21117     return ExprError();
21118 
21119   // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
21120   ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
21121   if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
21122 
21123   CastExpr = result.get();
21124   VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
21125   CastKind = CK_NoOp;
21126 
21127   return CastExpr;
21128 }
21129 
forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr * E,QualType ToType)21130 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) {
21131   return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E);
21132 }
21133 
checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,Expr * arg,QualType & paramType)21134 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,
21135                                     Expr *arg, QualType &paramType) {
21136   // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of
21137   // any sort, just do default argument promotion.
21138   ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens());
21139   if (!castArg) {
21140     ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg);
21141     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
21142     paramType = result.get()->getType();
21143     return result;
21144   }
21145 
21146   // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast.
21147   assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType());
21148   paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten();
21149 
21150   // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type.
21151   InitializedEntity entity =
21152     InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType,
21153                                            /*consumed*/ false);
21154   return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg);
21155 }
21156 
diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema & S,Expr * E)21157 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
21158   Expr *orig = E;
21159   unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
21160   while (true) {
21161     E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
21162     if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
21163       E = call->getCallee();
21164       diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
21165     } else {
21166       break;
21167     }
21168   }
21169 
21170   SourceLocation loc;
21171   NamedDecl *d;
21172   if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
21173     loc = ref->getLocation();
21174     d = ref->getDecl();
21175   } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
21176     loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
21177     d = mem->getMemberDecl();
21178   } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
21179     diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
21180     loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
21181     d = msg->getMethodDecl();
21182     if (!d) {
21183       S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
21184         << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
21185         << orig->getSourceRange();
21186       return ExprError();
21187     }
21188   } else {
21189     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
21190       << E->getSourceRange();
21191     return ExprError();
21192   }
21193 
21194   S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
21195 
21196   // Never recoverable.
21197   return ExprError();
21198 }
21199 
CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr * E)21200 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
21201   const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType();
21202   if (!placeholderType) return E;
21203 
21204   switch (placeholderType->getKind()) {
21205   case BuiltinType::UnresolvedTemplate: {
21206     auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E);
21207     const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo = ULE->getNameInfo();
21208     // There's only one FoundDecl for UnresolvedTemplate type. See
21209     // BuildTemplateIdExpr.
21210     NamedDecl *Temp = *ULE->decls_begin();
21211     const bool IsTypeAliasTemplateDecl = isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Temp);
21212 
21213     NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = ULE->getQualifierLoc().getNestedNameSpecifier();
21214     // FIXME: AssumedTemplate is not very appropriate for error recovery here,
21215     // as it models only the unqualified-id case, where this case can clearly be
21216     // qualified. Thus we can't just qualify an assumed template.
21217     TemplateName TN;
21218     if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(Temp))
21219       TN = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(NNS, ULE->hasTemplateKeyword(),
21220                                             TemplateName(TD));
21221     else
21222       TN = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
21223 
21224     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_template_kw_refers_to_type_template)
21225         << TN << ULE->getSourceRange() << IsTypeAliasTemplateDecl;
21226     Diag(Temp->getLocation(), diag::note_referenced_type_template)
21227         << IsTypeAliasTemplateDecl;
21228 
21229     TemplateArgumentListInfo TAL(ULE->getLAngleLoc(), ULE->getRAngleLoc());
21230     bool HasAnyDependentTA = false;
21231     for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : ULE->template_arguments()) {
21232       HasAnyDependentTA |= Arg.getArgument().isDependent();
21233       TAL.addArgument(Arg);
21234     }
21235 
21236     QualType TST;
21237     {
21238       SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
21239       TST = CheckTemplateIdType(TN, NameInfo.getBeginLoc(), TAL);
21240     }
21241     if (TST.isNull())
21242       TST = Context.getTemplateSpecializationType(
21243           TN, ULE->template_arguments(), /*CanonicalArgs=*/{},
21244           HasAnyDependentTA ? Context.DependentTy : Context.IntTy);
21245     QualType ET =
21246         Context.getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword::None, NNS, TST);
21247     return CreateRecoveryExpr(NameInfo.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo.getEndLoc(), {},
21248                               ET);
21249   }
21250 
21251   // Overloaded expressions.
21252   case BuiltinType::Overload: {
21253     // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
21254     // This is obligatory.
21255     ExprResult Result = E;
21256     if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Result, false))
21257       return Result;
21258 
21259     // No guarantees that ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization
21260     // leaves Result unchanged on failure.
21261     Result = E;
21262     if (resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Result))
21263       return Result;
21264 
21265     // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
21266     tryToRecoverWithCall(Result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
21267                          /*complain*/ true);
21268     return Result;
21269   }
21270 
21271   // Bound member functions.
21272   case BuiltinType::BoundMember: {
21273     ExprResult result = E;
21274     const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens();
21275     PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function);
21276     // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize.
21277     if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) {
21278       PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1;
21279     } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) {
21280       if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() ==
21281           DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName)
21282         PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0;
21283     }
21284     tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD,
21285                          /*complain*/ true);
21286     return result;
21287   }
21288 
21289   // ARC unbridged casts.
21290   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: {
21291     Expr *realCast = ObjC().stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
21292     ObjC().diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast);
21293     return realCast;
21294   }
21295 
21296   // Expressions of unknown type.
21297   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
21298     return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
21299 
21300   // Pseudo-objects.
21301   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
21302     return PseudoObject().checkRValue(E);
21303 
21304   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: {
21305     // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr.
21306     auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
21307     if (DRE) {
21308       auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
21309       unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID();
21310       if (BuiltinID == Builtin::BI__noop) {
21311         E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()),
21312                               CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr)
21313                 .get();
21314         return CallExpr::Create(Context, E, /*Args=*/{}, Context.IntTy,
21315                                 VK_PRValue, SourceLocation(),
21316                                 FPOptionsOverride());
21317       }
21318 
21319       if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID)) {
21320         // Any use of these other than a direct call is ill-formed as of C++20,
21321         // because they are not addressable functions. In earlier language
21322         // modes, warn and force an instantiation of the real body.
21323         Diag(E->getBeginLoc(),
21324              getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
21325                  ? diag::err_use_of_unaddressable_function
21326                  : diag::warn_cxx20_compat_use_of_unaddressable_function);
21327         if (FD->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
21328           // Require a definition here because a normal attempt at
21329           // instantiation for a builtin will be ignored, and we won't try
21330           // again later. We assume that the definition of the template
21331           // precedes this use.
21332           InstantiateFunctionDefinition(E->getBeginLoc(), FD,
21333                                         /*Recursive=*/false,
21334                                         /*DefinitionRequired=*/true,
21335                                         /*AtEndOfTU=*/false);
21336         }
21337         // Produce a properly-typed reference to the function.
21338         CXXScopeSpec SS;
21339         SS.Adopt(DRE->getQualifierLoc());
21340         TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs;
21341         DRE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgs);
21342         return BuildDeclRefExpr(
21343             FD, FD->getType(), VK_LValue, DRE->getNameInfo(),
21344             DRE->hasQualifier() ? &SS : nullptr, DRE->getFoundDecl(),
21345             DRE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
21346             DRE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr);
21347       }
21348     }
21349 
21350     Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use);
21351     return ExprError();
21352   }
21353 
21354   case BuiltinType::IncompleteMatrixIdx:
21355     Diag(cast<MatrixSubscriptExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())
21356              ->getRowIdx()
21357              ->getBeginLoc(),
21358          diag::err_matrix_incomplete_index);
21359     return ExprError();
21360 
21361   // Expressions of unknown type.
21362   case BuiltinType::ArraySection:
21363     Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_array_section_use)
21364         << cast<ArraySectionExpr>(E)->isOMPArraySection();
21365     return ExprError();
21366 
21367   // Expressions of unknown type.
21368   case BuiltinType::OMPArrayShaping:
21369     return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_omp_array_shaping_use));
21370 
21371   case BuiltinType::OMPIterator:
21372     return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_omp_iterator_use));
21373 
21374   // Everything else should be impossible.
21375 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
21376   case BuiltinType::Id:
21377 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
21378 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
21379   case BuiltinType::Id:
21380 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
21381 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
21382   case BuiltinType::Id:
21383 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64ACLETypes.def"
21384 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
21385   case BuiltinType::Id:
21386 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
21387 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
21388 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
21389 #define WASM_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
21390 #include "clang/Basic/WebAssemblyReferenceTypes.def"
21391 #define AMDGPU_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, Width, Align) case BuiltinType::Id:
21392 #include "clang/Basic/AMDGPUTypes.def"
21393 #define HLSL_INTANGIBLE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
21394 #include "clang/Basic/HLSLIntangibleTypes.def"
21395 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
21396 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
21397 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
21398     break;
21399   }
21400 
21401   llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!");
21402 }
21403 
CheckCaseExpression(Expr * E)21404 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
21405   if (E->isTypeDependent())
21406     return true;
21407   if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
21408     return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
21409   return false;
21410 }
21411 
CreateRecoveryExpr(SourceLocation Begin,SourceLocation End,ArrayRef<Expr * > SubExprs,QualType T)21412 ExprResult Sema::CreateRecoveryExpr(SourceLocation Begin, SourceLocation End,
21413                                     ArrayRef<Expr *> SubExprs, QualType T) {
21414   if (!Context.getLangOpts().RecoveryAST)
21415     return ExprError();
21416 
21417   if (isSFINAEContext())
21418     return ExprError();
21419 
21420   if (T.isNull() || T->isUndeducedType() ||
21421       !Context.getLangOpts().RecoveryASTType)
21422     // We don't know the concrete type, fallback to dependent type.
21423     T = Context.DependentTy;
21424 
21425   return RecoveryExpr::Create(Context, T, Begin, End, SubExprs);
21426 }
21427